LLVM 22.0.0git
ValueTracking.cpp
Go to the documentation of this file.
1//===- ValueTracking.cpp - Walk computations to compute properties --------===//
2//
3// Part of the LLVM Project, under the Apache License v2.0 with LLVM Exceptions.
4// See https://llvm.org/LICENSE.txt for license information.
5// SPDX-License-Identifier: Apache-2.0 WITH LLVM-exception
6//
7//===----------------------------------------------------------------------===//
8//
9// This file contains routines that help analyze properties that chains of
10// computations have.
11//
12//===----------------------------------------------------------------------===//
13
15#include "llvm/ADT/APFloat.h"
16#include "llvm/ADT/APInt.h"
17#include "llvm/ADT/ArrayRef.h"
19#include "llvm/ADT/STLExtras.h"
20#include "llvm/ADT/ScopeExit.h"
23#include "llvm/ADT/StringRef.h"
33#include "llvm/Analysis/Loads.h"
38#include "llvm/IR/Argument.h"
39#include "llvm/IR/Attributes.h"
40#include "llvm/IR/BasicBlock.h"
41#include "llvm/IR/Constant.h"
44#include "llvm/IR/Constants.h"
47#include "llvm/IR/Dominators.h"
49#include "llvm/IR/Function.h"
51#include "llvm/IR/GlobalAlias.h"
52#include "llvm/IR/GlobalValue.h"
54#include "llvm/IR/InstrTypes.h"
55#include "llvm/IR/Instruction.h"
58#include "llvm/IR/Intrinsics.h"
59#include "llvm/IR/IntrinsicsAArch64.h"
60#include "llvm/IR/IntrinsicsAMDGPU.h"
61#include "llvm/IR/IntrinsicsRISCV.h"
62#include "llvm/IR/IntrinsicsX86.h"
63#include "llvm/IR/LLVMContext.h"
64#include "llvm/IR/Metadata.h"
65#include "llvm/IR/Module.h"
66#include "llvm/IR/Operator.h"
68#include "llvm/IR/Type.h"
69#include "llvm/IR/User.h"
70#include "llvm/IR/Value.h"
79#include <algorithm>
80#include <cassert>
81#include <cstdint>
82#include <optional>
83#include <utility>
84
85using namespace llvm;
86using namespace llvm::PatternMatch;
87
88// Controls the number of uses of the value searched for possible
89// dominating comparisons.
90static cl::opt<unsigned> DomConditionsMaxUses("dom-conditions-max-uses",
91 cl::Hidden, cl::init(20));
92
93/// Maximum number of instructions to check between assume and context
94/// instruction.
95static constexpr unsigned MaxInstrsToCheckForFree = 16;
96
97/// Returns the bitwidth of the given scalar or pointer type. For vector types,
98/// returns the element type's bitwidth.
99static unsigned getBitWidth(Type *Ty, const DataLayout &DL) {
100 if (unsigned BitWidth = Ty->getScalarSizeInBits())
101 return BitWidth;
102
103 return DL.getPointerTypeSizeInBits(Ty);
104}
105
106// Given the provided Value and, potentially, a context instruction, return
107// the preferred context instruction (if any).
108static const Instruction *safeCxtI(const Value *V, const Instruction *CxtI) {
109 // If we've been provided with a context instruction, then use that (provided
110 // it has been inserted).
111 if (CxtI && CxtI->getParent())
112 return CxtI;
113
114 // If the value is really an already-inserted instruction, then use that.
115 CxtI = dyn_cast<Instruction>(V);
116 if (CxtI && CxtI->getParent())
117 return CxtI;
118
119 return nullptr;
120}
121
123 const APInt &DemandedElts,
124 APInt &DemandedLHS, APInt &DemandedRHS) {
125 if (isa<ScalableVectorType>(Shuf->getType())) {
126 assert(DemandedElts == APInt(1,1));
127 DemandedLHS = DemandedRHS = DemandedElts;
128 return true;
129 }
130
131 int NumElts =
132 cast<FixedVectorType>(Shuf->getOperand(0)->getType())->getNumElements();
133 return llvm::getShuffleDemandedElts(NumElts, Shuf->getShuffleMask(),
134 DemandedElts, DemandedLHS, DemandedRHS);
135}
136
137static void computeKnownBits(const Value *V, const APInt &DemandedElts,
138 KnownBits &Known, const SimplifyQuery &Q,
139 unsigned Depth);
140
142 const SimplifyQuery &Q, unsigned Depth) {
143 // Since the number of lanes in a scalable vector is unknown at compile time,
144 // we track one bit which is implicitly broadcast to all lanes. This means
145 // that all lanes in a scalable vector are considered demanded.
146 auto *FVTy = dyn_cast<FixedVectorType>(V->getType());
147 APInt DemandedElts =
148 FVTy ? APInt::getAllOnes(FVTy->getNumElements()) : APInt(1, 1);
149 ::computeKnownBits(V, DemandedElts, Known, Q, Depth);
150}
151
153 const DataLayout &DL, AssumptionCache *AC,
154 const Instruction *CxtI, const DominatorTree *DT,
155 bool UseInstrInfo, unsigned Depth) {
156 computeKnownBits(V, Known,
157 SimplifyQuery(DL, DT, AC, safeCxtI(V, CxtI), UseInstrInfo),
158 Depth);
159}
160
162 AssumptionCache *AC, const Instruction *CxtI,
163 const DominatorTree *DT, bool UseInstrInfo,
164 unsigned Depth) {
165 return computeKnownBits(
166 V, SimplifyQuery(DL, DT, AC, safeCxtI(V, CxtI), UseInstrInfo), Depth);
167}
168
169KnownBits llvm::computeKnownBits(const Value *V, const APInt &DemandedElts,
170 const DataLayout &DL, AssumptionCache *AC,
171 const Instruction *CxtI,
172 const DominatorTree *DT, bool UseInstrInfo,
173 unsigned Depth) {
174 return computeKnownBits(
175 V, DemandedElts,
176 SimplifyQuery(DL, DT, AC, safeCxtI(V, CxtI), UseInstrInfo), Depth);
177}
178
180 const SimplifyQuery &SQ) {
181 // Look for an inverted mask: (X & ~M) op (Y & M).
182 {
183 Value *M;
184 if (match(LHS, m_c_And(m_Not(m_Value(M)), m_Value())) &&
186 isGuaranteedNotToBeUndef(M, SQ.AC, SQ.CxtI, SQ.DT))
187 return true;
188 }
189
190 // X op (Y & ~X)
193 return true;
194
195 // X op ((X & Y) ^ Y) -- this is the canonical form of the previous pattern
196 // for constant Y.
197 Value *Y;
198 if (match(RHS,
200 isGuaranteedNotToBeUndef(LHS, SQ.AC, SQ.CxtI, SQ.DT) &&
201 isGuaranteedNotToBeUndef(Y, SQ.AC, SQ.CxtI, SQ.DT))
202 return true;
203
204 // Peek through extends to find a 'not' of the other side:
205 // (ext Y) op ext(~Y)
206 if (match(LHS, m_ZExtOrSExt(m_Value(Y))) &&
208 isGuaranteedNotToBeUndef(Y, SQ.AC, SQ.CxtI, SQ.DT))
209 return true;
210
211 // Look for: (A & B) op ~(A | B)
212 {
213 Value *A, *B;
214 if (match(LHS, m_And(m_Value(A), m_Value(B))) &&
216 isGuaranteedNotToBeUndef(A, SQ.AC, SQ.CxtI, SQ.DT) &&
217 isGuaranteedNotToBeUndef(B, SQ.AC, SQ.CxtI, SQ.DT))
218 return true;
219 }
220
221 // Look for: (X << V) op (Y >> (BitWidth - V))
222 // or (X >> V) op (Y << (BitWidth - V))
223 {
224 const Value *V;
225 const APInt *R;
226 if (((match(RHS, m_Shl(m_Value(), m_Sub(m_APInt(R), m_Value(V)))) &&
227 match(LHS, m_LShr(m_Value(), m_Specific(V)))) ||
228 (match(RHS, m_LShr(m_Value(), m_Sub(m_APInt(R), m_Value(V)))) &&
229 match(LHS, m_Shl(m_Value(), m_Specific(V))))) &&
230 R->uge(LHS->getType()->getScalarSizeInBits()))
231 return true;
232 }
233
234 return false;
235}
236
238 const WithCache<const Value *> &RHSCache,
239 const SimplifyQuery &SQ) {
240 const Value *LHS = LHSCache.getValue();
241 const Value *RHS = RHSCache.getValue();
242
243 assert(LHS->getType() == RHS->getType() &&
244 "LHS and RHS should have the same type");
245 assert(LHS->getType()->isIntOrIntVectorTy() &&
246 "LHS and RHS should be integers");
247
248 if (haveNoCommonBitsSetSpecialCases(LHS, RHS, SQ) ||
250 return true;
251
253 RHSCache.getKnownBits(SQ));
254}
255
257 return !I->user_empty() &&
258 all_of(I->users(), match_fn(m_ICmp(m_Value(), m_Zero())));
259}
260
262 return !I->user_empty() && all_of(I->users(), [](const User *U) {
263 CmpPredicate P;
264 return match(U, m_ICmp(P, m_Value(), m_Zero())) && ICmpInst::isEquality(P);
265 });
266}
267
269 bool OrZero, AssumptionCache *AC,
270 const Instruction *CxtI,
271 const DominatorTree *DT, bool UseInstrInfo,
272 unsigned Depth) {
273 return ::isKnownToBeAPowerOfTwo(
274 V, OrZero, SimplifyQuery(DL, DT, AC, safeCxtI(V, CxtI), UseInstrInfo),
275 Depth);
276}
277
278static bool isKnownNonZero(const Value *V, const APInt &DemandedElts,
279 const SimplifyQuery &Q, unsigned Depth);
280
282 unsigned Depth) {
283 return computeKnownBits(V, SQ, Depth).isNonNegative();
284}
285
287 unsigned Depth) {
288 if (auto *CI = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(V))
289 return CI->getValue().isStrictlyPositive();
290
291 // If `isKnownNonNegative` ever becomes more sophisticated, make sure to keep
292 // this updated.
293 KnownBits Known = computeKnownBits(V, SQ, Depth);
294 return Known.isNonNegative() &&
295 (Known.isNonZero() || isKnownNonZero(V, SQ, Depth));
296}
297
299 unsigned Depth) {
300 return computeKnownBits(V, SQ, Depth).isNegative();
301}
302
303static bool isKnownNonEqual(const Value *V1, const Value *V2,
304 const APInt &DemandedElts, const SimplifyQuery &Q,
305 unsigned Depth);
306
307bool llvm::isKnownNonEqual(const Value *V1, const Value *V2,
308 const SimplifyQuery &Q, unsigned Depth) {
309 // We don't support looking through casts.
310 if (V1 == V2 || V1->getType() != V2->getType())
311 return false;
312 auto *FVTy = dyn_cast<FixedVectorType>(V1->getType());
313 APInt DemandedElts =
314 FVTy ? APInt::getAllOnes(FVTy->getNumElements()) : APInt(1, 1);
315 return ::isKnownNonEqual(V1, V2, DemandedElts, Q, Depth);
316}
317
318bool llvm::MaskedValueIsZero(const Value *V, const APInt &Mask,
319 const SimplifyQuery &SQ, unsigned Depth) {
320 KnownBits Known(Mask.getBitWidth());
321 computeKnownBits(V, Known, SQ, Depth);
322 return Mask.isSubsetOf(Known.Zero);
323}
324
325static unsigned ComputeNumSignBits(const Value *V, const APInt &DemandedElts,
326 const SimplifyQuery &Q, unsigned Depth);
327
328static unsigned ComputeNumSignBits(const Value *V, const SimplifyQuery &Q,
329 unsigned Depth = 0) {
330 auto *FVTy = dyn_cast<FixedVectorType>(V->getType());
331 APInt DemandedElts =
332 FVTy ? APInt::getAllOnes(FVTy->getNumElements()) : APInt(1, 1);
333 return ComputeNumSignBits(V, DemandedElts, Q, Depth);
334}
335
336unsigned llvm::ComputeNumSignBits(const Value *V, const DataLayout &DL,
337 AssumptionCache *AC, const Instruction *CxtI,
338 const DominatorTree *DT, bool UseInstrInfo,
339 unsigned Depth) {
340 return ::ComputeNumSignBits(
341 V, SimplifyQuery(DL, DT, AC, safeCxtI(V, CxtI), UseInstrInfo), Depth);
342}
343
345 AssumptionCache *AC,
346 const Instruction *CxtI,
347 const DominatorTree *DT,
348 unsigned Depth) {
349 unsigned SignBits = ComputeNumSignBits(V, DL, AC, CxtI, DT, Depth);
350 return V->getType()->getScalarSizeInBits() - SignBits + 1;
351}
352
353/// Try to detect the lerp pattern: a * (b - c) + c * d
354/// where a >= 0, b >= 0, c >= 0, d >= 0, and b >= c.
355///
356/// In that particular case, we can use the following chain of reasoning:
357///
358/// a * (b - c) + c * d <= a' * (b - c) + a' * c = a' * b where a' = max(a, d)
359///
360/// Since that is true for arbitrary a, b, c and d within our constraints, we
361/// can conclude that:
362///
363/// max(a * (b - c) + c * d) <= max(max(a), max(d)) * max(b) = U
364///
365/// Considering that any result of the lerp would be less or equal to U, it
366/// would have at least the number of leading 0s as in U.
367///
368/// While being quite a specific situation, it is fairly common in computer
369/// graphics in the shape of alpha blending.
370///
371/// Modifies given KnownOut in-place with the inferred information.
372static void computeKnownBitsFromLerpPattern(const Value *Op0, const Value *Op1,
373 const APInt &DemandedElts,
374 KnownBits &KnownOut,
375 const SimplifyQuery &Q,
376 unsigned Depth) {
377
378 Type *Ty = Op0->getType();
379 const unsigned BitWidth = Ty->getScalarSizeInBits();
380
381 // Only handle scalar types for now
382 if (Ty->isVectorTy())
383 return;
384
385 // Try to match: a * (b - c) + c * d.
386 // When a == 1 => A == nullptr, the same applies to d/D as well.
387 const Value *A = nullptr, *B = nullptr, *C = nullptr, *D = nullptr;
388 const Instruction *SubBC = nullptr;
389
390 const auto MatchSubBC = [&]() {
391 // (b - c) can have two forms that interest us:
392 //
393 // 1. sub nuw %b, %c
394 // 2. xor %c, %b
395 //
396 // For the first case, nuw flag guarantees our requirement b >= c.
397 //
398 // The second case might happen when the analysis can infer that b is a mask
399 // for c and we can transform sub operation into xor (that is usually true
400 // for constant b's). Even though xor is symmetrical, canonicalization
401 // ensures that the constant will be the RHS. We have additional checks
402 // later on to ensure that this xor operation is equivalent to subtraction.
404 m_Xor(m_Value(C), m_Value(B))));
405 };
406
407 const auto MatchASubBC = [&]() {
408 // Cases:
409 // - a * (b - c)
410 // - (b - c) * a
411 // - (b - c) <- a implicitly equals 1
412 return m_CombineOr(m_c_Mul(m_Value(A), MatchSubBC()), MatchSubBC());
413 };
414
415 const auto MatchCD = [&]() {
416 // Cases:
417 // - d * c
418 // - c * d
419 // - c <- d implicitly equals 1
421 };
422
423 const auto Match = [&](const Value *LHS, const Value *RHS) {
424 // We do use m_Specific(C) in MatchCD, so we have to make sure that
425 // it's bound to anything and match(LHS, MatchASubBC()) absolutely
426 // has to evaluate first and return true.
427 //
428 // If Match returns true, it is guaranteed that B != nullptr, C != nullptr.
429 return match(LHS, MatchASubBC()) && match(RHS, MatchCD());
430 };
431
432 if (!Match(Op0, Op1) && !Match(Op1, Op0))
433 return;
434
435 const auto ComputeKnownBitsOrOne = [&](const Value *V) {
436 // For some of the values we use the convention of leaving
437 // it nullptr to signify an implicit constant 1.
438 return V ? computeKnownBits(V, DemandedElts, Q, Depth + 1)
440 };
441
442 // Check that all operands are non-negative
443 const KnownBits KnownA = ComputeKnownBitsOrOne(A);
444 if (!KnownA.isNonNegative())
445 return;
446
447 const KnownBits KnownD = ComputeKnownBitsOrOne(D);
448 if (!KnownD.isNonNegative())
449 return;
450
451 const KnownBits KnownB = computeKnownBits(B, DemandedElts, Q, Depth + 1);
452 if (!KnownB.isNonNegative())
453 return;
454
455 const KnownBits KnownC = computeKnownBits(C, DemandedElts, Q, Depth + 1);
456 if (!KnownC.isNonNegative())
457 return;
458
459 // If we matched subtraction as xor, we need to actually check that xor
460 // is semantically equivalent to subtraction.
461 //
462 // For that to be true, b has to be a mask for c or that b's known
463 // ones cover all known and possible ones of c.
464 if (SubBC->getOpcode() == Instruction::Xor &&
465 !KnownC.getMaxValue().isSubsetOf(KnownB.getMinValue()))
466 return;
467
468 const APInt MaxA = KnownA.getMaxValue();
469 const APInt MaxD = KnownD.getMaxValue();
470 const APInt MaxAD = APIntOps::umax(MaxA, MaxD);
471 const APInt MaxB = KnownB.getMaxValue();
472
473 // We can't infer leading zeros info if the upper-bound estimate wraps.
474 bool Overflow;
475 const APInt UpperBound = MaxAD.umul_ov(MaxB, Overflow);
476
477 if (Overflow)
478 return;
479
480 // If we know that x <= y and both are positive than x has at least the same
481 // number of leading zeros as y.
482 const unsigned MinimumNumberOfLeadingZeros = UpperBound.countl_zero();
483 KnownOut.Zero.setHighBits(MinimumNumberOfLeadingZeros);
484}
485
486static void computeKnownBitsAddSub(bool Add, const Value *Op0, const Value *Op1,
487 bool NSW, bool NUW,
488 const APInt &DemandedElts,
489 KnownBits &KnownOut, KnownBits &Known2,
490 const SimplifyQuery &Q, unsigned Depth) {
491 computeKnownBits(Op1, DemandedElts, KnownOut, Q, Depth + 1);
492
493 // If one operand is unknown and we have no nowrap information,
494 // the result will be unknown independently of the second operand.
495 if (KnownOut.isUnknown() && !NSW && !NUW)
496 return;
497
498 computeKnownBits(Op0, DemandedElts, Known2, Q, Depth + 1);
499 KnownOut = KnownBits::computeForAddSub(Add, NSW, NUW, Known2, KnownOut);
500
501 if (!Add && NSW && !KnownOut.isNonNegative() &&
503 .value_or(false))
504 KnownOut.makeNonNegative();
505
506 if (Add)
507 // Try to match lerp pattern and combine results
508 computeKnownBitsFromLerpPattern(Op0, Op1, DemandedElts, KnownOut, Q, Depth);
509}
510
511static void computeKnownBitsMul(const Value *Op0, const Value *Op1, bool NSW,
512 bool NUW, const APInt &DemandedElts,
513 KnownBits &Known, KnownBits &Known2,
514 const SimplifyQuery &Q, unsigned Depth) {
515 computeKnownBits(Op1, DemandedElts, Known, Q, Depth + 1);
516 computeKnownBits(Op0, DemandedElts, Known2, Q, Depth + 1);
517
518 bool isKnownNegative = false;
519 bool isKnownNonNegative = false;
520 // If the multiplication is known not to overflow, compute the sign bit.
521 if (NSW) {
522 if (Op0 == Op1) {
523 // The product of a number with itself is non-negative.
524 isKnownNonNegative = true;
525 } else {
526 bool isKnownNonNegativeOp1 = Known.isNonNegative();
527 bool isKnownNonNegativeOp0 = Known2.isNonNegative();
528 bool isKnownNegativeOp1 = Known.isNegative();
529 bool isKnownNegativeOp0 = Known2.isNegative();
530 // The product of two numbers with the same sign is non-negative.
531 isKnownNonNegative = (isKnownNegativeOp1 && isKnownNegativeOp0) ||
532 (isKnownNonNegativeOp1 && isKnownNonNegativeOp0);
533 if (!isKnownNonNegative && NUW) {
534 // mul nuw nsw with a factor > 1 is non-negative.
536 isKnownNonNegative = KnownBits::sgt(Known, One).value_or(false) ||
537 KnownBits::sgt(Known2, One).value_or(false);
538 }
539
540 // The product of a negative number and a non-negative number is either
541 // negative or zero.
544 (isKnownNegativeOp1 && isKnownNonNegativeOp0 &&
545 Known2.isNonZero()) ||
546 (isKnownNegativeOp0 && isKnownNonNegativeOp1 && Known.isNonZero());
547 }
548 }
549
550 bool SelfMultiply = Op0 == Op1;
551 if (SelfMultiply)
552 SelfMultiply &=
553 isGuaranteedNotToBeUndef(Op0, Q.AC, Q.CxtI, Q.DT, Depth + 1);
554 Known = KnownBits::mul(Known, Known2, SelfMultiply);
555
556 if (SelfMultiply) {
557 unsigned SignBits = ComputeNumSignBits(Op0, DemandedElts, Q, Depth + 1);
558 unsigned TyBits = Op0->getType()->getScalarSizeInBits();
559 unsigned OutValidBits = 2 * (TyBits - SignBits + 1);
560
561 if (OutValidBits < TyBits) {
562 APInt KnownZeroMask =
563 APInt::getHighBitsSet(TyBits, TyBits - OutValidBits + 1);
564 Known.Zero |= KnownZeroMask;
565 }
566 }
567
568 // Only make use of no-wrap flags if we failed to compute the sign bit
569 // directly. This matters if the multiplication always overflows, in
570 // which case we prefer to follow the result of the direct computation,
571 // though as the program is invoking undefined behaviour we can choose
572 // whatever we like here.
573 if (isKnownNonNegative && !Known.isNegative())
574 Known.makeNonNegative();
575 else if (isKnownNegative && !Known.isNonNegative())
576 Known.makeNegative();
577}
578
580 KnownBits &Known) {
581 unsigned BitWidth = Known.getBitWidth();
582 unsigned NumRanges = Ranges.getNumOperands() / 2;
583 assert(NumRanges >= 1);
584
585 Known.setAllConflict();
586
587 for (unsigned i = 0; i < NumRanges; ++i) {
589 mdconst::extract<ConstantInt>(Ranges.getOperand(2 * i + 0));
591 mdconst::extract<ConstantInt>(Ranges.getOperand(2 * i + 1));
592 ConstantRange Range(Lower->getValue(), Upper->getValue());
593 // BitWidth must equal the Ranges BitWidth for the correct number of high
594 // bits to be set.
595 assert(BitWidth == Range.getBitWidth() &&
596 "Known bit width must match range bit width!");
597
598 // The first CommonPrefixBits of all values in Range are equal.
599 unsigned CommonPrefixBits =
600 (Range.getUnsignedMax() ^ Range.getUnsignedMin()).countl_zero();
601 APInt Mask = APInt::getHighBitsSet(BitWidth, CommonPrefixBits);
602 APInt UnsignedMax = Range.getUnsignedMax().zextOrTrunc(BitWidth);
603 Known.One &= UnsignedMax & Mask;
604 Known.Zero &= ~UnsignedMax & Mask;
605 }
606}
607
608static bool isEphemeralValueOf(const Instruction *I, const Value *E) {
612
613 // The instruction defining an assumption's condition itself is always
614 // considered ephemeral to that assumption (even if it has other
615 // non-ephemeral users). See r246696's test case for an example.
616 if (is_contained(I->operands(), E))
617 return true;
618
619 while (!WorkSet.empty()) {
620 const Instruction *V = WorkSet.pop_back_val();
621 if (!Visited.insert(V).second)
622 continue;
623
624 // If all uses of this value are ephemeral, then so is this value.
625 if (all_of(V->users(), [&](const User *U) {
626 return EphValues.count(cast<Instruction>(U));
627 })) {
628 if (V == E)
629 return true;
630
631 if (V == I || (!V->mayHaveSideEffects() && !V->isTerminator())) {
632 EphValues.insert(V);
633
634 if (const User *U = dyn_cast<User>(V)) {
635 for (const Use &U : U->operands()) {
636 if (const auto *I = dyn_cast<Instruction>(U.get()))
637 WorkSet.push_back(I);
638 }
639 }
640 }
641 }
642 }
643
644 return false;
645}
646
647// Is this an intrinsic that cannot be speculated but also cannot trap?
649 if (const IntrinsicInst *CI = dyn_cast<IntrinsicInst>(I))
650 return CI->isAssumeLikeIntrinsic();
651
652 return false;
653}
654
656 const Instruction *CxtI,
657 const DominatorTree *DT,
658 bool AllowEphemerals) {
659 // There are two restrictions on the use of an assume:
660 // 1. The assume must dominate the context (or the control flow must
661 // reach the assume whenever it reaches the context).
662 // 2. The context must not be in the assume's set of ephemeral values
663 // (otherwise we will use the assume to prove that the condition
664 // feeding the assume is trivially true, thus causing the removal of
665 // the assume).
666
667 if (Inv->getParent() == CxtI->getParent()) {
668 // If Inv and CtxI are in the same block, check if the assume (Inv) is first
669 // in the BB.
670 if (Inv->comesBefore(CxtI))
671 return true;
672
673 // Don't let an assume affect itself - this would cause the problems
674 // `isEphemeralValueOf` is trying to prevent, and it would also make
675 // the loop below go out of bounds.
676 if (!AllowEphemerals && Inv == CxtI)
677 return false;
678
679 // The context comes first, but they're both in the same block.
680 // Make sure there is nothing in between that might interrupt
681 // the control flow, not even CxtI itself.
682 // We limit the scan distance between the assume and its context instruction
683 // to avoid a compile-time explosion. This limit is chosen arbitrarily, so
684 // it can be adjusted if needed (could be turned into a cl::opt).
685 auto Range = make_range(CxtI->getIterator(), Inv->getIterator());
687 return false;
688
689 return AllowEphemerals || !isEphemeralValueOf(Inv, CxtI);
690 }
691
692 // Inv and CxtI are in different blocks.
693 if (DT) {
694 if (DT->dominates(Inv, CxtI))
695 return true;
696 } else if (Inv->getParent() == CxtI->getParent()->getSinglePredecessor() ||
697 Inv->getParent()->isEntryBlock()) {
698 // We don't have a DT, but this trivially dominates.
699 return true;
700 }
701
702 return false;
703}
704
706 const Instruction *CtxI) {
707 // Helper to check if there are any calls in the range that may free memory.
708 auto hasNoFreeCalls = [](auto Range) {
709 for (const auto &[Idx, I] : enumerate(Range)) {
710 if (Idx > MaxInstrsToCheckForFree)
711 return false;
712 if (const auto *CB = dyn_cast<CallBase>(&I))
713 if (!CB->hasFnAttr(Attribute::NoFree))
714 return false;
715 }
716 return true;
717 };
718
719 // Make sure the current function cannot arrange for another thread to free on
720 // its behalf.
721 if (!CtxI->getFunction()->hasNoSync())
722 return false;
723
724 // Handle cross-block case: CtxI in a successor of Assume's block.
725 const BasicBlock *CtxBB = CtxI->getParent();
726 const BasicBlock *AssumeBB = Assume->getParent();
727 BasicBlock::const_iterator CtxIter = CtxI->getIterator();
728 if (CtxBB != AssumeBB) {
729 if (CtxBB->getSinglePredecessor() != AssumeBB)
730 return false;
731
732 if (!hasNoFreeCalls(make_range(CtxBB->begin(), CtxIter)))
733 return false;
734
735 CtxIter = AssumeBB->end();
736 } else {
737 // Same block case: check that Assume comes before CtxI.
738 if (!Assume->comesBefore(CtxI))
739 return false;
740 }
741
742 // Check if there are any calls between Assume and CtxIter that may free
743 // memory.
744 return hasNoFreeCalls(make_range(Assume->getIterator(), CtxIter));
745}
746
747// TODO: cmpExcludesZero misses many cases where `RHS` is non-constant but
748// we still have enough information about `RHS` to conclude non-zero. For
749// example Pred=EQ, RHS=isKnownNonZero. cmpExcludesZero is called in loops
750// so the extra compile time may not be worth it, but possibly a second API
751// should be created for use outside of loops.
752static bool cmpExcludesZero(CmpInst::Predicate Pred, const Value *RHS) {
753 // v u> y implies v != 0.
754 if (Pred == ICmpInst::ICMP_UGT)
755 return true;
756
757 // Special-case v != 0 to also handle v != null.
758 if (Pred == ICmpInst::ICMP_NE)
759 return match(RHS, m_Zero());
760
761 // All other predicates - rely on generic ConstantRange handling.
762 const APInt *C;
763 auto Zero = APInt::getZero(RHS->getType()->getScalarSizeInBits());
764 if (match(RHS, m_APInt(C))) {
766 return !TrueValues.contains(Zero);
767 }
768
770 if (VC == nullptr)
771 return false;
772
773 for (unsigned ElemIdx = 0, NElem = VC->getNumElements(); ElemIdx < NElem;
774 ++ElemIdx) {
776 Pred, VC->getElementAsAPInt(ElemIdx));
777 if (TrueValues.contains(Zero))
778 return false;
779 }
780 return true;
781}
782
783static void breakSelfRecursivePHI(const Use *U, const PHINode *PHI,
784 Value *&ValOut, Instruction *&CtxIOut,
785 const PHINode **PhiOut = nullptr) {
786 ValOut = U->get();
787 if (ValOut == PHI)
788 return;
789 CtxIOut = PHI->getIncomingBlock(*U)->getTerminator();
790 if (PhiOut)
791 *PhiOut = PHI;
792 Value *V;
793 // If the Use is a select of this phi, compute analysis on other arm to break
794 // recursion.
795 // TODO: Min/Max
796 if (match(ValOut, m_Select(m_Value(), m_Specific(PHI), m_Value(V))) ||
797 match(ValOut, m_Select(m_Value(), m_Value(V), m_Specific(PHI))))
798 ValOut = V;
799
800 // Same for select, if this phi is 2-operand phi, compute analysis on other
801 // incoming value to break recursion.
802 // TODO: We could handle any number of incoming edges as long as we only have
803 // two unique values.
804 if (auto *IncPhi = dyn_cast<PHINode>(ValOut);
805 IncPhi && IncPhi->getNumIncomingValues() == 2) {
806 for (int Idx = 0; Idx < 2; ++Idx) {
807 if (IncPhi->getIncomingValue(Idx) == PHI) {
808 ValOut = IncPhi->getIncomingValue(1 - Idx);
809 if (PhiOut)
810 *PhiOut = IncPhi;
811 CtxIOut = IncPhi->getIncomingBlock(1 - Idx)->getTerminator();
812 break;
813 }
814 }
815 }
816}
817
818static bool isKnownNonZeroFromAssume(const Value *V, const SimplifyQuery &Q) {
819 // Use of assumptions is context-sensitive. If we don't have a context, we
820 // cannot use them!
821 if (!Q.AC || !Q.CxtI)
822 return false;
823
824 for (AssumptionCache::ResultElem &Elem : Q.AC->assumptionsFor(V)) {
825 if (!Elem.Assume)
826 continue;
827
828 AssumeInst *I = cast<AssumeInst>(Elem.Assume);
829 assert(I->getFunction() == Q.CxtI->getFunction() &&
830 "Got assumption for the wrong function!");
831
832 if (Elem.Index != AssumptionCache::ExprResultIdx) {
833 if (!V->getType()->isPointerTy())
834 continue;
836 *I, I->bundle_op_info_begin()[Elem.Index])) {
837 if (RK.WasOn == V &&
838 (RK.AttrKind == Attribute::NonNull ||
839 (RK.AttrKind == Attribute::Dereferenceable &&
841 V->getType()->getPointerAddressSpace()))) &&
843 return true;
844 }
845 continue;
846 }
847
848 // Warning: This loop can end up being somewhat performance sensitive.
849 // We're running this loop for once for each value queried resulting in a
850 // runtime of ~O(#assumes * #values).
851
852 Value *RHS;
853 CmpPredicate Pred;
854 auto m_V = m_CombineOr(m_Specific(V), m_PtrToInt(m_Specific(V)));
855 if (!match(I->getArgOperand(0), m_c_ICmp(Pred, m_V, m_Value(RHS))))
856 continue;
857
858 if (cmpExcludesZero(Pred, RHS) && isValidAssumeForContext(I, Q.CxtI, Q.DT))
859 return true;
860 }
861
862 return false;
863}
864
866 Value *LHS, Value *RHS, KnownBits &Known,
867 const SimplifyQuery &Q) {
868 if (RHS->getType()->isPointerTy()) {
869 // Handle comparison of pointer to null explicitly, as it will not be
870 // covered by the m_APInt() logic below.
871 if (LHS == V && match(RHS, m_Zero())) {
872 switch (Pred) {
874 Known.setAllZero();
875 break;
878 Known.makeNonNegative();
879 break;
881 Known.makeNegative();
882 break;
883 default:
884 break;
885 }
886 }
887 return;
888 }
889
890 unsigned BitWidth = Known.getBitWidth();
891 auto m_V =
893
894 Value *Y;
895 const APInt *Mask, *C;
896 if (!match(RHS, m_APInt(C)))
897 return;
898
899 uint64_t ShAmt;
900 switch (Pred) {
902 // assume(V = C)
903 if (match(LHS, m_V)) {
904 Known = Known.unionWith(KnownBits::makeConstant(*C));
905 // assume(V & Mask = C)
906 } else if (match(LHS, m_c_And(m_V, m_Value(Y)))) {
907 // For one bits in Mask, we can propagate bits from C to V.
908 Known.One |= *C;
909 if (match(Y, m_APInt(Mask)))
910 Known.Zero |= ~*C & *Mask;
911 // assume(V | Mask = C)
912 } else if (match(LHS, m_c_Or(m_V, m_Value(Y)))) {
913 // For zero bits in Mask, we can propagate bits from C to V.
914 Known.Zero |= ~*C;
915 if (match(Y, m_APInt(Mask)))
916 Known.One |= *C & ~*Mask;
917 // assume(V << ShAmt = C)
918 } else if (match(LHS, m_Shl(m_V, m_ConstantInt(ShAmt))) &&
919 ShAmt < BitWidth) {
920 // For those bits in C that are known, we can propagate them to known
921 // bits in V shifted to the right by ShAmt.
923 RHSKnown >>= ShAmt;
924 Known = Known.unionWith(RHSKnown);
925 // assume(V >> ShAmt = C)
926 } else if (match(LHS, m_Shr(m_V, m_ConstantInt(ShAmt))) &&
927 ShAmt < BitWidth) {
928 // For those bits in RHS that are known, we can propagate them to known
929 // bits in V shifted to the right by C.
931 RHSKnown <<= ShAmt;
932 Known = Known.unionWith(RHSKnown);
933 }
934 break;
935 case ICmpInst::ICMP_NE: {
936 // assume (V & B != 0) where B is a power of 2
937 const APInt *BPow2;
938 if (C->isZero() && match(LHS, m_And(m_V, m_Power2(BPow2))))
939 Known.One |= *BPow2;
940 break;
941 }
942 default: {
943 const APInt *Offset = nullptr;
944 if (match(LHS, m_CombineOr(m_V, m_AddLike(m_V, m_APInt(Offset))))) {
946 if (Offset)
947 LHSRange = LHSRange.sub(*Offset);
948 Known = Known.unionWith(LHSRange.toKnownBits());
949 }
950 if (Pred == ICmpInst::ICMP_UGT || Pred == ICmpInst::ICMP_UGE) {
951 // X & Y u> C -> X u> C && Y u> C
952 // X nuw- Y u> C -> X u> C
953 if (match(LHS, m_c_And(m_V, m_Value())) ||
954 match(LHS, m_NUWSub(m_V, m_Value())))
955 Known.One.setHighBits(
956 (*C + (Pred == ICmpInst::ICMP_UGT)).countLeadingOnes());
957 }
958 if (Pred == ICmpInst::ICMP_ULT || Pred == ICmpInst::ICMP_ULE) {
959 // X | Y u< C -> X u< C && Y u< C
960 // X nuw+ Y u< C -> X u< C && Y u< C
961 if (match(LHS, m_c_Or(m_V, m_Value())) ||
962 match(LHS, m_c_NUWAdd(m_V, m_Value()))) {
963 Known.Zero.setHighBits(
964 (*C - (Pred == ICmpInst::ICMP_ULT)).countLeadingZeros());
965 }
966 }
967 } break;
968 }
969}
970
971static void computeKnownBitsFromICmpCond(const Value *V, ICmpInst *Cmp,
972 KnownBits &Known,
973 const SimplifyQuery &SQ, bool Invert) {
975 Invert ? Cmp->getInversePredicate() : Cmp->getPredicate();
976 Value *LHS = Cmp->getOperand(0);
977 Value *RHS = Cmp->getOperand(1);
978
979 // Handle icmp pred (trunc V), C
980 if (match(LHS, m_Trunc(m_Specific(V)))) {
981 KnownBits DstKnown(LHS->getType()->getScalarSizeInBits());
982 computeKnownBitsFromCmp(LHS, Pred, LHS, RHS, DstKnown, SQ);
984 Known = Known.unionWith(DstKnown.zext(Known.getBitWidth()));
985 else
986 Known = Known.unionWith(DstKnown.anyext(Known.getBitWidth()));
987 return;
988 }
989
990 computeKnownBitsFromCmp(V, Pred, LHS, RHS, Known, SQ);
991}
992
994 KnownBits &Known, const SimplifyQuery &SQ,
995 bool Invert, unsigned Depth) {
996 Value *A, *B;
999 KnownBits Known2(Known.getBitWidth());
1000 KnownBits Known3(Known.getBitWidth());
1001 computeKnownBitsFromCond(V, A, Known2, SQ, Invert, Depth + 1);
1002 computeKnownBitsFromCond(V, B, Known3, SQ, Invert, Depth + 1);
1003 if (Invert ? match(Cond, m_LogicalOr(m_Value(), m_Value()))
1005 Known2 = Known2.unionWith(Known3);
1006 else
1007 Known2 = Known2.intersectWith(Known3);
1008 Known = Known.unionWith(Known2);
1009 return;
1010 }
1011
1012 if (auto *Cmp = dyn_cast<ICmpInst>(Cond)) {
1013 computeKnownBitsFromICmpCond(V, Cmp, Known, SQ, Invert);
1014 return;
1015 }
1016
1017 if (match(Cond, m_Trunc(m_Specific(V)))) {
1018 KnownBits DstKnown(1);
1019 if (Invert) {
1020 DstKnown.setAllZero();
1021 } else {
1022 DstKnown.setAllOnes();
1023 }
1025 Known = Known.unionWith(DstKnown.zext(Known.getBitWidth()));
1026 return;
1027 }
1028 Known = Known.unionWith(DstKnown.anyext(Known.getBitWidth()));
1029 return;
1030 }
1031
1033 computeKnownBitsFromCond(V, A, Known, SQ, !Invert, Depth + 1);
1034}
1035
1037 const SimplifyQuery &Q, unsigned Depth) {
1038 // Handle injected condition.
1039 if (Q.CC && Q.CC->AffectedValues.contains(V))
1040 computeKnownBitsFromCond(V, Q.CC->Cond, Known, Q, Q.CC->Invert, Depth);
1041
1042 if (!Q.CxtI)
1043 return;
1044
1045 if (Q.DC && Q.DT) {
1046 // Handle dominating conditions.
1047 for (BranchInst *BI : Q.DC->conditionsFor(V)) {
1048 BasicBlockEdge Edge0(BI->getParent(), BI->getSuccessor(0));
1049 if (Q.DT->dominates(Edge0, Q.CxtI->getParent()))
1050 computeKnownBitsFromCond(V, BI->getCondition(), Known, Q,
1051 /*Invert*/ false, Depth);
1052
1053 BasicBlockEdge Edge1(BI->getParent(), BI->getSuccessor(1));
1054 if (Q.DT->dominates(Edge1, Q.CxtI->getParent()))
1055 computeKnownBitsFromCond(V, BI->getCondition(), Known, Q,
1056 /*Invert*/ true, Depth);
1057 }
1058
1059 if (Known.hasConflict())
1060 Known.resetAll();
1061 }
1062
1063 if (!Q.AC)
1064 return;
1065
1066 unsigned BitWidth = Known.getBitWidth();
1067
1068 // Note that the patterns below need to be kept in sync with the code
1069 // in AssumptionCache::updateAffectedValues.
1070
1071 for (AssumptionCache::ResultElem &Elem : Q.AC->assumptionsFor(V)) {
1072 if (!Elem.Assume)
1073 continue;
1074
1075 AssumeInst *I = cast<AssumeInst>(Elem.Assume);
1076 assert(I->getParent()->getParent() == Q.CxtI->getParent()->getParent() &&
1077 "Got assumption for the wrong function!");
1078
1079 if (Elem.Index != AssumptionCache::ExprResultIdx) {
1080 if (!V->getType()->isPointerTy())
1081 continue;
1083 *I, I->bundle_op_info_begin()[Elem.Index])) {
1084 // Allow AllowEphemerals in isValidAssumeForContext, as the CxtI might
1085 // be the producer of the pointer in the bundle. At the moment, align
1086 // assumptions aren't optimized away.
1087 if (RK.WasOn == V && RK.AttrKind == Attribute::Alignment &&
1088 isPowerOf2_64(RK.ArgValue) &&
1089 isValidAssumeForContext(I, Q.CxtI, Q.DT, /*AllowEphemerals*/ true))
1090 Known.Zero.setLowBits(Log2_64(RK.ArgValue));
1091 }
1092 continue;
1093 }
1094
1095 // Warning: This loop can end up being somewhat performance sensitive.
1096 // We're running this loop for once for each value queried resulting in a
1097 // runtime of ~O(#assumes * #values).
1098
1099 Value *Arg = I->getArgOperand(0);
1100
1101 if (Arg == V && isValidAssumeForContext(I, Q.CxtI, Q.DT)) {
1102 assert(BitWidth == 1 && "assume operand is not i1?");
1103 (void)BitWidth;
1104 Known.setAllOnes();
1105 return;
1106 }
1107 if (match(Arg, m_Not(m_Specific(V))) &&
1109 assert(BitWidth == 1 && "assume operand is not i1?");
1110 (void)BitWidth;
1111 Known.setAllZero();
1112 return;
1113 }
1114 auto *Trunc = dyn_cast<TruncInst>(Arg);
1115 if (Trunc && Trunc->getOperand(0) == V &&
1117 if (Trunc->hasNoUnsignedWrap()) {
1119 return;
1120 }
1121 Known.One.setBit(0);
1122 return;
1123 }
1124
1125 // The remaining tests are all recursive, so bail out if we hit the limit.
1127 continue;
1128
1129 ICmpInst *Cmp = dyn_cast<ICmpInst>(Arg);
1130 if (!Cmp)
1131 continue;
1132
1133 if (!isValidAssumeForContext(I, Q.CxtI, Q.DT))
1134 continue;
1135
1136 computeKnownBitsFromICmpCond(V, Cmp, Known, Q, /*Invert=*/false);
1137 }
1138
1139 // Conflicting assumption: Undefined behavior will occur on this execution
1140 // path.
1141 if (Known.hasConflict())
1142 Known.resetAll();
1143}
1144
1145/// Compute known bits from a shift operator, including those with a
1146/// non-constant shift amount. Known is the output of this function. Known2 is a
1147/// pre-allocated temporary with the same bit width as Known and on return
1148/// contains the known bit of the shift value source. KF is an
1149/// operator-specific function that, given the known-bits and a shift amount,
1150/// compute the implied known-bits of the shift operator's result respectively
1151/// for that shift amount. The results from calling KF are conservatively
1152/// combined for all permitted shift amounts.
1154 const Operator *I, const APInt &DemandedElts, KnownBits &Known,
1155 KnownBits &Known2, const SimplifyQuery &Q, unsigned Depth,
1156 function_ref<KnownBits(const KnownBits &, const KnownBits &, bool)> KF) {
1157 computeKnownBits(I->getOperand(0), DemandedElts, Known2, Q, Depth + 1);
1158 computeKnownBits(I->getOperand(1), DemandedElts, Known, Q, Depth + 1);
1159 // To limit compile-time impact, only query isKnownNonZero() if we know at
1160 // least something about the shift amount.
1161 bool ShAmtNonZero =
1162 Known.isNonZero() ||
1163 (Known.getMaxValue().ult(Known.getBitWidth()) &&
1164 isKnownNonZero(I->getOperand(1), DemandedElts, Q, Depth + 1));
1165 Known = KF(Known2, Known, ShAmtNonZero);
1166}
1167
1168static KnownBits
1169getKnownBitsFromAndXorOr(const Operator *I, const APInt &DemandedElts,
1170 const KnownBits &KnownLHS, const KnownBits &KnownRHS,
1171 const SimplifyQuery &Q, unsigned Depth) {
1172 unsigned BitWidth = KnownLHS.getBitWidth();
1173 KnownBits KnownOut(BitWidth);
1174 bool IsAnd = false;
1175 bool HasKnownOne = !KnownLHS.One.isZero() || !KnownRHS.One.isZero();
1176 Value *X = nullptr, *Y = nullptr;
1177
1178 switch (I->getOpcode()) {
1179 case Instruction::And:
1180 KnownOut = KnownLHS & KnownRHS;
1181 IsAnd = true;
1182 // and(x, -x) is common idioms that will clear all but lowest set
1183 // bit. If we have a single known bit in x, we can clear all bits
1184 // above it.
1185 // TODO: instcombine often reassociates independent `and` which can hide
1186 // this pattern. Try to match and(x, and(-x, y)) / and(and(x, y), -x).
1187 if (HasKnownOne && match(I, m_c_And(m_Value(X), m_Neg(m_Deferred(X))))) {
1188 // -(-x) == x so using whichever (LHS/RHS) gets us a better result.
1189 if (KnownLHS.countMaxTrailingZeros() <= KnownRHS.countMaxTrailingZeros())
1190 KnownOut = KnownLHS.blsi();
1191 else
1192 KnownOut = KnownRHS.blsi();
1193 }
1194 break;
1195 case Instruction::Or:
1196 KnownOut = KnownLHS | KnownRHS;
1197 break;
1198 case Instruction::Xor:
1199 KnownOut = KnownLHS ^ KnownRHS;
1200 // xor(x, x-1) is common idioms that will clear all but lowest set
1201 // bit. If we have a single known bit in x, we can clear all bits
1202 // above it.
1203 // TODO: xor(x, x-1) is often rewritting as xor(x, x-C) where C !=
1204 // -1 but for the purpose of demanded bits (xor(x, x-C) &
1205 // Demanded) == (xor(x, x-1) & Demanded). Extend the xor pattern
1206 // to use arbitrary C if xor(x, x-C) as the same as xor(x, x-1).
1207 if (HasKnownOne &&
1209 const KnownBits &XBits = I->getOperand(0) == X ? KnownLHS : KnownRHS;
1210 KnownOut = XBits.blsmsk();
1211 }
1212 break;
1213 default:
1214 llvm_unreachable("Invalid Op used in 'analyzeKnownBitsFromAndXorOr'");
1215 }
1216
1217 // and(x, add (x, -1)) is a common idiom that always clears the low bit;
1218 // xor/or(x, add (x, -1)) is an idiom that will always set the low bit.
1219 // here we handle the more general case of adding any odd number by
1220 // matching the form and/xor/or(x, add(x, y)) where y is odd.
1221 // TODO: This could be generalized to clearing any bit set in y where the
1222 // following bit is known to be unset in y.
1223 if (!KnownOut.Zero[0] && !KnownOut.One[0] &&
1227 KnownBits KnownY(BitWidth);
1228 computeKnownBits(Y, DemandedElts, KnownY, Q, Depth + 1);
1229 if (KnownY.countMinTrailingOnes() > 0) {
1230 if (IsAnd)
1231 KnownOut.Zero.setBit(0);
1232 else
1233 KnownOut.One.setBit(0);
1234 }
1235 }
1236 return KnownOut;
1237}
1238
1240 const Operator *I, const APInt &DemandedElts, const SimplifyQuery &Q,
1241 unsigned Depth,
1242 const function_ref<KnownBits(const KnownBits &, const KnownBits &)>
1243 KnownBitsFunc) {
1244 APInt DemandedEltsLHS, DemandedEltsRHS;
1246 DemandedElts, DemandedEltsLHS,
1247 DemandedEltsRHS);
1248
1249 const auto ComputeForSingleOpFunc =
1250 [Depth, &Q, KnownBitsFunc](const Value *Op, APInt &DemandedEltsOp) {
1251 return KnownBitsFunc(
1252 computeKnownBits(Op, DemandedEltsOp, Q, Depth + 1),
1253 computeKnownBits(Op, DemandedEltsOp << 1, Q, Depth + 1));
1254 };
1255
1256 if (DemandedEltsRHS.isZero())
1257 return ComputeForSingleOpFunc(I->getOperand(0), DemandedEltsLHS);
1258 if (DemandedEltsLHS.isZero())
1259 return ComputeForSingleOpFunc(I->getOperand(1), DemandedEltsRHS);
1260
1261 return ComputeForSingleOpFunc(I->getOperand(0), DemandedEltsLHS)
1262 .intersectWith(ComputeForSingleOpFunc(I->getOperand(1), DemandedEltsRHS));
1263}
1264
1265// Public so this can be used in `SimplifyDemandedUseBits`.
1267 const KnownBits &KnownLHS,
1268 const KnownBits &KnownRHS,
1269 const SimplifyQuery &SQ,
1270 unsigned Depth) {
1271 auto *FVTy = dyn_cast<FixedVectorType>(I->getType());
1272 APInt DemandedElts =
1273 FVTy ? APInt::getAllOnes(FVTy->getNumElements()) : APInt(1, 1);
1274
1275 return getKnownBitsFromAndXorOr(I, DemandedElts, KnownLHS, KnownRHS, SQ,
1276 Depth);
1277}
1278
1280 Attribute Attr = F->getFnAttribute(Attribute::VScaleRange);
1281 // Without vscale_range, we only know that vscale is non-zero.
1282 if (!Attr.isValid())
1284
1285 unsigned AttrMin = Attr.getVScaleRangeMin();
1286 // Minimum is larger than vscale width, result is always poison.
1287 if ((unsigned)llvm::bit_width(AttrMin) > BitWidth)
1288 return ConstantRange::getEmpty(BitWidth);
1289
1290 APInt Min(BitWidth, AttrMin);
1291 std::optional<unsigned> AttrMax = Attr.getVScaleRangeMax();
1292 if (!AttrMax || (unsigned)llvm::bit_width(*AttrMax) > BitWidth)
1294
1295 return ConstantRange(Min, APInt(BitWidth, *AttrMax) + 1);
1296}
1297
1299 Value *Arm, bool Invert,
1300 const SimplifyQuery &Q, unsigned Depth) {
1301 // If we have a constant arm, we are done.
1302 if (Known.isConstant())
1303 return;
1304
1305 // See what condition implies about the bits of the select arm.
1306 KnownBits CondRes(Known.getBitWidth());
1307 computeKnownBitsFromCond(Arm, Cond, CondRes, Q, Invert, Depth + 1);
1308 // If we don't get any information from the condition, no reason to
1309 // proceed.
1310 if (CondRes.isUnknown())
1311 return;
1312
1313 // We can have conflict if the condition is dead. I.e if we have
1314 // (x | 64) < 32 ? (x | 64) : y
1315 // we will have conflict at bit 6 from the condition/the `or`.
1316 // In that case just return. Its not particularly important
1317 // what we do, as this select is going to be simplified soon.
1318 CondRes = CondRes.unionWith(Known);
1319 if (CondRes.hasConflict())
1320 return;
1321
1322 // Finally make sure the information we found is valid. This is relatively
1323 // expensive so it's left for the very end.
1324 if (!isGuaranteedNotToBeUndef(Arm, Q.AC, Q.CxtI, Q.DT, Depth + 1))
1325 return;
1326
1327 // Finally, we know we get information from the condition and its valid,
1328 // so return it.
1329 Known = CondRes;
1330}
1331
1332// Match a signed min+max clamp pattern like smax(smin(In, CHigh), CLow).
1333// Returns the input and lower/upper bounds.
1334static bool isSignedMinMaxClamp(const Value *Select, const Value *&In,
1335 const APInt *&CLow, const APInt *&CHigh) {
1337 cast<Operator>(Select)->getOpcode() == Instruction::Select &&
1338 "Input should be a Select!");
1339
1340 const Value *LHS = nullptr, *RHS = nullptr;
1342 if (SPF != SPF_SMAX && SPF != SPF_SMIN)
1343 return false;
1344
1345 if (!match(RHS, m_APInt(CLow)))
1346 return false;
1347
1348 const Value *LHS2 = nullptr, *RHS2 = nullptr;
1350 if (getInverseMinMaxFlavor(SPF) != SPF2)
1351 return false;
1352
1353 if (!match(RHS2, m_APInt(CHigh)))
1354 return false;
1355
1356 if (SPF == SPF_SMIN)
1357 std::swap(CLow, CHigh);
1358
1359 In = LHS2;
1360 return CLow->sle(*CHigh);
1361}
1362
1364 const APInt *&CLow,
1365 const APInt *&CHigh) {
1366 assert((II->getIntrinsicID() == Intrinsic::smin ||
1367 II->getIntrinsicID() == Intrinsic::smax) &&
1368 "Must be smin/smax");
1369
1370 Intrinsic::ID InverseID = getInverseMinMaxIntrinsic(II->getIntrinsicID());
1371 auto *InnerII = dyn_cast<IntrinsicInst>(II->getArgOperand(0));
1372 if (!InnerII || InnerII->getIntrinsicID() != InverseID ||
1373 !match(II->getArgOperand(1), m_APInt(CLow)) ||
1374 !match(InnerII->getArgOperand(1), m_APInt(CHigh)))
1375 return false;
1376
1377 if (II->getIntrinsicID() == Intrinsic::smin)
1378 std::swap(CLow, CHigh);
1379 return CLow->sle(*CHigh);
1380}
1381
1383 KnownBits &Known) {
1384 const APInt *CLow, *CHigh;
1385 if (isSignedMinMaxIntrinsicClamp(II, CLow, CHigh))
1386 Known = Known.unionWith(
1387 ConstantRange::getNonEmpty(*CLow, *CHigh + 1).toKnownBits());
1388}
1389
1391 const APInt &DemandedElts,
1392 KnownBits &Known,
1393 const SimplifyQuery &Q,
1394 unsigned Depth) {
1395 unsigned BitWidth = Known.getBitWidth();
1396
1397 KnownBits Known2(BitWidth);
1398 switch (I->getOpcode()) {
1399 default: break;
1400 case Instruction::Load:
1401 if (MDNode *MD =
1402 Q.IIQ.getMetadata(cast<LoadInst>(I), LLVMContext::MD_range))
1404 break;
1405 case Instruction::And:
1406 computeKnownBits(I->getOperand(1), DemandedElts, Known, Q, Depth + 1);
1407 computeKnownBits(I->getOperand(0), DemandedElts, Known2, Q, Depth + 1);
1408
1409 Known = getKnownBitsFromAndXorOr(I, DemandedElts, Known2, Known, Q, Depth);
1410 break;
1411 case Instruction::Or:
1412 computeKnownBits(I->getOperand(1), DemandedElts, Known, Q, Depth + 1);
1413 computeKnownBits(I->getOperand(0), DemandedElts, Known2, Q, Depth + 1);
1414
1415 Known = getKnownBitsFromAndXorOr(I, DemandedElts, Known2, Known, Q, Depth);
1416 break;
1417 case Instruction::Xor:
1418 computeKnownBits(I->getOperand(1), DemandedElts, Known, Q, Depth + 1);
1419 computeKnownBits(I->getOperand(0), DemandedElts, Known2, Q, Depth + 1);
1420
1421 Known = getKnownBitsFromAndXorOr(I, DemandedElts, Known2, Known, Q, Depth);
1422 break;
1423 case Instruction::Mul: {
1426 computeKnownBitsMul(I->getOperand(0), I->getOperand(1), NSW, NUW,
1427 DemandedElts, Known, Known2, Q, Depth);
1428 break;
1429 }
1430 case Instruction::UDiv: {
1431 computeKnownBits(I->getOperand(0), DemandedElts, Known, Q, Depth + 1);
1432 computeKnownBits(I->getOperand(1), DemandedElts, Known2, Q, Depth + 1);
1433 Known =
1434 KnownBits::udiv(Known, Known2, Q.IIQ.isExact(cast<BinaryOperator>(I)));
1435 break;
1436 }
1437 case Instruction::SDiv: {
1438 computeKnownBits(I->getOperand(0), DemandedElts, Known, Q, Depth + 1);
1439 computeKnownBits(I->getOperand(1), DemandedElts, Known2, Q, Depth + 1);
1440 Known =
1441 KnownBits::sdiv(Known, Known2, Q.IIQ.isExact(cast<BinaryOperator>(I)));
1442 break;
1443 }
1444 case Instruction::Select: {
1445 auto ComputeForArm = [&](Value *Arm, bool Invert) {
1446 KnownBits Res(Known.getBitWidth());
1447 computeKnownBits(Arm, DemandedElts, Res, Q, Depth + 1);
1448 adjustKnownBitsForSelectArm(Res, I->getOperand(0), Arm, Invert, Q, Depth);
1449 return Res;
1450 };
1451 // Only known if known in both the LHS and RHS.
1452 Known =
1453 ComputeForArm(I->getOperand(1), /*Invert=*/false)
1454 .intersectWith(ComputeForArm(I->getOperand(2), /*Invert=*/true));
1455 break;
1456 }
1457 case Instruction::FPTrunc:
1458 case Instruction::FPExt:
1459 case Instruction::FPToUI:
1460 case Instruction::FPToSI:
1461 case Instruction::SIToFP:
1462 case Instruction::UIToFP:
1463 break; // Can't work with floating point.
1464 case Instruction::PtrToInt:
1465 case Instruction::IntToPtr:
1466 // Fall through and handle them the same as zext/trunc.
1467 [[fallthrough]];
1468 case Instruction::ZExt:
1469 case Instruction::Trunc: {
1470 Type *SrcTy = I->getOperand(0)->getType();
1471
1472 unsigned SrcBitWidth;
1473 // Note that we handle pointer operands here because of inttoptr/ptrtoint
1474 // which fall through here.
1475 Type *ScalarTy = SrcTy->getScalarType();
1476 SrcBitWidth = ScalarTy->isPointerTy() ?
1477 Q.DL.getPointerTypeSizeInBits(ScalarTy) :
1478 Q.DL.getTypeSizeInBits(ScalarTy);
1479
1480 assert(SrcBitWidth && "SrcBitWidth can't be zero");
1481 Known = Known.anyextOrTrunc(SrcBitWidth);
1482 computeKnownBits(I->getOperand(0), DemandedElts, Known, Q, Depth + 1);
1483 if (auto *Inst = dyn_cast<PossiblyNonNegInst>(I);
1484 Inst && Inst->hasNonNeg() && !Known.isNegative())
1485 Known.makeNonNegative();
1486 Known = Known.zextOrTrunc(BitWidth);
1487 break;
1488 }
1489 case Instruction::BitCast: {
1490 Type *SrcTy = I->getOperand(0)->getType();
1491 if (SrcTy->isIntOrPtrTy() &&
1492 // TODO: For now, not handling conversions like:
1493 // (bitcast i64 %x to <2 x i32>)
1494 !I->getType()->isVectorTy()) {
1495 computeKnownBits(I->getOperand(0), Known, Q, Depth + 1);
1496 break;
1497 }
1498
1499 const Value *V;
1500 // Handle bitcast from floating point to integer.
1501 if (match(I, m_ElementWiseBitCast(m_Value(V))) &&
1502 V->getType()->isFPOrFPVectorTy()) {
1503 Type *FPType = V->getType()->getScalarType();
1504 KnownFPClass Result =
1505 computeKnownFPClass(V, DemandedElts, fcAllFlags, Q, Depth + 1);
1506 FPClassTest FPClasses = Result.KnownFPClasses;
1507
1508 // TODO: Treat it as zero/poison if the use of I is unreachable.
1509 if (FPClasses == fcNone)
1510 break;
1511
1512 if (Result.isKnownNever(fcNormal | fcSubnormal | fcNan)) {
1513 Known.setAllConflict();
1514
1515 if (FPClasses & fcInf)
1517 APFloat::getInf(FPType->getFltSemantics()).bitcastToAPInt()));
1518
1519 if (FPClasses & fcZero)
1521 APInt::getZero(FPType->getScalarSizeInBits())));
1522
1523 Known.Zero.clearSignBit();
1524 Known.One.clearSignBit();
1525 }
1526
1527 if (Result.SignBit) {
1528 if (*Result.SignBit)
1529 Known.makeNegative();
1530 else
1531 Known.makeNonNegative();
1532 }
1533
1534 break;
1535 }
1536
1537 // Handle cast from vector integer type to scalar or vector integer.
1538 auto *SrcVecTy = dyn_cast<FixedVectorType>(SrcTy);
1539 if (!SrcVecTy || !SrcVecTy->getElementType()->isIntegerTy() ||
1540 !I->getType()->isIntOrIntVectorTy() ||
1541 isa<ScalableVectorType>(I->getType()))
1542 break;
1543
1544 unsigned NumElts = DemandedElts.getBitWidth();
1545 bool IsLE = Q.DL.isLittleEndian();
1546 // Look through a cast from narrow vector elements to wider type.
1547 // Examples: v4i32 -> v2i64, v3i8 -> v24
1548 unsigned SubBitWidth = SrcVecTy->getScalarSizeInBits();
1549 if (BitWidth % SubBitWidth == 0) {
1550 // Known bits are automatically intersected across demanded elements of a
1551 // vector. So for example, if a bit is computed as known zero, it must be
1552 // zero across all demanded elements of the vector.
1553 //
1554 // For this bitcast, each demanded element of the output is sub-divided
1555 // across a set of smaller vector elements in the source vector. To get
1556 // the known bits for an entire element of the output, compute the known
1557 // bits for each sub-element sequentially. This is done by shifting the
1558 // one-set-bit demanded elements parameter across the sub-elements for
1559 // consecutive calls to computeKnownBits. We are using the demanded
1560 // elements parameter as a mask operator.
1561 //
1562 // The known bits of each sub-element are then inserted into place
1563 // (dependent on endian) to form the full result of known bits.
1564 unsigned SubScale = BitWidth / SubBitWidth;
1565 APInt SubDemandedElts = APInt::getZero(NumElts * SubScale);
1566 for (unsigned i = 0; i != NumElts; ++i) {
1567 if (DemandedElts[i])
1568 SubDemandedElts.setBit(i * SubScale);
1569 }
1570
1571 KnownBits KnownSrc(SubBitWidth);
1572 for (unsigned i = 0; i != SubScale; ++i) {
1573 computeKnownBits(I->getOperand(0), SubDemandedElts.shl(i), KnownSrc, Q,
1574 Depth + 1);
1575 unsigned ShiftElt = IsLE ? i : SubScale - 1 - i;
1576 Known.insertBits(KnownSrc, ShiftElt * SubBitWidth);
1577 }
1578 }
1579 // Look through a cast from wider vector elements to narrow type.
1580 // Examples: v2i64 -> v4i32
1581 if (SubBitWidth % BitWidth == 0) {
1582 unsigned SubScale = SubBitWidth / BitWidth;
1583 KnownBits KnownSrc(SubBitWidth);
1584 APInt SubDemandedElts =
1585 APIntOps::ScaleBitMask(DemandedElts, NumElts / SubScale);
1586 computeKnownBits(I->getOperand(0), SubDemandedElts, KnownSrc, Q,
1587 Depth + 1);
1588
1589 Known.setAllConflict();
1590 for (unsigned i = 0; i != NumElts; ++i) {
1591 if (DemandedElts[i]) {
1592 unsigned Shifts = IsLE ? i : NumElts - 1 - i;
1593 unsigned Offset = (Shifts % SubScale) * BitWidth;
1594 Known = Known.intersectWith(KnownSrc.extractBits(BitWidth, Offset));
1595 if (Known.isUnknown())
1596 break;
1597 }
1598 }
1599 }
1600 break;
1601 }
1602 case Instruction::SExt: {
1603 // Compute the bits in the result that are not present in the input.
1604 unsigned SrcBitWidth = I->getOperand(0)->getType()->getScalarSizeInBits();
1605
1606 Known = Known.trunc(SrcBitWidth);
1607 computeKnownBits(I->getOperand(0), DemandedElts, Known, Q, Depth + 1);
1608 // If the sign bit of the input is known set or clear, then we know the
1609 // top bits of the result.
1610 Known = Known.sext(BitWidth);
1611 break;
1612 }
1613 case Instruction::Shl: {
1616 auto KF = [NUW, NSW](const KnownBits &KnownVal, const KnownBits &KnownAmt,
1617 bool ShAmtNonZero) {
1618 return KnownBits::shl(KnownVal, KnownAmt, NUW, NSW, ShAmtNonZero);
1619 };
1620 computeKnownBitsFromShiftOperator(I, DemandedElts, Known, Known2, Q, Depth,
1621 KF);
1622 // Trailing zeros of a right-shifted constant never decrease.
1623 const APInt *C;
1624 if (match(I->getOperand(0), m_APInt(C)))
1625 Known.Zero.setLowBits(C->countr_zero());
1626 break;
1627 }
1628 case Instruction::LShr: {
1629 bool Exact = Q.IIQ.isExact(cast<BinaryOperator>(I));
1630 auto KF = [Exact](const KnownBits &KnownVal, const KnownBits &KnownAmt,
1631 bool ShAmtNonZero) {
1632 return KnownBits::lshr(KnownVal, KnownAmt, ShAmtNonZero, Exact);
1633 };
1634 computeKnownBitsFromShiftOperator(I, DemandedElts, Known, Known2, Q, Depth,
1635 KF);
1636 // Leading zeros of a left-shifted constant never decrease.
1637 const APInt *C;
1638 if (match(I->getOperand(0), m_APInt(C)))
1639 Known.Zero.setHighBits(C->countl_zero());
1640 break;
1641 }
1642 case Instruction::AShr: {
1643 bool Exact = Q.IIQ.isExact(cast<BinaryOperator>(I));
1644 auto KF = [Exact](const KnownBits &KnownVal, const KnownBits &KnownAmt,
1645 bool ShAmtNonZero) {
1646 return KnownBits::ashr(KnownVal, KnownAmt, ShAmtNonZero, Exact);
1647 };
1648 computeKnownBitsFromShiftOperator(I, DemandedElts, Known, Known2, Q, Depth,
1649 KF);
1650 break;
1651 }
1652 case Instruction::Sub: {
1655 computeKnownBitsAddSub(false, I->getOperand(0), I->getOperand(1), NSW, NUW,
1656 DemandedElts, Known, Known2, Q, Depth);
1657 break;
1658 }
1659 case Instruction::Add: {
1662 computeKnownBitsAddSub(true, I->getOperand(0), I->getOperand(1), NSW, NUW,
1663 DemandedElts, Known, Known2, Q, Depth);
1664 break;
1665 }
1666 case Instruction::SRem:
1667 computeKnownBits(I->getOperand(0), DemandedElts, Known, Q, Depth + 1);
1668 computeKnownBits(I->getOperand(1), DemandedElts, Known2, Q, Depth + 1);
1669 Known = KnownBits::srem(Known, Known2);
1670 break;
1671
1672 case Instruction::URem:
1673 computeKnownBits(I->getOperand(0), DemandedElts, Known, Q, Depth + 1);
1674 computeKnownBits(I->getOperand(1), DemandedElts, Known2, Q, Depth + 1);
1675 Known = KnownBits::urem(Known, Known2);
1676 break;
1677 case Instruction::Alloca:
1679 break;
1680 case Instruction::GetElementPtr: {
1681 // Analyze all of the subscripts of this getelementptr instruction
1682 // to determine if we can prove known low zero bits.
1683 computeKnownBits(I->getOperand(0), Known, Q, Depth + 1);
1684 // Accumulate the constant indices in a separate variable
1685 // to minimize the number of calls to computeForAddSub.
1686 unsigned IndexWidth = Q.DL.getIndexTypeSizeInBits(I->getType());
1687 APInt AccConstIndices(IndexWidth, 0);
1688
1689 auto AddIndexToKnown = [&](KnownBits IndexBits) {
1690 if (IndexWidth == BitWidth) {
1691 // Note that inbounds does *not* guarantee nsw for the addition, as only
1692 // the offset is signed, while the base address is unsigned.
1693 Known = KnownBits::add(Known, IndexBits);
1694 } else {
1695 // If the index width is smaller than the pointer width, only add the
1696 // value to the low bits.
1697 assert(IndexWidth < BitWidth &&
1698 "Index width can't be larger than pointer width");
1699 Known.insertBits(KnownBits::add(Known.trunc(IndexWidth), IndexBits), 0);
1700 }
1701 };
1702
1704 for (unsigned i = 1, e = I->getNumOperands(); i != e; ++i, ++GTI) {
1705 // TrailZ can only become smaller, short-circuit if we hit zero.
1706 if (Known.isUnknown())
1707 break;
1708
1709 Value *Index = I->getOperand(i);
1710
1711 // Handle case when index is zero.
1712 Constant *CIndex = dyn_cast<Constant>(Index);
1713 if (CIndex && CIndex->isZeroValue())
1714 continue;
1715
1716 if (StructType *STy = GTI.getStructTypeOrNull()) {
1717 // Handle struct member offset arithmetic.
1718
1719 assert(CIndex &&
1720 "Access to structure field must be known at compile time");
1721
1722 if (CIndex->getType()->isVectorTy())
1723 Index = CIndex->getSplatValue();
1724
1725 unsigned Idx = cast<ConstantInt>(Index)->getZExtValue();
1726 const StructLayout *SL = Q.DL.getStructLayout(STy);
1727 uint64_t Offset = SL->getElementOffset(Idx);
1728 AccConstIndices += Offset;
1729 continue;
1730 }
1731
1732 // Handle array index arithmetic.
1733 Type *IndexedTy = GTI.getIndexedType();
1734 if (!IndexedTy->isSized()) {
1735 Known.resetAll();
1736 break;
1737 }
1738
1739 TypeSize Stride = GTI.getSequentialElementStride(Q.DL);
1740 uint64_t StrideInBytes = Stride.getKnownMinValue();
1741 if (!Stride.isScalable()) {
1742 // Fast path for constant offset.
1743 if (auto *CI = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(Index)) {
1744 AccConstIndices +=
1745 CI->getValue().sextOrTrunc(IndexWidth) * StrideInBytes;
1746 continue;
1747 }
1748 }
1749
1750 KnownBits IndexBits =
1751 computeKnownBits(Index, Q, Depth + 1).sextOrTrunc(IndexWidth);
1752 KnownBits ScalingFactor(IndexWidth);
1753 // Multiply by current sizeof type.
1754 // &A[i] == A + i * sizeof(*A[i]).
1755 if (Stride.isScalable()) {
1756 // For scalable types the only thing we know about sizeof is
1757 // that this is a multiple of the minimum size.
1758 ScalingFactor.Zero.setLowBits(llvm::countr_zero(StrideInBytes));
1759 } else {
1760 ScalingFactor =
1761 KnownBits::makeConstant(APInt(IndexWidth, StrideInBytes));
1762 }
1763 AddIndexToKnown(KnownBits::mul(IndexBits, ScalingFactor));
1764 }
1765 if (!Known.isUnknown() && !AccConstIndices.isZero())
1766 AddIndexToKnown(KnownBits::makeConstant(AccConstIndices));
1767 break;
1768 }
1769 case Instruction::PHI: {
1770 const PHINode *P = cast<PHINode>(I);
1771 BinaryOperator *BO = nullptr;
1772 Value *R = nullptr, *L = nullptr;
1773 if (matchSimpleRecurrence(P, BO, R, L)) {
1774 // Handle the case of a simple two-predecessor recurrence PHI.
1775 // There's a lot more that could theoretically be done here, but
1776 // this is sufficient to catch some interesting cases.
1777 unsigned Opcode = BO->getOpcode();
1778
1779 switch (Opcode) {
1780 // If this is a shift recurrence, we know the bits being shifted in. We
1781 // can combine that with information about the start value of the
1782 // recurrence to conclude facts about the result. If this is a udiv
1783 // recurrence, we know that the result can never exceed either the
1784 // numerator or the start value, whichever is greater.
1785 case Instruction::LShr:
1786 case Instruction::AShr:
1787 case Instruction::Shl:
1788 case Instruction::UDiv:
1789 if (BO->getOperand(0) != I)
1790 break;
1791 [[fallthrough]];
1792
1793 // For a urem recurrence, the result can never exceed the start value. The
1794 // phi could either be the numerator or the denominator.
1795 case Instruction::URem: {
1796 // We have matched a recurrence of the form:
1797 // %iv = [R, %entry], [%iv.next, %backedge]
1798 // %iv.next = shift_op %iv, L
1799
1800 // Recurse with the phi context to avoid concern about whether facts
1801 // inferred hold at original context instruction. TODO: It may be
1802 // correct to use the original context. IF warranted, explore and
1803 // add sufficient tests to cover.
1805 RecQ.CxtI = P;
1806 computeKnownBits(R, DemandedElts, Known2, RecQ, Depth + 1);
1807 switch (Opcode) {
1808 case Instruction::Shl:
1809 // A shl recurrence will only increase the tailing zeros
1810 Known.Zero.setLowBits(Known2.countMinTrailingZeros());
1811 break;
1812 case Instruction::LShr:
1813 case Instruction::UDiv:
1814 case Instruction::URem:
1815 // lshr, udiv, and urem recurrences will preserve the leading zeros of
1816 // the start value.
1817 Known.Zero.setHighBits(Known2.countMinLeadingZeros());
1818 break;
1819 case Instruction::AShr:
1820 // An ashr recurrence will extend the initial sign bit
1821 Known.Zero.setHighBits(Known2.countMinLeadingZeros());
1822 Known.One.setHighBits(Known2.countMinLeadingOnes());
1823 break;
1824 }
1825 break;
1826 }
1827
1828 // Check for operations that have the property that if
1829 // both their operands have low zero bits, the result
1830 // will have low zero bits.
1831 case Instruction::Add:
1832 case Instruction::Sub:
1833 case Instruction::And:
1834 case Instruction::Or:
1835 case Instruction::Mul: {
1836 // Change the context instruction to the "edge" that flows into the
1837 // phi. This is important because that is where the value is actually
1838 // "evaluated" even though it is used later somewhere else. (see also
1839 // D69571).
1841
1842 unsigned OpNum = P->getOperand(0) == R ? 0 : 1;
1843 Instruction *RInst = P->getIncomingBlock(OpNum)->getTerminator();
1844 Instruction *LInst = P->getIncomingBlock(1 - OpNum)->getTerminator();
1845
1846 // Ok, we have a PHI of the form L op= R. Check for low
1847 // zero bits.
1848 RecQ.CxtI = RInst;
1849 computeKnownBits(R, DemandedElts, Known2, RecQ, Depth + 1);
1850
1851 // We need to take the minimum number of known bits
1852 KnownBits Known3(BitWidth);
1853 RecQ.CxtI = LInst;
1854 computeKnownBits(L, DemandedElts, Known3, RecQ, Depth + 1);
1855
1856 Known.Zero.setLowBits(std::min(Known2.countMinTrailingZeros(),
1857 Known3.countMinTrailingZeros()));
1858
1859 auto *OverflowOp = dyn_cast<OverflowingBinaryOperator>(BO);
1860 if (!OverflowOp || !Q.IIQ.hasNoSignedWrap(OverflowOp))
1861 break;
1862
1863 switch (Opcode) {
1864 // If initial value of recurrence is nonnegative, and we are adding
1865 // a nonnegative number with nsw, the result can only be nonnegative
1866 // or poison value regardless of the number of times we execute the
1867 // add in phi recurrence. If initial value is negative and we are
1868 // adding a negative number with nsw, the result can only be
1869 // negative or poison value. Similar arguments apply to sub and mul.
1870 //
1871 // (add non-negative, non-negative) --> non-negative
1872 // (add negative, negative) --> negative
1873 case Instruction::Add: {
1874 if (Known2.isNonNegative() && Known3.isNonNegative())
1875 Known.makeNonNegative();
1876 else if (Known2.isNegative() && Known3.isNegative())
1877 Known.makeNegative();
1878 break;
1879 }
1880
1881 // (sub nsw non-negative, negative) --> non-negative
1882 // (sub nsw negative, non-negative) --> negative
1883 case Instruction::Sub: {
1884 if (BO->getOperand(0) != I)
1885 break;
1886 if (Known2.isNonNegative() && Known3.isNegative())
1887 Known.makeNonNegative();
1888 else if (Known2.isNegative() && Known3.isNonNegative())
1889 Known.makeNegative();
1890 break;
1891 }
1892
1893 // (mul nsw non-negative, non-negative) --> non-negative
1894 case Instruction::Mul:
1895 if (Known2.isNonNegative() && Known3.isNonNegative())
1896 Known.makeNonNegative();
1897 break;
1898
1899 default:
1900 break;
1901 }
1902 break;
1903 }
1904
1905 default:
1906 break;
1907 }
1908 }
1909
1910 // Unreachable blocks may have zero-operand PHI nodes.
1911 if (P->getNumIncomingValues() == 0)
1912 break;
1913
1914 // Otherwise take the unions of the known bit sets of the operands,
1915 // taking conservative care to avoid excessive recursion.
1916 if (Depth < MaxAnalysisRecursionDepth - 1 && Known.isUnknown()) {
1917 // Skip if every incoming value references to ourself.
1918 if (isa_and_nonnull<UndefValue>(P->hasConstantValue()))
1919 break;
1920
1921 Known.setAllConflict();
1922 for (const Use &U : P->operands()) {
1923 Value *IncValue;
1924 const PHINode *CxtPhi;
1925 Instruction *CxtI;
1926 breakSelfRecursivePHI(&U, P, IncValue, CxtI, &CxtPhi);
1927 // Skip direct self references.
1928 if (IncValue == P)
1929 continue;
1930
1931 // Change the context instruction to the "edge" that flows into the
1932 // phi. This is important because that is where the value is actually
1933 // "evaluated" even though it is used later somewhere else. (see also
1934 // D69571).
1936
1937 Known2 = KnownBits(BitWidth);
1938
1939 // Recurse, but cap the recursion to one level, because we don't
1940 // want to waste time spinning around in loops.
1941 // TODO: See if we can base recursion limiter on number of incoming phi
1942 // edges so we don't overly clamp analysis.
1943 computeKnownBits(IncValue, DemandedElts, Known2, RecQ,
1945
1946 // See if we can further use a conditional branch into the phi
1947 // to help us determine the range of the value.
1948 if (!Known2.isConstant()) {
1949 CmpPredicate Pred;
1950 const APInt *RHSC;
1951 BasicBlock *TrueSucc, *FalseSucc;
1952 // TODO: Use RHS Value and compute range from its known bits.
1953 if (match(RecQ.CxtI,
1954 m_Br(m_c_ICmp(Pred, m_Specific(IncValue), m_APInt(RHSC)),
1955 m_BasicBlock(TrueSucc), m_BasicBlock(FalseSucc)))) {
1956 // Check for cases of duplicate successors.
1957 if ((TrueSucc == CxtPhi->getParent()) !=
1958 (FalseSucc == CxtPhi->getParent())) {
1959 // If we're using the false successor, invert the predicate.
1960 if (FalseSucc == CxtPhi->getParent())
1961 Pred = CmpInst::getInversePredicate(Pred);
1962 // Get the knownbits implied by the incoming phi condition.
1963 auto CR = ConstantRange::makeExactICmpRegion(Pred, *RHSC);
1964 KnownBits KnownUnion = Known2.unionWith(CR.toKnownBits());
1965 // We can have conflicts here if we are analyzing deadcode (its
1966 // impossible for us reach this BB based the icmp).
1967 if (KnownUnion.hasConflict()) {
1968 // No reason to continue analyzing in a known dead region, so
1969 // just resetAll and break. This will cause us to also exit the
1970 // outer loop.
1971 Known.resetAll();
1972 break;
1973 }
1974 Known2 = KnownUnion;
1975 }
1976 }
1977 }
1978
1979 Known = Known.intersectWith(Known2);
1980 // If all bits have been ruled out, there's no need to check
1981 // more operands.
1982 if (Known.isUnknown())
1983 break;
1984 }
1985 }
1986 break;
1987 }
1988 case Instruction::Call:
1989 case Instruction::Invoke: {
1990 // If range metadata is attached to this call, set known bits from that,
1991 // and then intersect with known bits based on other properties of the
1992 // function.
1993 if (MDNode *MD =
1994 Q.IIQ.getMetadata(cast<Instruction>(I), LLVMContext::MD_range))
1996
1997 const auto *CB = cast<CallBase>(I);
1998
1999 if (std::optional<ConstantRange> Range = CB->getRange())
2000 Known = Known.unionWith(Range->toKnownBits());
2001
2002 if (const Value *RV = CB->getReturnedArgOperand()) {
2003 if (RV->getType() == I->getType()) {
2004 computeKnownBits(RV, Known2, Q, Depth + 1);
2005 Known = Known.unionWith(Known2);
2006 // If the function doesn't return properly for all input values
2007 // (e.g. unreachable exits) then there might be conflicts between the
2008 // argument value and the range metadata. Simply discard the known bits
2009 // in case of conflicts.
2010 if (Known.hasConflict())
2011 Known.resetAll();
2012 }
2013 }
2014 if (const IntrinsicInst *II = dyn_cast<IntrinsicInst>(I)) {
2015 switch (II->getIntrinsicID()) {
2016 default:
2017 break;
2018 case Intrinsic::abs: {
2019 computeKnownBits(I->getOperand(0), DemandedElts, Known2, Q, Depth + 1);
2020 bool IntMinIsPoison = match(II->getArgOperand(1), m_One());
2021 Known = Known.unionWith(Known2.abs(IntMinIsPoison));
2022 break;
2023 }
2024 case Intrinsic::bitreverse:
2025 computeKnownBits(I->getOperand(0), DemandedElts, Known2, Q, Depth + 1);
2026 Known = Known.unionWith(Known2.reverseBits());
2027 break;
2028 case Intrinsic::bswap:
2029 computeKnownBits(I->getOperand(0), DemandedElts, Known2, Q, Depth + 1);
2030 Known = Known.unionWith(Known2.byteSwap());
2031 break;
2032 case Intrinsic::ctlz: {
2033 computeKnownBits(I->getOperand(0), DemandedElts, Known2, Q, Depth + 1);
2034 // If we have a known 1, its position is our upper bound.
2035 unsigned PossibleLZ = Known2.countMaxLeadingZeros();
2036 // If this call is poison for 0 input, the result will be less than 2^n.
2037 if (II->getArgOperand(1) == ConstantInt::getTrue(II->getContext()))
2038 PossibleLZ = std::min(PossibleLZ, BitWidth - 1);
2039 unsigned LowBits = llvm::bit_width(PossibleLZ);
2040 Known.Zero.setBitsFrom(LowBits);
2041 break;
2042 }
2043 case Intrinsic::cttz: {
2044 computeKnownBits(I->getOperand(0), DemandedElts, Known2, Q, Depth + 1);
2045 // If we have a known 1, its position is our upper bound.
2046 unsigned PossibleTZ = Known2.countMaxTrailingZeros();
2047 // If this call is poison for 0 input, the result will be less than 2^n.
2048 if (II->getArgOperand(1) == ConstantInt::getTrue(II->getContext()))
2049 PossibleTZ = std::min(PossibleTZ, BitWidth - 1);
2050 unsigned LowBits = llvm::bit_width(PossibleTZ);
2051 Known.Zero.setBitsFrom(LowBits);
2052 break;
2053 }
2054 case Intrinsic::ctpop: {
2055 computeKnownBits(I->getOperand(0), DemandedElts, Known2, Q, Depth + 1);
2056 // We can bound the space the count needs. Also, bits known to be zero
2057 // can't contribute to the population.
2058 unsigned BitsPossiblySet = Known2.countMaxPopulation();
2059 unsigned LowBits = llvm::bit_width(BitsPossiblySet);
2060 Known.Zero.setBitsFrom(LowBits);
2061 // TODO: we could bound KnownOne using the lower bound on the number
2062 // of bits which might be set provided by popcnt KnownOne2.
2063 break;
2064 }
2065 case Intrinsic::fshr:
2066 case Intrinsic::fshl: {
2067 const APInt *SA;
2068 if (!match(I->getOperand(2), m_APInt(SA)))
2069 break;
2070
2071 // Normalize to funnel shift left.
2072 uint64_t ShiftAmt = SA->urem(BitWidth);
2073 if (II->getIntrinsicID() == Intrinsic::fshr)
2074 ShiftAmt = BitWidth - ShiftAmt;
2075
2076 KnownBits Known3(BitWidth);
2077 computeKnownBits(I->getOperand(0), DemandedElts, Known2, Q, Depth + 1);
2078 computeKnownBits(I->getOperand(1), DemandedElts, Known3, Q, Depth + 1);
2079
2080 Known2 <<= ShiftAmt;
2081 Known3 >>= BitWidth - ShiftAmt;
2082 Known = Known2.unionWith(Known3);
2083 break;
2084 }
2085 case Intrinsic::uadd_sat:
2086 computeKnownBits(I->getOperand(0), DemandedElts, Known, Q, Depth + 1);
2087 computeKnownBits(I->getOperand(1), DemandedElts, Known2, Q, Depth + 1);
2088 Known = KnownBits::uadd_sat(Known, Known2);
2089 break;
2090 case Intrinsic::usub_sat:
2091 computeKnownBits(I->getOperand(0), DemandedElts, Known, Q, Depth + 1);
2092 computeKnownBits(I->getOperand(1), DemandedElts, Known2, Q, Depth + 1);
2093 Known = KnownBits::usub_sat(Known, Known2);
2094 break;
2095 case Intrinsic::sadd_sat:
2096 computeKnownBits(I->getOperand(0), DemandedElts, Known, Q, Depth + 1);
2097 computeKnownBits(I->getOperand(1), DemandedElts, Known2, Q, Depth + 1);
2098 Known = KnownBits::sadd_sat(Known, Known2);
2099 break;
2100 case Intrinsic::ssub_sat:
2101 computeKnownBits(I->getOperand(0), DemandedElts, Known, Q, Depth + 1);
2102 computeKnownBits(I->getOperand(1), DemandedElts, Known2, Q, Depth + 1);
2103 Known = KnownBits::ssub_sat(Known, Known2);
2104 break;
2105 // Vec reverse preserves bits from input vec.
2106 case Intrinsic::vector_reverse:
2107 computeKnownBits(I->getOperand(0), DemandedElts.reverseBits(), Known, Q,
2108 Depth + 1);
2109 break;
2110 // for min/max/and/or reduce, any bit common to each element in the
2111 // input vec is set in the output.
2112 case Intrinsic::vector_reduce_and:
2113 case Intrinsic::vector_reduce_or:
2114 case Intrinsic::vector_reduce_umax:
2115 case Intrinsic::vector_reduce_umin:
2116 case Intrinsic::vector_reduce_smax:
2117 case Intrinsic::vector_reduce_smin:
2118 computeKnownBits(I->getOperand(0), Known, Q, Depth + 1);
2119 break;
2120 case Intrinsic::vector_reduce_xor: {
2121 computeKnownBits(I->getOperand(0), Known, Q, Depth + 1);
2122 // The zeros common to all vecs are zero in the output.
2123 // If the number of elements is odd, then the common ones remain. If the
2124 // number of elements is even, then the common ones becomes zeros.
2125 auto *VecTy = cast<VectorType>(I->getOperand(0)->getType());
2126 // Even, so the ones become zeros.
2127 bool EvenCnt = VecTy->getElementCount().isKnownEven();
2128 if (EvenCnt)
2129 Known.Zero |= Known.One;
2130 // Maybe even element count so need to clear ones.
2131 if (VecTy->isScalableTy() || EvenCnt)
2132 Known.One.clearAllBits();
2133 break;
2134 }
2135 case Intrinsic::umin:
2136 computeKnownBits(I->getOperand(0), DemandedElts, Known, Q, Depth + 1);
2137 computeKnownBits(I->getOperand(1), DemandedElts, Known2, Q, Depth + 1);
2138 Known = KnownBits::umin(Known, Known2);
2139 break;
2140 case Intrinsic::umax:
2141 computeKnownBits(I->getOperand(0), DemandedElts, Known, Q, Depth + 1);
2142 computeKnownBits(I->getOperand(1), DemandedElts, Known2, Q, Depth + 1);
2143 Known = KnownBits::umax(Known, Known2);
2144 break;
2145 case Intrinsic::smin:
2146 computeKnownBits(I->getOperand(0), DemandedElts, Known, Q, Depth + 1);
2147 computeKnownBits(I->getOperand(1), DemandedElts, Known2, Q, Depth + 1);
2148 Known = KnownBits::smin(Known, Known2);
2150 break;
2151 case Intrinsic::smax:
2152 computeKnownBits(I->getOperand(0), DemandedElts, Known, Q, Depth + 1);
2153 computeKnownBits(I->getOperand(1), DemandedElts, Known2, Q, Depth + 1);
2154 Known = KnownBits::smax(Known, Known2);
2156 break;
2157 case Intrinsic::ptrmask: {
2158 computeKnownBits(I->getOperand(0), DemandedElts, Known, Q, Depth + 1);
2159
2160 const Value *Mask = I->getOperand(1);
2161 Known2 = KnownBits(Mask->getType()->getScalarSizeInBits());
2162 computeKnownBits(Mask, DemandedElts, Known2, Q, Depth + 1);
2163 // TODO: 1-extend would be more precise.
2164 Known &= Known2.anyextOrTrunc(BitWidth);
2165 break;
2166 }
2167 case Intrinsic::x86_sse2_pmulh_w:
2168 case Intrinsic::x86_avx2_pmulh_w:
2169 case Intrinsic::x86_avx512_pmulh_w_512:
2170 computeKnownBits(I->getOperand(0), DemandedElts, Known, Q, Depth + 1);
2171 computeKnownBits(I->getOperand(1), DemandedElts, Known2, Q, Depth + 1);
2172 Known = KnownBits::mulhs(Known, Known2);
2173 break;
2174 case Intrinsic::x86_sse2_pmulhu_w:
2175 case Intrinsic::x86_avx2_pmulhu_w:
2176 case Intrinsic::x86_avx512_pmulhu_w_512:
2177 computeKnownBits(I->getOperand(0), DemandedElts, Known, Q, Depth + 1);
2178 computeKnownBits(I->getOperand(1), DemandedElts, Known2, Q, Depth + 1);
2179 Known = KnownBits::mulhu(Known, Known2);
2180 break;
2181 case Intrinsic::x86_sse42_crc32_64_64:
2182 Known.Zero.setBitsFrom(32);
2183 break;
2184 case Intrinsic::x86_ssse3_phadd_d_128:
2185 case Intrinsic::x86_ssse3_phadd_w_128:
2186 case Intrinsic::x86_avx2_phadd_d:
2187 case Intrinsic::x86_avx2_phadd_w: {
2189 I, DemandedElts, Q, Depth,
2190 [](const KnownBits &KnownLHS, const KnownBits &KnownRHS) {
2191 return KnownBits::add(KnownLHS, KnownRHS);
2192 });
2193 break;
2194 }
2195 case Intrinsic::x86_ssse3_phadd_sw_128:
2196 case Intrinsic::x86_avx2_phadd_sw: {
2198 I, DemandedElts, Q, Depth, KnownBits::sadd_sat);
2199 break;
2200 }
2201 case Intrinsic::x86_ssse3_phsub_d_128:
2202 case Intrinsic::x86_ssse3_phsub_w_128:
2203 case Intrinsic::x86_avx2_phsub_d:
2204 case Intrinsic::x86_avx2_phsub_w: {
2206 I, DemandedElts, Q, Depth,
2207 [](const KnownBits &KnownLHS, const KnownBits &KnownRHS) {
2208 return KnownBits::sub(KnownLHS, KnownRHS);
2209 });
2210 break;
2211 }
2212 case Intrinsic::x86_ssse3_phsub_sw_128:
2213 case Intrinsic::x86_avx2_phsub_sw: {
2215 I, DemandedElts, Q, Depth, KnownBits::ssub_sat);
2216 break;
2217 }
2218 case Intrinsic::riscv_vsetvli:
2219 case Intrinsic::riscv_vsetvlimax: {
2220 bool HasAVL = II->getIntrinsicID() == Intrinsic::riscv_vsetvli;
2221 const ConstantRange Range = getVScaleRange(II->getFunction(), BitWidth);
2223 cast<ConstantInt>(II->getArgOperand(HasAVL))->getZExtValue());
2224 RISCVVType::VLMUL VLMUL = static_cast<RISCVVType::VLMUL>(
2225 cast<ConstantInt>(II->getArgOperand(1 + HasAVL))->getZExtValue());
2226 uint64_t MaxVLEN =
2227 Range.getUnsignedMax().getZExtValue() * RISCV::RVVBitsPerBlock;
2228 uint64_t MaxVL = MaxVLEN / RISCVVType::getSEWLMULRatio(SEW, VLMUL);
2229
2230 // Result of vsetvli must be not larger than AVL.
2231 if (HasAVL)
2232 if (auto *CI = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(II->getArgOperand(0)))
2233 MaxVL = std::min(MaxVL, CI->getZExtValue());
2234
2235 unsigned KnownZeroFirstBit = Log2_32(MaxVL) + 1;
2236 if (BitWidth > KnownZeroFirstBit)
2237 Known.Zero.setBitsFrom(KnownZeroFirstBit);
2238 break;
2239 }
2240 case Intrinsic::vscale: {
2241 if (!II->getParent() || !II->getFunction())
2242 break;
2243
2244 Known = getVScaleRange(II->getFunction(), BitWidth).toKnownBits();
2245 break;
2246 }
2247 }
2248 }
2249 break;
2250 }
2251 case Instruction::ShuffleVector: {
2252 if (auto *Splat = getSplatValue(I)) {
2253 computeKnownBits(Splat, Known, Q, Depth + 1);
2254 break;
2255 }
2256
2257 auto *Shuf = dyn_cast<ShuffleVectorInst>(I);
2258 // FIXME: Do we need to handle ConstantExpr involving shufflevectors?
2259 if (!Shuf) {
2260 Known.resetAll();
2261 return;
2262 }
2263 // For undef elements, we don't know anything about the common state of
2264 // the shuffle result.
2265 APInt DemandedLHS, DemandedRHS;
2266 if (!getShuffleDemandedElts(Shuf, DemandedElts, DemandedLHS, DemandedRHS)) {
2267 Known.resetAll();
2268 return;
2269 }
2270 Known.setAllConflict();
2271 if (!!DemandedLHS) {
2272 const Value *LHS = Shuf->getOperand(0);
2273 computeKnownBits(LHS, DemandedLHS, Known, Q, Depth + 1);
2274 // If we don't know any bits, early out.
2275 if (Known.isUnknown())
2276 break;
2277 }
2278 if (!!DemandedRHS) {
2279 const Value *RHS = Shuf->getOperand(1);
2280 computeKnownBits(RHS, DemandedRHS, Known2, Q, Depth + 1);
2281 Known = Known.intersectWith(Known2);
2282 }
2283 break;
2284 }
2285 case Instruction::InsertElement: {
2286 if (isa<ScalableVectorType>(I->getType())) {
2287 Known.resetAll();
2288 return;
2289 }
2290 const Value *Vec = I->getOperand(0);
2291 const Value *Elt = I->getOperand(1);
2292 auto *CIdx = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(I->getOperand(2));
2293 unsigned NumElts = DemandedElts.getBitWidth();
2294 APInt DemandedVecElts = DemandedElts;
2295 bool NeedsElt = true;
2296 // If we know the index we are inserting too, clear it from Vec check.
2297 if (CIdx && CIdx->getValue().ult(NumElts)) {
2298 DemandedVecElts.clearBit(CIdx->getZExtValue());
2299 NeedsElt = DemandedElts[CIdx->getZExtValue()];
2300 }
2301
2302 Known.setAllConflict();
2303 if (NeedsElt) {
2304 computeKnownBits(Elt, Known, Q, Depth + 1);
2305 // If we don't know any bits, early out.
2306 if (Known.isUnknown())
2307 break;
2308 }
2309
2310 if (!DemandedVecElts.isZero()) {
2311 computeKnownBits(Vec, DemandedVecElts, Known2, Q, Depth + 1);
2312 Known = Known.intersectWith(Known2);
2313 }
2314 break;
2315 }
2316 case Instruction::ExtractElement: {
2317 // Look through extract element. If the index is non-constant or
2318 // out-of-range demand all elements, otherwise just the extracted element.
2319 const Value *Vec = I->getOperand(0);
2320 const Value *Idx = I->getOperand(1);
2321 auto *CIdx = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(Idx);
2322 if (isa<ScalableVectorType>(Vec->getType())) {
2323 // FIXME: there's probably *something* we can do with scalable vectors
2324 Known.resetAll();
2325 break;
2326 }
2327 unsigned NumElts = cast<FixedVectorType>(Vec->getType())->getNumElements();
2328 APInt DemandedVecElts = APInt::getAllOnes(NumElts);
2329 if (CIdx && CIdx->getValue().ult(NumElts))
2330 DemandedVecElts = APInt::getOneBitSet(NumElts, CIdx->getZExtValue());
2331 computeKnownBits(Vec, DemandedVecElts, Known, Q, Depth + 1);
2332 break;
2333 }
2334 case Instruction::ExtractValue:
2335 if (IntrinsicInst *II = dyn_cast<IntrinsicInst>(I->getOperand(0))) {
2337 if (EVI->getNumIndices() != 1) break;
2338 if (EVI->getIndices()[0] == 0) {
2339 switch (II->getIntrinsicID()) {
2340 default: break;
2341 case Intrinsic::uadd_with_overflow:
2342 case Intrinsic::sadd_with_overflow:
2344 true, II->getArgOperand(0), II->getArgOperand(1), /*NSW=*/false,
2345 /* NUW=*/false, DemandedElts, Known, Known2, Q, Depth);
2346 break;
2347 case Intrinsic::usub_with_overflow:
2348 case Intrinsic::ssub_with_overflow:
2350 false, II->getArgOperand(0), II->getArgOperand(1), /*NSW=*/false,
2351 /* NUW=*/false, DemandedElts, Known, Known2, Q, Depth);
2352 break;
2353 case Intrinsic::umul_with_overflow:
2354 case Intrinsic::smul_with_overflow:
2355 computeKnownBitsMul(II->getArgOperand(0), II->getArgOperand(1), false,
2356 false, DemandedElts, Known, Known2, Q, Depth);
2357 break;
2358 }
2359 }
2360 }
2361 break;
2362 case Instruction::Freeze:
2363 if (isGuaranteedNotToBePoison(I->getOperand(0), Q.AC, Q.CxtI, Q.DT,
2364 Depth + 1))
2365 computeKnownBits(I->getOperand(0), Known, Q, Depth + 1);
2366 break;
2367 }
2368}
2369
2370/// Determine which bits of V are known to be either zero or one and return
2371/// them.
2372KnownBits llvm::computeKnownBits(const Value *V, const APInt &DemandedElts,
2373 const SimplifyQuery &Q, unsigned Depth) {
2374 KnownBits Known(getBitWidth(V->getType(), Q.DL));
2375 ::computeKnownBits(V, DemandedElts, Known, Q, Depth);
2376 return Known;
2377}
2378
2379/// Determine which bits of V are known to be either zero or one and return
2380/// them.
2382 unsigned Depth) {
2383 KnownBits Known(getBitWidth(V->getType(), Q.DL));
2384 computeKnownBits(V, Known, Q, Depth);
2385 return Known;
2386}
2387
2388/// Determine which bits of V are known to be either zero or one and return
2389/// them in the Known bit set.
2390///
2391/// NOTE: we cannot consider 'undef' to be "IsZero" here. The problem is that
2392/// we cannot optimize based on the assumption that it is zero without changing
2393/// it to be an explicit zero. If we don't change it to zero, other code could
2394/// optimized based on the contradictory assumption that it is non-zero.
2395/// Because instcombine aggressively folds operations with undef args anyway,
2396/// this won't lose us code quality.
2397///
2398/// This function is defined on values with integer type, values with pointer
2399/// type, and vectors of integers. In the case
2400/// where V is a vector, known zero, and known one values are the
2401/// same width as the vector element, and the bit is set only if it is true
2402/// for all of the demanded elements in the vector specified by DemandedElts.
2403void computeKnownBits(const Value *V, const APInt &DemandedElts,
2404 KnownBits &Known, const SimplifyQuery &Q,
2405 unsigned Depth) {
2406 if (!DemandedElts) {
2407 // No demanded elts, better to assume we don't know anything.
2408 Known.resetAll();
2409 return;
2410 }
2411
2412 assert(V && "No Value?");
2413 assert(Depth <= MaxAnalysisRecursionDepth && "Limit Search Depth");
2414
2415#ifndef NDEBUG
2416 Type *Ty = V->getType();
2417 unsigned BitWidth = Known.getBitWidth();
2418
2419 assert((Ty->isIntOrIntVectorTy(BitWidth) || Ty->isPtrOrPtrVectorTy()) &&
2420 "Not integer or pointer type!");
2421
2422 if (auto *FVTy = dyn_cast<FixedVectorType>(Ty)) {
2423 assert(
2424 FVTy->getNumElements() == DemandedElts.getBitWidth() &&
2425 "DemandedElt width should equal the fixed vector number of elements");
2426 } else {
2427 assert(DemandedElts == APInt(1, 1) &&
2428 "DemandedElt width should be 1 for scalars or scalable vectors");
2429 }
2430
2431 Type *ScalarTy = Ty->getScalarType();
2432 if (ScalarTy->isPointerTy()) {
2433 assert(BitWidth == Q.DL.getPointerTypeSizeInBits(ScalarTy) &&
2434 "V and Known should have same BitWidth");
2435 } else {
2436 assert(BitWidth == Q.DL.getTypeSizeInBits(ScalarTy) &&
2437 "V and Known should have same BitWidth");
2438 }
2439#endif
2440
2441 const APInt *C;
2442 if (match(V, m_APInt(C))) {
2443 // We know all of the bits for a scalar constant or a splat vector constant!
2444 Known = KnownBits::makeConstant(*C);
2445 return;
2446 }
2447 // Null and aggregate-zero are all-zeros.
2449 Known.setAllZero();
2450 return;
2451 }
2452 // Handle a constant vector by taking the intersection of the known bits of
2453 // each element.
2455 assert(!isa<ScalableVectorType>(V->getType()));
2456 // We know that CDV must be a vector of integers. Take the intersection of
2457 // each element.
2458 Known.setAllConflict();
2459 for (unsigned i = 0, e = CDV->getNumElements(); i != e; ++i) {
2460 if (!DemandedElts[i])
2461 continue;
2462 APInt Elt = CDV->getElementAsAPInt(i);
2463 Known.Zero &= ~Elt;
2464 Known.One &= Elt;
2465 }
2466 if (Known.hasConflict())
2467 Known.resetAll();
2468 return;
2469 }
2470
2471 if (const auto *CV = dyn_cast<ConstantVector>(V)) {
2472 assert(!isa<ScalableVectorType>(V->getType()));
2473 // We know that CV must be a vector of integers. Take the intersection of
2474 // each element.
2475 Known.setAllConflict();
2476 for (unsigned i = 0, e = CV->getNumOperands(); i != e; ++i) {
2477 if (!DemandedElts[i])
2478 continue;
2479 Constant *Element = CV->getAggregateElement(i);
2480 if (isa<PoisonValue>(Element))
2481 continue;
2482 auto *ElementCI = dyn_cast_or_null<ConstantInt>(Element);
2483 if (!ElementCI) {
2484 Known.resetAll();
2485 return;
2486 }
2487 const APInt &Elt = ElementCI->getValue();
2488 Known.Zero &= ~Elt;
2489 Known.One &= Elt;
2490 }
2491 if (Known.hasConflict())
2492 Known.resetAll();
2493 return;
2494 }
2495
2496 // Start out not knowing anything.
2497 Known.resetAll();
2498
2499 // We can't imply anything about undefs.
2500 if (isa<UndefValue>(V))
2501 return;
2502
2503 // There's no point in looking through other users of ConstantData for
2504 // assumptions. Confirm that we've handled them all.
2505 assert(!isa<ConstantData>(V) && "Unhandled constant data!");
2506
2507 if (const auto *A = dyn_cast<Argument>(V))
2508 if (std::optional<ConstantRange> Range = A->getRange())
2509 Known = Range->toKnownBits();
2510
2511 // All recursive calls that increase depth must come after this.
2513 return;
2514
2515 // A weak GlobalAlias is totally unknown. A non-weak GlobalAlias has
2516 // the bits of its aliasee.
2517 if (const GlobalAlias *GA = dyn_cast<GlobalAlias>(V)) {
2518 if (!GA->isInterposable())
2519 computeKnownBits(GA->getAliasee(), Known, Q, Depth + 1);
2520 return;
2521 }
2522
2523 if (const Operator *I = dyn_cast<Operator>(V))
2524 computeKnownBitsFromOperator(I, DemandedElts, Known, Q, Depth);
2525 else if (const GlobalValue *GV = dyn_cast<GlobalValue>(V)) {
2526 if (std::optional<ConstantRange> CR = GV->getAbsoluteSymbolRange())
2527 Known = CR->toKnownBits();
2528 }
2529
2530 // Aligned pointers have trailing zeros - refine Known.Zero set
2531 if (isa<PointerType>(V->getType())) {
2532 Align Alignment = V->getPointerAlignment(Q.DL);
2533 Known.Zero.setLowBits(Log2(Alignment));
2534 }
2535
2536 // computeKnownBitsFromContext strictly refines Known.
2537 // Therefore, we run them after computeKnownBitsFromOperator.
2538
2539 // Check whether we can determine known bits from context such as assumes.
2540 computeKnownBitsFromContext(V, Known, Q, Depth);
2541}
2542
2543/// Try to detect a recurrence that the value of the induction variable is
2544/// always a power of two (or zero).
2545static bool isPowerOfTwoRecurrence(const PHINode *PN, bool OrZero,
2546 SimplifyQuery &Q, unsigned Depth) {
2547 BinaryOperator *BO = nullptr;
2548 Value *Start = nullptr, *Step = nullptr;
2549 if (!matchSimpleRecurrence(PN, BO, Start, Step))
2550 return false;
2551
2552 // Initial value must be a power of two.
2553 for (const Use &U : PN->operands()) {
2554 if (U.get() == Start) {
2555 // Initial value comes from a different BB, need to adjust context
2556 // instruction for analysis.
2557 Q.CxtI = PN->getIncomingBlock(U)->getTerminator();
2558 if (!isKnownToBeAPowerOfTwo(Start, OrZero, Q, Depth))
2559 return false;
2560 }
2561 }
2562
2563 // Except for Mul, the induction variable must be on the left side of the
2564 // increment expression, otherwise its value can be arbitrary.
2565 if (BO->getOpcode() != Instruction::Mul && BO->getOperand(1) != Step)
2566 return false;
2567
2568 Q.CxtI = BO->getParent()->getTerminator();
2569 switch (BO->getOpcode()) {
2570 case Instruction::Mul:
2571 // Power of two is closed under multiplication.
2572 return (OrZero || Q.IIQ.hasNoUnsignedWrap(BO) ||
2573 Q.IIQ.hasNoSignedWrap(BO)) &&
2574 isKnownToBeAPowerOfTwo(Step, OrZero, Q, Depth);
2575 case Instruction::SDiv:
2576 // Start value must not be signmask for signed division, so simply being a
2577 // power of two is not sufficient, and it has to be a constant.
2578 if (!match(Start, m_Power2()) || match(Start, m_SignMask()))
2579 return false;
2580 [[fallthrough]];
2581 case Instruction::UDiv:
2582 // Divisor must be a power of two.
2583 // If OrZero is false, cannot guarantee induction variable is non-zero after
2584 // division, same for Shr, unless it is exact division.
2585 return (OrZero || Q.IIQ.isExact(BO)) &&
2586 isKnownToBeAPowerOfTwo(Step, false, Q, Depth);
2587 case Instruction::Shl:
2588 return OrZero || Q.IIQ.hasNoUnsignedWrap(BO) || Q.IIQ.hasNoSignedWrap(BO);
2589 case Instruction::AShr:
2590 if (!match(Start, m_Power2()) || match(Start, m_SignMask()))
2591 return false;
2592 [[fallthrough]];
2593 case Instruction::LShr:
2594 return OrZero || Q.IIQ.isExact(BO);
2595 default:
2596 return false;
2597 }
2598}
2599
2600/// Return true if we can infer that \p V is known to be a power of 2 from
2601/// dominating condition \p Cond (e.g., ctpop(V) == 1).
2602static bool isImpliedToBeAPowerOfTwoFromCond(const Value *V, bool OrZero,
2603 const Value *Cond,
2604 bool CondIsTrue) {
2605 CmpPredicate Pred;
2606 const APInt *RHSC;
2608 m_APInt(RHSC))))
2609 return false;
2610 if (!CondIsTrue)
2611 Pred = ICmpInst::getInversePredicate(Pred);
2612 // ctpop(V) u< 2
2613 if (OrZero && Pred == ICmpInst::ICMP_ULT && *RHSC == 2)
2614 return true;
2615 // ctpop(V) == 1
2616 return Pred == ICmpInst::ICMP_EQ && *RHSC == 1;
2617}
2618
2619/// Return true if the given value is known to have exactly one
2620/// bit set when defined. For vectors return true if every element is known to
2621/// be a power of two when defined. Supports values with integer or pointer
2622/// types and vectors of integers.
2623bool llvm::isKnownToBeAPowerOfTwo(const Value *V, bool OrZero,
2624 const SimplifyQuery &Q, unsigned Depth) {
2625 assert(Depth <= MaxAnalysisRecursionDepth && "Limit Search Depth");
2626
2627 if (isa<Constant>(V))
2628 return OrZero ? match(V, m_Power2OrZero()) : match(V, m_Power2());
2629
2630 // i1 is by definition a power of 2 or zero.
2631 if (OrZero && V->getType()->getScalarSizeInBits() == 1)
2632 return true;
2633
2634 // Try to infer from assumptions.
2635 if (Q.AC && Q.CxtI) {
2636 for (auto &AssumeVH : Q.AC->assumptionsFor(V)) {
2637 if (!AssumeVH)
2638 continue;
2639 CallInst *I = cast<CallInst>(AssumeVH);
2640 if (isImpliedToBeAPowerOfTwoFromCond(V, OrZero, I->getArgOperand(0),
2641 /*CondIsTrue=*/true) &&
2643 return true;
2644 }
2645 }
2646
2647 // Handle dominating conditions.
2648 if (Q.DC && Q.CxtI && Q.DT) {
2649 for (BranchInst *BI : Q.DC->conditionsFor(V)) {
2650 Value *Cond = BI->getCondition();
2651
2652 BasicBlockEdge Edge0(BI->getParent(), BI->getSuccessor(0));
2654 /*CondIsTrue=*/true) &&
2655 Q.DT->dominates(Edge0, Q.CxtI->getParent()))
2656 return true;
2657
2658 BasicBlockEdge Edge1(BI->getParent(), BI->getSuccessor(1));
2660 /*CondIsTrue=*/false) &&
2661 Q.DT->dominates(Edge1, Q.CxtI->getParent()))
2662 return true;
2663 }
2664 }
2665
2666 auto *I = dyn_cast<Instruction>(V);
2667 if (!I)
2668 return false;
2669
2670 if (Q.CxtI && match(V, m_VScale())) {
2671 const Function *F = Q.CxtI->getFunction();
2672 // The vscale_range indicates vscale is a power-of-two.
2673 return F->hasFnAttribute(Attribute::VScaleRange);
2674 }
2675
2676 // 1 << X is clearly a power of two if the one is not shifted off the end. If
2677 // it is shifted off the end then the result is undefined.
2678 if (match(I, m_Shl(m_One(), m_Value())))
2679 return true;
2680
2681 // (signmask) >>l X is clearly a power of two if the one is not shifted off
2682 // the bottom. If it is shifted off the bottom then the result is undefined.
2683 if (match(I, m_LShr(m_SignMask(), m_Value())))
2684 return true;
2685
2686 // The remaining tests are all recursive, so bail out if we hit the limit.
2688 return false;
2689
2690 switch (I->getOpcode()) {
2691 case Instruction::ZExt:
2692 return isKnownToBeAPowerOfTwo(I->getOperand(0), OrZero, Q, Depth);
2693 case Instruction::Trunc:
2694 return OrZero && isKnownToBeAPowerOfTwo(I->getOperand(0), OrZero, Q, Depth);
2695 case Instruction::Shl:
2696 if (OrZero || Q.IIQ.hasNoUnsignedWrap(I) || Q.IIQ.hasNoSignedWrap(I))
2697 return isKnownToBeAPowerOfTwo(I->getOperand(0), OrZero, Q, Depth);
2698 return false;
2699 case Instruction::LShr:
2700 if (OrZero || Q.IIQ.isExact(cast<BinaryOperator>(I)))
2701 return isKnownToBeAPowerOfTwo(I->getOperand(0), OrZero, Q, Depth);
2702 return false;
2703 case Instruction::UDiv:
2705 return isKnownToBeAPowerOfTwo(I->getOperand(0), OrZero, Q, Depth);
2706 return false;
2707 case Instruction::Mul:
2708 return isKnownToBeAPowerOfTwo(I->getOperand(1), OrZero, Q, Depth) &&
2709 isKnownToBeAPowerOfTwo(I->getOperand(0), OrZero, Q, Depth) &&
2710 (OrZero || isKnownNonZero(I, Q, Depth));
2711 case Instruction::And:
2712 // A power of two and'd with anything is a power of two or zero.
2713 if (OrZero &&
2714 (isKnownToBeAPowerOfTwo(I->getOperand(1), /*OrZero*/ true, Q, Depth) ||
2715 isKnownToBeAPowerOfTwo(I->getOperand(0), /*OrZero*/ true, Q, Depth)))
2716 return true;
2717 // X & (-X) is always a power of two or zero.
2718 if (match(I->getOperand(0), m_Neg(m_Specific(I->getOperand(1)))) ||
2719 match(I->getOperand(1), m_Neg(m_Specific(I->getOperand(0)))))
2720 return OrZero || isKnownNonZero(I->getOperand(0), Q, Depth);
2721 return false;
2722 case Instruction::Add: {
2723 // Adding a power-of-two or zero to the same power-of-two or zero yields
2724 // either the original power-of-two, a larger power-of-two or zero.
2726 if (OrZero || Q.IIQ.hasNoUnsignedWrap(VOBO) ||
2727 Q.IIQ.hasNoSignedWrap(VOBO)) {
2728 if (match(I->getOperand(0),
2729 m_c_And(m_Specific(I->getOperand(1)), m_Value())) &&
2730 isKnownToBeAPowerOfTwo(I->getOperand(1), OrZero, Q, Depth))
2731 return true;
2732 if (match(I->getOperand(1),
2733 m_c_And(m_Specific(I->getOperand(0)), m_Value())) &&
2734 isKnownToBeAPowerOfTwo(I->getOperand(0), OrZero, Q, Depth))
2735 return true;
2736
2737 unsigned BitWidth = V->getType()->getScalarSizeInBits();
2738 KnownBits LHSBits(BitWidth);
2739 computeKnownBits(I->getOperand(0), LHSBits, Q, Depth);
2740
2741 KnownBits RHSBits(BitWidth);
2742 computeKnownBits(I->getOperand(1), RHSBits, Q, Depth);
2743 // If i8 V is a power of two or zero:
2744 // ZeroBits: 1 1 1 0 1 1 1 1
2745 // ~ZeroBits: 0 0 0 1 0 0 0 0
2746 if ((~(LHSBits.Zero & RHSBits.Zero)).isPowerOf2())
2747 // If OrZero isn't set, we cannot give back a zero result.
2748 // Make sure either the LHS or RHS has a bit set.
2749 if (OrZero || RHSBits.One.getBoolValue() || LHSBits.One.getBoolValue())
2750 return true;
2751 }
2752
2753 // LShr(UINT_MAX, Y) + 1 is a power of two (if add is nuw) or zero.
2754 if (OrZero || Q.IIQ.hasNoUnsignedWrap(VOBO))
2755 if (match(I, m_Add(m_LShr(m_AllOnes(), m_Value()), m_One())))
2756 return true;
2757 return false;
2758 }
2759 case Instruction::Select:
2760 return isKnownToBeAPowerOfTwo(I->getOperand(1), OrZero, Q, Depth) &&
2761 isKnownToBeAPowerOfTwo(I->getOperand(2), OrZero, Q, Depth);
2762 case Instruction::PHI: {
2763 // A PHI node is power of two if all incoming values are power of two, or if
2764 // it is an induction variable where in each step its value is a power of
2765 // two.
2766 auto *PN = cast<PHINode>(I);
2768
2769 // Check if it is an induction variable and always power of two.
2770 if (isPowerOfTwoRecurrence(PN, OrZero, RecQ, Depth))
2771 return true;
2772
2773 // Recursively check all incoming values. Limit recursion to 2 levels, so
2774 // that search complexity is limited to number of operands^2.
2775 unsigned NewDepth = std::max(Depth, MaxAnalysisRecursionDepth - 1);
2776 return llvm::all_of(PN->operands(), [&](const Use &U) {
2777 // Value is power of 2 if it is coming from PHI node itself by induction.
2778 if (U.get() == PN)
2779 return true;
2780
2781 // Change the context instruction to the incoming block where it is
2782 // evaluated.
2783 RecQ.CxtI = PN->getIncomingBlock(U)->getTerminator();
2784 return isKnownToBeAPowerOfTwo(U.get(), OrZero, RecQ, NewDepth);
2785 });
2786 }
2787 case Instruction::Invoke:
2788 case Instruction::Call: {
2789 if (auto *II = dyn_cast<IntrinsicInst>(I)) {
2790 switch (II->getIntrinsicID()) {
2791 case Intrinsic::umax:
2792 case Intrinsic::smax:
2793 case Intrinsic::umin:
2794 case Intrinsic::smin:
2795 return isKnownToBeAPowerOfTwo(II->getArgOperand(1), OrZero, Q, Depth) &&
2796 isKnownToBeAPowerOfTwo(II->getArgOperand(0), OrZero, Q, Depth);
2797 // bswap/bitreverse just move around bits, but don't change any 1s/0s
2798 // thus dont change pow2/non-pow2 status.
2799 case Intrinsic::bitreverse:
2800 case Intrinsic::bswap:
2801 return isKnownToBeAPowerOfTwo(II->getArgOperand(0), OrZero, Q, Depth);
2802 case Intrinsic::fshr:
2803 case Intrinsic::fshl:
2804 // If Op0 == Op1, this is a rotate. is_pow2(rotate(x, y)) == is_pow2(x)
2805 if (II->getArgOperand(0) == II->getArgOperand(1))
2806 return isKnownToBeAPowerOfTwo(II->getArgOperand(0), OrZero, Q, Depth);
2807 break;
2808 default:
2809 break;
2810 }
2811 }
2812 return false;
2813 }
2814 default:
2815 return false;
2816 }
2817}
2818
2819/// Test whether a GEP's result is known to be non-null.
2820///
2821/// Uses properties inherent in a GEP to try to determine whether it is known
2822/// to be non-null.
2823///
2824/// Currently this routine does not support vector GEPs.
2825static bool isGEPKnownNonNull(const GEPOperator *GEP, const SimplifyQuery &Q,
2826 unsigned Depth) {
2827 const Function *F = nullptr;
2828 if (const Instruction *I = dyn_cast<Instruction>(GEP))
2829 F = I->getFunction();
2830
2831 // If the gep is nuw or inbounds with invalid null pointer, then the GEP
2832 // may be null iff the base pointer is null and the offset is zero.
2833 if (!GEP->hasNoUnsignedWrap() &&
2834 !(GEP->isInBounds() &&
2835 !NullPointerIsDefined(F, GEP->getPointerAddressSpace())))
2836 return false;
2837
2838 // FIXME: Support vector-GEPs.
2839 assert(GEP->getType()->isPointerTy() && "We only support plain pointer GEP");
2840
2841 // If the base pointer is non-null, we cannot walk to a null address with an
2842 // inbounds GEP in address space zero.
2843 if (isKnownNonZero(GEP->getPointerOperand(), Q, Depth))
2844 return true;
2845
2846 // Walk the GEP operands and see if any operand introduces a non-zero offset.
2847 // If so, then the GEP cannot produce a null pointer, as doing so would
2848 // inherently violate the inbounds contract within address space zero.
2850 GTI != GTE; ++GTI) {
2851 // Struct types are easy -- they must always be indexed by a constant.
2852 if (StructType *STy = GTI.getStructTypeOrNull()) {
2853 ConstantInt *OpC = cast<ConstantInt>(GTI.getOperand());
2854 unsigned ElementIdx = OpC->getZExtValue();
2855 const StructLayout *SL = Q.DL.getStructLayout(STy);
2856 uint64_t ElementOffset = SL->getElementOffset(ElementIdx);
2857 if (ElementOffset > 0)
2858 return true;
2859 continue;
2860 }
2861
2862 // If we have a zero-sized type, the index doesn't matter. Keep looping.
2863 if (GTI.getSequentialElementStride(Q.DL).isZero())
2864 continue;
2865
2866 // Fast path the constant operand case both for efficiency and so we don't
2867 // increment Depth when just zipping down an all-constant GEP.
2868 if (ConstantInt *OpC = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(GTI.getOperand())) {
2869 if (!OpC->isZero())
2870 return true;
2871 continue;
2872 }
2873
2874 // We post-increment Depth here because while isKnownNonZero increments it
2875 // as well, when we pop back up that increment won't persist. We don't want
2876 // to recurse 10k times just because we have 10k GEP operands. We don't
2877 // bail completely out because we want to handle constant GEPs regardless
2878 // of depth.
2880 continue;
2881
2882 if (isKnownNonZero(GTI.getOperand(), Q, Depth))
2883 return true;
2884 }
2885
2886 return false;
2887}
2888
2890 const Instruction *CtxI,
2891 const DominatorTree *DT) {
2892 assert(!isa<Constant>(V) && "Called for constant?");
2893
2894 if (!CtxI || !DT)
2895 return false;
2896
2897 unsigned NumUsesExplored = 0;
2898 for (auto &U : V->uses()) {
2899 // Avoid massive lists
2900 if (NumUsesExplored >= DomConditionsMaxUses)
2901 break;
2902 NumUsesExplored++;
2903
2904 const Instruction *UI = cast<Instruction>(U.getUser());
2905 // If the value is used as an argument to a call or invoke, then argument
2906 // attributes may provide an answer about null-ness.
2907 if (V->getType()->isPointerTy()) {
2908 if (const auto *CB = dyn_cast<CallBase>(UI)) {
2909 if (CB->isArgOperand(&U) &&
2910 CB->paramHasNonNullAttr(CB->getArgOperandNo(&U),
2911 /*AllowUndefOrPoison=*/false) &&
2912 DT->dominates(CB, CtxI))
2913 return true;
2914 }
2915 }
2916
2917 // If the value is used as a load/store, then the pointer must be non null.
2918 if (V == getLoadStorePointerOperand(UI)) {
2921 DT->dominates(UI, CtxI))
2922 return true;
2923 }
2924
2925 if ((match(UI, m_IDiv(m_Value(), m_Specific(V))) ||
2926 match(UI, m_IRem(m_Value(), m_Specific(V)))) &&
2927 isValidAssumeForContext(UI, CtxI, DT))
2928 return true;
2929
2930 // Consider only compare instructions uniquely controlling a branch
2931 Value *RHS;
2932 CmpPredicate Pred;
2933 if (!match(UI, m_c_ICmp(Pred, m_Specific(V), m_Value(RHS))))
2934 continue;
2935
2936 bool NonNullIfTrue;
2937 if (cmpExcludesZero(Pred, RHS))
2938 NonNullIfTrue = true;
2940 NonNullIfTrue = false;
2941 else
2942 continue;
2943
2946 for (const auto *CmpU : UI->users()) {
2947 assert(WorkList.empty() && "Should be!");
2948 if (Visited.insert(CmpU).second)
2949 WorkList.push_back(CmpU);
2950
2951 while (!WorkList.empty()) {
2952 auto *Curr = WorkList.pop_back_val();
2953
2954 // If a user is an AND, add all its users to the work list. We only
2955 // propagate "pred != null" condition through AND because it is only
2956 // correct to assume that all conditions of AND are met in true branch.
2957 // TODO: Support similar logic of OR and EQ predicate?
2958 if (NonNullIfTrue)
2959 if (match(Curr, m_LogicalAnd(m_Value(), m_Value()))) {
2960 for (const auto *CurrU : Curr->users())
2961 if (Visited.insert(CurrU).second)
2962 WorkList.push_back(CurrU);
2963 continue;
2964 }
2965
2966 if (const BranchInst *BI = dyn_cast<BranchInst>(Curr)) {
2967 assert(BI->isConditional() && "uses a comparison!");
2968
2969 BasicBlock *NonNullSuccessor =
2970 BI->getSuccessor(NonNullIfTrue ? 0 : 1);
2971 BasicBlockEdge Edge(BI->getParent(), NonNullSuccessor);
2972 if (Edge.isSingleEdge() && DT->dominates(Edge, CtxI->getParent()))
2973 return true;
2974 } else if (NonNullIfTrue && isGuard(Curr) &&
2975 DT->dominates(cast<Instruction>(Curr), CtxI)) {
2976 return true;
2977 }
2978 }
2979 }
2980 }
2981
2982 return false;
2983}
2984
2985/// Does the 'Range' metadata (which must be a valid MD_range operand list)
2986/// ensure that the value it's attached to is never Value? 'RangeType' is
2987/// is the type of the value described by the range.
2988static bool rangeMetadataExcludesValue(const MDNode* Ranges, const APInt& Value) {
2989 const unsigned NumRanges = Ranges->getNumOperands() / 2;
2990 assert(NumRanges >= 1);
2991 for (unsigned i = 0; i < NumRanges; ++i) {
2993 mdconst::extract<ConstantInt>(Ranges->getOperand(2 * i + 0));
2995 mdconst::extract<ConstantInt>(Ranges->getOperand(2 * i + 1));
2996 ConstantRange Range(Lower->getValue(), Upper->getValue());
2997 if (Range.contains(Value))
2998 return false;
2999 }
3000 return true;
3001}
3002
3003/// Try to detect a recurrence that monotonically increases/decreases from a
3004/// non-zero starting value. These are common as induction variables.
3005static bool isNonZeroRecurrence(const PHINode *PN) {
3006 BinaryOperator *BO = nullptr;
3007 Value *Start = nullptr, *Step = nullptr;
3008 const APInt *StartC, *StepC;
3009 if (!matchSimpleRecurrence(PN, BO, Start, Step) ||
3010 !match(Start, m_APInt(StartC)) || StartC->isZero())
3011 return false;
3012
3013 switch (BO->getOpcode()) {
3014 case Instruction::Add:
3015 // Starting from non-zero and stepping away from zero can never wrap back
3016 // to zero.
3017 return BO->hasNoUnsignedWrap() ||
3018 (BO->hasNoSignedWrap() && match(Step, m_APInt(StepC)) &&
3019 StartC->isNegative() == StepC->isNegative());
3020 case Instruction::Mul:
3021 return (BO->hasNoUnsignedWrap() || BO->hasNoSignedWrap()) &&
3022 match(Step, m_APInt(StepC)) && !StepC->isZero();
3023 case Instruction::Shl:
3024 return BO->hasNoUnsignedWrap() || BO->hasNoSignedWrap();
3025 case Instruction::AShr:
3026 case Instruction::LShr:
3027 return BO->isExact();
3028 default:
3029 return false;
3030 }
3031}
3032
3033static bool matchOpWithOpEqZero(Value *Op0, Value *Op1) {
3035 m_Specific(Op1), m_Zero()))) ||
3037 m_Specific(Op0), m_Zero())));
3038}
3039
3040static bool isNonZeroAdd(const APInt &DemandedElts, const SimplifyQuery &Q,
3041 unsigned BitWidth, Value *X, Value *Y, bool NSW,
3042 bool NUW, unsigned Depth) {
3043 // (X + (X != 0)) is non zero
3044 if (matchOpWithOpEqZero(X, Y))
3045 return true;
3046
3047 if (NUW)
3048 return isKnownNonZero(Y, DemandedElts, Q, Depth) ||
3049 isKnownNonZero(X, DemandedElts, Q, Depth);
3050
3051 KnownBits XKnown = computeKnownBits(X, DemandedElts, Q, Depth);
3052 KnownBits YKnown = computeKnownBits(Y, DemandedElts, Q, Depth);
3053
3054 // If X and Y are both non-negative (as signed values) then their sum is not
3055 // zero unless both X and Y are zero.
3056 if (XKnown.isNonNegative() && YKnown.isNonNegative())
3057 if (isKnownNonZero(Y, DemandedElts, Q, Depth) ||
3058 isKnownNonZero(X, DemandedElts, Q, Depth))
3059 return true;
3060
3061 // If X and Y are both negative (as signed values) then their sum is not
3062 // zero unless both X and Y equal INT_MIN.
3063 if (XKnown.isNegative() && YKnown.isNegative()) {
3065 // The sign bit of X is set. If some other bit is set then X is not equal
3066 // to INT_MIN.
3067 if (XKnown.One.intersects(Mask))
3068 return true;
3069 // The sign bit of Y is set. If some other bit is set then Y is not equal
3070 // to INT_MIN.
3071 if (YKnown.One.intersects(Mask))
3072 return true;
3073 }
3074
3075 // The sum of a non-negative number and a power of two is not zero.
3076 if (XKnown.isNonNegative() &&
3077 isKnownToBeAPowerOfTwo(Y, /*OrZero*/ false, Q, Depth))
3078 return true;
3079 if (YKnown.isNonNegative() &&
3080 isKnownToBeAPowerOfTwo(X, /*OrZero*/ false, Q, Depth))
3081 return true;
3082
3083 return KnownBits::add(XKnown, YKnown, NSW, NUW).isNonZero();
3084}
3085
3086static bool isNonZeroSub(const APInt &DemandedElts, const SimplifyQuery &Q,
3087 unsigned BitWidth, Value *X, Value *Y,
3088 unsigned Depth) {
3089 // (X - (X != 0)) is non zero
3090 // ((X != 0) - X) is non zero
3091 if (matchOpWithOpEqZero(X, Y))
3092 return true;
3093
3094 // TODO: Move this case into isKnownNonEqual().
3095 if (auto *C = dyn_cast<Constant>(X))
3096 if (C->isNullValue() && isKnownNonZero(Y, DemandedElts, Q, Depth))
3097 return true;
3098
3099 return ::isKnownNonEqual(X, Y, DemandedElts, Q, Depth);
3100}
3101
3102static bool isNonZeroMul(const APInt &DemandedElts, const SimplifyQuery &Q,
3103 unsigned BitWidth, Value *X, Value *Y, bool NSW,
3104 bool NUW, unsigned Depth) {
3105 // If X and Y are non-zero then so is X * Y as long as the multiplication
3106 // does not overflow.
3107 if (NSW || NUW)
3108 return isKnownNonZero(X, DemandedElts, Q, Depth) &&
3109 isKnownNonZero(Y, DemandedElts, Q, Depth);
3110
3111 // If either X or Y is odd, then if the other is non-zero the result can't
3112 // be zero.
3113 KnownBits XKnown = computeKnownBits(X, DemandedElts, Q, Depth);
3114 if (XKnown.One[0])
3115 return isKnownNonZero(Y, DemandedElts, Q, Depth);
3116
3117 KnownBits YKnown = computeKnownBits(Y, DemandedElts, Q, Depth);
3118 if (YKnown.One[0])
3119 return XKnown.isNonZero() || isKnownNonZero(X, DemandedElts, Q, Depth);
3120
3121 // If there exists any subset of X (sX) and subset of Y (sY) s.t sX * sY is
3122 // non-zero, then X * Y is non-zero. We can find sX and sY by just taking
3123 // the lowest known One of X and Y. If they are non-zero, the result
3124 // must be non-zero. We can check if LSB(X) * LSB(Y) != 0 by doing
3125 // X.CountLeadingZeros + Y.CountLeadingZeros < BitWidth.
3126 return (XKnown.countMaxTrailingZeros() + YKnown.countMaxTrailingZeros()) <
3127 BitWidth;
3128}
3129
3130static bool isNonZeroShift(const Operator *I, const APInt &DemandedElts,
3131 const SimplifyQuery &Q, const KnownBits &KnownVal,
3132 unsigned Depth) {
3133 auto ShiftOp = [&](const APInt &Lhs, const APInt &Rhs) {
3134 switch (I->getOpcode()) {
3135 case Instruction::Shl:
3136 return Lhs.shl(Rhs);
3137 case Instruction::LShr:
3138 return Lhs.lshr(Rhs);
3139 case Instruction::AShr:
3140 return Lhs.ashr(Rhs);
3141 default:
3142 llvm_unreachable("Unknown Shift Opcode");
3143 }
3144 };
3145
3146 auto InvShiftOp = [&](const APInt &Lhs, const APInt &Rhs) {
3147 switch (I->getOpcode()) {
3148 case Instruction::Shl:
3149 return Lhs.lshr(Rhs);
3150 case Instruction::LShr:
3151 case Instruction::AShr:
3152 return Lhs.shl(Rhs);
3153 default:
3154 llvm_unreachable("Unknown Shift Opcode");
3155 }
3156 };
3157
3158 if (KnownVal.isUnknown())
3159 return false;
3160
3161 KnownBits KnownCnt =
3162 computeKnownBits(I->getOperand(1), DemandedElts, Q, Depth);
3163 APInt MaxShift = KnownCnt.getMaxValue();
3164 unsigned NumBits = KnownVal.getBitWidth();
3165 if (MaxShift.uge(NumBits))
3166 return false;
3167
3168 if (!ShiftOp(KnownVal.One, MaxShift).isZero())
3169 return true;
3170
3171 // If all of the bits shifted out are known to be zero, and Val is known
3172 // non-zero then at least one non-zero bit must remain.
3173 if (InvShiftOp(KnownVal.Zero, NumBits - MaxShift)
3174 .eq(InvShiftOp(APInt::getAllOnes(NumBits), NumBits - MaxShift)) &&
3175 isKnownNonZero(I->getOperand(0), DemandedElts, Q, Depth))
3176 return true;
3177
3178 return false;
3179}
3180
3182 const APInt &DemandedElts,
3183 const SimplifyQuery &Q, unsigned Depth) {
3184 unsigned BitWidth = getBitWidth(I->getType()->getScalarType(), Q.DL);
3185 switch (I->getOpcode()) {
3186 case Instruction::Alloca:
3187 // Alloca never returns null, malloc might.
3188 return I->getType()->getPointerAddressSpace() == 0;
3189 case Instruction::GetElementPtr:
3190 if (I->getType()->isPointerTy())
3192 break;
3193 case Instruction::BitCast: {
3194 // We need to be a bit careful here. We can only peek through the bitcast
3195 // if the scalar size of elements in the operand are smaller than and a
3196 // multiple of the size they are casting too. Take three cases:
3197 //
3198 // 1) Unsafe:
3199 // bitcast <2 x i16> %NonZero to <4 x i8>
3200 //
3201 // %NonZero can have 2 non-zero i16 elements, but isKnownNonZero on a
3202 // <4 x i8> requires that all 4 i8 elements be non-zero which isn't
3203 // guranteed (imagine just sign bit set in the 2 i16 elements).
3204 //
3205 // 2) Unsafe:
3206 // bitcast <4 x i3> %NonZero to <3 x i4>
3207 //
3208 // Even though the scalar size of the src (`i3`) is smaller than the
3209 // scalar size of the dst `i4`, because `i3` is not a multiple of `i4`
3210 // its possible for the `3 x i4` elements to be zero because there are
3211 // some elements in the destination that don't contain any full src
3212 // element.
3213 //
3214 // 3) Safe:
3215 // bitcast <4 x i8> %NonZero to <2 x i16>
3216 //
3217 // This is always safe as non-zero in the 4 i8 elements implies
3218 // non-zero in the combination of any two adjacent ones. Since i8 is a
3219 // multiple of i16, each i16 is guranteed to have 2 full i8 elements.
3220 // This all implies the 2 i16 elements are non-zero.
3221 Type *FromTy = I->getOperand(0)->getType();
3222 if ((FromTy->isIntOrIntVectorTy() || FromTy->isPtrOrPtrVectorTy()) &&
3223 (BitWidth % getBitWidth(FromTy->getScalarType(), Q.DL)) == 0)
3224 return isKnownNonZero(I->getOperand(0), Q, Depth);
3225 } break;
3226 case Instruction::IntToPtr:
3227 // Note that we have to take special care to avoid looking through
3228 // truncating casts, e.g., int2ptr/ptr2int with appropriate sizes, as well
3229 // as casts that can alter the value, e.g., AddrSpaceCasts.
3230 if (!isa<ScalableVectorType>(I->getType()) &&
3231 Q.DL.getTypeSizeInBits(I->getOperand(0)->getType()).getFixedValue() <=
3232 Q.DL.getTypeSizeInBits(I->getType()).getFixedValue())
3233 return isKnownNonZero(I->getOperand(0), DemandedElts, Q, Depth);
3234 break;
3235 case Instruction::PtrToInt:
3236 // Similar to int2ptr above, we can look through ptr2int here if the cast
3237 // is a no-op or an extend and not a truncate.
3238 if (!isa<ScalableVectorType>(I->getType()) &&
3239 Q.DL.getTypeSizeInBits(I->getOperand(0)->getType()).getFixedValue() <=
3240 Q.DL.getTypeSizeInBits(I->getType()).getFixedValue())
3241 return isKnownNonZero(I->getOperand(0), DemandedElts, Q, Depth);
3242 break;
3243 case Instruction::Trunc:
3244 // nuw/nsw trunc preserves zero/non-zero status of input.
3245 if (auto *TI = dyn_cast<TruncInst>(I))
3246 if (TI->hasNoSignedWrap() || TI->hasNoUnsignedWrap())
3247 return isKnownNonZero(TI->getOperand(0), DemandedElts, Q, Depth);
3248 break;
3249
3250 // Iff x - y != 0, then x ^ y != 0
3251 // Therefore we can do the same exact checks
3252 case Instruction::Xor:
3253 case Instruction::Sub:
3254 return isNonZeroSub(DemandedElts, Q, BitWidth, I->getOperand(0),
3255 I->getOperand(1), Depth);
3256 case Instruction::Or:
3257 // (X | (X != 0)) is non zero
3258 if (matchOpWithOpEqZero(I->getOperand(0), I->getOperand(1)))
3259 return true;
3260 // X | Y != 0 if X != Y.
3261 if (isKnownNonEqual(I->getOperand(0), I->getOperand(1), DemandedElts, Q,
3262 Depth))
3263 return true;
3264 // X | Y != 0 if X != 0 or Y != 0.
3265 return isKnownNonZero(I->getOperand(1), DemandedElts, Q, Depth) ||
3266 isKnownNonZero(I->getOperand(0), DemandedElts, Q, Depth);
3267 case Instruction::SExt:
3268 case Instruction::ZExt:
3269 // ext X != 0 if X != 0.
3270 return isKnownNonZero(I->getOperand(0), DemandedElts, Q, Depth);
3271
3272 case Instruction::Shl: {
3273 // shl nsw/nuw can't remove any non-zero bits.
3275 if (Q.IIQ.hasNoUnsignedWrap(BO) || Q.IIQ.hasNoSignedWrap(BO))
3276 return isKnownNonZero(I->getOperand(0), DemandedElts, Q, Depth);
3277
3278 // shl X, Y != 0 if X is odd. Note that the value of the shift is undefined
3279 // if the lowest bit is shifted off the end.
3280 KnownBits Known(BitWidth);
3281 computeKnownBits(I->getOperand(0), DemandedElts, Known, Q, Depth);
3282 if (Known.One[0])
3283 return true;
3284
3285 return isNonZeroShift(I, DemandedElts, Q, Known, Depth);
3286 }
3287 case Instruction::LShr:
3288 case Instruction::AShr: {
3289 // shr exact can only shift out zero bits.
3291 if (BO->isExact())
3292 return isKnownNonZero(I->getOperand(0), DemandedElts, Q, Depth);
3293
3294 // shr X, Y != 0 if X is negative. Note that the value of the shift is not
3295 // defined if the sign bit is shifted off the end.
3296 KnownBits Known =
3297 computeKnownBits(I->getOperand(0), DemandedElts, Q, Depth);
3298 if (Known.isNegative())
3299 return true;
3300
3301 return isNonZeroShift(I, DemandedElts, Q, Known, Depth);
3302 }
3303 case Instruction::UDiv:
3304 case Instruction::SDiv: {
3305 // X / Y
3306 // div exact can only produce a zero if the dividend is zero.
3307 if (cast<PossiblyExactOperator>(I)->isExact())
3308 return isKnownNonZero(I->getOperand(0), DemandedElts, Q, Depth);
3309
3310 KnownBits XKnown =
3311 computeKnownBits(I->getOperand(0), DemandedElts, Q, Depth);
3312 // If X is fully unknown we won't be able to figure anything out so don't
3313 // both computing knownbits for Y.
3314 if (XKnown.isUnknown())
3315 return false;
3316
3317 KnownBits YKnown =
3318 computeKnownBits(I->getOperand(1), DemandedElts, Q, Depth);
3319 if (I->getOpcode() == Instruction::SDiv) {
3320 // For signed division need to compare abs value of the operands.
3321 XKnown = XKnown.abs(/*IntMinIsPoison*/ false);
3322 YKnown = YKnown.abs(/*IntMinIsPoison*/ false);
3323 }
3324 // If X u>= Y then div is non zero (0/0 is UB).
3325 std::optional<bool> XUgeY = KnownBits::uge(XKnown, YKnown);
3326 // If X is total unknown or X u< Y we won't be able to prove non-zero
3327 // with compute known bits so just return early.
3328 return XUgeY && *XUgeY;
3329 }
3330 case Instruction::Add: {
3331 // X + Y.
3332
3333 // If Add has nuw wrap flag, then if either X or Y is non-zero the result is
3334 // non-zero.
3336 return isNonZeroAdd(DemandedElts, Q, BitWidth, I->getOperand(0),
3337 I->getOperand(1), Q.IIQ.hasNoSignedWrap(BO),
3338 Q.IIQ.hasNoUnsignedWrap(BO), Depth);
3339 }
3340 case Instruction::Mul: {
3342 return isNonZeroMul(DemandedElts, Q, BitWidth, I->getOperand(0),
3343 I->getOperand(1), Q.IIQ.hasNoSignedWrap(BO),
3344 Q.IIQ.hasNoUnsignedWrap(BO), Depth);
3345 }
3346 case Instruction::Select: {
3347 // (C ? X : Y) != 0 if X != 0 and Y != 0.
3348
3349 // First check if the arm is non-zero using `isKnownNonZero`. If that fails,
3350 // then see if the select condition implies the arm is non-zero. For example
3351 // (X != 0 ? X : Y), we know the true arm is non-zero as the `X` "return" is
3352 // dominated by `X != 0`.
3353 auto SelectArmIsNonZero = [&](bool IsTrueArm) {
3354 Value *Op;
3355 Op = IsTrueArm ? I->getOperand(1) : I->getOperand(2);
3356 // Op is trivially non-zero.
3357 if (isKnownNonZero(Op, DemandedElts, Q, Depth))
3358 return true;
3359
3360 // The condition of the select dominates the true/false arm. Check if the
3361 // condition implies that a given arm is non-zero.
3362 Value *X;
3363 CmpPredicate Pred;
3364 if (!match(I->getOperand(0), m_c_ICmp(Pred, m_Specific(Op), m_Value(X))))
3365 return false;
3366
3367 if (!IsTrueArm)
3368 Pred = ICmpInst::getInversePredicate(Pred);
3369
3370 return cmpExcludesZero(Pred, X);
3371 };
3372
3373 if (SelectArmIsNonZero(/* IsTrueArm */ true) &&
3374 SelectArmIsNonZero(/* IsTrueArm */ false))
3375 return true;
3376 break;
3377 }
3378 case Instruction::PHI: {
3379 auto *PN = cast<PHINode>(I);
3381 return true;
3382
3383 // Check if all incoming values are non-zero using recursion.
3385 unsigned NewDepth = std::max(Depth, MaxAnalysisRecursionDepth - 1);
3386 return llvm::all_of(PN->operands(), [&](const Use &U) {
3387 if (U.get() == PN)
3388 return true;
3389 RecQ.CxtI = PN->getIncomingBlock(U)->getTerminator();
3390 // Check if the branch on the phi excludes zero.
3391 CmpPredicate Pred;
3392 Value *X;
3393 BasicBlock *TrueSucc, *FalseSucc;
3394 if (match(RecQ.CxtI,
3395 m_Br(m_c_ICmp(Pred, m_Specific(U.get()), m_Value(X)),
3396 m_BasicBlock(TrueSucc), m_BasicBlock(FalseSucc)))) {
3397 // Check for cases of duplicate successors.
3398 if ((TrueSucc == PN->getParent()) != (FalseSucc == PN->getParent())) {
3399 // If we're using the false successor, invert the predicate.
3400 if (FalseSucc == PN->getParent())
3401 Pred = CmpInst::getInversePredicate(Pred);
3402 if (cmpExcludesZero(Pred, X))
3403 return true;
3404 }
3405 }
3406 // Finally recurse on the edge and check it directly.
3407 return isKnownNonZero(U.get(), DemandedElts, RecQ, NewDepth);
3408 });
3409 }
3410 case Instruction::InsertElement: {
3411 if (isa<ScalableVectorType>(I->getType()))
3412 break;
3413
3414 const Value *Vec = I->getOperand(0);
3415 const Value *Elt = I->getOperand(1);
3416 auto *CIdx = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(I->getOperand(2));
3417
3418 unsigned NumElts = DemandedElts.getBitWidth();
3419 APInt DemandedVecElts = DemandedElts;
3420 bool SkipElt = false;
3421 // If we know the index we are inserting too, clear it from Vec check.
3422 if (CIdx && CIdx->getValue().ult(NumElts)) {
3423 DemandedVecElts.clearBit(CIdx->getZExtValue());
3424 SkipElt = !DemandedElts[CIdx->getZExtValue()];
3425 }
3426
3427 // Result is zero if Elt is non-zero and rest of the demanded elts in Vec
3428 // are non-zero.
3429 return (SkipElt || isKnownNonZero(Elt, Q, Depth)) &&
3430 (DemandedVecElts.isZero() ||
3431 isKnownNonZero(Vec, DemandedVecElts, Q, Depth));
3432 }
3433 case Instruction::ExtractElement:
3434 if (const auto *EEI = dyn_cast<ExtractElementInst>(I)) {
3435 const Value *Vec = EEI->getVectorOperand();
3436 const Value *Idx = EEI->getIndexOperand();
3437 auto *CIdx = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(Idx);
3438 if (auto *VecTy = dyn_cast<FixedVectorType>(Vec->getType())) {
3439 unsigned NumElts = VecTy->getNumElements();
3440 APInt DemandedVecElts = APInt::getAllOnes(NumElts);
3441 if (CIdx && CIdx->getValue().ult(NumElts))
3442 DemandedVecElts = APInt::getOneBitSet(NumElts, CIdx->getZExtValue());
3443 return isKnownNonZero(Vec, DemandedVecElts, Q, Depth);
3444 }
3445 }
3446 break;
3447 case Instruction::ShuffleVector: {
3448 auto *Shuf = dyn_cast<ShuffleVectorInst>(I);
3449 if (!Shuf)
3450 break;
3451 APInt DemandedLHS, DemandedRHS;
3452 // For undef elements, we don't know anything about the common state of
3453 // the shuffle result.
3454 if (!getShuffleDemandedElts(Shuf, DemandedElts, DemandedLHS, DemandedRHS))
3455 break;
3456 // If demanded elements for both vecs are non-zero, the shuffle is non-zero.
3457 return (DemandedRHS.isZero() ||
3458 isKnownNonZero(Shuf->getOperand(1), DemandedRHS, Q, Depth)) &&
3459 (DemandedLHS.isZero() ||
3460 isKnownNonZero(Shuf->getOperand(0), DemandedLHS, Q, Depth));
3461 }
3462 case Instruction::Freeze:
3463 return isKnownNonZero(I->getOperand(0), Q, Depth) &&
3464 isGuaranteedNotToBePoison(I->getOperand(0), Q.AC, Q.CxtI, Q.DT,
3465 Depth);
3466 case Instruction::Load: {
3467 auto *LI = cast<LoadInst>(I);
3468 // A Load tagged with nonnull or dereferenceable with null pointer undefined
3469 // is never null.
3470 if (auto *PtrT = dyn_cast<PointerType>(I->getType())) {
3471 if (Q.IIQ.getMetadata(LI, LLVMContext::MD_nonnull) ||
3472 (Q.IIQ.getMetadata(LI, LLVMContext::MD_dereferenceable) &&
3473 !NullPointerIsDefined(LI->getFunction(), PtrT->getAddressSpace())))
3474 return true;
3475 } else if (MDNode *Ranges = Q.IIQ.getMetadata(LI, LLVMContext::MD_range)) {
3477 }
3478
3479 // No need to fall through to computeKnownBits as range metadata is already
3480 // handled in isKnownNonZero.
3481 return false;
3482 }
3483 case Instruction::ExtractValue: {
3484 const WithOverflowInst *WO;
3486 switch (WO->getBinaryOp()) {
3487 default:
3488 break;
3489 case Instruction::Add:
3490 return isNonZeroAdd(DemandedElts, Q, BitWidth, WO->getArgOperand(0),
3491 WO->getArgOperand(1),
3492 /*NSW=*/false,
3493 /*NUW=*/false, Depth);
3494 case Instruction::Sub:
3495 return isNonZeroSub(DemandedElts, Q, BitWidth, WO->getArgOperand(0),
3496 WO->getArgOperand(1), Depth);
3497 case Instruction::Mul:
3498 return isNonZeroMul(DemandedElts, Q, BitWidth, WO->getArgOperand(0),
3499 WO->getArgOperand(1),
3500 /*NSW=*/false, /*NUW=*/false, Depth);
3501 break;
3502 }
3503 }
3504 break;
3505 }
3506 case Instruction::Call:
3507 case Instruction::Invoke: {
3508 const auto *Call = cast<CallBase>(I);
3509 if (I->getType()->isPointerTy()) {
3510 if (Call->isReturnNonNull())
3511 return true;
3512 if (const auto *RP = getArgumentAliasingToReturnedPointer(Call, true))
3513 return isKnownNonZero(RP, Q, Depth);
3514 } else {
3515 if (MDNode *Ranges = Q.IIQ.getMetadata(Call, LLVMContext::MD_range))
3517 if (std::optional<ConstantRange> Range = Call->getRange()) {
3518 const APInt ZeroValue(Range->getBitWidth(), 0);
3519 if (!Range->contains(ZeroValue))
3520 return true;
3521 }
3522 if (const Value *RV = Call->getReturnedArgOperand())
3523 if (RV->getType() == I->getType() && isKnownNonZero(RV, Q, Depth))
3524 return true;
3525 }
3526
3527 if (auto *II = dyn_cast<IntrinsicInst>(I)) {
3528 switch (II->getIntrinsicID()) {
3529 case Intrinsic::sshl_sat:
3530 case Intrinsic::ushl_sat:
3531 case Intrinsic::abs:
3532 case Intrinsic::bitreverse:
3533 case Intrinsic::bswap:
3534 case Intrinsic::ctpop:
3535 return isKnownNonZero(II->getArgOperand(0), DemandedElts, Q, Depth);
3536 // NB: We don't do usub_sat here as in any case we can prove its
3537 // non-zero, we will fold it to `sub nuw` in InstCombine.
3538 case Intrinsic::ssub_sat:
3539 return isNonZeroSub(DemandedElts, Q, BitWidth, II->getArgOperand(0),
3540 II->getArgOperand(1), Depth);
3541 case Intrinsic::sadd_sat:
3542 return isNonZeroAdd(DemandedElts, Q, BitWidth, II->getArgOperand(0),
3543 II->getArgOperand(1),
3544 /*NSW=*/true, /* NUW=*/false, Depth);
3545 // Vec reverse preserves zero/non-zero status from input vec.
3546 case Intrinsic::vector_reverse:
3547 return isKnownNonZero(II->getArgOperand(0), DemandedElts.reverseBits(),
3548 Q, Depth);
3549 // umin/smin/smax/smin/or of all non-zero elements is always non-zero.
3550 case Intrinsic::vector_reduce_or:
3551 case Intrinsic::vector_reduce_umax:
3552 case Intrinsic::vector_reduce_umin:
3553 case Intrinsic::vector_reduce_smax:
3554 case Intrinsic::vector_reduce_smin:
3555 return isKnownNonZero(II->getArgOperand(0), Q, Depth);
3556 case Intrinsic::umax:
3557 case Intrinsic::uadd_sat:
3558 // umax(X, (X != 0)) is non zero
3559 // X +usat (X != 0) is non zero
3560 if (matchOpWithOpEqZero(II->getArgOperand(0), II->getArgOperand(1)))
3561 return true;
3562
3563 return isKnownNonZero(II->getArgOperand(1), DemandedElts, Q, Depth) ||
3564 isKnownNonZero(II->getArgOperand(0), DemandedElts, Q, Depth);
3565 case Intrinsic::smax: {
3566 // If either arg is strictly positive the result is non-zero. Otherwise
3567 // the result is non-zero if both ops are non-zero.
3568 auto IsNonZero = [&](Value *Op, std::optional<bool> &OpNonZero,
3569 const KnownBits &OpKnown) {
3570 if (!OpNonZero.has_value())
3571 OpNonZero = OpKnown.isNonZero() ||
3572 isKnownNonZero(Op, DemandedElts, Q, Depth);
3573 return *OpNonZero;
3574 };
3575 // Avoid re-computing isKnownNonZero.
3576 std::optional<bool> Op0NonZero, Op1NonZero;
3577 KnownBits Op1Known =
3578 computeKnownBits(II->getArgOperand(1), DemandedElts, Q, Depth);
3579 if (Op1Known.isNonNegative() &&
3580 IsNonZero(II->getArgOperand(1), Op1NonZero, Op1Known))
3581 return true;
3582 KnownBits Op0Known =
3583 computeKnownBits(II->getArgOperand(0), DemandedElts, Q, Depth);
3584 if (Op0Known.isNonNegative() &&
3585 IsNonZero(II->getArgOperand(0), Op0NonZero, Op0Known))
3586 return true;
3587 return IsNonZero(II->getArgOperand(1), Op1NonZero, Op1Known) &&
3588 IsNonZero(II->getArgOperand(0), Op0NonZero, Op0Known);
3589 }
3590 case Intrinsic::smin: {
3591 // If either arg is negative the result is non-zero. Otherwise
3592 // the result is non-zero if both ops are non-zero.
3593 KnownBits Op1Known =
3594 computeKnownBits(II->getArgOperand(1), DemandedElts, Q, Depth);
3595 if (Op1Known.isNegative())
3596 return true;
3597 KnownBits Op0Known =
3598 computeKnownBits(II->getArgOperand(0), DemandedElts, Q, Depth);
3599 if (Op0Known.isNegative())
3600 return true;
3601
3602 if (Op1Known.isNonZero() && Op0Known.isNonZero())
3603 return true;
3604 }
3605 [[fallthrough]];
3606 case Intrinsic::umin:
3607 return isKnownNonZero(II->getArgOperand(0), DemandedElts, Q, Depth) &&
3608 isKnownNonZero(II->getArgOperand(1), DemandedElts, Q, Depth);
3609 case Intrinsic::cttz:
3610 return computeKnownBits(II->getArgOperand(0), DemandedElts, Q, Depth)
3611 .Zero[0];
3612 case Intrinsic::ctlz:
3613 return computeKnownBits(II->getArgOperand(0), DemandedElts, Q, Depth)
3614 .isNonNegative();
3615 case Intrinsic::fshr:
3616 case Intrinsic::fshl:
3617 // If Op0 == Op1, this is a rotate. rotate(x, y) != 0 iff x != 0.
3618 if (II->getArgOperand(0) == II->getArgOperand(1))
3619 return isKnownNonZero(II->getArgOperand(0), DemandedElts, Q, Depth);
3620 break;
3621 case Intrinsic::vscale:
3622 return true;
3623 case Intrinsic::experimental_get_vector_length:
3624 return isKnownNonZero(I->getOperand(0), Q, Depth);
3625 default:
3626 break;
3627 }
3628 break;
3629 }
3630
3631 return false;
3632 }
3633 }
3634
3635 KnownBits Known(BitWidth);
3636 computeKnownBits(I, DemandedElts, Known, Q, Depth);
3637 return Known.One != 0;
3638}
3639
3640/// Return true if the given value is known to be non-zero when defined. For
3641/// vectors, return true if every demanded element is known to be non-zero when
3642/// defined. For pointers, if the context instruction and dominator tree are
3643/// specified, perform context-sensitive analysis and return true if the
3644/// pointer couldn't possibly be null at the specified instruction.
3645/// Supports values with integer or pointer type and vectors of integers.
3646bool isKnownNonZero(const Value *V, const APInt &DemandedElts,
3647 const SimplifyQuery &Q, unsigned Depth) {
3648 Type *Ty = V->getType();
3649
3650#ifndef NDEBUG
3651 assert(Depth <= MaxAnalysisRecursionDepth && "Limit Search Depth");
3652
3653 if (auto *FVTy = dyn_cast<FixedVectorType>(Ty)) {
3654 assert(
3655 FVTy->getNumElements() == DemandedElts.getBitWidth() &&
3656 "DemandedElt width should equal the fixed vector number of elements");
3657 } else {
3658 assert(DemandedElts == APInt(1, 1) &&
3659 "DemandedElt width should be 1 for scalars");
3660 }
3661#endif
3662
3663 if (auto *C = dyn_cast<Constant>(V)) {
3664 if (C->isNullValue())
3665 return false;
3666 if (isa<ConstantInt>(C))
3667 // Must be non-zero due to null test above.
3668 return true;
3669
3670 // For constant vectors, check that all elements are poison or known
3671 // non-zero to determine that the whole vector is known non-zero.
3672 if (auto *VecTy = dyn_cast<FixedVectorType>(Ty)) {
3673 for (unsigned i = 0, e = VecTy->getNumElements(); i != e; ++i) {
3674 if (!DemandedElts[i])
3675 continue;
3676 Constant *Elt = C->getAggregateElement(i);
3677 if (!Elt || Elt->isNullValue())
3678 return false;
3679 if (!isa<PoisonValue>(Elt) && !isa<ConstantInt>(Elt))
3680 return false;
3681 }
3682 return true;
3683 }
3684
3685 // Constant ptrauth can be null, iff the base pointer can be.
3686 if (auto *CPA = dyn_cast<ConstantPtrAuth>(V))
3687 return isKnownNonZero(CPA->getPointer(), DemandedElts, Q, Depth);
3688
3689 // A global variable in address space 0 is non null unless extern weak
3690 // or an absolute symbol reference. Other address spaces may have null as a
3691 // valid address for a global, so we can't assume anything.
3692 if (const GlobalValue *GV = dyn_cast<GlobalValue>(V)) {
3693 if (!GV->isAbsoluteSymbolRef() && !GV->hasExternalWeakLinkage() &&
3694 GV->getType()->getAddressSpace() == 0)
3695 return true;
3696 }
3697
3698 // For constant expressions, fall through to the Operator code below.
3699 if (!isa<ConstantExpr>(V))
3700 return false;
3701 }
3702
3703 if (const auto *A = dyn_cast<Argument>(V))
3704 if (std::optional<ConstantRange> Range = A->getRange()) {
3705 const APInt ZeroValue(Range->getBitWidth(), 0);
3706 if (!Range->contains(ZeroValue))
3707 return true;
3708 }
3709
3710 if (!isa<Constant>(V) && isKnownNonZeroFromAssume(V, Q))
3711 return true;
3712
3713 // Some of the tests below are recursive, so bail out if we hit the limit.
3715 return false;
3716
3717 // Check for pointer simplifications.
3718
3719 if (PointerType *PtrTy = dyn_cast<PointerType>(Ty)) {
3720 // A byval, inalloca may not be null in a non-default addres space. A
3721 // nonnull argument is assumed never 0.
3722 if (const Argument *A = dyn_cast<Argument>(V)) {
3723 if (((A->hasPassPointeeByValueCopyAttr() &&
3724 !NullPointerIsDefined(A->getParent(), PtrTy->getAddressSpace())) ||
3725 A->hasNonNullAttr()))
3726 return true;
3727 }
3728 }
3729
3730 if (const auto *I = dyn_cast<Operator>(V))
3731 if (isKnownNonZeroFromOperator(I, DemandedElts, Q, Depth))
3732 return true;
3733
3734 if (!isa<Constant>(V) &&
3736 return true;
3737
3738 if (const Value *Stripped = stripNullTest(V))
3739 return isKnownNonZero(Stripped, DemandedElts, Q, Depth);
3740
3741 return false;
3742}
3743
3745 unsigned Depth) {
3746 auto *FVTy = dyn_cast<FixedVectorType>(V->getType());
3747 APInt DemandedElts =
3748 FVTy ? APInt::getAllOnes(FVTy->getNumElements()) : APInt(1, 1);
3749 return ::isKnownNonZero(V, DemandedElts, Q, Depth);
3750}
3751
3752/// If the pair of operators are the same invertible function, return the
3753/// the operands of the function corresponding to each input. Otherwise,
3754/// return std::nullopt. An invertible function is one that is 1-to-1 and maps
3755/// every input value to exactly one output value. This is equivalent to
3756/// saying that Op1 and Op2 are equal exactly when the specified pair of
3757/// operands are equal, (except that Op1 and Op2 may be poison more often.)
3758static std::optional<std::pair<Value*, Value*>>
3760 const Operator *Op2) {
3761 if (Op1->getOpcode() != Op2->getOpcode())
3762 return std::nullopt;
3763
3764 auto getOperands = [&](unsigned OpNum) -> auto {
3765 return std::make_pair(Op1->getOperand(OpNum), Op2->getOperand(OpNum));
3766 };
3767
3768 switch (Op1->getOpcode()) {
3769 default:
3770 break;
3771 case Instruction::Or:
3772 if (!cast<PossiblyDisjointInst>(Op1)->isDisjoint() ||
3773 !cast<PossiblyDisjointInst>(Op2)->isDisjoint())
3774 break;
3775 [[fallthrough]];
3776 case Instruction::Xor:
3777 case Instruction::Add: {
3778 Value *Other;
3779 if (match(Op2, m_c_BinOp(m_Specific(Op1->getOperand(0)), m_Value(Other))))
3780 return std::make_pair(Op1->getOperand(1), Other);
3781 if (match(Op2, m_c_BinOp(m_Specific(Op1->getOperand(1)), m_Value(Other))))
3782 return std::make_pair(Op1->getOperand(0), Other);
3783 break;
3784 }
3785 case Instruction::Sub:
3786 if (Op1->getOperand(0) == Op2->getOperand(0))
3787 return getOperands(1);
3788 if (Op1->getOperand(1) == Op2->getOperand(1))
3789 return getOperands(0);
3790 break;
3791 case Instruction::Mul: {
3792 // invertible if A * B == (A * B) mod 2^N where A, and B are integers
3793 // and N is the bitwdith. The nsw case is non-obvious, but proven by
3794 // alive2: https://alive2.llvm.org/ce/z/Z6D5qK
3795 auto *OBO1 = cast<OverflowingBinaryOperator>(Op1);
3796 auto *OBO2 = cast<OverflowingBinaryOperator>(Op2);
3797 if ((!OBO1->hasNoUnsignedWrap() || !OBO2->hasNoUnsignedWrap()) &&
3798 (!OBO1->hasNoSignedWrap() || !OBO2->hasNoSignedWrap()))
3799 break;
3800
3801 // Assume operand order has been canonicalized
3802 if (Op1->getOperand(1) == Op2->getOperand(1) &&
3803 isa<ConstantInt>(Op1->getOperand(1)) &&
3804 !cast<ConstantInt>(Op1->getOperand(1))->isZero())
3805 return getOperands(0);
3806 break;
3807 }
3808 case Instruction::Shl: {
3809 // Same as multiplies, with the difference that we don't need to check
3810 // for a non-zero multiply. Shifts always multiply by non-zero.
3811 auto *OBO1 = cast<OverflowingBinaryOperator>(Op1);
3812 auto *OBO2 = cast<OverflowingBinaryOperator>(Op2);
3813 if ((!OBO1->hasNoUnsignedWrap() || !OBO2->hasNoUnsignedWrap()) &&
3814 (!OBO1->hasNoSignedWrap() || !OBO2->hasNoSignedWrap()))
3815 break;
3816
3817 if (Op1->getOperand(1) == Op2->getOperand(1))
3818 return getOperands(0);
3819 break;
3820 }
3821 case Instruction::AShr:
3822 case Instruction::LShr: {
3823 auto *PEO1 = cast<PossiblyExactOperator>(Op1);
3824 auto *PEO2 = cast<PossiblyExactOperator>(Op2);
3825 if (!PEO1->isExact() || !PEO2->isExact())
3826 break;
3827
3828 if (Op1->getOperand(1) == Op2->getOperand(1))
3829 return getOperands(0);
3830 break;
3831 }
3832 case Instruction::SExt:
3833 case Instruction::ZExt:
3834 if (Op1->getOperand(0)->getType() == Op2->getOperand(0)->getType())
3835 return getOperands(0);
3836 break;
3837 case Instruction::PHI: {
3838 const PHINode *PN1 = cast<PHINode>(Op1);
3839 const PHINode *PN2 = cast<PHINode>(Op2);
3840
3841 // If PN1 and PN2 are both recurrences, can we prove the entire recurrences
3842 // are a single invertible function of the start values? Note that repeated
3843 // application of an invertible function is also invertible
3844 BinaryOperator *BO1 = nullptr;
3845 Value *Start1 = nullptr, *Step1 = nullptr;
3846 BinaryOperator *BO2 = nullptr;
3847 Value *Start2 = nullptr, *Step2 = nullptr;
3848 if (PN1->getParent() != PN2->getParent() ||
3849 !matchSimpleRecurrence(PN1, BO1, Start1, Step1) ||
3850 !matchSimpleRecurrence(PN2, BO2, Start2, Step2))
3851 break;
3852
3853 auto Values = getInvertibleOperands(cast<Operator>(BO1),
3854 cast<Operator>(BO2));
3855 if (!Values)
3856 break;
3857
3858 // We have to be careful of mutually defined recurrences here. Ex:
3859 // * X_i = X_(i-1) OP Y_(i-1), and Y_i = X_(i-1) OP V
3860 // * X_i = Y_i = X_(i-1) OP Y_(i-1)
3861 // The invertibility of these is complicated, and not worth reasoning
3862 // about (yet?).
3863 if (Values->first != PN1 || Values->second != PN2)
3864 break;
3865
3866 return std::make_pair(Start1, Start2);
3867 }
3868 }
3869 return std::nullopt;
3870}
3871
3872/// Return true if V1 == (binop V2, X), where X is known non-zero.
3873/// Only handle a small subset of binops where (binop V2, X) with non-zero X
3874/// implies V2 != V1.
3875static bool isModifyingBinopOfNonZero(const Value *V1, const Value *V2,
3876 const APInt &DemandedElts,
3877 const SimplifyQuery &Q, unsigned Depth) {
3879 if (!BO)
3880 return false;
3881 switch (BO->getOpcode()) {
3882 default:
3883 break;
3884 case Instruction::Or:
3885 if (!cast<PossiblyDisjointInst>(V1)->isDisjoint())
3886 break;
3887 [[fallthrough]];
3888 case Instruction::Xor:
3889 case Instruction::Add:
3890 Value *Op = nullptr;
3891 if (V2 == BO->getOperand(0))
3892 Op = BO->getOperand(1);
3893 else if (V2 == BO->getOperand(1))
3894 Op = BO->getOperand(0);
3895 else
3896 return false;
3897 return isKnownNonZero(Op, DemandedElts, Q, Depth + 1);
3898 }
3899 return false;
3900}
3901
3902/// Return true if V2 == V1 * C, where V1 is known non-zero, C is not 0/1 and
3903/// the multiplication is nuw or nsw.
3904static bool isNonEqualMul(const Value *V1, const Value *V2,
3905 const APInt &DemandedElts, const SimplifyQuery &Q,
3906 unsigned Depth) {
3907 if (auto *OBO = dyn_cast<OverflowingBinaryOperator>(V2)) {
3908 const APInt *C;
3909 return match(OBO, m_Mul(m_Specific(V1), m_APInt(C))) &&
3910 (OBO->hasNoUnsignedWrap() || OBO->hasNoSignedWrap()) &&
3911 !C->isZero() && !C->isOne() &&
3912 isKnownNonZero(V1, DemandedElts, Q, Depth + 1);
3913 }
3914 return false;
3915}
3916
3917/// Return true if V2 == V1 << C, where V1 is known non-zero, C is not 0 and
3918/// the shift is nuw or nsw.
3919static bool isNonEqualShl(const Value *V1, const Value *V2,
3920 const APInt &DemandedElts, const SimplifyQuery &Q,
3921 unsigned Depth) {
3922 if (auto *OBO = dyn_cast<OverflowingBinaryOperator>(V2)) {
3923 const APInt *C;
3924 return match(OBO, m_Shl(m_Specific(V1), m_APInt(C))) &&
3925 (OBO->hasNoUnsignedWrap() || OBO->hasNoSignedWrap()) &&
3926 !C->isZero() && isKnownNonZero(V1, DemandedElts, Q, Depth + 1);
3927 }
3928 return false;
3929}
3930
3931static bool isNonEqualPHIs(const PHINode *PN1, const PHINode *PN2,
3932 const APInt &DemandedElts, const SimplifyQuery &Q,
3933 unsigned Depth) {
3934 // Check two PHIs are in same block.
3935 if (PN1->getParent() != PN2->getParent())
3936 return false;
3937
3939 bool UsedFullRecursion = false;
3940 for (const BasicBlock *IncomBB : PN1->blocks()) {
3941 if (!VisitedBBs.insert(IncomBB).second)
3942 continue; // Don't reprocess blocks that we have dealt with already.
3943 const Value *IV1 = PN1->getIncomingValueForBlock(IncomBB);
3944 const Value *IV2 = PN2->getIncomingValueForBlock(IncomBB);
3945 const APInt *C1, *C2;
3946 if (match(IV1, m_APInt(C1)) && match(IV2, m_APInt(C2)) && *C1 != *C2)
3947 continue;
3948
3949 // Only one pair of phi operands is allowed for full recursion.
3950 if (UsedFullRecursion)
3951 return false;
3952
3954 RecQ.CxtI = IncomBB->getTerminator();
3955 if (!isKnownNonEqual(IV1, IV2, DemandedElts, RecQ, Depth + 1))
3956 return false;
3957 UsedFullRecursion = true;
3958 }
3959 return true;
3960}
3961
3962static bool isNonEqualSelect(const Value *V1, const Value *V2,
3963 const APInt &DemandedElts, const SimplifyQuery &Q,
3964 unsigned Depth) {
3965 const SelectInst *SI1 = dyn_cast<SelectInst>(V1);
3966 if (!SI1)
3967 return false;
3968
3969 if (const SelectInst *SI2 = dyn_cast<SelectInst>(V2)) {
3970 const Value *Cond1 = SI1->getCondition();
3971 const Value *Cond2 = SI2->getCondition();
3972 if (Cond1 == Cond2)
3973 return isKnownNonEqual(SI1->getTrueValue(), SI2->getTrueValue(),
3974 DemandedElts, Q, Depth + 1) &&
3975 isKnownNonEqual(SI1->getFalseValue(), SI2->getFalseValue(),
3976 DemandedElts, Q, Depth + 1);
3977 }
3978 return isKnownNonEqual(SI1->getTrueValue(), V2, DemandedElts, Q, Depth + 1) &&
3979 isKnownNonEqual(SI1->getFalseValue(), V2, DemandedElts, Q, Depth + 1);
3980}
3981
3982// Check to see if A is both a GEP and is the incoming value for a PHI in the
3983// loop, and B is either a ptr or another GEP. If the PHI has 2 incoming values,
3984// one of them being the recursive GEP A and the other a ptr at same base and at
3985// the same/higher offset than B we are only incrementing the pointer further in
3986// loop if offset of recursive GEP is greater than 0.
3988 const SimplifyQuery &Q) {
3989 if (!A->getType()->isPointerTy() || !B->getType()->isPointerTy())
3990 return false;
3991
3992 auto *GEPA = dyn_cast<GEPOperator>(A);
3993 if (!GEPA || GEPA->getNumIndices() != 1 || !isa<Constant>(GEPA->idx_begin()))
3994 return false;
3995
3996 // Handle 2 incoming PHI values with one being a recursive GEP.
3997 auto *PN = dyn_cast<PHINode>(GEPA->getPointerOperand());
3998 if (!PN || PN->getNumIncomingValues() != 2)
3999 return false;
4000
4001 // Search for the recursive GEP as an incoming operand, and record that as
4002 // Step.
4003 Value *Start = nullptr;
4004 Value *Step = const_cast<Value *>(A);
4005 if (PN->getIncomingValue(0) == Step)
4006 Start = PN->getIncomingValue(1);
4007 else if (PN->getIncomingValue(1) == Step)
4008 Start = PN->getIncomingValue(0);
4009 else
4010 return false;
4011
4012 // Other incoming node base should match the B base.
4013 // StartOffset >= OffsetB && StepOffset > 0?
4014 // StartOffset <= OffsetB && StepOffset < 0?
4015 // Is non-equal if above are true.
4016 // We use stripAndAccumulateInBoundsConstantOffsets to restrict the
4017 // optimisation to inbounds GEPs only.
4018 unsigned IndexWidth = Q.DL.getIndexTypeSizeInBits(Start->getType());
4019 APInt StartOffset(IndexWidth, 0);
4020 Start = Start->stripAndAccumulateInBoundsConstantOffsets(Q.DL, StartOffset);
4021 APInt StepOffset(IndexWidth, 0);
4022 Step = Step->stripAndAccumulateInBoundsConstantOffsets(Q.DL, StepOffset);
4023
4024 // Check if Base Pointer of Step matches the PHI.
4025 if (Step != PN)
4026 return false;
4027 APInt OffsetB(IndexWidth, 0);
4028 B = B->stripAndAccumulateInBoundsConstantOffsets(Q.DL, OffsetB);
4029 return Start == B &&
4030 ((StartOffset.sge(OffsetB) && StepOffset.isStrictlyPositive()) ||
4031 (StartOffset.sle(OffsetB) && StepOffset.isNegative()));
4032}
4033
4034static bool isKnownNonEqualFromContext(const Value *V1, const Value *V2,
4035 const SimplifyQuery &Q, unsigned Depth) {
4036 if (!Q.CxtI)
4037 return false;
4038
4039 // Try to infer NonEqual based on information from dominating conditions.
4040 if (Q.DC && Q.DT) {
4041 auto IsKnownNonEqualFromDominatingCondition = [&](const Value *V) {
4042 for (BranchInst *BI : Q.DC->conditionsFor(V)) {
4043 Value *Cond = BI->getCondition();
4044 BasicBlockEdge Edge0(BI->getParent(), BI->getSuccessor(0));
4045 if (Q.DT->dominates(Edge0, Q.CxtI->getParent()) &&
4047 /*LHSIsTrue=*/true, Depth)
4048 .value_or(false))
4049 return true;
4050
4051 BasicBlockEdge Edge1(BI->getParent(), BI->getSuccessor(1));
4052 if (Q.DT->dominates(Edge1, Q.CxtI->getParent()) &&
4054 /*LHSIsTrue=*/false, Depth)
4055 .value_or(false))
4056 return true;
4057 }
4058
4059 return false;
4060 };
4061
4062 if (IsKnownNonEqualFromDominatingCondition(V1) ||
4063 IsKnownNonEqualFromDominatingCondition(V2))
4064 return true;
4065 }
4066
4067 if (!Q.AC)
4068 return false;
4069
4070 // Try to infer NonEqual based on information from assumptions.
4071 for (auto &AssumeVH : Q.AC->assumptionsFor(V1)) {
4072 if (!AssumeVH)
4073 continue;
4074 CallInst *I = cast<CallInst>(AssumeVH);
4075
4076 assert(I->getFunction() == Q.CxtI->getFunction() &&
4077 "Got assumption for the wrong function!");
4078 assert(I->getIntrinsicID() == Intrinsic::assume &&
4079 "must be an assume intrinsic");
4080
4081 if (isImpliedCondition(I->getArgOperand(0), ICmpInst::ICMP_NE, V1, V2, Q.DL,
4082 /*LHSIsTrue=*/true, Depth)
4083 .value_or(false) &&
4085 return true;
4086 }
4087
4088 return false;
4089}
4090
4091/// Return true if it is known that V1 != V2.
4092static bool isKnownNonEqual(const Value *V1, const Value *V2,
4093 const APInt &DemandedElts, const SimplifyQuery &Q,
4094 unsigned Depth) {
4095 if (V1 == V2)
4096 return false;
4097 if (V1->getType() != V2->getType())
4098 // We can't look through casts yet.
4099 return false;
4100
4102 return false;
4103
4104 // See if we can recurse through (exactly one of) our operands. This
4105 // requires our operation be 1-to-1 and map every input value to exactly
4106 // one output value. Such an operation is invertible.
4107 auto *O1 = dyn_cast<Operator>(V1);
4108 auto *O2 = dyn_cast<Operator>(V2);
4109 if (O1 && O2 && O1->getOpcode() == O2->getOpcode()) {
4110 if (auto Values = getInvertibleOperands(O1, O2))
4111 return isKnownNonEqual(Values->first, Values->second, DemandedElts, Q,
4112 Depth + 1);
4113
4114 if (const PHINode *PN1 = dyn_cast<PHINode>(V1)) {
4115 const PHINode *PN2 = cast<PHINode>(V2);
4116 // FIXME: This is missing a generalization to handle the case where one is
4117 // a PHI and another one isn't.
4118 if (isNonEqualPHIs(PN1, PN2, DemandedElts, Q, Depth))
4119 return true;
4120 };
4121 }
4122
4123 if (isModifyingBinopOfNonZero(V1, V2, DemandedElts, Q, Depth) ||
4124 isModifyingBinopOfNonZero(V2, V1, DemandedElts, Q, Depth))
4125 return true;
4126
4127 if (isNonEqualMul(V1, V2, DemandedElts, Q, Depth) ||
4128 isNonEqualMul(V2, V1, DemandedElts, Q, Depth))
4129 return true;
4130
4131 if (isNonEqualShl(V1, V2, DemandedElts, Q, Depth) ||
4132 isNonEqualShl(V2, V1, DemandedElts, Q, Depth))
4133 return true;
4134
4135 if (V1->getType()->isIntOrIntVectorTy()) {
4136 // Are any known bits in V1 contradictory to known bits in V2? If V1
4137 // has a known zero where V2 has a known one, they must not be equal.
4138 KnownBits Known1 = computeKnownBits(V1, DemandedElts, Q, Depth);
4139 if (!Known1.isUnknown()) {
4140 KnownBits Known2 = computeKnownBits(V2, DemandedElts, Q, Depth);
4141 if (Known1.Zero.intersects(Known2.One) ||
4142 Known2.Zero.intersects(Known1.One))
4143 return true;
4144 }
4145 }
4146
4147 if (isNonEqualSelect(V1, V2, DemandedElts, Q, Depth) ||
4148 isNonEqualSelect(V2, V1, DemandedElts, Q, Depth))
4149 return true;
4150
4151 if (isNonEqualPointersWithRecursiveGEP(V1, V2, Q) ||
4153 return true;
4154
4155 Value *A, *B;
4156 // PtrToInts are NonEqual if their Ptrs are NonEqual.
4157 // Check PtrToInt type matches the pointer size.
4158 if (match(V1, m_PtrToIntSameSize(Q.DL, m_Value(A))) &&
4160 return isKnownNonEqual(A, B, DemandedElts, Q, Depth + 1);
4161
4162 if (isKnownNonEqualFromContext(V1, V2, Q, Depth))
4163 return true;
4164
4165 return false;
4166}
4167
4168/// For vector constants, loop over the elements and find the constant with the
4169/// minimum number of sign bits. Return 0 if the value is not a vector constant
4170/// or if any element was not analyzed; otherwise, return the count for the
4171/// element with the minimum number of sign bits.
4173 const APInt &DemandedElts,
4174 unsigned TyBits) {
4175 const auto *CV = dyn_cast<Constant>(V);
4176 if (!CV || !isa<FixedVectorType>(CV->getType()))
4177 return 0;
4178
4179 unsigned MinSignBits = TyBits;
4180 unsigned NumElts = cast<FixedVectorType>(CV->getType())->getNumElements();
4181 for (unsigned i = 0; i != NumElts; ++i) {
4182 if (!DemandedElts[i])
4183 continue;
4184 // If we find a non-ConstantInt, bail out.
4185 auto *Elt = dyn_cast_or_null<ConstantInt>(CV->getAggregateElement(i));
4186 if (!Elt)
4187 return 0;
4188
4189 MinSignBits = std::min(MinSignBits, Elt->getValue().getNumSignBits());
4190 }
4191
4192 return MinSignBits;
4193}
4194
4195static unsigned ComputeNumSignBitsImpl(const Value *V,
4196 const APInt &DemandedElts,
4197 const SimplifyQuery &Q, unsigned Depth);
4198
4199static unsigned ComputeNumSignBits(const Value *V, const APInt &DemandedElts,
4200 const SimplifyQuery &Q, unsigned Depth) {
4201 unsigned Result = ComputeNumSignBitsImpl(V, DemandedElts, Q, Depth);
4202 assert(Result > 0 && "At least one sign bit needs to be present!");
4203 return Result;
4204}
4205
4206/// Return the number of times the sign bit of the register is replicated into
4207/// the other bits. We know that at least 1 bit is always equal to the sign bit
4208/// (itself), but other cases can give us information. For example, immediately
4209/// after an "ashr X, 2", we know that the top 3 bits are all equal to each
4210/// other, so we return 3. For vectors, return the number of sign bits for the
4211/// vector element with the minimum number of known sign bits of the demanded
4212/// elements in the vector specified by DemandedElts.
4213static unsigned ComputeNumSignBitsImpl(const Value *V,
4214 const APInt &DemandedElts,
4215 const SimplifyQuery &Q, unsigned Depth) {
4216 Type *Ty = V->getType();
4217#ifndef NDEBUG
4218 assert(Depth <= MaxAnalysisRecursionDepth && "Limit Search Depth");
4219
4220 if (auto *FVTy = dyn_cast<FixedVectorType>(Ty)) {
4221 assert(
4222 FVTy->getNumElements() == DemandedElts.getBitWidth() &&
4223 "DemandedElt width should equal the fixed vector number of elements");
4224 } else {
4225 assert(DemandedElts == APInt(1, 1) &&
4226 "DemandedElt width should be 1 for scalars");
4227 }
4228#endif
4229
4230 // We return the minimum number of sign bits that are guaranteed to be present
4231 // in V, so for undef we have to conservatively return 1. We don't have the
4232 // same behavior for poison though -- that's a FIXME today.
4233
4234 Type *ScalarTy = Ty->getScalarType();
4235 unsigned TyBits = ScalarTy->isPointerTy() ?
4236 Q.DL.getPointerTypeSizeInBits(ScalarTy) :
4237 Q.DL.getTypeSizeInBits(ScalarTy);
4238
4239 unsigned Tmp, Tmp2;
4240 unsigned FirstAnswer = 1;
4241
4242 // Note that ConstantInt is handled by the general computeKnownBits case
4243 // below.
4244
4246 return 1;
4247
4248 if (auto *U = dyn_cast<Operator>(V)) {
4249 switch (Operator::getOpcode(V)) {
4250 default: break;
4251 case Instruction::BitCast: {
4252 Value *Src = U->getOperand(0);
4253 Type *SrcTy = Src->getType();
4254
4255 // Skip if the source type is not an integer or integer vector type
4256 // This ensures we only process integer-like types
4257 if (!SrcTy->isIntOrIntVectorTy())
4258 break;
4259
4260 unsigned SrcBits = SrcTy->getScalarSizeInBits();
4261
4262 // Bitcast 'large element' scalar/vector to 'small element' vector.
4263 if ((SrcBits % TyBits) != 0)
4264 break;
4265
4266 // Only proceed if the destination type is a fixed-size vector
4267 if (isa<FixedVectorType>(Ty)) {
4268 // Fast case - sign splat can be simply split across the small elements.
4269 // This works for both vector and scalar sources
4270 Tmp = ComputeNumSignBits(Src, Q, Depth + 1);
4271 if (Tmp == SrcBits)
4272 return TyBits;
4273 }
4274 break;
4275 }
4276 case Instruction::SExt:
4277 Tmp = TyBits - U->getOperand(0)->getType()->getScalarSizeInBits();
4278 return ComputeNumSignBits(U->getOperand(0), DemandedElts, Q, Depth + 1) +
4279 Tmp;
4280
4281 case Instruction::SDiv: {
4282 const APInt *Denominator;
4283 // sdiv X, C -> adds log(C) sign bits.
4284 if (match(U->getOperand(1), m_APInt(Denominator))) {
4285
4286 // Ignore non-positive denominator.
4287 if (!Denominator->isStrictlyPositive())
4288 break;
4289
4290 // Calculate the incoming numerator bits.
4291 unsigned NumBits =
4292 ComputeNumSignBits(U->getOperand(0), DemandedElts, Q, Depth + 1);
4293
4294 // Add floor(log(C)) bits to the numerator bits.
4295 return std::min(TyBits, NumBits + Denominator->logBase2());
4296 }
4297 break;
4298 }
4299
4300 case Instruction::SRem: {
4301 Tmp = ComputeNumSignBits(U->getOperand(0), DemandedElts, Q, Depth + 1);
4302
4303 const APInt *Denominator;
4304 // srem X, C -> we know that the result is within [-C+1,C) when C is a
4305 // positive constant. This let us put a lower bound on the number of sign
4306 // bits.
4307 if (match(U->getOperand(1), m_APInt(Denominator))) {
4308
4309 // Ignore non-positive denominator.
4310 if (Denominator->isStrictlyPositive()) {
4311 // Calculate the leading sign bit constraints by examining the
4312 // denominator. Given that the denominator is positive, there are two
4313 // cases:
4314 //
4315 // 1. The numerator is positive. The result range is [0,C) and
4316 // [0,C) u< (1 << ceilLogBase2(C)).
4317 //
4318 // 2. The numerator is negative. Then the result range is (-C,0] and
4319 // integers in (-C,0] are either 0 or >u (-1 << ceilLogBase2(C)).
4320 //
4321 // Thus a lower bound on the number of sign bits is `TyBits -
4322 // ceilLogBase2(C)`.
4323
4324 unsigned ResBits = TyBits - Denominator->ceilLogBase2();
4325 Tmp = std::max(Tmp, ResBits);
4326 }
4327 }
4328 return Tmp;
4329 }
4330
4331 case Instruction::AShr: {
4332 Tmp = ComputeNumSignBits(U->getOperand(0), DemandedElts, Q, Depth + 1);
4333 // ashr X, C -> adds C sign bits. Vectors too.
4334 const APInt *ShAmt;
4335 if (match(U->getOperand(1), m_APInt(ShAmt))) {
4336 if (ShAmt->uge(TyBits))
4337 break; // Bad shift.
4338 unsigned ShAmtLimited = ShAmt->getZExtValue();
4339 Tmp += ShAmtLimited;
4340 if (Tmp > TyBits) Tmp = TyBits;
4341 }
4342 return Tmp;
4343 }
4344 case Instruction::Shl: {
4345 const APInt *ShAmt;
4346 Value *X = nullptr;
4347 if (match(U->getOperand(1), m_APInt(ShAmt))) {
4348 // shl destroys sign bits.
4349 if (ShAmt->uge(TyBits))
4350 break; // Bad shift.
4351 // We can look through a zext (more or less treating it as a sext) if
4352 // all extended bits are shifted out.
4353 if (match(U->getOperand(0), m_ZExt(m_Value(X))) &&
4354 ShAmt->uge(TyBits - X->getType()->getScalarSizeInBits())) {
4355 Tmp = ComputeNumSignBits(X, DemandedElts, Q, Depth + 1);
4356 Tmp += TyBits - X->getType()->getScalarSizeInBits();
4357 } else
4358 Tmp =
4359 ComputeNumSignBits(U->getOperand(0), DemandedElts, Q, Depth + 1);
4360 if (ShAmt->uge(Tmp))
4361 break; // Shifted all sign bits out.
4362 Tmp2 = ShAmt->getZExtValue();
4363 return Tmp - Tmp2;
4364 }
4365 break;
4366 }
4367 case Instruction::And:
4368 case Instruction::Or:
4369 case Instruction::Xor: // NOT is handled here.
4370 // Logical binary ops preserve the number of sign bits at the worst.
4371 Tmp = ComputeNumSignBits(U->getOperand(0), DemandedElts, Q, Depth + 1);
4372 if (Tmp != 1) {
4373 Tmp2 = ComputeNumSignBits(U->getOperand(1), DemandedElts, Q, Depth + 1);
4374 FirstAnswer = std::min(Tmp, Tmp2);
4375 // We computed what we know about the sign bits as our first
4376 // answer. Now proceed to the generic code that uses
4377 // computeKnownBits, and pick whichever answer is better.
4378 }
4379 break;
4380
4381 case Instruction::Select: {
4382 // If we have a clamp pattern, we know that the number of sign bits will
4383 // be the minimum of the clamp min/max range.
4384 const Value *X;
4385 const APInt *CLow, *CHigh;
4386 if (isSignedMinMaxClamp(U, X, CLow, CHigh))
4387 return std::min(CLow->getNumSignBits(), CHigh->getNumSignBits());
4388
4389 Tmp = ComputeNumSignBits(U->getOperand(1), DemandedElts, Q, Depth + 1);
4390 if (Tmp == 1)
4391 break;
4392 Tmp2 = ComputeNumSignBits(U->getOperand(2), DemandedElts, Q, Depth + 1);
4393 return std::min(Tmp, Tmp2);
4394 }
4395
4396 case Instruction::Add:
4397 // Add can have at most one carry bit. Thus we know that the output
4398 // is, at worst, one more bit than the inputs.
4399 Tmp = ComputeNumSignBits(U->getOperand(0), Q, Depth + 1);
4400 if (Tmp == 1) break;
4401
4402 // Special case decrementing a value (ADD X, -1):
4403 if (const auto *CRHS = dyn_cast<Constant>(U->getOperand(1)))
4404 if (CRHS->isAllOnesValue()) {
4405 KnownBits Known(TyBits);
4406 computeKnownBits(U->getOperand(0), DemandedElts, Known, Q, Depth + 1);
4407
4408 // If the input is known to be 0 or 1, the output is 0/-1, which is
4409 // all sign bits set.
4410 if ((Known.Zero | 1).isAllOnes())
4411 return TyBits;
4412
4413 // If we are subtracting one from a positive number, there is no carry
4414 // out of the result.
4415 if (Known.isNonNegative())
4416 return Tmp;
4417 }
4418
4419 Tmp2 = ComputeNumSignBits(U->getOperand(1), DemandedElts, Q, Depth + 1);
4420 if (Tmp2 == 1)
4421 break;
4422 return std::min(Tmp, Tmp2) - 1;
4423
4424 case Instruction::Sub:
4425 Tmp2 = ComputeNumSignBits(U->getOperand(1), DemandedElts, Q, Depth + 1);
4426 if (Tmp2 == 1)
4427 break;
4428
4429 // Handle NEG.
4430 if (const auto *CLHS = dyn_cast<Constant>(U->getOperand(0)))
4431 if (CLHS->isNullValue()) {
4432 KnownBits Known(TyBits);
4433 computeKnownBits(U->getOperand(1), DemandedElts, Known, Q, Depth + 1);
4434 // If the input is known to be 0 or 1, the output is 0/-1, which is
4435 // all sign bits set.
4436 if ((Known.Zero | 1).isAllOnes())
4437 return TyBits;
4438
4439 // If the input is known to be positive (the sign bit is known clear),
4440 // the output of the NEG has the same number of sign bits as the
4441 // input.
4442 if (Known.isNonNegative())
4443 return Tmp2;
4444
4445 // Otherwise, we treat this like a SUB.
4446 }
4447
4448 // Sub can have at most one carry bit. Thus we know that the output
4449 // is, at worst, one more bit than the inputs.
4450 Tmp = ComputeNumSignBits(U->getOperand(0), DemandedElts, Q, Depth + 1);
4451 if (Tmp == 1)
4452 break;
4453 return std::min(Tmp, Tmp2) - 1;
4454
4455 case Instruction::Mul: {
4456 // The output of the Mul can be at most twice the valid bits in the
4457 // inputs.
4458 unsigned SignBitsOp0 =
4459 ComputeNumSignBits(U->getOperand(0), DemandedElts, Q, Depth + 1);
4460 if (SignBitsOp0 == 1)
4461 break;
4462 unsigned SignBitsOp1 =
4463 ComputeNumSignBits(U->getOperand(1), DemandedElts, Q, Depth + 1);
4464 if (SignBitsOp1 == 1)
4465 break;
4466 unsigned OutValidBits =
4467 (TyBits - SignBitsOp0 + 1) + (TyBits - SignBitsOp1 + 1);
4468 return OutValidBits > TyBits ? 1 : TyBits - OutValidBits + 1;
4469 }
4470
4471 case Instruction::PHI: {
4472 const PHINode *PN = cast<PHINode>(U);
4473 unsigned NumIncomingValues = PN->getNumIncomingValues();
4474 // Don't analyze large in-degree PHIs.
4475 if (NumIncomingValues > 4) break;
4476 // Unreachable blocks may have zero-operand PHI nodes.
4477 if (NumIncomingValues == 0) break;
4478
4479 // Take the minimum of all incoming values. This can't infinitely loop
4480 // because of our depth threshold.
4482 Tmp = TyBits;
4483 for (unsigned i = 0, e = NumIncomingValues; i != e; ++i) {
4484 if (Tmp == 1) return Tmp;
4485 RecQ.CxtI = PN->getIncomingBlock(i)->getTerminator();
4486 Tmp = std::min(Tmp, ComputeNumSignBits(PN->getIncomingValue(i),
4487 DemandedElts, RecQ, Depth + 1));
4488 }
4489 return Tmp;
4490 }
4491
4492 case Instruction::Trunc: {
4493 // If the input contained enough sign bits that some remain after the
4494 // truncation, then we can make use of that. Otherwise we don't know
4495 // anything.
4496 Tmp = ComputeNumSignBits(U->getOperand(0), Q, Depth + 1);
4497 unsigned OperandTyBits = U->getOperand(0)->getType()->getScalarSizeInBits();
4498 if (Tmp > (OperandTyBits - TyBits))
4499 return Tmp - (OperandTyBits - TyBits);
4500
4501 return 1;
4502 }
4503
4504 case Instruction::ExtractElement:
4505 // Look through extract element. At the moment we keep this simple and
4506 // skip tracking the specific element. But at least we might find
4507 // information valid for all elements of the vector (for example if vector
4508 // is sign extended, shifted, etc).
4509 return ComputeNumSignBits(U->getOperand(0), Q, Depth + 1);
4510
4511 case Instruction::ShuffleVector: {
4512 // Collect the minimum number of sign bits that are shared by every vector
4513 // element referenced by the shuffle.
4514 auto *Shuf = dyn_cast<ShuffleVectorInst>(U);
4515 if (!Shuf) {
4516 // FIXME: Add support for shufflevector constant expressions.
4517 return 1;
4518 }
4519 APInt DemandedLHS, DemandedRHS;
4520 // For undef elements, we don't know anything about the common state of
4521 // the shuffle result.
4522 if (!getShuffleDemandedElts(Shuf, DemandedElts, DemandedLHS, DemandedRHS))
4523 return 1;
4524 Tmp = std::numeric_limits<unsigned>::max();
4525 if (!!DemandedLHS) {
4526 const Value *LHS = Shuf->getOperand(0);
4527 Tmp = ComputeNumSignBits(LHS, DemandedLHS, Q, Depth + 1);
4528 }
4529 // If we don't know anything, early out and try computeKnownBits
4530 // fall-back.
4531 if (Tmp == 1)
4532 break;
4533 if (!!DemandedRHS) {
4534 const Value *RHS = Shuf->getOperand(1);
4535 Tmp2 = ComputeNumSignBits(RHS, DemandedRHS, Q, Depth + 1);
4536 Tmp = std::min(Tmp, Tmp2);
4537 }
4538 // If we don't know anything, early out and try computeKnownBits
4539 // fall-back.
4540 if (Tmp == 1)
4541 break;
4542 assert(Tmp <= TyBits && "Failed to determine minimum sign bits");
4543 return Tmp;
4544 }
4545 case Instruction::Call: {
4546 if (const auto *II = dyn_cast<IntrinsicInst>(U)) {
4547 switch (II->getIntrinsicID()) {
4548 default:
4549 break;
4550 case Intrinsic::abs:
4551 Tmp =
4552 ComputeNumSignBits(U->getOperand(0), DemandedElts, Q, Depth + 1);
4553 if (Tmp == 1)
4554 break;
4555
4556 // Absolute value reduces number of sign bits by at most 1.
4557 return Tmp - 1;
4558 case Intrinsic::smin:
4559 case Intrinsic::smax: {
4560 const APInt *CLow, *CHigh;
4561 if (isSignedMinMaxIntrinsicClamp(II, CLow, CHigh))
4562 return std::min(CLow->getNumSignBits(), CHigh->getNumSignBits());
4563 }
4564 }
4565 }
4566 }
4567 }
4568 }
4569
4570 // Finally, if we can prove that the top bits of the result are 0's or 1's,
4571 // use this information.
4572
4573 // If we can examine all elements of a vector constant successfully, we're
4574 // done (we can't do any better than that). If not, keep trying.
4575 if (unsigned VecSignBits =
4576 computeNumSignBitsVectorConstant(V, DemandedElts, TyBits))
4577 return VecSignBits;
4578
4579 KnownBits Known(TyBits);
4580 computeKnownBits(V, DemandedElts, Known, Q, Depth);
4581
4582 // If we know that the sign bit is either zero or one, determine the number of
4583 // identical bits in the top of the input value.
4584 return std::max(FirstAnswer, Known.countMinSignBits());
4585}
4586
4588 const TargetLibraryInfo *TLI) {
4589 const Function *F = CB.getCalledFunction();
4590 if (!F)
4592
4593 if (F->isIntrinsic())
4594 return F->getIntrinsicID();
4595
4596 // We are going to infer semantics of a library function based on mapping it
4597 // to an LLVM intrinsic. Check that the library function is available from
4598 // this callbase and in this environment.
4599 LibFunc Func;
4600 if (F->hasLocalLinkage() || !TLI || !TLI->getLibFunc(CB, Func) ||
4601 !CB.onlyReadsMemory())
4603
4604 switch (Func) {
4605 default:
4606 break;
4607 case LibFunc_sin:
4608 case LibFunc_sinf:
4609 case LibFunc_sinl:
4610 return Intrinsic::sin;
4611 case LibFunc_cos:
4612 case LibFunc_cosf:
4613 case LibFunc_cosl:
4614 return Intrinsic::cos;
4615 case LibFunc_tan:
4616 case LibFunc_tanf:
4617 case LibFunc_tanl:
4618 return Intrinsic::tan;
4619 case LibFunc_asin:
4620 case LibFunc_asinf:
4621 case LibFunc_asinl:
4622 return Intrinsic::asin;
4623 case LibFunc_acos:
4624 case LibFunc_acosf:
4625 case LibFunc_acosl:
4626 return Intrinsic::acos;
4627 case LibFunc_atan:
4628 case LibFunc_atanf:
4629 case LibFunc_atanl:
4630 return Intrinsic::atan;
4631 case LibFunc_atan2:
4632 case LibFunc_atan2f:
4633 case LibFunc_atan2l:
4634 return Intrinsic::atan2;
4635 case LibFunc_sinh:
4636 case LibFunc_sinhf:
4637 case LibFunc_sinhl:
4638 return Intrinsic::sinh;
4639 case LibFunc_cosh:
4640 case LibFunc_coshf:
4641 case LibFunc_coshl:
4642 return Intrinsic::cosh;
4643 case LibFunc_tanh:
4644 case LibFunc_tanhf:
4645 case LibFunc_tanhl:
4646 return Intrinsic::tanh;
4647 case LibFunc_exp:
4648 case LibFunc_expf:
4649 case LibFunc_expl:
4650 return Intrinsic::exp;
4651 case LibFunc_exp2:
4652 case LibFunc_exp2f:
4653 case LibFunc_exp2l:
4654 return Intrinsic::exp2;
4655 case LibFunc_exp10:
4656 case LibFunc_exp10f:
4657 case LibFunc_exp10l:
4658 return Intrinsic::exp10;
4659 case LibFunc_log:
4660 case LibFunc_logf:
4661 case LibFunc_logl:
4662 return Intrinsic::log;
4663 case LibFunc_log10:
4664 case LibFunc_log10f:
4665 case LibFunc_log10l:
4666 return Intrinsic::log10;
4667 case LibFunc_log2:
4668 case LibFunc_log2f:
4669 case LibFunc_log2l:
4670 return Intrinsic::log2;
4671 case LibFunc_fabs:
4672 case LibFunc_fabsf:
4673 case LibFunc_fabsl:
4674 return Intrinsic::fabs;
4675 case LibFunc_fmin:
4676 case LibFunc_fminf:
4677 case LibFunc_fminl:
4678 return Intrinsic::minnum;
4679 case LibFunc_fmax:
4680 case LibFunc_fmaxf:
4681 case LibFunc_fmaxl:
4682 return Intrinsic::maxnum;
4683 case LibFunc_copysign:
4684 case LibFunc_copysignf:
4685 case LibFunc_copysignl:
4686 return Intrinsic::copysign;
4687 case LibFunc_floor:
4688 case LibFunc_floorf:
4689 case LibFunc_floorl:
4690 return Intrinsic::floor;
4691 case LibFunc_ceil:
4692 case LibFunc_ceilf:
4693 case LibFunc_ceill:
4694 return Intrinsic::ceil;
4695 case LibFunc_trunc:
4696 case LibFunc_truncf:
4697 case LibFunc_truncl:
4698 return Intrinsic::trunc;
4699 case LibFunc_rint:
4700 case LibFunc_rintf:
4701 case LibFunc_rintl:
4702 return Intrinsic::rint;
4703 case LibFunc_nearbyint:
4704 case LibFunc_nearbyintf:
4705 case LibFunc_nearbyintl:
4706 return Intrinsic::nearbyint;
4707 case LibFunc_round:
4708 case LibFunc_roundf:
4709 case LibFunc_roundl:
4710 return Intrinsic::round;
4711 case LibFunc_roundeven:
4712 case LibFunc_roundevenf:
4713 case LibFunc_roundevenl:
4714 return Intrinsic::roundeven;
4715 case LibFunc_pow:
4716 case LibFunc_powf:
4717 case LibFunc_powl:
4718 return Intrinsic::pow;
4719 case LibFunc_sqrt:
4720 case LibFunc_sqrtf:
4721 case LibFunc_sqrtl:
4722 return Intrinsic::sqrt;
4723 }
4724
4726}
4727
4728static bool outputDenormalIsIEEEOrPosZero(const Function &F, const Type *Ty) {
4729 Ty = Ty->getScalarType();
4730 DenormalMode Mode = F.getDenormalMode(Ty->getFltSemantics());
4731 return Mode.Output == DenormalMode::IEEE ||
4733}
4734/// Given an exploded icmp instruction, return true if the comparison only
4735/// checks the sign bit. If it only checks the sign bit, set TrueIfSigned if
4736/// the result of the comparison is true when the input value is signed.
4738 bool &TrueIfSigned) {
4739 switch (Pred) {
4740 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SLT: // True if LHS s< 0
4741 TrueIfSigned = true;
4742 return RHS.isZero();
4743 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SLE: // True if LHS s<= -1
4744 TrueIfSigned = true;
4745 return RHS.isAllOnes();
4746 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SGT: // True if LHS s> -1
4747 TrueIfSigned = false;
4748 return RHS.isAllOnes();
4749 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SGE: // True if LHS s>= 0
4750 TrueIfSigned = false;
4751 return RHS.isZero();
4752 case ICmpInst::ICMP_UGT:
4753 // True if LHS u> RHS and RHS == sign-bit-mask - 1
4754 TrueIfSigned = true;
4755 return RHS.isMaxSignedValue();
4756 case ICmpInst::ICMP_UGE:
4757 // True if LHS u>= RHS and RHS == sign-bit-mask (2^7, 2^15, 2^31, etc)
4758 TrueIfSigned = true;
4759 return RHS.isMinSignedValue();
4760 case ICmpInst::ICMP_ULT:
4761 // True if LHS u< RHS and RHS == sign-bit-mask (2^7, 2^15, 2^31, etc)
4762 TrueIfSigned = false;
4763 return RHS.isMinSignedValue();
4764 case ICmpInst::ICMP_ULE:
4765 // True if LHS u<= RHS and RHS == sign-bit-mask - 1
4766 TrueIfSigned = false;
4767 return RHS.isMaxSignedValue();
4768 default:
4769 return false;
4770 }
4771}
4772
4774 bool CondIsTrue,
4775 const Instruction *CxtI,
4776 KnownFPClass &KnownFromContext,
4777 unsigned Depth = 0) {
4778 Value *A, *B;
4780 (CondIsTrue ? match(Cond, m_LogicalAnd(m_Value(A), m_Value(B)))
4781 : match(Cond, m_LogicalOr(m_Value(A), m_Value(B))))) {
4782 computeKnownFPClassFromCond(V, A, CondIsTrue, CxtI, KnownFromContext,
4783 Depth + 1);
4784 computeKnownFPClassFromCond(V, B, CondIsTrue, CxtI, KnownFromContext,
4785 Depth + 1);
4786 return;
4787 }
4789 computeKnownFPClassFromCond(V, A, !CondIsTrue, CxtI, KnownFromContext,
4790 Depth + 1);
4791 return;
4792 }
4793 CmpPredicate Pred;
4794 Value *LHS;
4795 uint64_t ClassVal = 0;
4796 const APFloat *CRHS;
4797 const APInt *RHS;
4798 if (match(Cond, m_FCmp(Pred, m_Value(LHS), m_APFloat(CRHS)))) {
4799 auto [CmpVal, MaskIfTrue, MaskIfFalse] = fcmpImpliesClass(
4800 Pred, *CxtI->getParent()->getParent(), LHS, *CRHS, LHS != V);
4801 if (CmpVal == V)
4802 KnownFromContext.knownNot(~(CondIsTrue ? MaskIfTrue : MaskIfFalse));
4804 m_Specific(V), m_ConstantInt(ClassVal)))) {
4805 FPClassTest Mask = static_cast<FPClassTest>(ClassVal);
4806 KnownFromContext.knownNot(CondIsTrue ? ~Mask : Mask);
4807 } else if (match(Cond, m_ICmp(Pred, m_ElementWiseBitCast(m_Specific(V)),
4808 m_APInt(RHS)))) {
4809 bool TrueIfSigned;
4810 if (!isSignBitCheck(Pred, *RHS, TrueIfSigned))
4811 return;
4812 if (TrueIfSigned == CondIsTrue)
4813 KnownFromContext.signBitMustBeOne();
4814 else
4815 KnownFromContext.signBitMustBeZero();
4816 }
4817}
4818
4820 const SimplifyQuery &Q) {
4821 KnownFPClass KnownFromContext;
4822
4823 if (Q.CC && Q.CC->AffectedValues.contains(V))
4825 KnownFromContext);
4826
4827 if (!Q.CxtI)
4828 return KnownFromContext;
4829
4830 if (Q.DC && Q.DT) {
4831 // Handle dominating conditions.
4832 for (BranchInst *BI : Q.DC->conditionsFor(V)) {
4833 Value *Cond = BI->getCondition();
4834
4835 BasicBlockEdge Edge0(BI->getParent(), BI->getSuccessor(0));
4836 if (Q.DT->dominates(Edge0, Q.CxtI->getParent()))
4837 computeKnownFPClassFromCond(V, Cond, /*CondIsTrue=*/true, Q.CxtI,
4838 KnownFromContext);
4839
4840 BasicBlockEdge Edge1(BI->getParent(), BI->getSuccessor(1));
4841 if (Q.DT->dominates(Edge1, Q.CxtI->getParent()))
4842 computeKnownFPClassFromCond(V, Cond, /*CondIsTrue=*/false, Q.CxtI,
4843 KnownFromContext);
4844 }
4845 }
4846
4847 if (!Q.AC)
4848 return KnownFromContext;
4849
4850 // Try to restrict the floating-point classes based on information from
4851 // assumptions.
4852 for (auto &AssumeVH : Q.AC->assumptionsFor(V)) {
4853 if (!AssumeVH)
4854 continue;
4855 CallInst *I = cast<CallInst>(AssumeVH);
4856
4857 assert(I->getFunction() == Q.CxtI->getParent()->getParent() &&
4858 "Got assumption for the wrong function!");
4859 assert(I->getIntrinsicID() == Intrinsic::assume &&
4860 "must be an assume intrinsic");
4861
4862 if (!isValidAssumeForContext(I, Q.CxtI, Q.DT))
4863 continue;
4864
4865 computeKnownFPClassFromCond(V, I->getArgOperand(0),
4866 /*CondIsTrue=*/true, Q.CxtI, KnownFromContext);
4867 }
4868
4869 return KnownFromContext;
4870}
4871
4872void computeKnownFPClass(const Value *V, const APInt &DemandedElts,
4873 FPClassTest InterestedClasses, KnownFPClass &Known,
4874 const SimplifyQuery &Q, unsigned Depth);
4875
4876static void computeKnownFPClass(const Value *V, KnownFPClass &Known,
4877 FPClassTest InterestedClasses,
4878 const SimplifyQuery &Q, unsigned Depth) {
4879 auto *FVTy = dyn_cast<FixedVectorType>(V->getType());
4880 APInt DemandedElts =
4881 FVTy ? APInt::getAllOnes(FVTy->getNumElements()) : APInt(1, 1);
4882 computeKnownFPClass(V, DemandedElts, InterestedClasses, Known, Q, Depth);
4883}
4884
4886 const APInt &DemandedElts,
4887 FPClassTest InterestedClasses,
4888 KnownFPClass &Known,
4889 const SimplifyQuery &Q,
4890 unsigned Depth) {
4891 if ((InterestedClasses &
4893 return;
4894
4895 KnownFPClass KnownSrc;
4896 computeKnownFPClass(Op->getOperand(0), DemandedElts, InterestedClasses,
4897 KnownSrc, Q, Depth + 1);
4898
4899 // Sign should be preserved
4900 // TODO: Handle cannot be ordered greater than zero
4901 if (KnownSrc.cannotBeOrderedLessThanZero())
4903
4904 Known.propagateNaN(KnownSrc, true);
4905
4906 // Infinity needs a range check.
4907}
4908
4909void computeKnownFPClass(const Value *V, const APInt &DemandedElts,
4910 FPClassTest InterestedClasses, KnownFPClass &Known,
4911 const SimplifyQuery &Q, unsigned Depth) {
4912 assert(Known.isUnknown() && "should not be called with known information");
4913
4914 if (!DemandedElts) {
4915 // No demanded elts, better to assume we don't know anything.
4916 Known.resetAll();
4917 return;
4918 }
4919
4920 assert(Depth <= MaxAnalysisRecursionDepth && "Limit Search Depth");
4921
4922 if (auto *CFP = dyn_cast<ConstantFP>(V)) {
4923 Known.KnownFPClasses = CFP->getValueAPF().classify();
4924 Known.SignBit = CFP->isNegative();
4925 return;
4926 }
4927
4929 Known.KnownFPClasses = fcPosZero;
4930 Known.SignBit = false;
4931 return;
4932 }
4933
4934 if (isa<PoisonValue>(V)) {
4935 Known.KnownFPClasses = fcNone;
4936 Known.SignBit = false;
4937 return;
4938 }
4939
4940 // Try to handle fixed width vector constants
4941 auto *VFVTy = dyn_cast<FixedVectorType>(V->getType());
4942 const Constant *CV = dyn_cast<Constant>(V);
4943 if (VFVTy && CV) {
4944 Known.KnownFPClasses = fcNone;
4945 bool SignBitAllZero = true;
4946 bool SignBitAllOne = true;
4947
4948 // For vectors, verify that each element is not NaN.
4949 unsigned NumElts = VFVTy->getNumElements();
4950 for (unsigned i = 0; i != NumElts; ++i) {
4951 if (!DemandedElts[i])
4952 continue;
4953
4954 Constant *Elt = CV->getAggregateElement(i);
4955 if (!Elt) {
4956 Known = KnownFPClass();
4957 return;
4958 }
4959 if (isa<PoisonValue>(Elt))
4960 continue;
4961 auto *CElt = dyn_cast<ConstantFP>(Elt);
4962 if (!CElt) {
4963 Known = KnownFPClass();
4964 return;
4965 }
4966
4967 const APFloat &C = CElt->getValueAPF();
4968 Known.KnownFPClasses |= C.classify();
4969 if (C.isNegative())
4970 SignBitAllZero = false;
4971 else
4972 SignBitAllOne = false;
4973 }
4974 if (SignBitAllOne != SignBitAllZero)
4975 Known.SignBit = SignBitAllOne;
4976 return;
4977 }
4978
4979 FPClassTest KnownNotFromFlags = fcNone;
4980 if (const auto *CB = dyn_cast<CallBase>(V))
4981 KnownNotFromFlags |= CB->getRetNoFPClass();
4982 else if (const auto *Arg = dyn_cast<Argument>(V))
4983 KnownNotFromFlags |= Arg->getNoFPClass();
4984
4985 const Operator *Op = dyn_cast<Operator>(V);
4987 if (FPOp->hasNoNaNs())
4988 KnownNotFromFlags |= fcNan;
4989 if (FPOp->hasNoInfs())
4990 KnownNotFromFlags |= fcInf;
4991 }
4992
4993 KnownFPClass AssumedClasses = computeKnownFPClassFromContext(V, Q);
4994 KnownNotFromFlags |= ~AssumedClasses.KnownFPClasses;
4995
4996 // We no longer need to find out about these bits from inputs if we can
4997 // assume this from flags/attributes.
4998 InterestedClasses &= ~KnownNotFromFlags;
4999
5000 auto ClearClassesFromFlags = make_scope_exit([=, &Known] {
5001 Known.knownNot(KnownNotFromFlags);
5002 if (!Known.SignBit && AssumedClasses.SignBit) {
5003 if (*AssumedClasses.SignBit)
5004 Known.signBitMustBeOne();
5005 else
5006 Known.signBitMustBeZero();
5007 }
5008 });
5009
5010 if (!Op)
5011 return;
5012
5013 // All recursive calls that increase depth must come after this.
5015 return;
5016
5017 const unsigned Opc = Op->getOpcode();
5018 switch (Opc) {
5019 case Instruction::FNeg: {
5020 computeKnownFPClass(Op->getOperand(0), DemandedElts, InterestedClasses,
5021 Known, Q, Depth + 1);
5022 Known.fneg();
5023 break;
5024 }
5025 case Instruction::Select: {
5026 Value *Cond = Op->getOperand(0);
5027 Value *LHS = Op->getOperand(1);
5028 Value *RHS = Op->getOperand(2);
5029
5030 FPClassTest FilterLHS = fcAllFlags;
5031 FPClassTest FilterRHS = fcAllFlags;
5032
5033 Value *TestedValue = nullptr;
5034 FPClassTest MaskIfTrue = fcAllFlags;
5035 FPClassTest MaskIfFalse = fcAllFlags;
5036 uint64_t ClassVal = 0;
5037 const Function *F = cast<Instruction>(Op)->getFunction();
5038 CmpPredicate Pred;
5039 Value *CmpLHS, *CmpRHS;
5040 if (F && match(Cond, m_FCmp(Pred, m_Value(CmpLHS), m_Value(CmpRHS)))) {
5041 // If the select filters out a value based on the class, it no longer
5042 // participates in the class of the result
5043
5044 // TODO: In some degenerate cases we can infer something if we try again
5045 // without looking through sign operations.
5046 bool LookThroughFAbsFNeg = CmpLHS != LHS && CmpLHS != RHS;
5047 std::tie(TestedValue, MaskIfTrue, MaskIfFalse) =
5048 fcmpImpliesClass(Pred, *F, CmpLHS, CmpRHS, LookThroughFAbsFNeg);
5049 } else if (match(Cond,
5051 m_Value(TestedValue), m_ConstantInt(ClassVal)))) {
5052 FPClassTest TestedMask = static_cast<FPClassTest>(ClassVal);
5053 MaskIfTrue = TestedMask;
5054 MaskIfFalse = ~TestedMask;
5055 }
5056
5057 if (TestedValue == LHS) {
5058 // match !isnan(x) ? x : y
5059 FilterLHS = MaskIfTrue;
5060 } else if (TestedValue == RHS) { // && IsExactClass
5061 // match !isnan(x) ? y : x
5062 FilterRHS = MaskIfFalse;
5063 }
5064
5065 KnownFPClass Known2;
5066 computeKnownFPClass(LHS, DemandedElts, InterestedClasses & FilterLHS, Known,
5067 Q, Depth + 1);
5068 Known.KnownFPClasses &= FilterLHS;
5069
5070 computeKnownFPClass(RHS, DemandedElts, InterestedClasses & FilterRHS,
5071 Known2, Q, Depth + 1);
5072 Known2.KnownFPClasses &= FilterRHS;
5073
5074 Known |= Known2;
5075 break;
5076 }
5077 case Instruction::Call: {
5078 const CallInst *II = cast<CallInst>(Op);
5079 const Intrinsic::ID IID = II->getIntrinsicID();
5080 switch (IID) {
5081 case Intrinsic::fabs: {
5082 if ((InterestedClasses & (fcNan | fcPositive)) != fcNone) {
5083 // If we only care about the sign bit we don't need to inspect the
5084 // operand.
5085 computeKnownFPClass(II->getArgOperand(0), DemandedElts,
5086 InterestedClasses, Known, Q, Depth + 1);
5087 }
5088
5089 Known.fabs();
5090 break;
5091 }
5092 case Intrinsic::copysign: {
5093 KnownFPClass KnownSign;
5094
5095 computeKnownFPClass(II->getArgOperand(0), DemandedElts, InterestedClasses,
5096 Known, Q, Depth + 1);
5097 computeKnownFPClass(II->getArgOperand(1), DemandedElts, InterestedClasses,
5098 KnownSign, Q, Depth + 1);
5099 Known.copysign(KnownSign);
5100 break;
5101 }
5102 case Intrinsic::fma:
5103 case Intrinsic::fmuladd: {
5104 if ((InterestedClasses & fcNegative) == fcNone)
5105 break;
5106
5107 if (II->getArgOperand(0) != II->getArgOperand(1))
5108 break;
5109
5110 // The multiply cannot be -0 and therefore the add can't be -0
5111 Known.knownNot(fcNegZero);
5112
5113 // x * x + y is non-negative if y is non-negative.
5114 KnownFPClass KnownAddend;
5115 computeKnownFPClass(II->getArgOperand(2), DemandedElts, InterestedClasses,
5116 KnownAddend, Q, Depth + 1);
5117
5118 if (KnownAddend.cannotBeOrderedLessThanZero())
5119 Known.knownNot(fcNegative);
5120 break;
5121 }
5122 case Intrinsic::sqrt:
5123 case Intrinsic::experimental_constrained_sqrt: {
5124 KnownFPClass KnownSrc;
5125 FPClassTest InterestedSrcs = InterestedClasses;
5126 if (InterestedClasses & fcNan)
5127 InterestedSrcs |= KnownFPClass::OrderedLessThanZeroMask;
5128
5129 computeKnownFPClass(II->getArgOperand(0), DemandedElts, InterestedSrcs,
5130 KnownSrc, Q, Depth + 1);
5131
5132 if (KnownSrc.isKnownNeverPosInfinity())
5133 Known.knownNot(fcPosInf);
5134 if (KnownSrc.isKnownNever(fcSNan))
5135 Known.knownNot(fcSNan);
5136
5137 // Any negative value besides -0 returns a nan.
5138 if (KnownSrc.isKnownNeverNaN() && KnownSrc.cannotBeOrderedLessThanZero())
5139 Known.knownNot(fcNan);
5140
5141 // The only negative value that can be returned is -0 for -0 inputs.
5143
5144 // If the input denormal mode could be PreserveSign, a negative
5145 // subnormal input could produce a negative zero output.
5146 const Function *F = II->getFunction();
5147 const fltSemantics &FltSem =
5148 II->getType()->getScalarType()->getFltSemantics();
5149
5150 if (Q.IIQ.hasNoSignedZeros(II) ||
5151 (F &&
5152 KnownSrc.isKnownNeverLogicalNegZero(F->getDenormalMode(FltSem))))
5153 Known.knownNot(fcNegZero);
5154
5155 break;
5156 }
5157 case Intrinsic::sin:
5158 case Intrinsic::cos: {
5159 // Return NaN on infinite inputs.
5160 KnownFPClass KnownSrc;
5161 computeKnownFPClass(II->getArgOperand(0), DemandedElts, InterestedClasses,
5162 KnownSrc, Q, Depth + 1);
5163 Known.knownNot(fcInf);
5164 if (KnownSrc.isKnownNeverNaN() && KnownSrc.isKnownNeverInfinity())
5165 Known.knownNot(fcNan);
5166 break;
5167 }
5168 case Intrinsic::maxnum:
5169 case Intrinsic::minnum:
5170 case Intrinsic::minimum:
5171 case Intrinsic::maximum:
5172 case Intrinsic::minimumnum:
5173 case Intrinsic::maximumnum: {
5174 KnownFPClass KnownLHS, KnownRHS;
5175 computeKnownFPClass(II->getArgOperand(0), DemandedElts, InterestedClasses,
5176 KnownLHS, Q, Depth + 1);
5177 computeKnownFPClass(II->getArgOperand(1), DemandedElts, InterestedClasses,
5178 KnownRHS, Q, Depth + 1);
5179
5180 bool NeverNaN = KnownLHS.isKnownNeverNaN() || KnownRHS.isKnownNeverNaN();
5181 Known = KnownLHS | KnownRHS;
5182
5183 // If either operand is not NaN, the result is not NaN.
5184 if (NeverNaN &&
5185 (IID == Intrinsic::minnum || IID == Intrinsic::maxnum ||
5186 IID == Intrinsic::minimumnum || IID == Intrinsic::maximumnum))
5187 Known.knownNot(fcNan);
5188
5189 if (IID == Intrinsic::maxnum || IID == Intrinsic::maximumnum) {
5190 // If at least one operand is known to be positive, the result must be
5191 // positive.
5192 if ((KnownLHS.cannotBeOrderedLessThanZero() &&
5193 KnownLHS.isKnownNeverNaN()) ||
5194 (KnownRHS.cannotBeOrderedLessThanZero() &&
5195 KnownRHS.isKnownNeverNaN()))
5197 } else if (IID == Intrinsic::maximum) {
5198 // If at least one operand is known to be positive, the result must be
5199 // positive.
5200 if (KnownLHS.cannotBeOrderedLessThanZero() ||
5201 KnownRHS.cannotBeOrderedLessThanZero())
5203 } else if (IID == Intrinsic::minnum || IID == Intrinsic::minimumnum) {
5204 // If at least one operand is known to be negative, the result must be
5205 // negative.
5206 if ((KnownLHS.cannotBeOrderedGreaterThanZero() &&
5207 KnownLHS.isKnownNeverNaN()) ||
5208 (KnownRHS.cannotBeOrderedGreaterThanZero() &&
5209 KnownRHS.isKnownNeverNaN()))
5211 } else if (IID == Intrinsic::minimum) {
5212 // If at least one operand is known to be negative, the result must be
5213 // negative.
5214 if (KnownLHS.cannotBeOrderedGreaterThanZero() ||
5217 } else
5218 llvm_unreachable("unhandled intrinsic");
5219
5220 // Fixup zero handling if denormals could be returned as a zero.
5221 //
5222 // As there's no spec for denormal flushing, be conservative with the
5223 // treatment of denormals that could be flushed to zero. For older
5224 // subtargets on AMDGPU the min/max instructions would not flush the
5225 // output and return the original value.
5226 //
5227 if ((Known.KnownFPClasses & fcZero) != fcNone &&
5228 !Known.isKnownNeverSubnormal()) {
5229 const Function *Parent = II->getFunction();
5230 if (!Parent)
5231 break;
5232
5234 II->getType()->getScalarType()->getFltSemantics());
5235 if (Mode != DenormalMode::getIEEE())
5236 Known.KnownFPClasses |= fcZero;
5237 }
5238
5239 if (Known.isKnownNeverNaN()) {
5240 if (KnownLHS.SignBit && KnownRHS.SignBit &&
5241 *KnownLHS.SignBit == *KnownRHS.SignBit) {
5242 if (*KnownLHS.SignBit)
5243 Known.signBitMustBeOne();
5244 else
5245 Known.signBitMustBeZero();
5246 } else if ((IID == Intrinsic::maximum || IID == Intrinsic::minimum ||
5247 IID == Intrinsic::maximumnum ||
5248 IID == Intrinsic::minimumnum) ||
5249 // FIXME: Should be using logical zero versions
5250 ((KnownLHS.isKnownNeverNegZero() ||
5251 KnownRHS.isKnownNeverPosZero()) &&
5252 (KnownLHS.isKnownNeverPosZero() ||
5253 KnownRHS.isKnownNeverNegZero()))) {
5254 // Don't take sign bit from NaN operands.
5255 if (!KnownLHS.isKnownNeverNaN())
5256 KnownLHS.SignBit = std::nullopt;
5257 if (!KnownRHS.isKnownNeverNaN())
5258 KnownRHS.SignBit = std::nullopt;
5259 if ((IID == Intrinsic::maximum || IID == Intrinsic::maximumnum ||
5260 IID == Intrinsic::maxnum) &&
5261 (KnownLHS.SignBit == false || KnownRHS.SignBit == false))
5262 Known.signBitMustBeZero();
5263 else if ((IID == Intrinsic::minimum || IID == Intrinsic::minimumnum ||
5264 IID == Intrinsic::minnum) &&
5265 (KnownLHS.SignBit == true || KnownRHS.SignBit == true))
5266 Known.signBitMustBeOne();
5267 }
5268 }
5269 break;
5270 }
5271 case Intrinsic::canonicalize: {
5272 KnownFPClass KnownSrc;
5273 computeKnownFPClass(II->getArgOperand(0), DemandedElts, InterestedClasses,
5274 KnownSrc, Q, Depth + 1);
5275
5276 // This is essentially a stronger form of
5277 // propagateCanonicalizingSrc. Other "canonicalizing" operations don't
5278 // actually have an IR canonicalization guarantee.
5279
5280 // Canonicalize may flush denormals to zero, so we have to consider the
5281 // denormal mode to preserve known-not-0 knowledge.
5282 Known.KnownFPClasses = KnownSrc.KnownFPClasses | fcZero | fcQNan;
5283
5284 // Stronger version of propagateNaN
5285 // Canonicalize is guaranteed to quiet signaling nans.
5286 if (KnownSrc.isKnownNeverNaN())
5287 Known.knownNot(fcNan);
5288 else
5289 Known.knownNot(fcSNan);
5290
5291 const Function *F = II->getFunction();
5292 if (!F)
5293 break;
5294
5295 // If the parent function flushes denormals, the canonical output cannot
5296 // be a denormal.
5297 const fltSemantics &FPType =
5298 II->getType()->getScalarType()->getFltSemantics();
5299 DenormalMode DenormMode = F->getDenormalMode(FPType);
5300 if (DenormMode == DenormalMode::getIEEE()) {
5301 if (KnownSrc.isKnownNever(fcPosZero))
5302 Known.knownNot(fcPosZero);
5303 if (KnownSrc.isKnownNever(fcNegZero))
5304 Known.knownNot(fcNegZero);
5305 break;
5306 }
5307
5308 if (DenormMode.inputsAreZero() || DenormMode.outputsAreZero())
5309 Known.knownNot(fcSubnormal);
5310
5311 if (DenormMode.Input == DenormalMode::PositiveZero ||
5312 (DenormMode.Output == DenormalMode::PositiveZero &&
5313 DenormMode.Input == DenormalMode::IEEE))
5314 Known.knownNot(fcNegZero);
5315
5316 break;
5317 }
5318 case Intrinsic::vector_reduce_fmax:
5319 case Intrinsic::vector_reduce_fmin:
5320 case Intrinsic::vector_reduce_fmaximum:
5321 case Intrinsic::vector_reduce_fminimum: {
5322 // reduce min/max will choose an element from one of the vector elements,
5323 // so we can infer and class information that is common to all elements.
5324 Known = computeKnownFPClass(II->getArgOperand(0), II->getFastMathFlags(),
5325 InterestedClasses, Q, Depth + 1);
5326 // Can only propagate sign if output is never NaN.
5327 if (!Known.isKnownNeverNaN())
5328 Known.SignBit.reset();
5329 break;
5330 }
5331 // reverse preserves all characteristics of the input vec's element.
5332 case Intrinsic::vector_reverse:
5333 Known = computeKnownFPClass(
5334 II->getArgOperand(0), DemandedElts.reverseBits(),
5335 II->getFastMathFlags(), InterestedClasses, Q, Depth + 1);
5336 break;
5337 case Intrinsic::trunc:
5338 case Intrinsic::floor:
5339 case Intrinsic::ceil:
5340 case Intrinsic::rint:
5341 case Intrinsic::nearbyint:
5342 case Intrinsic::round:
5343 case Intrinsic::roundeven: {
5344 KnownFPClass KnownSrc;
5345 FPClassTest InterestedSrcs = InterestedClasses;
5346 if (InterestedSrcs & fcPosFinite)
5347 InterestedSrcs |= fcPosFinite;
5348 if (InterestedSrcs & fcNegFinite)
5349 InterestedSrcs |= fcNegFinite;
5350 computeKnownFPClass(II->getArgOperand(0), DemandedElts, InterestedSrcs,
5351 KnownSrc, Q, Depth + 1);
5352
5353 // Integer results cannot be subnormal.
5354 Known.knownNot(fcSubnormal);
5355
5356 Known.propagateNaN(KnownSrc, true);
5357
5358 // Pass through infinities, except PPC_FP128 is a special case for
5359 // intrinsics other than trunc.
5360 if (IID == Intrinsic::trunc || !V->getType()->isMultiUnitFPType()) {
5361 if (KnownSrc.isKnownNeverPosInfinity())
5362 Known.knownNot(fcPosInf);
5363 if (KnownSrc.isKnownNeverNegInfinity())
5364 Known.knownNot(fcNegInf);
5365 }
5366
5367 // Negative round ups to 0 produce -0
5368 if (KnownSrc.isKnownNever(fcPosFinite))
5369 Known.knownNot(fcPosFinite);
5370 if (KnownSrc.isKnownNever(fcNegFinite))
5371 Known.knownNot(fcNegFinite);
5372
5373 break;
5374 }
5375 case Intrinsic::exp:
5376 case Intrinsic::exp2:
5377 case Intrinsic::exp10: {
5378 Known.knownNot(fcNegative);
5379 if ((InterestedClasses & fcNan) == fcNone)
5380 break;
5381
5382 KnownFPClass KnownSrc;
5383 computeKnownFPClass(II->getArgOperand(0), DemandedElts, InterestedClasses,
5384 KnownSrc, Q, Depth + 1);
5385 if (KnownSrc.isKnownNeverNaN()) {
5386 Known.knownNot(fcNan);
5387 Known.signBitMustBeZero();
5388 }
5389
5390 break;
5391 }
5392 case Intrinsic::fptrunc_round: {
5393 computeKnownFPClassForFPTrunc(Op, DemandedElts, InterestedClasses, Known,
5394 Q, Depth);
5395 break;
5396 }
5397 case Intrinsic::log:
5398 case Intrinsic::log10:
5399 case Intrinsic::log2:
5400 case Intrinsic::experimental_constrained_log:
5401 case Intrinsic::experimental_constrained_log10:
5402 case Intrinsic::experimental_constrained_log2: {
5403 // log(+inf) -> +inf
5404 // log([+-]0.0) -> -inf
5405 // log(-inf) -> nan
5406 // log(-x) -> nan
5407 if ((InterestedClasses & (fcNan | fcInf)) == fcNone)
5408 break;
5409
5410 FPClassTest InterestedSrcs = InterestedClasses;
5411 if ((InterestedClasses & fcNegInf) != fcNone)
5412 InterestedSrcs |= fcZero | fcSubnormal;
5413 if ((InterestedClasses & fcNan) != fcNone)
5414 InterestedSrcs |= fcNan | (fcNegative & ~fcNan);
5415
5416 KnownFPClass KnownSrc;
5417 computeKnownFPClass(II->getArgOperand(0), DemandedElts, InterestedSrcs,
5418 KnownSrc, Q, Depth + 1);
5419
5420 if (KnownSrc.isKnownNeverPosInfinity())
5421 Known.knownNot(fcPosInf);
5422
5423 if (KnownSrc.isKnownNeverNaN() && KnownSrc.cannotBeOrderedLessThanZero())
5424 Known.knownNot(fcNan);
5425
5426 const Function *F = II->getFunction();
5427
5428 if (!F)
5429 break;
5430
5431 const fltSemantics &FltSem =
5432 II->getType()->getScalarType()->getFltSemantics();
5433 DenormalMode Mode = F->getDenormalMode(FltSem);
5434
5435 if (KnownSrc.isKnownNeverLogicalZero(Mode))
5436 Known.knownNot(fcNegInf);
5437
5438 break;
5439 }
5440 case Intrinsic::powi: {
5441 if ((InterestedClasses & fcNegative) == fcNone)
5442 break;
5443
5444 const Value *Exp = II->getArgOperand(1);
5445 Type *ExpTy = Exp->getType();
5446 unsigned BitWidth = ExpTy->getScalarType()->getIntegerBitWidth();
5447 KnownBits ExponentKnownBits(BitWidth);
5448 computeKnownBits(Exp, isa<VectorType>(ExpTy) ? DemandedElts : APInt(1, 1),
5449 ExponentKnownBits, Q, Depth + 1);
5450
5451 if (ExponentKnownBits.Zero[0]) { // Is even
5452 Known.knownNot(fcNegative);
5453 break;
5454 }
5455
5456 // Given that exp is an integer, here are the
5457 // ways that pow can return a negative value:
5458 //
5459 // pow(-x, exp) --> negative if exp is odd and x is negative.
5460 // pow(-0, exp) --> -inf if exp is negative odd.
5461 // pow(-0, exp) --> -0 if exp is positive odd.
5462 // pow(-inf, exp) --> -0 if exp is negative odd.
5463 // pow(-inf, exp) --> -inf if exp is positive odd.
5464 KnownFPClass KnownSrc;
5465 computeKnownFPClass(II->getArgOperand(0), DemandedElts, fcNegative,
5466 KnownSrc, Q, Depth + 1);
5467 if (KnownSrc.isKnownNever(fcNegative))
5468 Known.knownNot(fcNegative);
5469 break;
5470 }
5471 case Intrinsic::ldexp: {
5472 KnownFPClass KnownSrc;
5473 computeKnownFPClass(II->getArgOperand(0), DemandedElts, InterestedClasses,
5474 KnownSrc, Q, Depth + 1);
5475 Known.propagateNaN(KnownSrc, /*PropagateSign=*/true);
5476
5477 // Sign is preserved, but underflows may produce zeroes.
5478 if (KnownSrc.isKnownNever(fcNegative))
5479 Known.knownNot(fcNegative);
5480 else if (KnownSrc.cannotBeOrderedLessThanZero())
5482
5483 if (KnownSrc.isKnownNever(fcPositive))
5484 Known.knownNot(fcPositive);
5485 else if (KnownSrc.cannotBeOrderedGreaterThanZero())
5487
5488 // Can refine inf/zero handling based on the exponent operand.
5489 const FPClassTest ExpInfoMask = fcZero | fcSubnormal | fcInf;
5490 if ((InterestedClasses & ExpInfoMask) == fcNone)
5491 break;
5492 if ((KnownSrc.KnownFPClasses & ExpInfoMask) == fcNone)
5493 break;
5494
5495 const fltSemantics &Flt =
5496 II->getType()->getScalarType()->getFltSemantics();
5497 unsigned Precision = APFloat::semanticsPrecision(Flt);
5498 const Value *ExpArg = II->getArgOperand(1);
5500 ExpArg, true, Q.IIQ.UseInstrInfo, Q.AC, Q.CxtI, Q.DT, Depth + 1);
5501
5502 const int MantissaBits = Precision - 1;
5503 if (ExpRange.getSignedMin().sge(static_cast<int64_t>(MantissaBits)))
5504 Known.knownNot(fcSubnormal);
5505
5506 const Function *F = II->getFunction();
5507 const APInt *ConstVal = ExpRange.getSingleElement();
5508 const fltSemantics &FltSem =
5509 II->getType()->getScalarType()->getFltSemantics();
5510 if (ConstVal && ConstVal->isZero()) {
5511 // ldexp(x, 0) -> x, so propagate everything.
5512 Known.propagateCanonicalizingSrc(KnownSrc, F->getDenormalMode(FltSem));
5513 } else if (ExpRange.isAllNegative()) {
5514 // If we know the power is <= 0, can't introduce inf
5515 if (KnownSrc.isKnownNeverPosInfinity())
5516 Known.knownNot(fcPosInf);
5517 if (KnownSrc.isKnownNeverNegInfinity())
5518 Known.knownNot(fcNegInf);
5519 } else if (ExpRange.isAllNonNegative()) {
5520 // If we know the power is >= 0, can't introduce subnormal or zero
5521 if (KnownSrc.isKnownNeverPosSubnormal())
5522 Known.knownNot(fcPosSubnormal);
5523 if (KnownSrc.isKnownNeverNegSubnormal())
5524 Known.knownNot(fcNegSubnormal);
5525 if (F &&
5526 KnownSrc.isKnownNeverLogicalPosZero(F->getDenormalMode(FltSem)))
5527 Known.knownNot(fcPosZero);
5528 if (F &&
5529 KnownSrc.isKnownNeverLogicalNegZero(F->getDenormalMode(FltSem)))
5530 Known.knownNot(fcNegZero);
5531 }
5532
5533 break;
5534 }
5535 case Intrinsic::arithmetic_fence: {
5536 computeKnownFPClass(II->getArgOperand(0), DemandedElts, InterestedClasses,
5537 Known, Q, Depth + 1);
5538 break;
5539 }
5540 case Intrinsic::experimental_constrained_sitofp:
5541 case Intrinsic::experimental_constrained_uitofp:
5542 // Cannot produce nan
5543 Known.knownNot(fcNan);
5544
5545 // sitofp and uitofp turn into +0.0 for zero.
5546 Known.knownNot(fcNegZero);
5547
5548 // Integers cannot be subnormal
5549 Known.knownNot(fcSubnormal);
5550
5551 if (IID == Intrinsic::experimental_constrained_uitofp)
5552 Known.signBitMustBeZero();
5553
5554 // TODO: Copy inf handling from instructions
5555 break;
5556 default:
5557 break;
5558 }
5559
5560 break;
5561 }
5562 case Instruction::FAdd:
5563 case Instruction::FSub: {
5564 KnownFPClass KnownLHS, KnownRHS;
5565 bool WantNegative =
5566 Op->getOpcode() == Instruction::FAdd &&
5567 (InterestedClasses & KnownFPClass::OrderedLessThanZeroMask) != fcNone;
5568 bool WantNaN = (InterestedClasses & fcNan) != fcNone;
5569 bool WantNegZero = (InterestedClasses & fcNegZero) != fcNone;
5570
5571 if (!WantNaN && !WantNegative && !WantNegZero)
5572 break;
5573
5574 FPClassTest InterestedSrcs = InterestedClasses;
5575 if (WantNegative)
5576 InterestedSrcs |= KnownFPClass::OrderedLessThanZeroMask;
5577 if (InterestedClasses & fcNan)
5578 InterestedSrcs |= fcInf;
5579 computeKnownFPClass(Op->getOperand(1), DemandedElts, InterestedSrcs,
5580 KnownRHS, Q, Depth + 1);
5581
5582 if ((WantNaN && KnownRHS.isKnownNeverNaN()) ||
5583 (WantNegative && KnownRHS.cannotBeOrderedLessThanZero()) ||
5584 WantNegZero || Opc == Instruction::FSub) {
5585
5586 // RHS is canonically cheaper to compute. Skip inspecting the LHS if
5587 // there's no point.
5588 computeKnownFPClass(Op->getOperand(0), DemandedElts, InterestedSrcs,
5589 KnownLHS, Q, Depth + 1);
5590 // Adding positive and negative infinity produces NaN.
5591 // TODO: Check sign of infinities.
5592 if (KnownLHS.isKnownNeverNaN() && KnownRHS.isKnownNeverNaN() &&
5593 (KnownLHS.isKnownNeverInfinity() || KnownRHS.isKnownNeverInfinity()))
5594 Known.knownNot(fcNan);
5595
5596 // FIXME: Context function should always be passed in separately
5597 const Function *F = cast<Instruction>(Op)->getFunction();
5598
5599 if (Op->getOpcode() == Instruction::FAdd) {
5600 if (KnownLHS.cannotBeOrderedLessThanZero() &&
5601 KnownRHS.cannotBeOrderedLessThanZero())
5603 if (!F)
5604 break;
5605
5606 const fltSemantics &FltSem =
5607 Op->getType()->getScalarType()->getFltSemantics();
5608 DenormalMode Mode = F->getDenormalMode(FltSem);
5609
5610 // (fadd x, 0.0) is guaranteed to return +0.0, not -0.0.
5611 if ((KnownLHS.isKnownNeverLogicalNegZero(Mode) ||
5612 KnownRHS.isKnownNeverLogicalNegZero(Mode)) &&
5613 // Make sure output negative denormal can't flush to -0
5614 outputDenormalIsIEEEOrPosZero(*F, Op->getType()))
5615 Known.knownNot(fcNegZero);
5616 } else {
5617 if (!F)
5618 break;
5619
5620 const fltSemantics &FltSem =
5621 Op->getType()->getScalarType()->getFltSemantics();
5622 DenormalMode Mode = F->getDenormalMode(FltSem);
5623
5624 // Only fsub -0, +0 can return -0
5625 if ((KnownLHS.isKnownNeverLogicalNegZero(Mode) ||
5626 KnownRHS.isKnownNeverLogicalPosZero(Mode)) &&
5627 // Make sure output negative denormal can't flush to -0
5628 outputDenormalIsIEEEOrPosZero(*F, Op->getType()))
5629 Known.knownNot(fcNegZero);
5630 }
5631 }
5632
5633 break;
5634 }
5635 case Instruction::FMul: {
5636 // X * X is always non-negative or a NaN.
5637 if (Op->getOperand(0) == Op->getOperand(1))
5638 Known.knownNot(fcNegative);
5639
5640 if ((InterestedClasses & fcNan) != fcNan)
5641 break;
5642
5643 // fcSubnormal is only needed in case of DAZ.
5644 const FPClassTest NeedForNan = fcNan | fcInf | fcZero | fcSubnormal;
5645
5646 KnownFPClass KnownLHS, KnownRHS;
5647 computeKnownFPClass(Op->getOperand(1), DemandedElts, NeedForNan, KnownRHS,
5648 Q, Depth + 1);
5649
5650 const APFloat *CRHS;
5651 if (match(Op->getOperand(1), m_APFloat(CRHS))) {
5652 // Match denormal scaling pattern, similar to the case in ldexp. If the
5653 // constant's exponent is sufficiently large, the result cannot be
5654 // subnormal.
5655
5656 // TODO: Should do general ConstantFPRange analysis.
5657 const fltSemantics &Flt =
5658 Op->getType()->getScalarType()->getFltSemantics();
5659 unsigned Precision = APFloat::semanticsPrecision(Flt);
5660 const int MantissaBits = Precision - 1;
5661
5662 int MinKnownExponent = ilogb(*CRHS);
5663 if (MinKnownExponent >= MantissaBits)
5664 Known.knownNot(fcSubnormal);
5665 }
5666
5667 if (!KnownRHS.isKnownNeverNaN())
5668 break;
5669
5670 computeKnownFPClass(Op->getOperand(0), DemandedElts, NeedForNan, KnownLHS,
5671 Q, Depth + 1);
5672 if (!KnownLHS.isKnownNeverNaN())
5673 break;
5674
5675 if (KnownLHS.SignBit && KnownRHS.SignBit) {
5676 if (*KnownLHS.SignBit == *KnownRHS.SignBit)
5677 Known.signBitMustBeZero();
5678 else
5679 Known.signBitMustBeOne();
5680 }
5681
5682 // If 0 * +/-inf produces NaN.
5683 if (KnownLHS.isKnownNeverInfinity() && KnownRHS.isKnownNeverInfinity()) {
5684 Known.knownNot(fcNan);
5685 break;
5686 }
5687
5688 const Function *F = cast<Instruction>(Op)->getFunction();
5689 if (!F)
5690 break;
5691
5692 Type *OpTy = Op->getType()->getScalarType();
5693 const fltSemantics &FltSem = OpTy->getFltSemantics();
5694 DenormalMode Mode = F->getDenormalMode(FltSem);
5695
5696 if ((KnownRHS.isKnownNeverInfinity() ||
5697 KnownLHS.isKnownNeverLogicalZero(Mode)) &&
5698 (KnownLHS.isKnownNeverInfinity() ||
5699 KnownRHS.isKnownNeverLogicalZero(Mode)))
5700 Known.knownNot(fcNan);
5701
5702 break;
5703 }
5704 case Instruction::FDiv:
5705 case Instruction::FRem: {
5706 if (Op->getOperand(0) == Op->getOperand(1)) {
5707 // TODO: Could filter out snan if we inspect the operand
5708 if (Op->getOpcode() == Instruction::FDiv) {
5709 // X / X is always exactly 1.0 or a NaN.
5711 } else {
5712 // X % X is always exactly [+-]0.0 or a NaN.
5713 Known.KnownFPClasses = fcNan | fcZero;
5714 }
5715
5716 break;
5717 }
5718
5719 const bool WantNan = (InterestedClasses & fcNan) != fcNone;
5720 const bool WantNegative = (InterestedClasses & fcNegative) != fcNone;
5721 const bool WantPositive =
5722 Opc == Instruction::FRem && (InterestedClasses & fcPositive) != fcNone;
5723 if (!WantNan && !WantNegative && !WantPositive)
5724 break;
5725
5726 KnownFPClass KnownLHS, KnownRHS;
5727
5728 computeKnownFPClass(Op->getOperand(1), DemandedElts,
5729 fcNan | fcInf | fcZero | fcNegative, KnownRHS, Q,
5730 Depth + 1);
5731
5732 bool KnowSomethingUseful =
5733 KnownRHS.isKnownNeverNaN() || KnownRHS.isKnownNever(fcNegative);
5734
5735 if (KnowSomethingUseful || WantPositive) {
5736 const FPClassTest InterestedLHS =
5737 WantPositive ? fcAllFlags
5739
5740 computeKnownFPClass(Op->getOperand(0), DemandedElts,
5741 InterestedClasses & InterestedLHS, KnownLHS, Q,
5742 Depth + 1);
5743 }
5744
5745 const Function *F = cast<Instruction>(Op)->getFunction();
5746 const fltSemantics &FltSem =
5747 Op->getType()->getScalarType()->getFltSemantics();
5748
5749 if (Op->getOpcode() == Instruction::FDiv) {
5750 // Only 0/0, Inf/Inf produce NaN.
5751 if (KnownLHS.isKnownNeverNaN() && KnownRHS.isKnownNeverNaN() &&
5752 (KnownLHS.isKnownNeverInfinity() ||
5753 KnownRHS.isKnownNeverInfinity()) &&
5754 ((F &&
5755 KnownLHS.isKnownNeverLogicalZero(F->getDenormalMode(FltSem))) ||
5756 (F &&
5757 KnownRHS.isKnownNeverLogicalZero(F->getDenormalMode(FltSem))))) {
5758 Known.knownNot(fcNan);
5759 }
5760
5761 // X / -0.0 is -Inf (or NaN).
5762 // +X / +X is +X
5763 if (KnownLHS.isKnownNever(fcNegative) && KnownRHS.isKnownNever(fcNegative))
5764 Known.knownNot(fcNegative);
5765 } else {
5766 // Inf REM x and x REM 0 produce NaN.
5767 if (KnownLHS.isKnownNeverNaN() && KnownRHS.isKnownNeverNaN() &&
5768 KnownLHS.isKnownNeverInfinity() && F &&
5769 KnownRHS.isKnownNeverLogicalZero(F->getDenormalMode(FltSem))) {
5770 Known.knownNot(fcNan);
5771 }
5772
5773 // The sign for frem is the same as the first operand.
5774 if (KnownLHS.cannotBeOrderedLessThanZero())
5776 if (KnownLHS.cannotBeOrderedGreaterThanZero())
5778
5779 // See if we can be more aggressive about the sign of 0.
5780 if (KnownLHS.isKnownNever(fcNegative))
5781 Known.knownNot(fcNegative);
5782 if (KnownLHS.isKnownNever(fcPositive))
5783 Known.knownNot(fcPositive);
5784 }
5785
5786 break;
5787 }
5788 case Instruction::FPExt: {
5789 // Infinity, nan and zero propagate from source.
5790 computeKnownFPClass(Op->getOperand(0), DemandedElts, InterestedClasses,
5791 Known, Q, Depth + 1);
5792
5793 const fltSemantics &DstTy =
5794 Op->getType()->getScalarType()->getFltSemantics();
5795 const fltSemantics &SrcTy =
5796 Op->getOperand(0)->getType()->getScalarType()->getFltSemantics();
5797
5798 // All subnormal inputs should be in the normal range in the result type.
5799 if (APFloat::isRepresentableAsNormalIn(SrcTy, DstTy)) {
5800 if (Known.KnownFPClasses & fcPosSubnormal)
5801 Known.KnownFPClasses |= fcPosNormal;
5802 if (Known.KnownFPClasses & fcNegSubnormal)
5803 Known.KnownFPClasses |= fcNegNormal;
5804 Known.knownNot(fcSubnormal);
5805 }
5806
5807 // Sign bit of a nan isn't guaranteed.
5808 if (!Known.isKnownNeverNaN())
5809 Known.SignBit = std::nullopt;
5810 break;
5811 }
5812 case Instruction::FPTrunc: {
5813 computeKnownFPClassForFPTrunc(Op, DemandedElts, InterestedClasses, Known, Q,
5814 Depth);
5815 break;
5816 }
5817 case Instruction::SIToFP:
5818 case Instruction::UIToFP: {
5819 // Cannot produce nan
5820 Known.knownNot(fcNan);
5821
5822 // Integers cannot be subnormal
5823 Known.knownNot(fcSubnormal);
5824
5825 // sitofp and uitofp turn into +0.0 for zero.
5826 Known.knownNot(fcNegZero);
5827 if (Op->getOpcode() == Instruction::UIToFP)
5828 Known.signBitMustBeZero();
5829
5830 if (InterestedClasses & fcInf) {
5831 // Get width of largest magnitude integer (remove a bit if signed).
5832 // This still works for a signed minimum value because the largest FP
5833 // value is scaled by some fraction close to 2.0 (1.0 + 0.xxxx).
5834 int IntSize = Op->getOperand(0)->getType()->getScalarSizeInBits();
5835 if (Op->getOpcode() == Instruction::SIToFP)
5836 --IntSize;
5837
5838 // If the exponent of the largest finite FP value can hold the largest
5839 // integer, the result of the cast must be finite.
5840 Type *FPTy = Op->getType()->getScalarType();
5841 if (ilogb(APFloat::getLargest(FPTy->getFltSemantics())) >= IntSize)
5842 Known.knownNot(fcInf);
5843 }
5844
5845 break;
5846 }
5847 case Instruction::ExtractElement: {
5848 // Look through extract element. If the index is non-constant or
5849 // out-of-range demand all elements, otherwise just the extracted element.
5850 const Value *Vec = Op->getOperand(0);
5851
5852 APInt DemandedVecElts;
5853 if (auto *VecTy = dyn_cast<FixedVectorType>(Vec->getType())) {
5854 unsigned NumElts = VecTy->getNumElements();
5855 DemandedVecElts = APInt::getAllOnes(NumElts);
5856 auto *CIdx = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(Op->getOperand(1));
5857 if (CIdx && CIdx->getValue().ult(NumElts))
5858 DemandedVecElts = APInt::getOneBitSet(NumElts, CIdx->getZExtValue());
5859 } else {
5860 DemandedVecElts = APInt(1, 1);
5861 }
5862
5863 return computeKnownFPClass(Vec, DemandedVecElts, InterestedClasses, Known,
5864 Q, Depth + 1);
5865 }
5866 case Instruction::InsertElement: {
5867 if (isa<ScalableVectorType>(Op->getType()))
5868 return;
5869
5870 const Value *Vec = Op->getOperand(0);
5871 const Value *Elt = Op->getOperand(1);
5872 auto *CIdx = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(Op->getOperand(2));
5873 unsigned NumElts = DemandedElts.getBitWidth();
5874 APInt DemandedVecElts = DemandedElts;
5875 bool NeedsElt = true;
5876 // If we know the index we are inserting to, clear it from Vec check.
5877 if (CIdx && CIdx->getValue().ult(NumElts)) {
5878 DemandedVecElts.clearBit(CIdx->getZExtValue());
5879 NeedsElt = DemandedElts[CIdx->getZExtValue()];
5880 }
5881
5882 // Do we demand the inserted element?
5883 if (NeedsElt) {
5884 computeKnownFPClass(Elt, Known, InterestedClasses, Q, Depth + 1);
5885 // If we don't know any bits, early out.
5886 if (Known.isUnknown())
5887 break;
5888 } else {
5889 Known.KnownFPClasses = fcNone;
5890 }
5891
5892 // Do we need anymore elements from Vec?
5893 if (!DemandedVecElts.isZero()) {
5894 KnownFPClass Known2;
5895 computeKnownFPClass(Vec, DemandedVecElts, InterestedClasses, Known2, Q,
5896 Depth + 1);
5897 Known |= Known2;
5898 }
5899
5900 break;
5901 }
5902 case Instruction::ShuffleVector: {
5903 // Handle vector splat idiom
5904 if (Value *Splat = getSplatValue(V)) {
5905 computeKnownFPClass(Splat, Known, InterestedClasses, Q, Depth + 1);
5906 break;
5907 }
5908
5909 // For undef elements, we don't know anything about the common state of
5910 // the shuffle result.
5911 APInt DemandedLHS, DemandedRHS;
5912 auto *Shuf = dyn_cast<ShuffleVectorInst>(Op);
5913 if (!Shuf || !getShuffleDemandedElts(Shuf, DemandedElts, DemandedLHS, DemandedRHS))
5914 return;
5915
5916 if (!!DemandedLHS) {
5917 const Value *LHS = Shuf->getOperand(0);
5918 computeKnownFPClass(LHS, DemandedLHS, InterestedClasses, Known, Q,
5919 Depth + 1);
5920
5921 // If we don't know any bits, early out.
5922 if (Known.isUnknown())
5923 break;
5924 } else {
5925 Known.KnownFPClasses = fcNone;
5926 }
5927
5928 if (!!DemandedRHS) {
5929 KnownFPClass Known2;
5930 const Value *RHS = Shuf->getOperand(1);
5931 computeKnownFPClass(RHS, DemandedRHS, InterestedClasses, Known2, Q,
5932 Depth + 1);
5933 Known |= Known2;
5934 }
5935
5936 break;
5937 }
5938 case Instruction::ExtractValue: {
5939 const ExtractValueInst *Extract = cast<ExtractValueInst>(Op);
5940 ArrayRef<unsigned> Indices = Extract->getIndices();
5941 const Value *Src = Extract->getAggregateOperand();
5942 if (isa<StructType>(Src->getType()) && Indices.size() == 1 &&
5943 Indices[0] == 0) {
5944 if (const auto *II = dyn_cast<IntrinsicInst>(Src)) {
5945 switch (II->getIntrinsicID()) {
5946 case Intrinsic::frexp: {
5947 Known.knownNot(fcSubnormal);
5948
5949 KnownFPClass KnownSrc;
5950 computeKnownFPClass(II->getArgOperand(0), DemandedElts,
5951 InterestedClasses, KnownSrc, Q, Depth + 1);
5952
5953 const Function *F = cast<Instruction>(Op)->getFunction();
5954 const fltSemantics &FltSem =
5955 Op->getType()->getScalarType()->getFltSemantics();
5956
5957 if (KnownSrc.isKnownNever(fcNegative))
5958 Known.knownNot(fcNegative);
5959 else {
5960 if (F &&
5961 KnownSrc.isKnownNeverLogicalNegZero(F->getDenormalMode(FltSem)))
5962 Known.knownNot(fcNegZero);
5963 if (KnownSrc.isKnownNever(fcNegInf))
5964 Known.knownNot(fcNegInf);
5965 }
5966
5967 if (KnownSrc.isKnownNever(fcPositive))
5968 Known.knownNot(fcPositive);
5969 else {
5970 if (F &&
5971 KnownSrc.isKnownNeverLogicalPosZero(F->getDenormalMode(FltSem)))
5972 Known.knownNot(fcPosZero);
5973 if (KnownSrc.isKnownNever(fcPosInf))
5974 Known.knownNot(fcPosInf);
5975 }
5976
5977 Known.propagateNaN(KnownSrc);
5978 return;
5979 }
5980 default:
5981 break;
5982 }
5983 }
5984 }
5985
5986 computeKnownFPClass(Src, DemandedElts, InterestedClasses, Known, Q,
5987 Depth + 1);
5988 break;
5989 }
5990 case Instruction::PHI: {
5991 const PHINode *P = cast<PHINode>(Op);
5992 // Unreachable blocks may have zero-operand PHI nodes.
5993 if (P->getNumIncomingValues() == 0)
5994 break;
5995
5996 // Otherwise take the unions of the known bit sets of the operands,
5997 // taking conservative care to avoid excessive recursion.
5998 const unsigned PhiRecursionLimit = MaxAnalysisRecursionDepth - 2;
5999
6000 if (Depth < PhiRecursionLimit) {
6001 // Skip if every incoming value references to ourself.
6002 if (isa_and_nonnull<UndefValue>(P->hasConstantValue()))
6003 break;
6004
6005 bool First = true;
6006
6007 for (const Use &U : P->operands()) {
6008 Value *IncValue;
6009 Instruction *CxtI;
6010 breakSelfRecursivePHI(&U, P, IncValue, CxtI);
6011 // Skip direct self references.
6012 if (IncValue == P)
6013 continue;
6014
6015 KnownFPClass KnownSrc;
6016 // Recurse, but cap the recursion to two levels, because we don't want
6017 // to waste time spinning around in loops. We need at least depth 2 to
6018 // detect known sign bits.
6019 computeKnownFPClass(IncValue, DemandedElts, InterestedClasses, KnownSrc,
6021 PhiRecursionLimit);
6022
6023 if (First) {
6024 Known = KnownSrc;
6025 First = false;
6026 } else {
6027 Known |= KnownSrc;
6028 }
6029
6030 if (Known.KnownFPClasses == fcAllFlags)
6031 break;
6032 }
6033 }
6034
6035 break;
6036 }
6037 case Instruction::BitCast: {
6038 const Value *Src;
6039 if (!match(Op, m_ElementWiseBitCast(m_Value(Src))) ||
6040 !Src->getType()->isIntOrIntVectorTy())
6041 break;
6042
6043 const Type *Ty = Op->getType()->getScalarType();
6044 KnownBits Bits(Ty->getScalarSizeInBits());
6045 computeKnownBits(Src, DemandedElts, Bits, Q, Depth + 1);
6046
6047 // Transfer information from the sign bit.
6048 if (Bits.isNonNegative())
6049 Known.signBitMustBeZero();
6050 else if (Bits.isNegative())
6051 Known.signBitMustBeOne();
6052
6053 if (Ty->isIEEELikeFPTy()) {
6054 // IEEE floats are NaN when all bits of the exponent plus at least one of
6055 // the fraction bits are 1. This means:
6056 // - If we assume unknown bits are 0 and the value is NaN, it will
6057 // always be NaN
6058 // - If we assume unknown bits are 1 and the value is not NaN, it can
6059 // never be NaN
6060 // Note: They do not hold for x86_fp80 format.
6061 if (APFloat(Ty->getFltSemantics(), Bits.One).isNaN())
6062 Known.KnownFPClasses = fcNan;
6063 else if (!APFloat(Ty->getFltSemantics(), ~Bits.Zero).isNaN())
6064 Known.knownNot(fcNan);
6065
6066 // Build KnownBits representing Inf and check if it must be equal or
6067 // unequal to this value.
6068 auto InfKB = KnownBits::makeConstant(
6069 APFloat::getInf(Ty->getFltSemantics()).bitcastToAPInt());
6070 InfKB.Zero.clearSignBit();
6071 if (const auto InfResult = KnownBits::eq(Bits, InfKB)) {
6072 assert(!InfResult.value());
6073 Known.knownNot(fcInf);
6074 } else if (Bits == InfKB) {
6075 Known.KnownFPClasses = fcInf;
6076 }
6077
6078 // Build KnownBits representing Zero and check if it must be equal or
6079 // unequal to this value.
6080 auto ZeroKB = KnownBits::makeConstant(
6081 APFloat::getZero(Ty->getFltSemantics()).bitcastToAPInt());
6082 ZeroKB.Zero.clearSignBit();
6083 if (const auto ZeroResult = KnownBits::eq(Bits, ZeroKB)) {
6084 assert(!ZeroResult.value());
6085 Known.knownNot(fcZero);
6086 } else if (Bits == ZeroKB) {
6087 Known.KnownFPClasses = fcZero;
6088 }
6089 }
6090
6091 break;
6092 }
6093 default:
6094 break;
6095 }
6096}
6097
6099 const APInt &DemandedElts,
6100 FPClassTest InterestedClasses,
6101 const SimplifyQuery &SQ,
6102 unsigned Depth) {
6103 KnownFPClass KnownClasses;
6104 ::computeKnownFPClass(V, DemandedElts, InterestedClasses, KnownClasses, SQ,
6105 Depth);
6106 return KnownClasses;
6107}
6108
6110 FPClassTest InterestedClasses,
6111 const SimplifyQuery &SQ,
6112 unsigned Depth) {
6113 KnownFPClass Known;
6114 ::computeKnownFPClass(V, Known, InterestedClasses, SQ, Depth);
6115 return Known;
6116}
6117
6119 const Value *V, const DataLayout &DL, FPClassTest InterestedClasses,
6120 const TargetLibraryInfo *TLI, AssumptionCache *AC, const Instruction *CxtI,
6121 const DominatorTree *DT, bool UseInstrInfo, unsigned Depth) {
6122 return computeKnownFPClass(V, InterestedClasses,
6123 SimplifyQuery(DL, TLI, DT, AC, CxtI, UseInstrInfo),
6124 Depth);
6125}
6126
6128llvm::computeKnownFPClass(const Value *V, const APInt &DemandedElts,
6129 FastMathFlags FMF, FPClassTest InterestedClasses,
6130 const SimplifyQuery &SQ, unsigned Depth) {
6131 if (FMF.noNaNs())
6132 InterestedClasses &= ~fcNan;
6133 if (FMF.noInfs())
6134 InterestedClasses &= ~fcInf;
6135
6136 KnownFPClass Result =
6137 computeKnownFPClass(V, DemandedElts, InterestedClasses, SQ, Depth);
6138
6139 if (FMF.noNaNs())
6140 Result.KnownFPClasses &= ~fcNan;
6141 if (FMF.noInfs())
6142 Result.KnownFPClasses &= ~fcInf;
6143 return Result;
6144}
6145
6147 FPClassTest InterestedClasses,
6148 const SimplifyQuery &SQ,
6149 unsigned Depth) {
6150 auto *FVTy = dyn_cast<FixedVectorType>(V->getType());
6151 APInt DemandedElts =
6152 FVTy ? APInt::getAllOnes(FVTy->getNumElements()) : APInt(1, 1);
6153 return computeKnownFPClass(V, DemandedElts, FMF, InterestedClasses, SQ,
6154 Depth);
6155}
6156
6158 unsigned Depth) {
6160 return Known.isKnownNeverNegZero();
6161}
6162
6169
6171 unsigned Depth) {
6173 return Known.isKnownNeverInfinity();
6174}
6175
6176/// Return true if the floating-point value can never contain a NaN or infinity.
6178 unsigned Depth) {
6180 return Known.isKnownNeverNaN() && Known.isKnownNeverInfinity();
6181}
6182
6183/// Return true if the floating-point scalar value is not a NaN or if the
6184/// floating-point vector value has no NaN elements. Return false if a value
6185/// could ever be NaN.
6187 unsigned Depth) {
6189 return Known.isKnownNeverNaN();
6190}
6191
6192/// Return false if we can prove that the specified FP value's sign bit is 0.
6193/// Return true if we can prove that the specified FP value's sign bit is 1.
6194/// Otherwise return std::nullopt.
6195std::optional<bool> llvm::computeKnownFPSignBit(const Value *V,
6196 const SimplifyQuery &SQ,
6197 unsigned Depth) {
6199 return Known.SignBit;
6200}
6201
6203 auto *User = cast<Instruction>(U.getUser());
6204 if (auto *FPOp = dyn_cast<FPMathOperator>(User)) {
6205 if (FPOp->hasNoSignedZeros())
6206 return true;
6207 }
6208
6209 switch (User->getOpcode()) {
6210 case Instruction::FPToSI:
6211 case Instruction::FPToUI:
6212 return true;
6213 case Instruction::FCmp:
6214 // fcmp treats both positive and negative zero as equal.
6215 return true;
6216 case Instruction::Call:
6217 if (auto *II = dyn_cast<IntrinsicInst>(User)) {
6218 switch (II->getIntrinsicID()) {
6219 case Intrinsic::fabs:
6220 return true;
6221 case Intrinsic::copysign:
6222 return U.getOperandNo() == 0;
6223 case Intrinsic::is_fpclass:
6224 case Intrinsic::vp_is_fpclass: {
6225 auto Test =
6226 static_cast<FPClassTest>(
6227 cast<ConstantInt>(II->getArgOperand(1))->getZExtValue()) &
6230 }
6231 default:
6232 return false;
6233 }
6234 }
6235 return false;
6236 default:
6237 return false;
6238 }
6239}
6240
6242 auto *User = cast<Instruction>(U.getUser());
6243 if (auto *FPOp = dyn_cast<FPMathOperator>(User)) {
6244 if (FPOp->hasNoNaNs())
6245 return true;
6246 }
6247
6248 switch (User->getOpcode()) {
6249 case Instruction::FPToSI:
6250 case Instruction::FPToUI:
6251 return true;
6252 // Proper FP math operations ignore the sign bit of NaN.
6253 case Instruction::FAdd:
6254 case Instruction::FSub:
6255 case Instruction::FMul:
6256 case Instruction::FDiv:
6257 case Instruction::FRem:
6258 case Instruction::FPTrunc:
6259 case Instruction::FPExt:
6260 case Instruction::FCmp:
6261 return true;
6262 // Bitwise FP operations should preserve the sign bit of NaN.
6263 case Instruction::FNeg:
6264 case Instruction::Select:
6265 case Instruction::PHI:
6266 return false;
6267 case Instruction::Ret:
6268 return User->getFunction()->getAttributes().getRetNoFPClass() &
6270 case Instruction::Call:
6271 case Instruction::Invoke: {
6272 if (auto *II = dyn_cast<IntrinsicInst>(User)) {
6273 switch (II->getIntrinsicID()) {
6274 case Intrinsic::fabs:
6275 return true;
6276 case Intrinsic::copysign:
6277 return U.getOperandNo() == 0;
6278 // Other proper FP math intrinsics ignore the sign bit of NaN.
6279 case Intrinsic::maxnum:
6280 case Intrinsic::minnum:
6281 case Intrinsic::maximum:
6282 case Intrinsic::minimum:
6283 case Intrinsic::maximumnum:
6284 case Intrinsic::minimumnum:
6285 case Intrinsic::canonicalize:
6286 case Intrinsic::fma:
6287 case Intrinsic::fmuladd:
6288 case Intrinsic::sqrt:
6289 case Intrinsic::pow:
6290 case Intrinsic::powi:
6291 case Intrinsic::fptoui_sat:
6292 case Intrinsic::fptosi_sat:
6293 case Intrinsic::is_fpclass:
6294 case Intrinsic::vp_is_fpclass:
6295 return true;
6296 default:
6297 return false;
6298 }
6299 }
6300
6301 FPClassTest NoFPClass =
6302 cast<CallBase>(User)->getParamNoFPClass(U.getOperandNo());
6303 return NoFPClass & FPClassTest::fcNan;
6304 }
6305 default:
6306 return false;
6307 }
6308}
6309
6311
6312 // All byte-wide stores are splatable, even of arbitrary variables.
6313 if (V->getType()->isIntegerTy(8))
6314 return V;
6315
6316 LLVMContext &Ctx = V->getContext();
6317
6318 // Undef don't care.
6319 auto *UndefInt8 = UndefValue::get(Type::getInt8Ty(Ctx));
6320 if (isa<UndefValue>(V))
6321 return UndefInt8;
6322
6323 // Return poison for zero-sized type.
6324 if (DL.getTypeStoreSize(V->getType()).isZero())
6325 return PoisonValue::get(Type::getInt8Ty(Ctx));
6326
6328 if (!C) {
6329 // Conceptually, we could handle things like:
6330 // %a = zext i8 %X to i16
6331 // %b = shl i16 %a, 8
6332 // %c = or i16 %a, %b
6333 // but until there is an example that actually needs this, it doesn't seem
6334 // worth worrying about.
6335 return nullptr;
6336 }
6337
6338 // Handle 'null' ConstantArrayZero etc.
6339 if (C->isNullValue())
6341
6342 // Constant floating-point values can be handled as integer values if the
6343 // corresponding integer value is "byteable". An important case is 0.0.
6344 if (ConstantFP *CFP = dyn_cast<ConstantFP>(C)) {
6345 Type *Ty = nullptr;
6346 if (CFP->getType()->isHalfTy())
6347 Ty = Type::getInt16Ty(Ctx);
6348 else if (CFP->getType()->isFloatTy())
6349 Ty = Type::getInt32Ty(Ctx);
6350 else if (CFP->getType()->isDoubleTy())
6351 Ty = Type::getInt64Ty(Ctx);
6352 // Don't handle long double formats, which have strange constraints.
6353 return Ty ? isBytewiseValue(ConstantExpr::getBitCast(CFP, Ty), DL)
6354 : nullptr;
6355 }
6356
6357 // We can handle constant integers that are multiple of 8 bits.
6358 if (ConstantInt *CI = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(C)) {
6359 if (CI->getBitWidth() % 8 == 0) {
6360 assert(CI->getBitWidth() > 8 && "8 bits should be handled above!");
6361 if (!CI->getValue().isSplat(8))
6362 return nullptr;
6363 return ConstantInt::get(Ctx, CI->getValue().trunc(8));
6364 }
6365 }
6366
6367 if (auto *CE = dyn_cast<ConstantExpr>(C)) {
6368 if (CE->getOpcode() == Instruction::IntToPtr) {
6369 if (auto *PtrTy = dyn_cast<PointerType>(CE->getType())) {
6370 unsigned BitWidth = DL.getPointerSizeInBits(PtrTy->getAddressSpace());
6372 CE->getOperand(0), Type::getIntNTy(Ctx, BitWidth), false, DL))
6373 return isBytewiseValue(Op, DL);
6374 }
6375 }
6376 }
6377
6378 auto Merge = [&](Value *LHS, Value *RHS) -> Value * {
6379 if (LHS == RHS)
6380 return LHS;
6381 if (!LHS || !RHS)
6382 return nullptr;
6383 if (LHS == UndefInt8)
6384 return RHS;
6385 if (RHS == UndefInt8)
6386 return LHS;
6387 return nullptr;
6388 };
6389
6391 Value *Val = UndefInt8;
6392 for (uint64_t I = 0, E = CA->getNumElements(); I != E; ++I)
6393 if (!(Val = Merge(Val, isBytewiseValue(CA->getElementAsConstant(I), DL))))
6394 return nullptr;
6395 return Val;
6396 }
6397
6399 Value *Val = UndefInt8;
6400 for (Value *Op : C->operands())
6401 if (!(Val = Merge(Val, isBytewiseValue(Op, DL))))
6402 return nullptr;
6403 return Val;
6404 }
6405
6406 // Don't try to handle the handful of other constants.
6407 return nullptr;
6408}
6409
6410// This is the recursive version of BuildSubAggregate. It takes a few different
6411// arguments. Idxs is the index within the nested struct From that we are
6412// looking at now (which is of type IndexedType). IdxSkip is the number of
6413// indices from Idxs that should be left out when inserting into the resulting
6414// struct. To is the result struct built so far, new insertvalue instructions
6415// build on that.
6416static Value *BuildSubAggregate(Value *From, Value *To, Type *IndexedType,
6418 unsigned IdxSkip,
6419 BasicBlock::iterator InsertBefore) {
6420 StructType *STy = dyn_cast<StructType>(IndexedType);
6421 if (STy) {
6422 // Save the original To argument so we can modify it
6423 Value *OrigTo = To;
6424 // General case, the type indexed by Idxs is a struct
6425 for (unsigned i = 0, e = STy->getNumElements(); i != e; ++i) {
6426 // Process each struct element recursively
6427 Idxs.push_back(i);
6428 Value *PrevTo = To;
6429 To = BuildSubAggregate(From, To, STy->getElementType(i), Idxs, IdxSkip,
6430 InsertBefore);
6431 Idxs.pop_back();
6432 if (!To) {
6433 // Couldn't find any inserted value for this index? Cleanup
6434 while (PrevTo != OrigTo) {
6436 PrevTo = Del->getAggregateOperand();
6437 Del->eraseFromParent();
6438 }
6439 // Stop processing elements
6440 break;
6441 }
6442 }
6443 // If we successfully found a value for each of our subaggregates
6444 if (To)
6445 return To;
6446 }
6447 // Base case, the type indexed by SourceIdxs is not a struct, or not all of
6448 // the struct's elements had a value that was inserted directly. In the latter
6449 // case, perhaps we can't determine each of the subelements individually, but
6450 // we might be able to find the complete struct somewhere.
6451
6452 // Find the value that is at that particular spot
6453 Value *V = FindInsertedValue(From, Idxs);
6454
6455 if (!V)
6456 return nullptr;
6457
6458 // Insert the value in the new (sub) aggregate
6459 return InsertValueInst::Create(To, V, ArrayRef(Idxs).slice(IdxSkip), "tmp",
6460 InsertBefore);
6461}
6462
6463// This helper takes a nested struct and extracts a part of it (which is again a
6464// struct) into a new value. For example, given the struct:
6465// { a, { b, { c, d }, e } }
6466// and the indices "1, 1" this returns
6467// { c, d }.
6468//
6469// It does this by inserting an insertvalue for each element in the resulting
6470// struct, as opposed to just inserting a single struct. This will only work if
6471// each of the elements of the substruct are known (ie, inserted into From by an
6472// insertvalue instruction somewhere).
6473//
6474// All inserted insertvalue instructions are inserted before InsertBefore
6476 BasicBlock::iterator InsertBefore) {
6477 Type *IndexedType = ExtractValueInst::getIndexedType(From->getType(),
6478 idx_range);
6479 Value *To = PoisonValue::get(IndexedType);
6480 SmallVector<unsigned, 10> Idxs(idx_range);
6481 unsigned IdxSkip = Idxs.size();
6482
6483 return BuildSubAggregate(From, To, IndexedType, Idxs, IdxSkip, InsertBefore);
6484}
6485
6486/// Given an aggregate and a sequence of indices, see if the scalar value
6487/// indexed is already around as a register, for example if it was inserted
6488/// directly into the aggregate.
6489///
6490/// If InsertBefore is not null, this function will duplicate (modified)
6491/// insertvalues when a part of a nested struct is extracted.
6492Value *
6494 std::optional<BasicBlock::iterator> InsertBefore) {
6495 // Nothing to index? Just return V then (this is useful at the end of our
6496 // recursion).
6497 if (idx_range.empty())
6498 return V;
6499 // We have indices, so V should have an indexable type.
6500 assert((V->getType()->isStructTy() || V->getType()->isArrayTy()) &&
6501 "Not looking at a struct or array?");
6502 assert(ExtractValueInst::getIndexedType(V->getType(), idx_range) &&
6503 "Invalid indices for type?");
6504
6505 if (Constant *C = dyn_cast<Constant>(V)) {
6506 C = C->getAggregateElement(idx_range[0]);
6507 if (!C) return nullptr;
6508 return FindInsertedValue(C, idx_range.slice(1), InsertBefore);
6509 }
6510
6512 // Loop the indices for the insertvalue instruction in parallel with the
6513 // requested indices
6514 const unsigned *req_idx = idx_range.begin();
6515 for (const unsigned *i = I->idx_begin(), *e = I->idx_end();
6516 i != e; ++i, ++req_idx) {
6517 if (req_idx == idx_range.end()) {
6518 // We can't handle this without inserting insertvalues
6519 if (!InsertBefore)
6520 return nullptr;
6521
6522 // The requested index identifies a part of a nested aggregate. Handle
6523 // this specially. For example,
6524 // %A = insertvalue { i32, {i32, i32 } } undef, i32 10, 1, 0
6525 // %B = insertvalue { i32, {i32, i32 } } %A, i32 11, 1, 1
6526 // %C = extractvalue {i32, { i32, i32 } } %B, 1
6527 // This can be changed into
6528 // %A = insertvalue {i32, i32 } undef, i32 10, 0
6529 // %C = insertvalue {i32, i32 } %A, i32 11, 1
6530 // which allows the unused 0,0 element from the nested struct to be
6531 // removed.
6532 return BuildSubAggregate(V, ArrayRef(idx_range.begin(), req_idx),
6533 *InsertBefore);
6534 }
6535
6536 // This insert value inserts something else than what we are looking for.
6537 // See if the (aggregate) value inserted into has the value we are
6538 // looking for, then.
6539 if (*req_idx != *i)
6540 return FindInsertedValue(I->getAggregateOperand(), idx_range,
6541 InsertBefore);
6542 }
6543 // If we end up here, the indices of the insertvalue match with those
6544 // requested (though possibly only partially). Now we recursively look at
6545 // the inserted value, passing any remaining indices.
6546 return FindInsertedValue(I->getInsertedValueOperand(),
6547 ArrayRef(req_idx, idx_range.end()), InsertBefore);
6548 }
6549
6551 // If we're extracting a value from an aggregate that was extracted from
6552 // something else, we can extract from that something else directly instead.
6553 // However, we will need to chain I's indices with the requested indices.
6554
6555 // Calculate the number of indices required
6556 unsigned size = I->getNumIndices() + idx_range.size();
6557 // Allocate some space to put the new indices in
6559 Idxs.reserve(size);
6560 // Add indices from the extract value instruction
6561 Idxs.append(I->idx_begin(), I->idx_end());
6562
6563 // Add requested indices
6564 Idxs.append(idx_range.begin(), idx_range.end());
6565
6566 assert(Idxs.size() == size
6567 && "Number of indices added not correct?");
6568
6569 return FindInsertedValue(I->getAggregateOperand(), Idxs, InsertBefore);
6570 }
6571 // Otherwise, we don't know (such as, extracting from a function return value
6572 // or load instruction)
6573 return nullptr;
6574}
6575
6576// If V refers to an initialized global constant, set Slice either to
6577// its initializer if the size of its elements equals ElementSize, or,
6578// for ElementSize == 8, to its representation as an array of unsiged
6579// char. Return true on success.
6580// Offset is in the unit "nr of ElementSize sized elements".
6583 unsigned ElementSize, uint64_t Offset) {
6584 assert(V && "V should not be null.");
6585 assert((ElementSize % 8) == 0 &&
6586 "ElementSize expected to be a multiple of the size of a byte.");
6587 unsigned ElementSizeInBytes = ElementSize / 8;
6588
6589 // Drill down into the pointer expression V, ignoring any intervening
6590 // casts, and determine the identity of the object it references along
6591 // with the cumulative byte offset into it.
6592 const GlobalVariable *GV =
6594 if (!GV || !GV->isConstant() || !GV->hasDefinitiveInitializer())
6595 // Fail if V is not based on constant global object.
6596 return false;
6597
6598 const DataLayout &DL = GV->getDataLayout();
6599 APInt Off(DL.getIndexTypeSizeInBits(V->getType()), 0);
6600
6601 if (GV != V->stripAndAccumulateConstantOffsets(DL, Off,
6602 /*AllowNonInbounds*/ true))
6603 // Fail if a constant offset could not be determined.
6604 return false;
6605
6606 uint64_t StartIdx = Off.getLimitedValue();
6607 if (StartIdx == UINT64_MAX)
6608 // Fail if the constant offset is excessive.
6609 return false;
6610
6611 // Off/StartIdx is in the unit of bytes. So we need to convert to number of
6612 // elements. Simply bail out if that isn't possible.
6613 if ((StartIdx % ElementSizeInBytes) != 0)
6614 return false;
6615
6616 Offset += StartIdx / ElementSizeInBytes;
6617 ConstantDataArray *Array = nullptr;
6618 ArrayType *ArrayTy = nullptr;
6619
6620 if (GV->getInitializer()->isNullValue()) {
6621 Type *GVTy = GV->getValueType();
6622 uint64_t SizeInBytes = DL.getTypeStoreSize(GVTy).getFixedValue();
6623 uint64_t Length = SizeInBytes / ElementSizeInBytes;
6624
6625 Slice.Array = nullptr;
6626 Slice.Offset = 0;
6627 // Return an empty Slice for undersized constants to let callers
6628 // transform even undefined library calls into simpler, well-defined
6629 // expressions. This is preferable to making the calls although it
6630 // prevents sanitizers from detecting such calls.
6631 Slice.Length = Length < Offset ? 0 : Length - Offset;
6632 return true;
6633 }
6634
6635 auto *Init = const_cast<Constant *>(GV->getInitializer());
6636 if (auto *ArrayInit = dyn_cast<ConstantDataArray>(Init)) {
6637 Type *InitElTy = ArrayInit->getElementType();
6638 if (InitElTy->isIntegerTy(ElementSize)) {
6639 // If Init is an initializer for an array of the expected type
6640 // and size, use it as is.
6641 Array = ArrayInit;
6642 ArrayTy = ArrayInit->getType();
6643 }
6644 }
6645
6646 if (!Array) {
6647 if (ElementSize != 8)
6648 // TODO: Handle conversions to larger integral types.
6649 return false;
6650
6651 // Otherwise extract the portion of the initializer starting
6652 // at Offset as an array of bytes, and reset Offset.
6654 if (!Init)
6655 return false;
6656
6657 Offset = 0;
6659 ArrayTy = dyn_cast<ArrayType>(Init->getType());
6660 }
6661
6662 uint64_t NumElts = ArrayTy->getArrayNumElements();
6663 if (Offset > NumElts)
6664 return false;
6665
6666 Slice.Array = Array;
6667 Slice.Offset = Offset;
6668 Slice.Length = NumElts - Offset;
6669 return true;
6670}
6671
6672/// Extract bytes from the initializer of the constant array V, which need
6673/// not be a nul-terminated string. On success, store the bytes in Str and
6674/// return true. When TrimAtNul is set, Str will contain only the bytes up
6675/// to but not including the first nul. Return false on failure.
6677 bool TrimAtNul) {
6679 if (!getConstantDataArrayInfo(V, Slice, 8))
6680 return false;
6681
6682 if (Slice.Array == nullptr) {
6683 if (TrimAtNul) {
6684 // Return a nul-terminated string even for an empty Slice. This is
6685 // safe because all existing SimplifyLibcalls callers require string
6686 // arguments and the behavior of the functions they fold is undefined
6687 // otherwise. Folding the calls this way is preferable to making
6688 // the undefined library calls, even though it prevents sanitizers
6689 // from reporting such calls.
6690 Str = StringRef();
6691 return true;
6692 }
6693 if (Slice.Length == 1) {
6694 Str = StringRef("", 1);
6695 return true;
6696 }
6697 // We cannot instantiate a StringRef as we do not have an appropriate string
6698 // of 0s at hand.
6699 return false;
6700 }
6701
6702 // Start out with the entire array in the StringRef.
6703 Str = Slice.Array->getAsString();
6704 // Skip over 'offset' bytes.
6705 Str = Str.substr(Slice.Offset);
6706
6707 if (TrimAtNul) {
6708 // Trim off the \0 and anything after it. If the array is not nul
6709 // terminated, we just return the whole end of string. The client may know
6710 // some other way that the string is length-bound.
6711 Str = Str.substr(0, Str.find('\0'));
6712 }
6713 return true;
6714}
6715
6716// These next two are very similar to the above, but also look through PHI
6717// nodes.
6718// TODO: See if we can integrate these two together.
6719
6720/// If we can compute the length of the string pointed to by
6721/// the specified pointer, return 'len+1'. If we can't, return 0.
6724 unsigned CharSize) {
6725 // Look through noop bitcast instructions.
6726 V = V->stripPointerCasts();
6727
6728 // If this is a PHI node, there are two cases: either we have already seen it
6729 // or we haven't.
6730 if (const PHINode *PN = dyn_cast<PHINode>(V)) {
6731 if (!PHIs.insert(PN).second)
6732 return ~0ULL; // already in the set.
6733
6734 // If it was new, see if all the input strings are the same length.
6735 uint64_t LenSoFar = ~0ULL;
6736 for (Value *IncValue : PN->incoming_values()) {
6737 uint64_t Len = GetStringLengthH(IncValue, PHIs, CharSize);
6738 if (Len == 0) return 0; // Unknown length -> unknown.
6739
6740 if (Len == ~0ULL) continue;
6741
6742 if (Len != LenSoFar && LenSoFar != ~0ULL)
6743 return 0; // Disagree -> unknown.
6744 LenSoFar = Len;
6745 }
6746
6747 // Success, all agree.
6748 return LenSoFar;
6749 }
6750
6751 // strlen(select(c,x,y)) -> strlen(x) ^ strlen(y)
6752 if (const SelectInst *SI = dyn_cast<SelectInst>(V)) {
6753 uint64_t Len1 = GetStringLengthH(SI->getTrueValue(), PHIs, CharSize);
6754 if (Len1 == 0) return 0;
6755 uint64_t Len2 = GetStringLengthH(SI->getFalseValue(), PHIs, CharSize);
6756 if (Len2 == 0) return 0;
6757 if (Len1 == ~0ULL) return Len2;
6758 if (Len2 == ~0ULL) return Len1;
6759 if (Len1 != Len2) return 0;
6760 return Len1;
6761 }
6762
6763 // Otherwise, see if we can read the string.
6765 if (!getConstantDataArrayInfo(V, Slice, CharSize))
6766 return 0;
6767
6768 if (Slice.Array == nullptr)
6769 // Zeroinitializer (including an empty one).
6770 return 1;
6771
6772 // Search for the first nul character. Return a conservative result even
6773 // when there is no nul. This is safe since otherwise the string function
6774 // being folded such as strlen is undefined, and can be preferable to
6775 // making the undefined library call.
6776 unsigned NullIndex = 0;
6777 for (unsigned E = Slice.Length; NullIndex < E; ++NullIndex) {
6778 if (Slice.Array->getElementAsInteger(Slice.Offset + NullIndex) == 0)
6779 break;
6780 }
6781
6782 return NullIndex + 1;
6783}
6784
6785/// If we can compute the length of the string pointed to by
6786/// the specified pointer, return 'len+1'. If we can't, return 0.
6787uint64_t llvm::GetStringLength(const Value *V, unsigned CharSize) {
6788 if (!V->getType()->isPointerTy())
6789 return 0;
6790
6792 uint64_t Len = GetStringLengthH(V, PHIs, CharSize);
6793 // If Len is ~0ULL, we had an infinite phi cycle: this is dead code, so return
6794 // an empty string as a length.
6795 return Len == ~0ULL ? 1 : Len;
6796}
6797
6798const Value *
6800 bool MustPreserveNullness) {
6801 assert(Call &&
6802 "getArgumentAliasingToReturnedPointer only works on nonnull calls");
6803 if (const Value *RV = Call->getReturnedArgOperand())
6804 return RV;
6805 // This can be used only as a aliasing property.
6807 Call, MustPreserveNullness))
6808 return Call->getArgOperand(0);
6809 return nullptr;
6810}
6811
6813 const CallBase *Call, bool MustPreserveNullness) {
6814 switch (Call->getIntrinsicID()) {
6815 case Intrinsic::launder_invariant_group:
6816 case Intrinsic::strip_invariant_group:
6817 case Intrinsic::aarch64_irg:
6818 case Intrinsic::aarch64_tagp:
6819 // The amdgcn_make_buffer_rsrc function does not alter the address of the
6820 // input pointer (and thus preserve null-ness for the purposes of escape
6821 // analysis, which is where the MustPreserveNullness flag comes in to play).
6822 // However, it will not necessarily map ptr addrspace(N) null to ptr
6823 // addrspace(8) null, aka the "null descriptor", which has "all loads return
6824 // 0, all stores are dropped" semantics. Given the context of this intrinsic
6825 // list, no one should be relying on such a strict interpretation of
6826 // MustPreserveNullness (and, at time of writing, they are not), but we
6827 // document this fact out of an abundance of caution.
6828 case Intrinsic::amdgcn_make_buffer_rsrc:
6829 return true;
6830 case Intrinsic::ptrmask:
6831 return !MustPreserveNullness;
6832 case Intrinsic::threadlocal_address:
6833 // The underlying variable changes with thread ID. The Thread ID may change
6834 // at coroutine suspend points.
6835 return !Call->getParent()->getParent()->isPresplitCoroutine();
6836 default:
6837 return false;
6838 }
6839}
6840
6841/// \p PN defines a loop-variant pointer to an object. Check if the
6842/// previous iteration of the loop was referring to the same object as \p PN.
6844 const LoopInfo *LI) {
6845 // Find the loop-defined value.
6846 Loop *L = LI->getLoopFor(PN->getParent());
6847 if (PN->getNumIncomingValues() != 2)
6848 return true;
6849
6850 // Find the value from previous iteration.
6851 auto *PrevValue = dyn_cast<Instruction>(PN->getIncomingValue(0));
6852 if (!PrevValue || LI->getLoopFor(PrevValue->getParent()) != L)
6853 PrevValue = dyn_cast<Instruction>(PN->getIncomingValue(1));
6854 if (!PrevValue || LI->getLoopFor(PrevValue->getParent()) != L)
6855 return true;
6856
6857 // If a new pointer is loaded in the loop, the pointer references a different
6858 // object in every iteration. E.g.:
6859 // for (i)
6860 // int *p = a[i];
6861 // ...
6862 if (auto *Load = dyn_cast<LoadInst>(PrevValue))
6863 if (!L->isLoopInvariant(Load->getPointerOperand()))
6864 return false;
6865 return true;
6866}
6867
6868const Value *llvm::getUnderlyingObject(const Value *V, unsigned MaxLookup) {
6869 for (unsigned Count = 0; MaxLookup == 0 || Count < MaxLookup; ++Count) {
6870 if (auto *GEP = dyn_cast<GEPOperator>(V)) {
6871 const Value *PtrOp = GEP->getPointerOperand();
6872 if (!PtrOp->getType()->isPointerTy()) // Only handle scalar pointer base.
6873 return V;
6874 V = PtrOp;
6875 } else if (Operator::getOpcode(V) == Instruction::BitCast ||
6876 Operator::getOpcode(V) == Instruction::AddrSpaceCast) {
6877 Value *NewV = cast<Operator>(V)->getOperand(0);
6878 if (!NewV->getType()->isPointerTy())
6879 return V;
6880 V = NewV;
6881 } else if (auto *GA = dyn_cast<GlobalAlias>(V)) {
6882 if (GA->isInterposable())
6883 return V;
6884 V = GA->getAliasee();
6885 } else {
6886 if (auto *PHI = dyn_cast<PHINode>(V)) {
6887 // Look through single-arg phi nodes created by LCSSA.
6888 if (PHI->getNumIncomingValues() == 1) {
6889 V = PHI->getIncomingValue(0);
6890 continue;
6891 }
6892 } else if (auto *Call = dyn_cast<CallBase>(V)) {
6893 // CaptureTracking can know about special capturing properties of some
6894 // intrinsics like launder.invariant.group, that can't be expressed with
6895 // the attributes, but have properties like returning aliasing pointer.
6896 // Because some analysis may assume that nocaptured pointer is not
6897 // returned from some special intrinsic (because function would have to
6898 // be marked with returns attribute), it is crucial to use this function
6899 // because it should be in sync with CaptureTracking. Not using it may
6900 // cause weird miscompilations where 2 aliasing pointers are assumed to
6901 // noalias.
6902 if (auto *RP = getArgumentAliasingToReturnedPointer(Call, false)) {
6903 V = RP;
6904 continue;
6905 }
6906 }
6907
6908 return V;
6909 }
6910 assert(V->getType()->isPointerTy() && "Unexpected operand type!");
6911 }
6912 return V;
6913}
6914
6917 const LoopInfo *LI, unsigned MaxLookup) {
6920 Worklist.push_back(V);
6921 do {
6922 const Value *P = Worklist.pop_back_val();
6923 P = getUnderlyingObject(P, MaxLookup);
6924
6925 if (!Visited.insert(P).second)
6926 continue;
6927
6928 if (auto *SI = dyn_cast<SelectInst>(P)) {
6929 Worklist.push_back(SI->getTrueValue());
6930 Worklist.push_back(SI->getFalseValue());
6931 continue;
6932 }
6933
6934 if (auto *PN = dyn_cast<PHINode>(P)) {
6935 // If this PHI changes the underlying object in every iteration of the
6936 // loop, don't look through it. Consider:
6937 // int **A;
6938 // for (i) {
6939 // Prev = Curr; // Prev = PHI (Prev_0, Curr)
6940 // Curr = A[i];
6941 // *Prev, *Curr;
6942 //
6943 // Prev is tracking Curr one iteration behind so they refer to different
6944 // underlying objects.
6945 if (!LI || !LI->isLoopHeader(PN->getParent()) ||
6947 append_range(Worklist, PN->incoming_values());
6948 else
6949 Objects.push_back(P);
6950 continue;
6951 }
6952
6953 Objects.push_back(P);
6954 } while (!Worklist.empty());
6955}
6956
6958 const unsigned MaxVisited = 8;
6959
6962 Worklist.push_back(V);
6963 const Value *Object = nullptr;
6964 // Used as fallback if we can't find a common underlying object through
6965 // recursion.
6966 bool First = true;
6967 const Value *FirstObject = getUnderlyingObject(V);
6968 do {
6969 const Value *P = Worklist.pop_back_val();
6970 P = First ? FirstObject : getUnderlyingObject(P);
6971 First = false;
6972
6973 if (!Visited.insert(P).second)
6974 continue;
6975
6976 if (Visited.size() == MaxVisited)
6977 return FirstObject;
6978
6979 if (auto *SI = dyn_cast<SelectInst>(P)) {
6980 Worklist.push_back(SI->getTrueValue());
6981 Worklist.push_back(SI->getFalseValue());
6982 continue;
6983 }
6984
6985 if (auto *PN = dyn_cast<PHINode>(P)) {
6986 append_range(Worklist, PN->incoming_values());
6987 continue;
6988 }
6989
6990 if (!Object)
6991 Object = P;
6992 else if (Object != P)
6993 return FirstObject;
6994 } while (!Worklist.empty());
6995
6996 return Object ? Object : FirstObject;
6997}
6998
6999/// This is the function that does the work of looking through basic
7000/// ptrtoint+arithmetic+inttoptr sequences.
7001static const Value *getUnderlyingObjectFromInt(const Value *V) {
7002 do {
7003 if (const Operator *U = dyn_cast<Operator>(V)) {
7004 // If we find a ptrtoint, we can transfer control back to the
7005 // regular getUnderlyingObjectFromInt.
7006 if (U->getOpcode() == Instruction::PtrToInt)
7007 return U->getOperand(0);
7008 // If we find an add of a constant, a multiplied value, or a phi, it's
7009 // likely that the other operand will lead us to the base
7010 // object. We don't have to worry about the case where the
7011 // object address is somehow being computed by the multiply,
7012 // because our callers only care when the result is an
7013 // identifiable object.
7014 if (U->getOpcode() != Instruction::Add ||
7015 (!isa<ConstantInt>(U->getOperand(1)) &&
7016 Operator::getOpcode(U->getOperand(1)) != Instruction::Mul &&
7017 !isa<PHINode>(U->getOperand(1))))
7018 return V;
7019 V = U->getOperand(0);
7020 } else {
7021 return V;
7022 }
7023 assert(V->getType()->isIntegerTy() && "Unexpected operand type!");
7024 } while (true);
7025}
7026
7027/// This is a wrapper around getUnderlyingObjects and adds support for basic
7028/// ptrtoint+arithmetic+inttoptr sequences.
7029/// It returns false if unidentified object is found in getUnderlyingObjects.
7031 SmallVectorImpl<Value *> &Objects) {
7033 SmallVector<const Value *, 4> Working(1, V);
7034 do {
7035 V = Working.pop_back_val();
7036
7038 getUnderlyingObjects(V, Objs);
7039
7040 for (const Value *V : Objs) {
7041 if (!Visited.insert(V).second)
7042 continue;
7043 if (Operator::getOpcode(V) == Instruction::IntToPtr) {
7044 const Value *O =
7045 getUnderlyingObjectFromInt(cast<User>(V)->getOperand(0));
7046 if (O->getType()->isPointerTy()) {
7047 Working.push_back(O);
7048 continue;
7049 }
7050 }
7051 // If getUnderlyingObjects fails to find an identifiable object,
7052 // getUnderlyingObjectsForCodeGen also fails for safety.
7053 if (!isIdentifiedObject(V)) {
7054 Objects.clear();
7055 return false;
7056 }
7057 Objects.push_back(const_cast<Value *>(V));
7058 }
7059 } while (!Working.empty());
7060 return true;
7061}
7062
7064 AllocaInst *Result = nullptr;
7066 SmallVector<Value *, 4> Worklist;
7067
7068 auto AddWork = [&](Value *V) {
7069 if (Visited.insert(V).second)
7070 Worklist.push_back(V);
7071 };
7072
7073 AddWork(V);
7074 do {
7075 V = Worklist.pop_back_val();
7076 assert(Visited.count(V));
7077
7078 if (AllocaInst *AI = dyn_cast<AllocaInst>(V)) {
7079 if (Result && Result != AI)
7080 return nullptr;
7081 Result = AI;
7082 } else if (CastInst *CI = dyn_cast<CastInst>(V)) {
7083 AddWork(CI->getOperand(0));
7084 } else if (PHINode *PN = dyn_cast<PHINode>(V)) {
7085 for (Value *IncValue : PN->incoming_values())
7086 AddWork(IncValue);
7087 } else if (auto *SI = dyn_cast<SelectInst>(V)) {
7088 AddWork(SI->getTrueValue());
7089 AddWork(SI->getFalseValue());
7091 if (OffsetZero && !GEP->hasAllZeroIndices())
7092 return nullptr;
7093 AddWork(GEP->getPointerOperand());
7094 } else if (CallBase *CB = dyn_cast<CallBase>(V)) {
7095 Value *Returned = CB->getReturnedArgOperand();
7096 if (Returned)
7097 AddWork(Returned);
7098 else
7099 return nullptr;
7100 } else {
7101 return nullptr;
7102 }
7103 } while (!Worklist.empty());
7104
7105 return Result;
7106}
7107
7109 const Value *V, bool AllowLifetime, bool AllowDroppable) {
7110 for (const User *U : V->users()) {
7112 if (!II)
7113 return false;
7114
7115 if (AllowLifetime && II->isLifetimeStartOrEnd())
7116 continue;
7117
7118 if (AllowDroppable && II->isDroppable())
7119 continue;
7120
7121 return false;
7122 }
7123 return true;
7124}
7125
7128 V, /* AllowLifetime */ true, /* AllowDroppable */ false);
7129}
7132 V, /* AllowLifetime */ true, /* AllowDroppable */ true);
7133}
7134
7136 if (auto *II = dyn_cast<IntrinsicInst>(I))
7137 return isTriviallyVectorizable(II->getIntrinsicID());
7138 auto *Shuffle = dyn_cast<ShuffleVectorInst>(I);
7139 return (!Shuffle || Shuffle->isSelect()) &&
7141}
7142
7144 const Instruction *Inst, const Instruction *CtxI, AssumptionCache *AC,
7145 const DominatorTree *DT, const TargetLibraryInfo *TLI, bool UseVariableInfo,
7146 bool IgnoreUBImplyingAttrs) {
7147 return isSafeToSpeculativelyExecuteWithOpcode(Inst->getOpcode(), Inst, CtxI,
7148 AC, DT, TLI, UseVariableInfo,
7149 IgnoreUBImplyingAttrs);
7150}
7151
7153 unsigned Opcode, const Instruction *Inst, const Instruction *CtxI,
7154 AssumptionCache *AC, const DominatorTree *DT, const TargetLibraryInfo *TLI,
7155 bool UseVariableInfo, bool IgnoreUBImplyingAttrs) {
7156#ifndef NDEBUG
7157 if (Inst->getOpcode() != Opcode) {
7158 // Check that the operands are actually compatible with the Opcode override.
7159 auto hasEqualReturnAndLeadingOperandTypes =
7160 [](const Instruction *Inst, unsigned NumLeadingOperands) {
7161 if (Inst->getNumOperands() < NumLeadingOperands)
7162 return false;
7163 const Type *ExpectedType = Inst->getType();
7164 for (unsigned ItOp = 0; ItOp < NumLeadingOperands; ++ItOp)
7165 if (Inst->getOperand(ItOp)->getType() != ExpectedType)
7166 return false;
7167 return true;
7168 };
7170 hasEqualReturnAndLeadingOperandTypes(Inst, 2));
7171 assert(!Instruction::isUnaryOp(Opcode) ||
7172 hasEqualReturnAndLeadingOperandTypes(Inst, 1));
7173 }
7174#endif
7175
7176 switch (Opcode) {
7177 default:
7178 return true;
7179 case Instruction::UDiv:
7180 case Instruction::URem: {
7181 // x / y is undefined if y == 0.
7182 const APInt *V;
7183 if (match(Inst->getOperand(1), m_APInt(V)))
7184 return *V != 0;
7185 return false;
7186 }
7187 case Instruction::SDiv:
7188 case Instruction::SRem: {
7189 // x / y is undefined if y == 0 or x == INT_MIN and y == -1
7190 const APInt *Numerator, *Denominator;
7191 if (!match(Inst->getOperand(1), m_APInt(Denominator)))
7192 return false;
7193 // We cannot hoist this division if the denominator is 0.
7194 if (*Denominator == 0)
7195 return false;
7196 // It's safe to hoist if the denominator is not 0 or -1.
7197 if (!Denominator->isAllOnes())
7198 return true;
7199 // At this point we know that the denominator is -1. It is safe to hoist as
7200 // long we know that the numerator is not INT_MIN.
7201 if (match(Inst->getOperand(0), m_APInt(Numerator)))
7202 return !Numerator->isMinSignedValue();
7203 // The numerator *might* be MinSignedValue.
7204 return false;
7205 }
7206 case Instruction::Load: {
7207 if (!UseVariableInfo)
7208 return false;
7209
7210 const LoadInst *LI = dyn_cast<LoadInst>(Inst);
7211 if (!LI)
7212 return false;
7213 if (mustSuppressSpeculation(*LI))
7214 return false;
7215 const DataLayout &DL = LI->getDataLayout();
7217 LI->getType(), LI->getAlign(), DL,
7218 CtxI, AC, DT, TLI);
7219 }
7220 case Instruction::Call: {
7221 auto *CI = dyn_cast<const CallInst>(Inst);
7222 if (!CI)
7223 return false;
7224 const Function *Callee = CI->getCalledFunction();
7225
7226 // The called function could have undefined behavior or side-effects, even
7227 // if marked readnone nounwind.
7228 if (!Callee || !Callee->isSpeculatable())
7229 return false;
7230 // Since the operands may be changed after hoisting, undefined behavior may
7231 // be triggered by some UB-implying attributes.
7232 return IgnoreUBImplyingAttrs || !CI->hasUBImplyingAttrs();
7233 }
7234 case Instruction::VAArg:
7235 case Instruction::Alloca:
7236 case Instruction::Invoke:
7237 case Instruction::CallBr:
7238 case Instruction::PHI:
7239 case Instruction::Store:
7240 case Instruction::Ret:
7241 case Instruction::Br:
7242 case Instruction::IndirectBr:
7243 case Instruction::Switch:
7244 case Instruction::Unreachable:
7245 case Instruction::Fence:
7246 case Instruction::AtomicRMW:
7247 case Instruction::AtomicCmpXchg:
7248 case Instruction::LandingPad:
7249 case Instruction::Resume:
7250 case Instruction::CatchSwitch:
7251 case Instruction::CatchPad:
7252 case Instruction::CatchRet:
7253 case Instruction::CleanupPad:
7254 case Instruction::CleanupRet:
7255 return false; // Misc instructions which have effects
7256 }
7257}
7258
7260 if (I.mayReadOrWriteMemory())
7261 // Memory dependency possible
7262 return true;
7264 // Can't move above a maythrow call or infinite loop. Or if an
7265 // inalloca alloca, above a stacksave call.
7266 return true;
7268 // 1) Can't reorder two inf-loop calls, even if readonly
7269 // 2) Also can't reorder an inf-loop call below a instruction which isn't
7270 // safe to speculative execute. (Inverse of above)
7271 return true;
7272 return false;
7273}
7274
7275/// Convert ConstantRange OverflowResult into ValueTracking OverflowResult.
7289
7290/// Combine constant ranges from computeConstantRange() and computeKnownBits().
7293 bool ForSigned,
7294 const SimplifyQuery &SQ) {
7295 ConstantRange CR1 =
7296 ConstantRange::fromKnownBits(V.getKnownBits(SQ), ForSigned);
7297 ConstantRange CR2 = computeConstantRange(V, ForSigned, SQ.IIQ.UseInstrInfo);
7300 return CR1.intersectWith(CR2, RangeType);
7301}
7302
7304 const Value *RHS,
7305 const SimplifyQuery &SQ,
7306 bool IsNSW) {
7307 ConstantRange LHSRange =
7308 computeConstantRangeIncludingKnownBits(LHS, /*ForSigned=*/false, SQ);
7309 ConstantRange RHSRange =
7310 computeConstantRangeIncludingKnownBits(RHS, /*ForSigned=*/false, SQ);
7311
7312 // mul nsw of two non-negative numbers is also nuw.
7313 if (IsNSW && LHSRange.isAllNonNegative() && RHSRange.isAllNonNegative())
7315
7316 return mapOverflowResult(LHSRange.unsignedMulMayOverflow(RHSRange));
7317}
7318
7320 const Value *RHS,
7321 const SimplifyQuery &SQ) {
7322 // Multiplying n * m significant bits yields a result of n + m significant
7323 // bits. If the total number of significant bits does not exceed the
7324 // result bit width (minus 1), there is no overflow.
7325 // This means if we have enough leading sign bits in the operands
7326 // we can guarantee that the result does not overflow.
7327 // Ref: "Hacker's Delight" by Henry Warren
7328 unsigned BitWidth = LHS->getType()->getScalarSizeInBits();
7329
7330 // Note that underestimating the number of sign bits gives a more
7331 // conservative answer.
7332 unsigned SignBits =
7333 ::ComputeNumSignBits(LHS, SQ) + ::ComputeNumSignBits(RHS, SQ);
7334
7335 // First handle the easy case: if we have enough sign bits there's
7336 // definitely no overflow.
7337 if (SignBits > BitWidth + 1)
7339
7340 // There are two ambiguous cases where there can be no overflow:
7341 // SignBits == BitWidth + 1 and
7342 // SignBits == BitWidth
7343 // The second case is difficult to check, therefore we only handle the
7344 // first case.
7345 if (SignBits == BitWidth + 1) {
7346 // It overflows only when both arguments are negative and the true
7347 // product is exactly the minimum negative number.
7348 // E.g. mul i16 with 17 sign bits: 0xff00 * 0xff80 = 0x8000
7349 // For simplicity we just check if at least one side is not negative.
7350 KnownBits LHSKnown = computeKnownBits(LHS, SQ);
7351 KnownBits RHSKnown = computeKnownBits(RHS, SQ);
7352 if (LHSKnown.isNonNegative() || RHSKnown.isNonNegative())
7354 }
7356}
7357
7360 const WithCache<const Value *> &RHS,
7361 const SimplifyQuery &SQ) {
7362 ConstantRange LHSRange =
7363 computeConstantRangeIncludingKnownBits(LHS, /*ForSigned=*/false, SQ);
7364 ConstantRange RHSRange =
7365 computeConstantRangeIncludingKnownBits(RHS, /*ForSigned=*/false, SQ);
7366 return mapOverflowResult(LHSRange.unsignedAddMayOverflow(RHSRange));
7367}
7368
7369static OverflowResult
7372 const AddOperator *Add, const SimplifyQuery &SQ) {
7373 if (Add && Add->hasNoSignedWrap()) {
7375 }
7376
7377 // If LHS and RHS each have at least two sign bits, the addition will look
7378 // like
7379 //
7380 // XX..... +
7381 // YY.....
7382 //
7383 // If the carry into the most significant position is 0, X and Y can't both
7384 // be 1 and therefore the carry out of the addition is also 0.
7385 //
7386 // If the carry into the most significant position is 1, X and Y can't both
7387 // be 0 and therefore the carry out of the addition is also 1.
7388 //
7389 // Since the carry into the most significant position is always equal to
7390 // the carry out of the addition, there is no signed overflow.
7391 if (::ComputeNumSignBits(LHS, SQ) > 1 && ::ComputeNumSignBits(RHS, SQ) > 1)
7393
7394 ConstantRange LHSRange =
7395 computeConstantRangeIncludingKnownBits(LHS, /*ForSigned=*/true, SQ);
7396 ConstantRange RHSRange =
7397 computeConstantRangeIncludingKnownBits(RHS, /*ForSigned=*/true, SQ);
7398 OverflowResult OR =
7399 mapOverflowResult(LHSRange.signedAddMayOverflow(RHSRange));
7401 return OR;
7402
7403 // The remaining code needs Add to be available. Early returns if not so.
7404 if (!Add)
7406
7407 // If the sign of Add is the same as at least one of the operands, this add
7408 // CANNOT overflow. If this can be determined from the known bits of the
7409 // operands the above signedAddMayOverflow() check will have already done so.
7410 // The only other way to improve on the known bits is from an assumption, so
7411 // call computeKnownBitsFromContext() directly.
7412 bool LHSOrRHSKnownNonNegative =
7413 (LHSRange.isAllNonNegative() || RHSRange.isAllNonNegative());
7414 bool LHSOrRHSKnownNegative =
7415 (LHSRange.isAllNegative() || RHSRange.isAllNegative());
7416 if (LHSOrRHSKnownNonNegative || LHSOrRHSKnownNegative) {
7417 KnownBits AddKnown(LHSRange.getBitWidth());
7418 computeKnownBitsFromContext(Add, AddKnown, SQ);
7419 if ((AddKnown.isNonNegative() && LHSOrRHSKnownNonNegative) ||
7420 (AddKnown.isNegative() && LHSOrRHSKnownNegative))
7422 }
7423
7425}
7426
7428 const Value *RHS,
7429 const SimplifyQuery &SQ) {
7430 // X - (X % ?)
7431 // The remainder of a value can't have greater magnitude than itself,
7432 // so the subtraction can't overflow.
7433
7434 // X - (X -nuw ?)
7435 // In the minimal case, this would simplify to "?", so there's no subtract
7436 // at all. But if this analysis is used to peek through casts, for example,
7437 // then determining no-overflow may allow other transforms.
7438
7439 // TODO: There are other patterns like this.
7440 // See simplifyICmpWithBinOpOnLHS() for candidates.
7441 if (match(RHS, m_URem(m_Specific(LHS), m_Value())) ||
7442 match(RHS, m_NUWSub(m_Specific(LHS), m_Value())))
7443 if (isGuaranteedNotToBeUndef(LHS, SQ.AC, SQ.CxtI, SQ.DT))
7445
7446 if (auto C = isImpliedByDomCondition(CmpInst::ICMP_UGE, LHS, RHS, SQ.CxtI,
7447 SQ.DL)) {
7448 if (*C)
7451 }
7452
7453 ConstantRange LHSRange =
7454 computeConstantRangeIncludingKnownBits(LHS, /*ForSigned=*/false, SQ);
7455 ConstantRange RHSRange =
7456 computeConstantRangeIncludingKnownBits(RHS, /*ForSigned=*/false, SQ);
7457 return mapOverflowResult(LHSRange.unsignedSubMayOverflow(RHSRange));
7458}
7459
7461 const Value *RHS,
7462 const SimplifyQuery &SQ) {
7463 // X - (X % ?)
7464 // The remainder of a value can't have greater magnitude than itself,
7465 // so the subtraction can't overflow.
7466
7467 // X - (X -nsw ?)
7468 // In the minimal case, this would simplify to "?", so there's no subtract
7469 // at all. But if this analysis is used to peek through casts, for example,
7470 // then determining no-overflow may allow other transforms.
7471 if (match(RHS, m_SRem(m_Specific(LHS), m_Value())) ||
7472 match(RHS, m_NSWSub(m_Specific(LHS), m_Value())))
7473 if (isGuaranteedNotToBeUndef(LHS, SQ.AC, SQ.CxtI, SQ.DT))
7475
7476 // If LHS and RHS each have at least two sign bits, the subtraction
7477 // cannot overflow.
7478 if (::ComputeNumSignBits(LHS, SQ) > 1 && ::ComputeNumSignBits(RHS, SQ) > 1)
7480
7481 ConstantRange LHSRange =
7482 computeConstantRangeIncludingKnownBits(LHS, /*ForSigned=*/true, SQ);
7483 ConstantRange RHSRange =
7484 computeConstantRangeIncludingKnownBits(RHS, /*ForSigned=*/true, SQ);
7485 return mapOverflowResult(LHSRange.signedSubMayOverflow(RHSRange));
7486}
7487
7489 const DominatorTree &DT) {
7490 SmallVector<const BranchInst *, 2> GuardingBranches;
7492
7493 for (const User *U : WO->users()) {
7494 if (const auto *EVI = dyn_cast<ExtractValueInst>(U)) {
7495 assert(EVI->getNumIndices() == 1 && "Obvious from CI's type");
7496
7497 if (EVI->getIndices()[0] == 0)
7498 Results.push_back(EVI);
7499 else {
7500 assert(EVI->getIndices()[0] == 1 && "Obvious from CI's type");
7501
7502 for (const auto *U : EVI->users())
7503 if (const auto *B = dyn_cast<BranchInst>(U)) {
7504 assert(B->isConditional() && "How else is it using an i1?");
7505 GuardingBranches.push_back(B);
7506 }
7507 }
7508 } else {
7509 // We are using the aggregate directly in a way we don't want to analyze
7510 // here (storing it to a global, say).
7511 return false;
7512 }
7513 }
7514
7515 auto AllUsesGuardedByBranch = [&](const BranchInst *BI) {
7516 BasicBlockEdge NoWrapEdge(BI->getParent(), BI->getSuccessor(1));
7517 if (!NoWrapEdge.isSingleEdge())
7518 return false;
7519
7520 // Check if all users of the add are provably no-wrap.
7521 for (const auto *Result : Results) {
7522 // If the extractvalue itself is not executed on overflow, the we don't
7523 // need to check each use separately, since domination is transitive.
7524 if (DT.dominates(NoWrapEdge, Result->getParent()))
7525 continue;
7526
7527 for (const auto &RU : Result->uses())
7528 if (!DT.dominates(NoWrapEdge, RU))
7529 return false;
7530 }
7531
7532 return true;
7533 };
7534
7535 return llvm::any_of(GuardingBranches, AllUsesGuardedByBranch);
7536}
7537
7538/// Shifts return poison if shiftwidth is larger than the bitwidth.
7539static bool shiftAmountKnownInRange(const Value *ShiftAmount) {
7540 auto *C = dyn_cast<Constant>(ShiftAmount);
7541 if (!C)
7542 return false;
7543
7544 // Shifts return poison if shiftwidth is larger than the bitwidth.
7546 if (auto *FVTy = dyn_cast<FixedVectorType>(C->getType())) {
7547 unsigned NumElts = FVTy->getNumElements();
7548 for (unsigned i = 0; i < NumElts; ++i)
7549 ShiftAmounts.push_back(C->getAggregateElement(i));
7550 } else if (isa<ScalableVectorType>(C->getType()))
7551 return false; // Can't tell, just return false to be safe
7552 else
7553 ShiftAmounts.push_back(C);
7554
7555 bool Safe = llvm::all_of(ShiftAmounts, [](const Constant *C) {
7556 auto *CI = dyn_cast_or_null<ConstantInt>(C);
7557 return CI && CI->getValue().ult(C->getType()->getIntegerBitWidth());
7558 });
7559
7560 return Safe;
7561}
7562
7568
7570 return (unsigned(Kind) & unsigned(UndefPoisonKind::PoisonOnly)) != 0;
7571}
7572
7574 return (unsigned(Kind) & unsigned(UndefPoisonKind::UndefOnly)) != 0;
7575}
7576
7578 bool ConsiderFlagsAndMetadata) {
7579
7580 if (ConsiderFlagsAndMetadata && includesPoison(Kind) &&
7581 Op->hasPoisonGeneratingAnnotations())
7582 return true;
7583
7584 unsigned Opcode = Op->getOpcode();
7585
7586 // Check whether opcode is a poison/undef-generating operation
7587 switch (Opcode) {
7588 case Instruction::Shl:
7589 case Instruction::AShr:
7590 case Instruction::LShr:
7591 return includesPoison(Kind) && !shiftAmountKnownInRange(Op->getOperand(1));
7592 case Instruction::FPToSI:
7593 case Instruction::FPToUI:
7594 // fptosi/ui yields poison if the resulting value does not fit in the
7595 // destination type.
7596 return true;
7597 case Instruction::Call:
7598 if (auto *II = dyn_cast<IntrinsicInst>(Op)) {
7599 switch (II->getIntrinsicID()) {
7600 // TODO: Add more intrinsics.
7601 case Intrinsic::ctlz:
7602 case Intrinsic::cttz:
7603 case Intrinsic::abs:
7604 if (cast<ConstantInt>(II->getArgOperand(1))->isNullValue())
7605 return false;
7606 break;
7607 case Intrinsic::sshl_sat:
7608 case Intrinsic::ushl_sat:
7609 if (!includesPoison(Kind) ||
7610 shiftAmountKnownInRange(II->getArgOperand(1)))
7611 return false;
7612 break;
7613 }
7614 }
7615 [[fallthrough]];
7616 case Instruction::CallBr:
7617 case Instruction::Invoke: {
7618 const auto *CB = cast<CallBase>(Op);
7619 return !CB->hasRetAttr(Attribute::NoUndef) &&
7620 !CB->hasFnAttr(Attribute::NoCreateUndefOrPoison);
7621 }
7622 case Instruction::InsertElement:
7623 case Instruction::ExtractElement: {
7624 // If index exceeds the length of the vector, it returns poison
7625 auto *VTy = cast<VectorType>(Op->getOperand(0)->getType());
7626 unsigned IdxOp = Op->getOpcode() == Instruction::InsertElement ? 2 : 1;
7627 auto *Idx = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(Op->getOperand(IdxOp));
7628 if (includesPoison(Kind))
7629 return !Idx ||
7630 Idx->getValue().uge(VTy->getElementCount().getKnownMinValue());
7631 return false;
7632 }
7633 case Instruction::ShuffleVector: {
7635 ? cast<ConstantExpr>(Op)->getShuffleMask()
7636 : cast<ShuffleVectorInst>(Op)->getShuffleMask();
7637 return includesPoison(Kind) && is_contained(Mask, PoisonMaskElem);
7638 }
7639 case Instruction::FNeg:
7640 case Instruction::PHI:
7641 case Instruction::Select:
7642 case Instruction::ExtractValue:
7643 case Instruction::InsertValue:
7644 case Instruction::Freeze:
7645 case Instruction::ICmp:
7646 case Instruction::FCmp:
7647 case Instruction::GetElementPtr:
7648 return false;
7649 case Instruction::AddrSpaceCast:
7650 return true;
7651 default: {
7652 const auto *CE = dyn_cast<ConstantExpr>(Op);
7653 if (isa<CastInst>(Op) || (CE && CE->isCast()))
7654 return false;
7655 else if (Instruction::isBinaryOp(Opcode))
7656 return false;
7657 // Be conservative and return true.
7658 return true;
7659 }
7660 }
7661}
7662
7664 bool ConsiderFlagsAndMetadata) {
7665 return ::canCreateUndefOrPoison(Op, UndefPoisonKind::UndefOrPoison,
7666 ConsiderFlagsAndMetadata);
7667}
7668
7669bool llvm::canCreatePoison(const Operator *Op, bool ConsiderFlagsAndMetadata) {
7670 return ::canCreateUndefOrPoison(Op, UndefPoisonKind::PoisonOnly,
7671 ConsiderFlagsAndMetadata);
7672}
7673
7674static bool directlyImpliesPoison(const Value *ValAssumedPoison, const Value *V,
7675 unsigned Depth) {
7676 if (ValAssumedPoison == V)
7677 return true;
7678
7679 const unsigned MaxDepth = 2;
7680 if (Depth >= MaxDepth)
7681 return false;
7682
7683 if (const auto *I = dyn_cast<Instruction>(V)) {
7684 if (any_of(I->operands(), [=](const Use &Op) {
7685 return propagatesPoison(Op) &&
7686 directlyImpliesPoison(ValAssumedPoison, Op, Depth + 1);
7687 }))
7688 return true;
7689
7690 // V = extractvalue V0, idx
7691 // V2 = extractvalue V0, idx2
7692 // V0's elements are all poison or not. (e.g., add_with_overflow)
7693 const WithOverflowInst *II;
7695 (match(ValAssumedPoison, m_ExtractValue(m_Specific(II))) ||
7696 llvm::is_contained(II->args(), ValAssumedPoison)))
7697 return true;
7698 }
7699 return false;
7700}
7701
7702static bool impliesPoison(const Value *ValAssumedPoison, const Value *V,
7703 unsigned Depth) {
7704 if (isGuaranteedNotToBePoison(ValAssumedPoison))
7705 return true;
7706
7707 if (directlyImpliesPoison(ValAssumedPoison, V, /* Depth */ 0))
7708 return true;
7709
7710 const unsigned MaxDepth = 2;
7711 if (Depth >= MaxDepth)
7712 return false;
7713
7714 const auto *I = dyn_cast<Instruction>(ValAssumedPoison);
7715 if (I && !canCreatePoison(cast<Operator>(I))) {
7716 return all_of(I->operands(), [=](const Value *Op) {
7717 return impliesPoison(Op, V, Depth + 1);
7718 });
7719 }
7720 return false;
7721}
7722
7723bool llvm::impliesPoison(const Value *ValAssumedPoison, const Value *V) {
7724 return ::impliesPoison(ValAssumedPoison, V, /* Depth */ 0);
7725}
7726
7727static bool programUndefinedIfUndefOrPoison(const Value *V, bool PoisonOnly);
7728
7730 const Value *V, AssumptionCache *AC, const Instruction *CtxI,
7731 const DominatorTree *DT, unsigned Depth, UndefPoisonKind Kind) {
7733 return false;
7734
7735 if (isa<MetadataAsValue>(V))
7736 return false;
7737
7738 if (const auto *A = dyn_cast<Argument>(V)) {
7739 if (A->hasAttribute(Attribute::NoUndef) ||
7740 A->hasAttribute(Attribute::Dereferenceable) ||
7741 A->hasAttribute(Attribute::DereferenceableOrNull))
7742 return true;
7743 }
7744
7745 if (auto *C = dyn_cast<Constant>(V)) {
7746 if (isa<PoisonValue>(C))
7747 return !includesPoison(Kind);
7748
7749 if (isa<UndefValue>(C))
7750 return !includesUndef(Kind);
7751
7754 return true;
7755
7756 if (C->getType()->isVectorTy()) {
7757 if (isa<ConstantExpr>(C)) {
7758 // Scalable vectors can use a ConstantExpr to build a splat.
7759 if (Constant *SplatC = C->getSplatValue())
7760 if (isa<ConstantInt>(SplatC) || isa<ConstantFP>(SplatC))
7761 return true;
7762 } else {
7763 if (includesUndef(Kind) && C->containsUndefElement())
7764 return false;
7765 if (includesPoison(Kind) && C->containsPoisonElement())
7766 return false;
7767 return !C->containsConstantExpression();
7768 }
7769 }
7770 }
7771
7772 // Strip cast operations from a pointer value.
7773 // Note that stripPointerCastsSameRepresentation can strip off getelementptr
7774 // inbounds with zero offset. To guarantee that the result isn't poison, the
7775 // stripped pointer is checked as it has to be pointing into an allocated
7776 // object or be null `null` to ensure `inbounds` getelement pointers with a
7777 // zero offset could not produce poison.
7778 // It can strip off addrspacecast that do not change bit representation as
7779 // well. We believe that such addrspacecast is equivalent to no-op.
7780 auto *StrippedV = V->stripPointerCastsSameRepresentation();
7781 if (isa<AllocaInst>(StrippedV) || isa<GlobalVariable>(StrippedV) ||
7782 isa<Function>(StrippedV) || isa<ConstantPointerNull>(StrippedV))
7783 return true;
7784
7785 auto OpCheck = [&](const Value *V) {
7786 return isGuaranteedNotToBeUndefOrPoison(V, AC, CtxI, DT, Depth + 1, Kind);
7787 };
7788
7789 if (auto *Opr = dyn_cast<Operator>(V)) {
7790 // If the value is a freeze instruction, then it can never
7791 // be undef or poison.
7792 if (isa<FreezeInst>(V))
7793 return true;
7794
7795 if (const auto *CB = dyn_cast<CallBase>(V)) {
7796 if (CB->hasRetAttr(Attribute::NoUndef) ||
7797 CB->hasRetAttr(Attribute::Dereferenceable) ||
7798 CB->hasRetAttr(Attribute::DereferenceableOrNull))
7799 return true;
7800 }
7801
7802 if (!::canCreateUndefOrPoison(Opr, Kind,
7803 /*ConsiderFlagsAndMetadata=*/true)) {
7804 if (const auto *PN = dyn_cast<PHINode>(V)) {
7805 unsigned Num = PN->getNumIncomingValues();
7806 bool IsWellDefined = true;
7807 for (unsigned i = 0; i < Num; ++i) {
7808 if (PN == PN->getIncomingValue(i))
7809 continue;
7810 auto *TI = PN->getIncomingBlock(i)->getTerminator();
7811 if (!isGuaranteedNotToBeUndefOrPoison(PN->getIncomingValue(i), AC, TI,
7812 DT, Depth + 1, Kind)) {
7813 IsWellDefined = false;
7814 break;
7815 }
7816 }
7817 if (IsWellDefined)
7818 return true;
7819 } else if (auto *Splat = isa<ShuffleVectorInst>(Opr) ? getSplatValue(Opr)
7820 : nullptr) {
7821 // For splats we only need to check the value being splatted.
7822 if (OpCheck(Splat))
7823 return true;
7824 } else if (all_of(Opr->operands(), OpCheck))
7825 return true;
7826 }
7827 }
7828
7829 if (auto *I = dyn_cast<LoadInst>(V))
7830 if (I->hasMetadata(LLVMContext::MD_noundef) ||
7831 I->hasMetadata(LLVMContext::MD_dereferenceable) ||
7832 I->hasMetadata(LLVMContext::MD_dereferenceable_or_null))
7833 return true;
7834
7836 return true;
7837
7838 // CxtI may be null or a cloned instruction.
7839 if (!CtxI || !CtxI->getParent() || !DT)
7840 return false;
7841
7842 auto *DNode = DT->getNode(CtxI->getParent());
7843 if (!DNode)
7844 // Unreachable block
7845 return false;
7846
7847 // If V is used as a branch condition before reaching CtxI, V cannot be
7848 // undef or poison.
7849 // br V, BB1, BB2
7850 // BB1:
7851 // CtxI ; V cannot be undef or poison here
7852 auto *Dominator = DNode->getIDom();
7853 // This check is purely for compile time reasons: we can skip the IDom walk
7854 // if what we are checking for includes undef and the value is not an integer.
7855 if (!includesUndef(Kind) || V->getType()->isIntegerTy())
7856 while (Dominator) {
7857 auto *TI = Dominator->getBlock()->getTerminator();
7858
7859 Value *Cond = nullptr;
7860 if (auto BI = dyn_cast_or_null<BranchInst>(TI)) {
7861 if (BI->isConditional())
7862 Cond = BI->getCondition();
7863 } else if (auto SI = dyn_cast_or_null<SwitchInst>(TI)) {
7864 Cond = SI->getCondition();
7865 }
7866
7867 if (Cond) {
7868 if (Cond == V)
7869 return true;
7870 else if (!includesUndef(Kind) && isa<Operator>(Cond)) {
7871 // For poison, we can analyze further
7872 auto *Opr = cast<Operator>(Cond);
7873 if (any_of(Opr->operands(), [V](const Use &U) {
7874 return V == U && propagatesPoison(U);
7875 }))
7876 return true;
7877 }
7878 }
7879
7880 Dominator = Dominator->getIDom();
7881 }
7882
7883 if (AC && getKnowledgeValidInContext(V, {Attribute::NoUndef}, *AC, CtxI, DT))
7884 return true;
7885
7886 return false;
7887}
7888
7890 const Instruction *CtxI,
7891 const DominatorTree *DT,
7892 unsigned Depth) {
7893 return ::isGuaranteedNotToBeUndefOrPoison(V, AC, CtxI, DT, Depth,
7895}
7896
7898 const Instruction *CtxI,
7899 const DominatorTree *DT, unsigned Depth) {
7900 return ::isGuaranteedNotToBeUndefOrPoison(V, AC, CtxI, DT, Depth,
7902}
7903
7905 const Instruction *CtxI,
7906 const DominatorTree *DT, unsigned Depth) {
7907 return ::isGuaranteedNotToBeUndefOrPoison(V, AC, CtxI, DT, Depth,
7909}
7910
7911/// Return true if undefined behavior would provably be executed on the path to
7912/// OnPathTo if Root produced a posion result. Note that this doesn't say
7913/// anything about whether OnPathTo is actually executed or whether Root is
7914/// actually poison. This can be used to assess whether a new use of Root can
7915/// be added at a location which is control equivalent with OnPathTo (such as
7916/// immediately before it) without introducing UB which didn't previously
7917/// exist. Note that a false result conveys no information.
7919 Instruction *OnPathTo,
7920 DominatorTree *DT) {
7921 // Basic approach is to assume Root is poison, propagate poison forward
7922 // through all users we can easily track, and then check whether any of those
7923 // users are provable UB and must execute before out exiting block might
7924 // exit.
7925
7926 // The set of all recursive users we've visited (which are assumed to all be
7927 // poison because of said visit)
7930 Worklist.push_back(Root);
7931 while (!Worklist.empty()) {
7932 const Instruction *I = Worklist.pop_back_val();
7933
7934 // If we know this must trigger UB on a path leading our target.
7935 if (mustTriggerUB(I, KnownPoison) && DT->dominates(I, OnPathTo))
7936 return true;
7937
7938 // If we can't analyze propagation through this instruction, just skip it
7939 // and transitive users. Safe as false is a conservative result.
7940 if (I != Root && !any_of(I->operands(), [&KnownPoison](const Use &U) {
7941 return KnownPoison.contains(U) && propagatesPoison(U);
7942 }))
7943 continue;
7944
7945 if (KnownPoison.insert(I).second)
7946 for (const User *User : I->users())
7947 Worklist.push_back(cast<Instruction>(User));
7948 }
7949
7950 // Might be non-UB, or might have a path we couldn't prove must execute on
7951 // way to exiting bb.
7952 return false;
7953}
7954
7956 const SimplifyQuery &SQ) {
7957 return ::computeOverflowForSignedAdd(Add->getOperand(0), Add->getOperand(1),
7958 Add, SQ);
7959}
7960
7963 const WithCache<const Value *> &RHS,
7964 const SimplifyQuery &SQ) {
7965 return ::computeOverflowForSignedAdd(LHS, RHS, nullptr, SQ);
7966}
7967
7969 // Note: An atomic operation isn't guaranteed to return in a reasonable amount
7970 // of time because it's possible for another thread to interfere with it for an
7971 // arbitrary length of time, but programs aren't allowed to rely on that.
7972
7973 // If there is no successor, then execution can't transfer to it.
7974 if (isa<ReturnInst>(I))
7975 return false;
7977 return false;
7978
7979 // Note: Do not add new checks here; instead, change Instruction::mayThrow or
7980 // Instruction::willReturn.
7981 //
7982 // FIXME: Move this check into Instruction::willReturn.
7983 if (isa<CatchPadInst>(I)) {
7984 switch (classifyEHPersonality(I->getFunction()->getPersonalityFn())) {
7985 default:
7986 // A catchpad may invoke exception object constructors and such, which
7987 // in some languages can be arbitrary code, so be conservative by default.
7988 return false;
7990 // For CoreCLR, it just involves a type test.
7991 return true;
7992 }
7993 }
7994
7995 // An instruction that returns without throwing must transfer control flow
7996 // to a successor.
7997 return !I->mayThrow() && I->willReturn();
7998}
7999
8001 // TODO: This is slightly conservative for invoke instruction since exiting
8002 // via an exception *is* normal control for them.
8003 for (const Instruction &I : *BB)
8005 return false;
8006 return true;
8007}
8008
8015
8018 assert(ScanLimit && "scan limit must be non-zero");
8019 for (const Instruction &I : Range) {
8020 if (--ScanLimit == 0)
8021 return false;
8023 return false;
8024 }
8025 return true;
8026}
8027
8029 const Loop *L) {
8030 // The loop header is guaranteed to be executed for every iteration.
8031 //
8032 // FIXME: Relax this constraint to cover all basic blocks that are
8033 // guaranteed to be executed at every iteration.
8034 if (I->getParent() != L->getHeader()) return false;
8035
8036 for (const Instruction &LI : *L->getHeader()) {
8037 if (&LI == I) return true;
8038 if (!isGuaranteedToTransferExecutionToSuccessor(&LI)) return false;
8039 }
8040 llvm_unreachable("Instruction not contained in its own parent basic block.");
8041}
8042
8044 switch (IID) {
8045 // TODO: Add more intrinsics.
8046 case Intrinsic::sadd_with_overflow:
8047 case Intrinsic::ssub_with_overflow:
8048 case Intrinsic::smul_with_overflow:
8049 case Intrinsic::uadd_with_overflow:
8050 case Intrinsic::usub_with_overflow:
8051 case Intrinsic::umul_with_overflow:
8052 // If an input is a vector containing a poison element, the
8053 // two output vectors (calculated results, overflow bits)'
8054 // corresponding lanes are poison.
8055 return true;
8056 case Intrinsic::ctpop:
8057 case Intrinsic::ctlz:
8058 case Intrinsic::cttz:
8059 case Intrinsic::abs:
8060 case Intrinsic::smax:
8061 case Intrinsic::smin:
8062 case Intrinsic::umax:
8063 case Intrinsic::umin:
8064 case Intrinsic::scmp:
8065 case Intrinsic::is_fpclass:
8066 case Intrinsic::ptrmask:
8067 case Intrinsic::ucmp:
8068 case Intrinsic::bitreverse:
8069 case Intrinsic::bswap:
8070 case Intrinsic::sadd_sat:
8071 case Intrinsic::ssub_sat:
8072 case Intrinsic::sshl_sat:
8073 case Intrinsic::uadd_sat:
8074 case Intrinsic::usub_sat:
8075 case Intrinsic::ushl_sat:
8076 case Intrinsic::smul_fix:
8077 case Intrinsic::smul_fix_sat:
8078 case Intrinsic::umul_fix:
8079 case Intrinsic::umul_fix_sat:
8080 case Intrinsic::pow:
8081 case Intrinsic::powi:
8082 case Intrinsic::sin:
8083 case Intrinsic::sinh:
8084 case Intrinsic::cos:
8085 case Intrinsic::cosh:
8086 case Intrinsic::sincos:
8087 case Intrinsic::sincospi:
8088 case Intrinsic::tan:
8089 case Intrinsic::tanh:
8090 case Intrinsic::asin:
8091 case Intrinsic::acos:
8092 case Intrinsic::atan:
8093 case Intrinsic::atan2:
8094 case Intrinsic::canonicalize:
8095 case Intrinsic::sqrt:
8096 case Intrinsic::exp:
8097 case Intrinsic::exp2:
8098 case Intrinsic::exp10:
8099 case Intrinsic::log:
8100 case Intrinsic::log2:
8101 case Intrinsic::log10:
8102 case Intrinsic::modf:
8103 case Intrinsic::floor:
8104 case Intrinsic::ceil:
8105 case Intrinsic::trunc:
8106 case Intrinsic::rint:
8107 case Intrinsic::nearbyint:
8108 case Intrinsic::round:
8109 case Intrinsic::roundeven:
8110 case Intrinsic::lrint:
8111 case Intrinsic::llrint:
8112 return true;
8113 default:
8114 return false;
8115 }
8116}
8117
8118bool llvm::propagatesPoison(const Use &PoisonOp) {
8119 const Operator *I = cast<Operator>(PoisonOp.getUser());
8120 switch (I->getOpcode()) {
8121 case Instruction::Freeze:
8122 case Instruction::PHI:
8123 case Instruction::Invoke:
8124 return false;
8125 case Instruction::Select:
8126 return PoisonOp.getOperandNo() == 0;
8127 case Instruction::Call:
8128 if (auto *II = dyn_cast<IntrinsicInst>(I))
8129 return intrinsicPropagatesPoison(II->getIntrinsicID());
8130 return false;
8131 case Instruction::ICmp:
8132 case Instruction::FCmp:
8133 case Instruction::GetElementPtr:
8134 return true;
8135 default:
8137 return true;
8138
8139 // Be conservative and return false.
8140 return false;
8141 }
8142}
8143
8144/// Enumerates all operands of \p I that are guaranteed to not be undef or
8145/// poison. If the callback \p Handle returns true, stop processing and return
8146/// true. Otherwise, return false.
8147template <typename CallableT>
8149 const CallableT &Handle) {
8150 switch (I->getOpcode()) {
8151 case Instruction::Store:
8152 if (Handle(cast<StoreInst>(I)->getPointerOperand()))
8153 return true;
8154 break;
8155
8156 case Instruction::Load:
8157 if (Handle(cast<LoadInst>(I)->getPointerOperand()))
8158 return true;
8159 break;
8160
8161 // Since dereferenceable attribute imply noundef, atomic operations
8162 // also implicitly have noundef pointers too
8163 case Instruction::AtomicCmpXchg:
8165 return true;
8166 break;
8167
8168 case Instruction::AtomicRMW:
8169 if (Handle(cast<AtomicRMWInst>(I)->getPointerOperand()))
8170 return true;
8171 break;
8172
8173 case Instruction::Call:
8174 case Instruction::Invoke: {
8175 const CallBase *CB = cast<CallBase>(I);
8176 if (CB->isIndirectCall() && Handle(CB->getCalledOperand()))
8177 return true;
8178 for (unsigned i = 0; i < CB->arg_size(); ++i)
8179 if ((CB->paramHasAttr(i, Attribute::NoUndef) ||
8180 CB->paramHasAttr(i, Attribute::Dereferenceable) ||
8181 CB->paramHasAttr(i, Attribute::DereferenceableOrNull)) &&
8182 Handle(CB->getArgOperand(i)))
8183 return true;
8184 break;
8185 }
8186 case Instruction::Ret:
8187 if (I->getFunction()->hasRetAttribute(Attribute::NoUndef) &&
8188 Handle(I->getOperand(0)))
8189 return true;
8190 break;
8191 case Instruction::Switch:
8192 if (Handle(cast<SwitchInst>(I)->getCondition()))
8193 return true;
8194 break;
8195 case Instruction::Br: {
8196 auto *BR = cast<BranchInst>(I);
8197 if (BR->isConditional() && Handle(BR->getCondition()))
8198 return true;
8199 break;
8200 }
8201 default:
8202 break;
8203 }
8204
8205 return false;
8206}
8207
8208/// Enumerates all operands of \p I that are guaranteed to not be poison.
8209template <typename CallableT>
8211 const CallableT &Handle) {
8212 if (handleGuaranteedWellDefinedOps(I, Handle))
8213 return true;
8214 switch (I->getOpcode()) {
8215 // Divisors of these operations are allowed to be partially undef.
8216 case Instruction::UDiv:
8217 case Instruction::SDiv:
8218 case Instruction::URem:
8219 case Instruction::SRem:
8220 return Handle(I->getOperand(1));
8221 default:
8222 return false;
8223 }
8224}
8225
8227 const SmallPtrSetImpl<const Value *> &KnownPoison) {
8229 I, [&](const Value *V) { return KnownPoison.count(V); });
8230}
8231
8233 bool PoisonOnly) {
8234 // We currently only look for uses of values within the same basic
8235 // block, as that makes it easier to guarantee that the uses will be
8236 // executed given that Inst is executed.
8237 //
8238 // FIXME: Expand this to consider uses beyond the same basic block. To do
8239 // this, look out for the distinction between post-dominance and strong
8240 // post-dominance.
8241 const BasicBlock *BB = nullptr;
8243 if (const auto *Inst = dyn_cast<Instruction>(V)) {
8244 BB = Inst->getParent();
8245 Begin = Inst->getIterator();
8246 Begin++;
8247 } else if (const auto *Arg = dyn_cast<Argument>(V)) {
8248 if (Arg->getParent()->isDeclaration())
8249 return false;
8250 BB = &Arg->getParent()->getEntryBlock();
8251 Begin = BB->begin();
8252 } else {
8253 return false;
8254 }
8255
8256 // Limit number of instructions we look at, to avoid scanning through large
8257 // blocks. The current limit is chosen arbitrarily.
8258 unsigned ScanLimit = 32;
8259 BasicBlock::const_iterator End = BB->end();
8260
8261 if (!PoisonOnly) {
8262 // Since undef does not propagate eagerly, be conservative & just check
8263 // whether a value is directly passed to an instruction that must take
8264 // well-defined operands.
8265
8266 for (const auto &I : make_range(Begin, End)) {
8267 if (--ScanLimit == 0)
8268 break;
8269
8270 if (handleGuaranteedWellDefinedOps(&I, [V](const Value *WellDefinedOp) {
8271 return WellDefinedOp == V;
8272 }))
8273 return true;
8274
8276 break;
8277 }
8278 return false;
8279 }
8280
8281 // Set of instructions that we have proved will yield poison if Inst
8282 // does.
8283 SmallPtrSet<const Value *, 16> YieldsPoison;
8285
8286 YieldsPoison.insert(V);
8287 Visited.insert(BB);
8288
8289 while (true) {
8290 for (const auto &I : make_range(Begin, End)) {
8291 if (--ScanLimit == 0)
8292 return false;
8293 if (mustTriggerUB(&I, YieldsPoison))
8294 return true;
8296 return false;
8297
8298 // If an operand is poison and propagates it, mark I as yielding poison.
8299 for (const Use &Op : I.operands()) {
8300 if (YieldsPoison.count(Op) && propagatesPoison(Op)) {
8301 YieldsPoison.insert(&I);
8302 break;
8303 }
8304 }
8305
8306 // Special handling for select, which returns poison if its operand 0 is
8307 // poison (handled in the loop above) *or* if both its true/false operands
8308 // are poison (handled here).
8309 if (I.getOpcode() == Instruction::Select &&
8310 YieldsPoison.count(I.getOperand(1)) &&
8311 YieldsPoison.count(I.getOperand(2))) {
8312 YieldsPoison.insert(&I);
8313 }
8314 }
8315
8316 BB = BB->getSingleSuccessor();
8317 if (!BB || !Visited.insert(BB).second)
8318 break;
8319
8320 Begin = BB->getFirstNonPHIIt();
8321 End = BB->end();
8322 }
8323 return false;
8324}
8325
8327 return ::programUndefinedIfUndefOrPoison(Inst, false);
8328}
8329
8331 return ::programUndefinedIfUndefOrPoison(Inst, true);
8332}
8333
8334static bool isKnownNonNaN(const Value *V, FastMathFlags FMF) {
8335 if (FMF.noNaNs())
8336 return true;
8337
8338 if (auto *C = dyn_cast<ConstantFP>(V))
8339 return !C->isNaN();
8340
8341 if (auto *C = dyn_cast<ConstantDataVector>(V)) {
8342 if (!C->getElementType()->isFloatingPointTy())
8343 return false;
8344 for (unsigned I = 0, E = C->getNumElements(); I < E; ++I) {
8345 if (C->getElementAsAPFloat(I).isNaN())
8346 return false;
8347 }
8348 return true;
8349 }
8350
8352 return true;
8353
8354 return false;
8355}
8356
8357static bool isKnownNonZero(const Value *V) {
8358 if (auto *C = dyn_cast<ConstantFP>(V))
8359 return !C->isZero();
8360
8361 if (auto *C = dyn_cast<ConstantDataVector>(V)) {
8362 if (!C->getElementType()->isFloatingPointTy())
8363 return false;
8364 for (unsigned I = 0, E = C->getNumElements(); I < E; ++I) {
8365 if (C->getElementAsAPFloat(I).isZero())
8366 return false;
8367 }
8368 return true;
8369 }
8370
8371 return false;
8372}
8373
8374/// Match clamp pattern for float types without care about NaNs or signed zeros.
8375/// Given non-min/max outer cmp/select from the clamp pattern this
8376/// function recognizes if it can be substitued by a "canonical" min/max
8377/// pattern.
8379 Value *CmpLHS, Value *CmpRHS,
8380 Value *TrueVal, Value *FalseVal,
8381 Value *&LHS, Value *&RHS) {
8382 // Try to match
8383 // X < C1 ? C1 : Min(X, C2) --> Max(C1, Min(X, C2))
8384 // X > C1 ? C1 : Max(X, C2) --> Min(C1, Max(X, C2))
8385 // and return description of the outer Max/Min.
8386
8387 // First, check if select has inverse order:
8388 if (CmpRHS == FalseVal) {
8389 std::swap(TrueVal, FalseVal);
8390 Pred = CmpInst::getInversePredicate(Pred);
8391 }
8392
8393 // Assume success now. If there's no match, callers should not use these anyway.
8394 LHS = TrueVal;
8395 RHS = FalseVal;
8396
8397 const APFloat *FC1;
8398 if (CmpRHS != TrueVal || !match(CmpRHS, m_APFloat(FC1)) || !FC1->isFinite())
8399 return {SPF_UNKNOWN, SPNB_NA, false};
8400
8401 const APFloat *FC2;
8402 switch (Pred) {
8403 case CmpInst::FCMP_OLT:
8404 case CmpInst::FCMP_OLE:
8405 case CmpInst::FCMP_ULT:
8406 case CmpInst::FCMP_ULE:
8407 if (match(FalseVal, m_OrdOrUnordFMin(m_Specific(CmpLHS), m_APFloat(FC2))) &&
8408 *FC1 < *FC2)
8409 return {SPF_FMAXNUM, SPNB_RETURNS_ANY, false};
8410 break;
8411 case CmpInst::FCMP_OGT:
8412 case CmpInst::FCMP_OGE:
8413 case CmpInst::FCMP_UGT:
8414 case CmpInst::FCMP_UGE:
8415 if (match(FalseVal, m_OrdOrUnordFMax(m_Specific(CmpLHS), m_APFloat(FC2))) &&
8416 *FC1 > *FC2)
8417 return {SPF_FMINNUM, SPNB_RETURNS_ANY, false};
8418 break;
8419 default:
8420 break;
8421 }
8422
8423 return {SPF_UNKNOWN, SPNB_NA, false};
8424}
8425
8426/// Recognize variations of:
8427/// CLAMP(v,l,h) ==> ((v) < (l) ? (l) : ((v) > (h) ? (h) : (v)))
8429 Value *CmpLHS, Value *CmpRHS,
8430 Value *TrueVal, Value *FalseVal) {
8431 // Swap the select operands and predicate to match the patterns below.
8432 if (CmpRHS != TrueVal) {
8433 Pred = ICmpInst::getSwappedPredicate(Pred);
8434 std::swap(TrueVal, FalseVal);
8435 }
8436 const APInt *C1;
8437 if (CmpRHS == TrueVal && match(CmpRHS, m_APInt(C1))) {
8438 const APInt *C2;
8439 // (X <s C1) ? C1 : SMIN(X, C2) ==> SMAX(SMIN(X, C2), C1)
8440 if (match(FalseVal, m_SMin(m_Specific(CmpLHS), m_APInt(C2))) &&
8441 C1->slt(*C2) && Pred == CmpInst::ICMP_SLT)
8442 return {SPF_SMAX, SPNB_NA, false};
8443
8444 // (X >s C1) ? C1 : SMAX(X, C2) ==> SMIN(SMAX(X, C2), C1)
8445 if (match(FalseVal, m_SMax(m_Specific(CmpLHS), m_APInt(C2))) &&
8446 C1->sgt(*C2) && Pred == CmpInst::ICMP_SGT)
8447 return {SPF_SMIN, SPNB_NA, false};
8448
8449 // (X <u C1) ? C1 : UMIN(X, C2) ==> UMAX(UMIN(X, C2), C1)
8450 if (match(FalseVal, m_UMin(m_Specific(CmpLHS), m_APInt(C2))) &&
8451 C1->ult(*C2) && Pred == CmpInst::ICMP_ULT)
8452 return {SPF_UMAX, SPNB_NA, false};
8453
8454 // (X >u C1) ? C1 : UMAX(X, C2) ==> UMIN(UMAX(X, C2), C1)
8455 if (match(FalseVal, m_UMax(m_Specific(CmpLHS), m_APInt(C2))) &&
8456 C1->ugt(*C2) && Pred == CmpInst::ICMP_UGT)
8457 return {SPF_UMIN, SPNB_NA, false};
8458 }
8459 return {SPF_UNKNOWN, SPNB_NA, false};
8460}
8461
8462/// Recognize variations of:
8463/// a < c ? min(a,b) : min(b,c) ==> min(min(a,b),min(b,c))
8465 Value *CmpLHS, Value *CmpRHS,
8466 Value *TVal, Value *FVal,
8467 unsigned Depth) {
8468 // TODO: Allow FP min/max with nnan/nsz.
8469 assert(CmpInst::isIntPredicate(Pred) && "Expected integer comparison");
8470
8471 Value *A = nullptr, *B = nullptr;
8472 SelectPatternResult L = matchSelectPattern(TVal, A, B, nullptr, Depth + 1);
8473 if (!SelectPatternResult::isMinOrMax(L.Flavor))
8474 return {SPF_UNKNOWN, SPNB_NA, false};
8475
8476 Value *C = nullptr, *D = nullptr;
8477 SelectPatternResult R = matchSelectPattern(FVal, C, D, nullptr, Depth + 1);
8478 if (L.Flavor != R.Flavor)
8479 return {SPF_UNKNOWN, SPNB_NA, false};
8480
8481 // We have something like: x Pred y ? min(a, b) : min(c, d).
8482 // Try to match the compare to the min/max operations of the select operands.
8483 // First, make sure we have the right compare predicate.
8484 switch (L.Flavor) {
8485 case SPF_SMIN:
8486 if (Pred == ICmpInst::ICMP_SGT || Pred == ICmpInst::ICMP_SGE) {
8487 Pred = ICmpInst::getSwappedPredicate(Pred);
8488 std::swap(CmpLHS, CmpRHS);
8489 }
8490 if (Pred == ICmpInst::ICMP_SLT || Pred == ICmpInst::ICMP_SLE)
8491 break;
8492 return {SPF_UNKNOWN, SPNB_NA, false};
8493 case SPF_SMAX:
8494 if (Pred == ICmpInst::ICMP_SLT || Pred == ICmpInst::ICMP_SLE) {
8495 Pred = ICmpInst::getSwappedPredicate(Pred);
8496 std::swap(CmpLHS, CmpRHS);
8497 }
8498 if (Pred == ICmpInst::ICMP_SGT || Pred == ICmpInst::ICMP_SGE)
8499 break;
8500 return {SPF_UNKNOWN, SPNB_NA, false};
8501 case SPF_UMIN:
8502 if (Pred == ICmpInst::ICMP_UGT || Pred == ICmpInst::ICMP_UGE) {
8503 Pred = ICmpInst::getSwappedPredicate(Pred);
8504 std::swap(CmpLHS, CmpRHS);
8505 }
8506 if (Pred == ICmpInst::ICMP_ULT || Pred == ICmpInst::ICMP_ULE)
8507 break;
8508 return {SPF_UNKNOWN, SPNB_NA, false};
8509 case SPF_UMAX:
8510 if (Pred == ICmpInst::ICMP_ULT || Pred == ICmpInst::ICMP_ULE) {
8511 Pred = ICmpInst::getSwappedPredicate(Pred);
8512 std::swap(CmpLHS, CmpRHS);
8513 }
8514 if (Pred == ICmpInst::ICMP_UGT || Pred == ICmpInst::ICMP_UGE)
8515 break;
8516 return {SPF_UNKNOWN, SPNB_NA, false};
8517 default:
8518 return {SPF_UNKNOWN, SPNB_NA, false};
8519 }
8520
8521 // If there is a common operand in the already matched min/max and the other
8522 // min/max operands match the compare operands (either directly or inverted),
8523 // then this is min/max of the same flavor.
8524
8525 // a pred c ? m(a, b) : m(c, b) --> m(m(a, b), m(c, b))
8526 // ~c pred ~a ? m(a, b) : m(c, b) --> m(m(a, b), m(c, b))
8527 if (D == B) {
8528 if ((CmpLHS == A && CmpRHS == C) || (match(C, m_Not(m_Specific(CmpLHS))) &&
8529 match(A, m_Not(m_Specific(CmpRHS)))))
8530 return {L.Flavor, SPNB_NA, false};
8531 }
8532 // a pred d ? m(a, b) : m(b, d) --> m(m(a, b), m(b, d))
8533 // ~d pred ~a ? m(a, b) : m(b, d) --> m(m(a, b), m(b, d))
8534 if (C == B) {
8535 if ((CmpLHS == A && CmpRHS == D) || (match(D, m_Not(m_Specific(CmpLHS))) &&
8536 match(A, m_Not(m_Specific(CmpRHS)))))
8537 return {L.Flavor, SPNB_NA, false};
8538 }
8539 // b pred c ? m(a, b) : m(c, a) --> m(m(a, b), m(c, a))
8540 // ~c pred ~b ? m(a, b) : m(c, a) --> m(m(a, b), m(c, a))
8541 if (D == A) {
8542 if ((CmpLHS == B && CmpRHS == C) || (match(C, m_Not(m_Specific(CmpLHS))) &&
8543 match(B, m_Not(m_Specific(CmpRHS)))))
8544 return {L.Flavor, SPNB_NA, false};
8545 }
8546 // b pred d ? m(a, b) : m(a, d) --> m(m(a, b), m(a, d))
8547 // ~d pred ~b ? m(a, b) : m(a, d) --> m(m(a, b), m(a, d))
8548 if (C == A) {
8549 if ((CmpLHS == B && CmpRHS == D) || (match(D, m_Not(m_Specific(CmpLHS))) &&
8550 match(B, m_Not(m_Specific(CmpRHS)))))
8551 return {L.Flavor, SPNB_NA, false};
8552 }
8553
8554 return {SPF_UNKNOWN, SPNB_NA, false};
8555}
8556
8557/// If the input value is the result of a 'not' op, constant integer, or vector
8558/// splat of a constant integer, return the bitwise-not source value.
8559/// TODO: This could be extended to handle non-splat vector integer constants.
8561 Value *NotV;
8562 if (match(V, m_Not(m_Value(NotV))))
8563 return NotV;
8564
8565 const APInt *C;
8566 if (match(V, m_APInt(C)))
8567 return ConstantInt::get(V->getType(), ~(*C));
8568
8569 return nullptr;
8570}
8571
8572/// Match non-obvious integer minimum and maximum sequences.
8574 Value *CmpLHS, Value *CmpRHS,
8575 Value *TrueVal, Value *FalseVal,
8576 Value *&LHS, Value *&RHS,
8577 unsigned Depth) {
8578 // Assume success. If there's no match, callers should not use these anyway.
8579 LHS = TrueVal;
8580 RHS = FalseVal;
8581
8582 SelectPatternResult SPR = matchClamp(Pred, CmpLHS, CmpRHS, TrueVal, FalseVal);
8584 return SPR;
8585
8586 SPR = matchMinMaxOfMinMax(Pred, CmpLHS, CmpRHS, TrueVal, FalseVal, Depth);
8588 return SPR;
8589
8590 // Look through 'not' ops to find disguised min/max.
8591 // (X > Y) ? ~X : ~Y ==> (~X < ~Y) ? ~X : ~Y ==> MIN(~X, ~Y)
8592 // (X < Y) ? ~X : ~Y ==> (~X > ~Y) ? ~X : ~Y ==> MAX(~X, ~Y)
8593 if (CmpLHS == getNotValue(TrueVal) && CmpRHS == getNotValue(FalseVal)) {
8594 switch (Pred) {
8595 case CmpInst::ICMP_SGT: return {SPF_SMIN, SPNB_NA, false};
8596 case CmpInst::ICMP_SLT: return {SPF_SMAX, SPNB_NA, false};
8597 case CmpInst::ICMP_UGT: return {SPF_UMIN, SPNB_NA, false};
8598 case CmpInst::ICMP_ULT: return {SPF_UMAX, SPNB_NA, false};
8599 default: break;
8600 }
8601 }
8602
8603 // (X > Y) ? ~Y : ~X ==> (~X < ~Y) ? ~Y : ~X ==> MAX(~Y, ~X)
8604 // (X < Y) ? ~Y : ~X ==> (~X > ~Y) ? ~Y : ~X ==> MIN(~Y, ~X)
8605 if (CmpLHS == getNotValue(FalseVal) && CmpRHS == getNotValue(TrueVal)) {
8606 switch (Pred) {
8607 case CmpInst::ICMP_SGT: return {SPF_SMAX, SPNB_NA, false};
8608 case CmpInst::ICMP_SLT: return {SPF_SMIN, SPNB_NA, false};
8609 case CmpInst::ICMP_UGT: return {SPF_UMAX, SPNB_NA, false};
8610 case CmpInst::ICMP_ULT: return {SPF_UMIN, SPNB_NA, false};
8611 default: break;
8612 }
8613 }
8614
8615 if (Pred != CmpInst::ICMP_SGT && Pred != CmpInst::ICMP_SLT)
8616 return {SPF_UNKNOWN, SPNB_NA, false};
8617
8618 const APInt *C1;
8619 if (!match(CmpRHS, m_APInt(C1)))
8620 return {SPF_UNKNOWN, SPNB_NA, false};
8621
8622 // An unsigned min/max can be written with a signed compare.
8623 const APInt *C2;
8624 if ((CmpLHS == TrueVal && match(FalseVal, m_APInt(C2))) ||
8625 (CmpLHS == FalseVal && match(TrueVal, m_APInt(C2)))) {
8626 // Is the sign bit set?
8627 // (X <s 0) ? X : MAXVAL ==> (X >u MAXVAL) ? X : MAXVAL ==> UMAX
8628 // (X <s 0) ? MAXVAL : X ==> (X >u MAXVAL) ? MAXVAL : X ==> UMIN
8629 if (Pred == CmpInst::ICMP_SLT && C1->isZero() && C2->isMaxSignedValue())
8630 return {CmpLHS == TrueVal ? SPF_UMAX : SPF_UMIN, SPNB_NA, false};
8631
8632 // Is the sign bit clear?
8633 // (X >s -1) ? MINVAL : X ==> (X <u MINVAL) ? MINVAL : X ==> UMAX
8634 // (X >s -1) ? X : MINVAL ==> (X <u MINVAL) ? X : MINVAL ==> UMIN
8635 if (Pred == CmpInst::ICMP_SGT && C1->isAllOnes() && C2->isMinSignedValue())
8636 return {CmpLHS == FalseVal ? SPF_UMAX : SPF_UMIN, SPNB_NA, false};
8637 }
8638
8639 return {SPF_UNKNOWN, SPNB_NA, false};
8640}
8641
8642bool llvm::isKnownNegation(const Value *X, const Value *Y, bool NeedNSW,
8643 bool AllowPoison) {
8644 assert(X && Y && "Invalid operand");
8645
8646 auto IsNegationOf = [&](const Value *X, const Value *Y) {
8647 if (!match(X, m_Neg(m_Specific(Y))))
8648 return false;
8649
8650 auto *BO = cast<BinaryOperator>(X);
8651 if (NeedNSW && !BO->hasNoSignedWrap())
8652 return false;
8653
8654 auto *Zero = cast<Constant>(BO->getOperand(0));
8655 if (!AllowPoison && !Zero->isNullValue())
8656 return false;
8657
8658 return true;
8659 };
8660
8661 // X = -Y or Y = -X
8662 if (IsNegationOf(X, Y) || IsNegationOf(Y, X))
8663 return true;
8664
8665 // X = sub (A, B), Y = sub (B, A) || X = sub nsw (A, B), Y = sub nsw (B, A)
8666 Value *A, *B;
8667 return (!NeedNSW && (match(X, m_Sub(m_Value(A), m_Value(B))) &&
8668 match(Y, m_Sub(m_Specific(B), m_Specific(A))))) ||
8669 (NeedNSW && (match(X, m_NSWSub(m_Value(A), m_Value(B))) &&
8671}
8672
8673bool llvm::isKnownInversion(const Value *X, const Value *Y) {
8674 // Handle X = icmp pred A, B, Y = icmp pred A, C.
8675 Value *A, *B, *C;
8676 CmpPredicate Pred1, Pred2;
8677 if (!match(X, m_ICmp(Pred1, m_Value(A), m_Value(B))) ||
8678 !match(Y, m_c_ICmp(Pred2, m_Specific(A), m_Value(C))))
8679 return false;
8680
8681 // They must both have samesign flag or not.
8682 if (Pred1.hasSameSign() != Pred2.hasSameSign())
8683 return false;
8684
8685 if (B == C)
8686 return Pred1 == ICmpInst::getInversePredicate(Pred2);
8687
8688 // Try to infer the relationship from constant ranges.
8689 const APInt *RHSC1, *RHSC2;
8690 if (!match(B, m_APInt(RHSC1)) || !match(C, m_APInt(RHSC2)))
8691 return false;
8692
8693 // Sign bits of two RHSCs should match.
8694 if (Pred1.hasSameSign() && RHSC1->isNonNegative() != RHSC2->isNonNegative())
8695 return false;
8696
8697 const auto CR1 = ConstantRange::makeExactICmpRegion(Pred1, *RHSC1);
8698 const auto CR2 = ConstantRange::makeExactICmpRegion(Pred2, *RHSC2);
8699
8700 return CR1.inverse() == CR2;
8701}
8702
8704 SelectPatternNaNBehavior NaNBehavior,
8705 bool Ordered) {
8706 switch (Pred) {
8707 default:
8708 return {SPF_UNKNOWN, SPNB_NA, false}; // Equality.
8709 case ICmpInst::ICMP_UGT:
8710 case ICmpInst::ICMP_UGE:
8711 return {SPF_UMAX, SPNB_NA, false};
8712 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SGT:
8713 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SGE:
8714 return {SPF_SMAX, SPNB_NA, false};
8715 case ICmpInst::ICMP_ULT:
8716 case ICmpInst::ICMP_ULE:
8717 return {SPF_UMIN, SPNB_NA, false};
8718 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SLT:
8719 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SLE:
8720 return {SPF_SMIN, SPNB_NA, false};
8721 case FCmpInst::FCMP_UGT:
8722 case FCmpInst::FCMP_UGE:
8723 case FCmpInst::FCMP_OGT:
8724 case FCmpInst::FCMP_OGE:
8725 return {SPF_FMAXNUM, NaNBehavior, Ordered};
8726 case FCmpInst::FCMP_ULT:
8727 case FCmpInst::FCMP_ULE:
8728 case FCmpInst::FCMP_OLT:
8729 case FCmpInst::FCMP_OLE:
8730 return {SPF_FMINNUM, NaNBehavior, Ordered};
8731 }
8732}
8733
8734std::optional<std::pair<CmpPredicate, Constant *>>
8737 "Only for relational integer predicates.");
8738 if (isa<UndefValue>(C))
8739 return std::nullopt;
8740
8741 Type *Type = C->getType();
8742 bool IsSigned = ICmpInst::isSigned(Pred);
8743
8745 bool WillIncrement =
8746 UnsignedPred == ICmpInst::ICMP_ULE || UnsignedPred == ICmpInst::ICMP_UGT;
8747
8748 // Check if the constant operand can be safely incremented/decremented
8749 // without overflowing/underflowing.
8750 auto ConstantIsOk = [WillIncrement, IsSigned](ConstantInt *C) {
8751 return WillIncrement ? !C->isMaxValue(IsSigned) : !C->isMinValue(IsSigned);
8752 };
8753
8754 Constant *SafeReplacementConstant = nullptr;
8755 if (auto *CI = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(C)) {
8756 // Bail out if the constant can't be safely incremented/decremented.
8757 if (!ConstantIsOk(CI))
8758 return std::nullopt;
8759 } else if (auto *FVTy = dyn_cast<FixedVectorType>(Type)) {
8760 unsigned NumElts = FVTy->getNumElements();
8761 for (unsigned i = 0; i != NumElts; ++i) {
8762 Constant *Elt = C->getAggregateElement(i);
8763 if (!Elt)
8764 return std::nullopt;
8765
8766 if (isa<UndefValue>(Elt))
8767 continue;
8768
8769 // Bail out if we can't determine if this constant is min/max or if we
8770 // know that this constant is min/max.
8771 auto *CI = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(Elt);
8772 if (!CI || !ConstantIsOk(CI))
8773 return std::nullopt;
8774
8775 if (!SafeReplacementConstant)
8776 SafeReplacementConstant = CI;
8777 }
8778 } else if (isa<VectorType>(C->getType())) {
8779 // Handle scalable splat
8780 Value *SplatC = C->getSplatValue();
8781 auto *CI = dyn_cast_or_null<ConstantInt>(SplatC);
8782 // Bail out if the constant can't be safely incremented/decremented.
8783 if (!CI || !ConstantIsOk(CI))
8784 return std::nullopt;
8785 } else {
8786 // ConstantExpr?
8787 return std::nullopt;
8788 }
8789
8790 // It may not be safe to change a compare predicate in the presence of
8791 // undefined elements, so replace those elements with the first safe constant
8792 // that we found.
8793 // TODO: in case of poison, it is safe; let's replace undefs only.
8794 if (C->containsUndefOrPoisonElement()) {
8795 assert(SafeReplacementConstant && "Replacement constant not set");
8796 C = Constant::replaceUndefsWith(C, SafeReplacementConstant);
8797 }
8798
8800
8801 // Increment or decrement the constant.
8802 Constant *OneOrNegOne = ConstantInt::get(Type, WillIncrement ? 1 : -1, true);
8803 Constant *NewC = ConstantExpr::getAdd(C, OneOrNegOne);
8804
8805 return std::make_pair(NewPred, NewC);
8806}
8807
8809 FastMathFlags FMF,
8810 Value *CmpLHS, Value *CmpRHS,
8811 Value *TrueVal, Value *FalseVal,
8812 Value *&LHS, Value *&RHS,
8813 unsigned Depth) {
8814 bool HasMismatchedZeros = false;
8815 if (CmpInst::isFPPredicate(Pred)) {
8816 // IEEE-754 ignores the sign of 0.0 in comparisons. So if the select has one
8817 // 0.0 operand, set the compare's 0.0 operands to that same value for the
8818 // purpose of identifying min/max. Disregard vector constants with undefined
8819 // elements because those can not be back-propagated for analysis.
8820 Value *OutputZeroVal = nullptr;
8821 if (match(TrueVal, m_AnyZeroFP()) && !match(FalseVal, m_AnyZeroFP()) &&
8822 !cast<Constant>(TrueVal)->containsUndefOrPoisonElement())
8823 OutputZeroVal = TrueVal;
8824 else if (match(FalseVal, m_AnyZeroFP()) && !match(TrueVal, m_AnyZeroFP()) &&
8825 !cast<Constant>(FalseVal)->containsUndefOrPoisonElement())
8826 OutputZeroVal = FalseVal;
8827
8828 if (OutputZeroVal) {
8829 if (match(CmpLHS, m_AnyZeroFP()) && CmpLHS != OutputZeroVal) {
8830 HasMismatchedZeros = true;
8831 CmpLHS = OutputZeroVal;
8832 }
8833 if (match(CmpRHS, m_AnyZeroFP()) && CmpRHS != OutputZeroVal) {
8834 HasMismatchedZeros = true;
8835 CmpRHS = OutputZeroVal;
8836 }
8837 }
8838 }
8839
8840 LHS = CmpLHS;
8841 RHS = CmpRHS;
8842
8843 // Signed zero may return inconsistent results between implementations.
8844 // (0.0 <= -0.0) ? 0.0 : -0.0 // Returns 0.0
8845 // minNum(0.0, -0.0) // May return -0.0 or 0.0 (IEEE 754-2008 5.3.1)
8846 // Therefore, we behave conservatively and only proceed if at least one of the
8847 // operands is known to not be zero or if we don't care about signed zero.
8848 switch (Pred) {
8849 default: break;
8852 if (!HasMismatchedZeros)
8853 break;
8854 [[fallthrough]];
8857 if (!FMF.noSignedZeros() && !isKnownNonZero(CmpLHS) &&
8858 !isKnownNonZero(CmpRHS))
8859 return {SPF_UNKNOWN, SPNB_NA, false};
8860 }
8861
8862 SelectPatternNaNBehavior NaNBehavior = SPNB_NA;
8863 bool Ordered = false;
8864
8865 // When given one NaN and one non-NaN input:
8866 // - maxnum/minnum (C99 fmaxf()/fminf()) return the non-NaN input.
8867 // - A simple C99 (a < b ? a : b) construction will return 'b' (as the
8868 // ordered comparison fails), which could be NaN or non-NaN.
8869 // so here we discover exactly what NaN behavior is required/accepted.
8870 if (CmpInst::isFPPredicate(Pred)) {
8871 bool LHSSafe = isKnownNonNaN(CmpLHS, FMF);
8872 bool RHSSafe = isKnownNonNaN(CmpRHS, FMF);
8873
8874 if (LHSSafe && RHSSafe) {
8875 // Both operands are known non-NaN.
8876 NaNBehavior = SPNB_RETURNS_ANY;
8877 Ordered = CmpInst::isOrdered(Pred);
8878 } else if (CmpInst::isOrdered(Pred)) {
8879 // An ordered comparison will return false when given a NaN, so it
8880 // returns the RHS.
8881 Ordered = true;
8882 if (LHSSafe)
8883 // LHS is non-NaN, so if RHS is NaN then NaN will be returned.
8884 NaNBehavior = SPNB_RETURNS_NAN;
8885 else if (RHSSafe)
8886 NaNBehavior = SPNB_RETURNS_OTHER;
8887 else
8888 // Completely unsafe.
8889 return {SPF_UNKNOWN, SPNB_NA, false};
8890 } else {
8891 Ordered = false;
8892 // An unordered comparison will return true when given a NaN, so it
8893 // returns the LHS.
8894 if (LHSSafe)
8895 // LHS is non-NaN, so if RHS is NaN then non-NaN will be returned.
8896 NaNBehavior = SPNB_RETURNS_OTHER;
8897 else if (RHSSafe)
8898 NaNBehavior = SPNB_RETURNS_NAN;
8899 else
8900 // Completely unsafe.
8901 return {SPF_UNKNOWN, SPNB_NA, false};
8902 }
8903 }
8904
8905 if (TrueVal == CmpRHS && FalseVal == CmpLHS) {
8906 std::swap(CmpLHS, CmpRHS);
8907 Pred = CmpInst::getSwappedPredicate(Pred);
8908 if (NaNBehavior == SPNB_RETURNS_NAN)
8909 NaNBehavior = SPNB_RETURNS_OTHER;
8910 else if (NaNBehavior == SPNB_RETURNS_OTHER)
8911 NaNBehavior = SPNB_RETURNS_NAN;
8912 Ordered = !Ordered;
8913 }
8914
8915 // ([if]cmp X, Y) ? X : Y
8916 if (TrueVal == CmpLHS && FalseVal == CmpRHS)
8917 return getSelectPattern(Pred, NaNBehavior, Ordered);
8918
8919 if (isKnownNegation(TrueVal, FalseVal)) {
8920 // Sign-extending LHS does not change its sign, so TrueVal/FalseVal can
8921 // match against either LHS or sext(LHS).
8922 auto MaybeSExtCmpLHS =
8923 m_CombineOr(m_Specific(CmpLHS), m_SExt(m_Specific(CmpLHS)));
8924 auto ZeroOrAllOnes = m_CombineOr(m_ZeroInt(), m_AllOnes());
8925 auto ZeroOrOne = m_CombineOr(m_ZeroInt(), m_One());
8926 if (match(TrueVal, MaybeSExtCmpLHS)) {
8927 // Set the return values. If the compare uses the negated value (-X >s 0),
8928 // swap the return values because the negated value is always 'RHS'.
8929 LHS = TrueVal;
8930 RHS = FalseVal;
8931 if (match(CmpLHS, m_Neg(m_Specific(FalseVal))))
8932 std::swap(LHS, RHS);
8933
8934 // (X >s 0) ? X : -X or (X >s -1) ? X : -X --> ABS(X)
8935 // (-X >s 0) ? -X : X or (-X >s -1) ? -X : X --> ABS(X)
8936 if (Pred == ICmpInst::ICMP_SGT && match(CmpRHS, ZeroOrAllOnes))
8937 return {SPF_ABS, SPNB_NA, false};
8938
8939 // (X >=s 0) ? X : -X or (X >=s 1) ? X : -X --> ABS(X)
8940 if (Pred == ICmpInst::ICMP_SGE && match(CmpRHS, ZeroOrOne))
8941 return {SPF_ABS, SPNB_NA, false};
8942
8943 // (X <s 0) ? X : -X or (X <s 1) ? X : -X --> NABS(X)
8944 // (-X <s 0) ? -X : X or (-X <s 1) ? -X : X --> NABS(X)
8945 if (Pred == ICmpInst::ICMP_SLT && match(CmpRHS, ZeroOrOne))
8946 return {SPF_NABS, SPNB_NA, false};
8947 }
8948 else if (match(FalseVal, MaybeSExtCmpLHS)) {
8949 // Set the return values. If the compare uses the negated value (-X >s 0),
8950 // swap the return values because the negated value is always 'RHS'.
8951 LHS = FalseVal;
8952 RHS = TrueVal;
8953 if (match(CmpLHS, m_Neg(m_Specific(TrueVal))))
8954 std::swap(LHS, RHS);
8955
8956 // (X >s 0) ? -X : X or (X >s -1) ? -X : X --> NABS(X)
8957 // (-X >s 0) ? X : -X or (-X >s -1) ? X : -X --> NABS(X)
8958 if (Pred == ICmpInst::ICMP_SGT && match(CmpRHS, ZeroOrAllOnes))
8959 return {SPF_NABS, SPNB_NA, false};
8960
8961 // (X <s 0) ? -X : X or (X <s 1) ? -X : X --> ABS(X)
8962 // (-X <s 0) ? X : -X or (-X <s 1) ? X : -X --> ABS(X)
8963 if (Pred == ICmpInst::ICMP_SLT && match(CmpRHS, ZeroOrOne))
8964 return {SPF_ABS, SPNB_NA, false};
8965 }
8966 }
8967
8968 if (CmpInst::isIntPredicate(Pred))
8969 return matchMinMax(Pred, CmpLHS, CmpRHS, TrueVal, FalseVal, LHS, RHS, Depth);
8970
8971 // According to (IEEE 754-2008 5.3.1), minNum(0.0, -0.0) and similar
8972 // may return either -0.0 or 0.0, so fcmp/select pair has stricter
8973 // semantics than minNum. Be conservative in such case.
8974 if (NaNBehavior != SPNB_RETURNS_ANY ||
8975 (!FMF.noSignedZeros() && !isKnownNonZero(CmpLHS) &&
8976 !isKnownNonZero(CmpRHS)))
8977 return {SPF_UNKNOWN, SPNB_NA, false};
8978
8979 return matchFastFloatClamp(Pred, CmpLHS, CmpRHS, TrueVal, FalseVal, LHS, RHS);
8980}
8981
8983 Instruction::CastOps *CastOp) {
8984 const DataLayout &DL = CmpI->getDataLayout();
8985
8986 Constant *CastedTo = nullptr;
8987 switch (*CastOp) {
8988 case Instruction::ZExt:
8989 if (CmpI->isUnsigned())
8990 CastedTo = ConstantExpr::getTrunc(C, SrcTy);
8991 break;
8992 case Instruction::SExt:
8993 if (CmpI->isSigned())
8994 CastedTo = ConstantExpr::getTrunc(C, SrcTy, true);
8995 break;
8996 case Instruction::Trunc:
8997 Constant *CmpConst;
8998 if (match(CmpI->getOperand(1), m_Constant(CmpConst)) &&
8999 CmpConst->getType() == SrcTy) {
9000 // Here we have the following case:
9001 //
9002 // %cond = cmp iN %x, CmpConst
9003 // %tr = trunc iN %x to iK
9004 // %narrowsel = select i1 %cond, iK %t, iK C
9005 //
9006 // We can always move trunc after select operation:
9007 //
9008 // %cond = cmp iN %x, CmpConst
9009 // %widesel = select i1 %cond, iN %x, iN CmpConst
9010 // %tr = trunc iN %widesel to iK
9011 //
9012 // Note that C could be extended in any way because we don't care about
9013 // upper bits after truncation. It can't be abs pattern, because it would
9014 // look like:
9015 //
9016 // select i1 %cond, x, -x.
9017 //
9018 // So only min/max pattern could be matched. Such match requires widened C
9019 // == CmpConst. That is why set widened C = CmpConst, condition trunc
9020 // CmpConst == C is checked below.
9021 CastedTo = CmpConst;
9022 } else {
9023 unsigned ExtOp = CmpI->isSigned() ? Instruction::SExt : Instruction::ZExt;
9024 CastedTo = ConstantFoldCastOperand(ExtOp, C, SrcTy, DL);
9025 }
9026 break;
9027 case Instruction::FPTrunc:
9028 CastedTo = ConstantFoldCastOperand(Instruction::FPExt, C, SrcTy, DL);
9029 break;
9030 case Instruction::FPExt:
9031 CastedTo = ConstantFoldCastOperand(Instruction::FPTrunc, C, SrcTy, DL);
9032 break;
9033 case Instruction::FPToUI:
9034 CastedTo = ConstantFoldCastOperand(Instruction::UIToFP, C, SrcTy, DL);
9035 break;
9036 case Instruction::FPToSI:
9037 CastedTo = ConstantFoldCastOperand(Instruction::SIToFP, C, SrcTy, DL);
9038 break;
9039 case Instruction::UIToFP:
9040 CastedTo = ConstantFoldCastOperand(Instruction::FPToUI, C, SrcTy, DL);
9041 break;
9042 case Instruction::SIToFP:
9043 CastedTo = ConstantFoldCastOperand(Instruction::FPToSI, C, SrcTy, DL);
9044 break;
9045 default:
9046 break;
9047 }
9048
9049 if (!CastedTo)
9050 return nullptr;
9051
9052 // Make sure the cast doesn't lose any information.
9053 Constant *CastedBack =
9054 ConstantFoldCastOperand(*CastOp, CastedTo, C->getType(), DL);
9055 if (CastedBack && CastedBack != C)
9056 return nullptr;
9057
9058 return CastedTo;
9059}
9060
9061/// Helps to match a select pattern in case of a type mismatch.
9062///
9063/// The function processes the case when type of true and false values of a
9064/// select instruction differs from type of the cmp instruction operands because
9065/// of a cast instruction. The function checks if it is legal to move the cast
9066/// operation after "select". If yes, it returns the new second value of
9067/// "select" (with the assumption that cast is moved):
9068/// 1. As operand of cast instruction when both values of "select" are same cast
9069/// instructions.
9070/// 2. As restored constant (by applying reverse cast operation) when the first
9071/// value of the "select" is a cast operation and the second value is a
9072/// constant. It is implemented in lookThroughCastConst().
9073/// 3. As one operand is cast instruction and the other is not. The operands in
9074/// sel(cmp) are in different type integer.
9075/// NOTE: We return only the new second value because the first value could be
9076/// accessed as operand of cast instruction.
9077static Value *lookThroughCast(CmpInst *CmpI, Value *V1, Value *V2,
9078 Instruction::CastOps *CastOp) {
9079 auto *Cast1 = dyn_cast<CastInst>(V1);
9080 if (!Cast1)
9081 return nullptr;
9082
9083 *CastOp = Cast1->getOpcode();
9084 Type *SrcTy = Cast1->getSrcTy();
9085 if (auto *Cast2 = dyn_cast<CastInst>(V2)) {
9086 // If V1 and V2 are both the same cast from the same type, look through V1.
9087 if (*CastOp == Cast2->getOpcode() && SrcTy == Cast2->getSrcTy())
9088 return Cast2->getOperand(0);
9089 return nullptr;
9090 }
9091
9092 auto *C = dyn_cast<Constant>(V2);
9093 if (C)
9094 return lookThroughCastConst(CmpI, SrcTy, C, CastOp);
9095
9096 Value *CastedTo = nullptr;
9097 if (*CastOp == Instruction::Trunc) {
9098 if (match(CmpI->getOperand(1), m_ZExtOrSExt(m_Specific(V2)))) {
9099 // Here we have the following case:
9100 // %y_ext = sext iK %y to iN
9101 // %cond = cmp iN %x, %y_ext
9102 // %tr = trunc iN %x to iK
9103 // %narrowsel = select i1 %cond, iK %tr, iK %y
9104 //
9105 // We can always move trunc after select operation:
9106 // %y_ext = sext iK %y to iN
9107 // %cond = cmp iN %x, %y_ext
9108 // %widesel = select i1 %cond, iN %x, iN %y_ext
9109 // %tr = trunc iN %widesel to iK
9110 assert(V2->getType() == Cast1->getType() &&
9111 "V2 and Cast1 should be the same type.");
9112 CastedTo = CmpI->getOperand(1);
9113 }
9114 }
9115
9116 return CastedTo;
9117}
9119 Instruction::CastOps *CastOp,
9120 unsigned Depth) {
9122 return {SPF_UNKNOWN, SPNB_NA, false};
9123
9125 if (!SI) return {SPF_UNKNOWN, SPNB_NA, false};
9126
9127 CmpInst *CmpI = dyn_cast<CmpInst>(SI->getCondition());
9128 if (!CmpI) return {SPF_UNKNOWN, SPNB_NA, false};
9129
9130 Value *TrueVal = SI->getTrueValue();
9131 Value *FalseVal = SI->getFalseValue();
9132
9134 CmpI, TrueVal, FalseVal, LHS, RHS,
9135 isa<FPMathOperator>(SI) ? SI->getFastMathFlags() : FastMathFlags(),
9136 CastOp, Depth);
9137}
9138
9140 CmpInst *CmpI, Value *TrueVal, Value *FalseVal, Value *&LHS, Value *&RHS,
9141 FastMathFlags FMF, Instruction::CastOps *CastOp, unsigned Depth) {
9142 CmpInst::Predicate Pred = CmpI->getPredicate();
9143 Value *CmpLHS = CmpI->getOperand(0);
9144 Value *CmpRHS = CmpI->getOperand(1);
9145 if (isa<FPMathOperator>(CmpI) && CmpI->hasNoNaNs())
9146 FMF.setNoNaNs();
9147
9148 // Bail out early.
9149 if (CmpI->isEquality())
9150 return {SPF_UNKNOWN, SPNB_NA, false};
9151
9152 // Deal with type mismatches.
9153 if (CastOp && CmpLHS->getType() != TrueVal->getType()) {
9154 if (Value *C = lookThroughCast(CmpI, TrueVal, FalseVal, CastOp)) {
9155 // If this is a potential fmin/fmax with a cast to integer, then ignore
9156 // -0.0 because there is no corresponding integer value.
9157 if (*CastOp == Instruction::FPToSI || *CastOp == Instruction::FPToUI)
9158 FMF.setNoSignedZeros();
9159 return ::matchSelectPattern(Pred, FMF, CmpLHS, CmpRHS,
9160 cast<CastInst>(TrueVal)->getOperand(0), C,
9161 LHS, RHS, Depth);
9162 }
9163 if (Value *C = lookThroughCast(CmpI, FalseVal, TrueVal, CastOp)) {
9164 // If this is a potential fmin/fmax with a cast to integer, then ignore
9165 // -0.0 because there is no corresponding integer value.
9166 if (*CastOp == Instruction::FPToSI || *CastOp == Instruction::FPToUI)
9167 FMF.setNoSignedZeros();
9168 return ::matchSelectPattern(Pred, FMF, CmpLHS, CmpRHS,
9169 C, cast<CastInst>(FalseVal)->getOperand(0),
9170 LHS, RHS, Depth);
9171 }
9172 }
9173 return ::matchSelectPattern(Pred, FMF, CmpLHS, CmpRHS, TrueVal, FalseVal,
9174 LHS, RHS, Depth);
9175}
9176
9178 if (SPF == SPF_SMIN) return ICmpInst::ICMP_SLT;
9179 if (SPF == SPF_UMIN) return ICmpInst::ICMP_ULT;
9180 if (SPF == SPF_SMAX) return ICmpInst::ICMP_SGT;
9181 if (SPF == SPF_UMAX) return ICmpInst::ICMP_UGT;
9182 if (SPF == SPF_FMINNUM)
9183 return Ordered ? FCmpInst::FCMP_OLT : FCmpInst::FCMP_ULT;
9184 if (SPF == SPF_FMAXNUM)
9185 return Ordered ? FCmpInst::FCMP_OGT : FCmpInst::FCMP_UGT;
9186 llvm_unreachable("unhandled!");
9187}
9188
9190 switch (SPF) {
9192 return Intrinsic::umin;
9194 return Intrinsic::umax;
9196 return Intrinsic::smin;
9198 return Intrinsic::smax;
9199 default:
9200 llvm_unreachable("Unexpected SPF");
9201 }
9202}
9203
9205 if (SPF == SPF_SMIN) return SPF_SMAX;
9206 if (SPF == SPF_UMIN) return SPF_UMAX;
9207 if (SPF == SPF_SMAX) return SPF_SMIN;
9208 if (SPF == SPF_UMAX) return SPF_UMIN;
9209 llvm_unreachable("unhandled!");
9210}
9211
9213 switch (MinMaxID) {
9214 case Intrinsic::smax: return Intrinsic::smin;
9215 case Intrinsic::smin: return Intrinsic::smax;
9216 case Intrinsic::umax: return Intrinsic::umin;
9217 case Intrinsic::umin: return Intrinsic::umax;
9218 // Please note that next four intrinsics may produce the same result for
9219 // original and inverted case even if X != Y due to NaN is handled specially.
9220 case Intrinsic::maximum: return Intrinsic::minimum;
9221 case Intrinsic::minimum: return Intrinsic::maximum;
9222 case Intrinsic::maxnum: return Intrinsic::minnum;
9223 case Intrinsic::minnum: return Intrinsic::maxnum;
9224 case Intrinsic::maximumnum:
9225 return Intrinsic::minimumnum;
9226 case Intrinsic::minimumnum:
9227 return Intrinsic::maximumnum;
9228 default: llvm_unreachable("Unexpected intrinsic");
9229 }
9230}
9231
9233 switch (SPF) {
9236 case SPF_UMAX: return APInt::getMaxValue(BitWidth);
9237 case SPF_UMIN: return APInt::getMinValue(BitWidth);
9238 default: llvm_unreachable("Unexpected flavor");
9239 }
9240}
9241
9242std::pair<Intrinsic::ID, bool>
9244 // Check if VL contains select instructions that can be folded into a min/max
9245 // vector intrinsic and return the intrinsic if it is possible.
9246 // TODO: Support floating point min/max.
9247 bool AllCmpSingleUse = true;
9248 SelectPatternResult SelectPattern;
9249 SelectPattern.Flavor = SPF_UNKNOWN;
9250 if (all_of(VL, [&SelectPattern, &AllCmpSingleUse](Value *I) {
9251 Value *LHS, *RHS;
9252 auto CurrentPattern = matchSelectPattern(I, LHS, RHS);
9253 if (!SelectPatternResult::isMinOrMax(CurrentPattern.Flavor))
9254 return false;
9255 if (SelectPattern.Flavor != SPF_UNKNOWN &&
9256 SelectPattern.Flavor != CurrentPattern.Flavor)
9257 return false;
9258 SelectPattern = CurrentPattern;
9259 AllCmpSingleUse &=
9261 return true;
9262 })) {
9263 switch (SelectPattern.Flavor) {
9264 case SPF_SMIN:
9265 return {Intrinsic::smin, AllCmpSingleUse};
9266 case SPF_UMIN:
9267 return {Intrinsic::umin, AllCmpSingleUse};
9268 case SPF_SMAX:
9269 return {Intrinsic::smax, AllCmpSingleUse};
9270 case SPF_UMAX:
9271 return {Intrinsic::umax, AllCmpSingleUse};
9272 case SPF_FMAXNUM:
9273 return {Intrinsic::maxnum, AllCmpSingleUse};
9274 case SPF_FMINNUM:
9275 return {Intrinsic::minnum, AllCmpSingleUse};
9276 default:
9277 llvm_unreachable("unexpected select pattern flavor");
9278 }
9279 }
9280 return {Intrinsic::not_intrinsic, false};
9281}
9282
9283template <typename InstTy>
9284static bool matchTwoInputRecurrence(const PHINode *PN, InstTy *&Inst,
9285 Value *&Init, Value *&OtherOp) {
9286 // Handle the case of a simple two-predecessor recurrence PHI.
9287 // There's a lot more that could theoretically be done here, but
9288 // this is sufficient to catch some interesting cases.
9289 // TODO: Expand list -- gep, uadd.sat etc.
9290 if (PN->getNumIncomingValues() != 2)
9291 return false;
9292
9293 for (unsigned I = 0; I != 2; ++I) {
9294 if (auto *Operation = dyn_cast<InstTy>(PN->getIncomingValue(I));
9295 Operation && Operation->getNumOperands() >= 2) {
9296 Value *LHS = Operation->getOperand(0);
9297 Value *RHS = Operation->getOperand(1);
9298 if (LHS != PN && RHS != PN)
9299 continue;
9300
9301 Inst = Operation;
9302 Init = PN->getIncomingValue(!I);
9303 OtherOp = (LHS == PN) ? RHS : LHS;
9304 return true;
9305 }
9306 }
9307 return false;
9308}
9309
9311 Value *&Start, Value *&Step) {
9312 // We try to match a recurrence of the form:
9313 // %iv = [Start, %entry], [%iv.next, %backedge]
9314 // %iv.next = binop %iv, Step
9315 // Or:
9316 // %iv = [Start, %entry], [%iv.next, %backedge]
9317 // %iv.next = binop Step, %iv
9318 return matchTwoInputRecurrence(P, BO, Start, Step);
9319}
9320
9322 Value *&Start, Value *&Step) {
9323 BinaryOperator *BO = nullptr;
9324 P = dyn_cast<PHINode>(I->getOperand(0));
9325 if (!P)
9326 P = dyn_cast<PHINode>(I->getOperand(1));
9327 return P && matchSimpleRecurrence(P, BO, Start, Step) && BO == I;
9328}
9329
9331 PHINode *&P, Value *&Init,
9332 Value *&OtherOp) {
9333 // Binary intrinsics only supported for now.
9334 if (I->arg_size() != 2 || I->getType() != I->getArgOperand(0)->getType() ||
9335 I->getType() != I->getArgOperand(1)->getType())
9336 return false;
9337
9338 IntrinsicInst *II = nullptr;
9339 P = dyn_cast<PHINode>(I->getArgOperand(0));
9340 if (!P)
9341 P = dyn_cast<PHINode>(I->getArgOperand(1));
9342
9343 return P && matchTwoInputRecurrence(P, II, Init, OtherOp) && II == I;
9344}
9345
9346/// Return true if "icmp Pred LHS RHS" is always true.
9348 const Value *RHS) {
9349 if (ICmpInst::isTrueWhenEqual(Pred) && LHS == RHS)
9350 return true;
9351
9352 switch (Pred) {
9353 default:
9354 return false;
9355
9356 case CmpInst::ICMP_SLE: {
9357 const APInt *C;
9358
9359 // LHS s<= LHS +_{nsw} C if C >= 0
9360 // LHS s<= LHS | C if C >= 0
9361 if (match(RHS, m_NSWAdd(m_Specific(LHS), m_APInt(C))) ||
9363 return !C->isNegative();
9364
9365 // LHS s<= smax(LHS, V) for any V
9367 return true;
9368
9369 // smin(RHS, V) s<= RHS for any V
9371 return true;
9372
9373 // Match A to (X +_{nsw} CA) and B to (X +_{nsw} CB)
9374 const Value *X;
9375 const APInt *CLHS, *CRHS;
9376 if (match(LHS, m_NSWAddLike(m_Value(X), m_APInt(CLHS))) &&
9378 return CLHS->sle(*CRHS);
9379
9380 return false;
9381 }
9382
9383 case CmpInst::ICMP_ULE: {
9384 // LHS u<= LHS +_{nuw} V for any V
9385 if (match(RHS, m_c_Add(m_Specific(LHS), m_Value())) &&
9387 return true;
9388
9389 // LHS u<= LHS | V for any V
9390 if (match(RHS, m_c_Or(m_Specific(LHS), m_Value())))
9391 return true;
9392
9393 // LHS u<= umax(LHS, V) for any V
9395 return true;
9396
9397 // RHS >> V u<= RHS for any V
9398 if (match(LHS, m_LShr(m_Specific(RHS), m_Value())))
9399 return true;
9400
9401 // RHS u/ C_ugt_1 u<= RHS
9402 const APInt *C;
9403 if (match(LHS, m_UDiv(m_Specific(RHS), m_APInt(C))) && C->ugt(1))
9404 return true;
9405
9406 // RHS & V u<= RHS for any V
9408 return true;
9409
9410 // umin(RHS, V) u<= RHS for any V
9412 return true;
9413
9414 // Match A to (X +_{nuw} CA) and B to (X +_{nuw} CB)
9415 const Value *X;
9416 const APInt *CLHS, *CRHS;
9417 if (match(LHS, m_NUWAddLike(m_Value(X), m_APInt(CLHS))) &&
9419 return CLHS->ule(*CRHS);
9420
9421 return false;
9422 }
9423 }
9424}
9425
9426/// Return true if "icmp Pred BLHS BRHS" is true whenever "icmp Pred
9427/// ALHS ARHS" is true. Otherwise, return std::nullopt.
9428static std::optional<bool>
9430 const Value *ARHS, const Value *BLHS, const Value *BRHS) {
9431 switch (Pred) {
9432 default:
9433 return std::nullopt;
9434
9435 case CmpInst::ICMP_SLT:
9436 case CmpInst::ICMP_SLE:
9437 if (isTruePredicate(CmpInst::ICMP_SLE, BLHS, ALHS) &&
9439 return true;
9440 return std::nullopt;
9441
9442 case CmpInst::ICMP_SGT:
9443 case CmpInst::ICMP_SGE:
9444 if (isTruePredicate(CmpInst::ICMP_SLE, ALHS, BLHS) &&
9446 return true;
9447 return std::nullopt;
9448
9449 case CmpInst::ICMP_ULT:
9450 case CmpInst::ICMP_ULE:
9451 if (isTruePredicate(CmpInst::ICMP_ULE, BLHS, ALHS) &&
9453 return true;
9454 return std::nullopt;
9455
9456 case CmpInst::ICMP_UGT:
9457 case CmpInst::ICMP_UGE:
9458 if (isTruePredicate(CmpInst::ICMP_ULE, ALHS, BLHS) &&
9460 return true;
9461 return std::nullopt;
9462 }
9463}
9464
9465/// Return true if "icmp LPred X, LCR" implies "icmp RPred X, RCR" is true.
9466/// Return false if "icmp LPred X, LCR" implies "icmp RPred X, RCR" is false.
9467/// Otherwise, return std::nullopt if we can't infer anything.
9468static std::optional<bool>
9470 CmpPredicate RPred, const ConstantRange &RCR) {
9471 auto CRImpliesPred = [&](ConstantRange CR,
9472 CmpInst::Predicate Pred) -> std::optional<bool> {
9473 // If all true values for lhs and true for rhs, lhs implies rhs
9474 if (CR.icmp(Pred, RCR))
9475 return true;
9476
9477 // If there is no overlap, lhs implies not rhs
9478 if (CR.icmp(CmpInst::getInversePredicate(Pred), RCR))
9479 return false;
9480
9481 return std::nullopt;
9482 };
9483 if (auto Res = CRImpliesPred(ConstantRange::makeAllowedICmpRegion(LPred, LCR),
9484 RPred))
9485 return Res;
9486 if (LPred.hasSameSign() ^ RPred.hasSameSign()) {
9488 : LPred.dropSameSign();
9490 : RPred.dropSameSign();
9491 return CRImpliesPred(ConstantRange::makeAllowedICmpRegion(LPred, LCR),
9492 RPred);
9493 }
9494 return std::nullopt;
9495}
9496
9497/// Return true if LHS implies RHS (expanded to its components as "R0 RPred R1")
9498/// is true. Return false if LHS implies RHS is false. Otherwise, return
9499/// std::nullopt if we can't infer anything.
9500static std::optional<bool>
9501isImpliedCondICmps(CmpPredicate LPred, const Value *L0, const Value *L1,
9502 CmpPredicate RPred, const Value *R0, const Value *R1,
9503 const DataLayout &DL, bool LHSIsTrue) {
9504 // The rest of the logic assumes the LHS condition is true. If that's not the
9505 // case, invert the predicate to make it so.
9506 if (!LHSIsTrue)
9507 LPred = ICmpInst::getInverseCmpPredicate(LPred);
9508
9509 // We can have non-canonical operands, so try to normalize any common operand
9510 // to L0/R0.
9511 if (L0 == R1) {
9512 std::swap(R0, R1);
9513 RPred = ICmpInst::getSwappedCmpPredicate(RPred);
9514 }
9515 if (R0 == L1) {
9516 std::swap(L0, L1);
9517 LPred = ICmpInst::getSwappedCmpPredicate(LPred);
9518 }
9519 if (L1 == R1) {
9520 // If we have L0 == R0 and L1 == R1, then make L1/R1 the constants.
9521 if (L0 != R0 || match(L0, m_ImmConstant())) {
9522 std::swap(L0, L1);
9523 LPred = ICmpInst::getSwappedCmpPredicate(LPred);
9524 std::swap(R0, R1);
9525 RPred = ICmpInst::getSwappedCmpPredicate(RPred);
9526 }
9527 }
9528
9529 // See if we can infer anything if operand-0 matches and we have at least one
9530 // constant.
9531 const APInt *Unused;
9532 if (L0 == R0 && (match(L1, m_APInt(Unused)) || match(R1, m_APInt(Unused)))) {
9533 // Potential TODO: We could also further use the constant range of L0/R0 to
9534 // further constraint the constant ranges. At the moment this leads to
9535 // several regressions related to not transforming `multi_use(A + C0) eq/ne
9536 // C1` (see discussion: D58633).
9538 L1, ICmpInst::isSigned(LPred), /* UseInstrInfo=*/true, /*AC=*/nullptr,
9539 /*CxtI=*/nullptr, /*DT=*/nullptr, MaxAnalysisRecursionDepth - 1);
9541 R1, ICmpInst::isSigned(RPred), /* UseInstrInfo=*/true, /*AC=*/nullptr,
9542 /*CxtI=*/nullptr, /*DT=*/nullptr, MaxAnalysisRecursionDepth - 1);
9543 // Even if L1/R1 are not both constant, we can still sometimes deduce
9544 // relationship from a single constant. For example X u> Y implies X != 0.
9545 if (auto R = isImpliedCondCommonOperandWithCR(LPred, LCR, RPred, RCR))
9546 return R;
9547 // If both L1/R1 were exact constant ranges and we didn't get anything
9548 // here, we won't be able to deduce this.
9549 if (match(L1, m_APInt(Unused)) && match(R1, m_APInt(Unused)))
9550 return std::nullopt;
9551 }
9552
9553 // Can we infer anything when the two compares have matching operands?
9554 if (L0 == R0 && L1 == R1)
9555 return ICmpInst::isImpliedByMatchingCmp(LPred, RPred);
9556
9557 // It only really makes sense in the context of signed comparison for "X - Y
9558 // must be positive if X >= Y and no overflow".
9559 // Take SGT as an example: L0:x > L1:y and C >= 0
9560 // ==> R0:(x -nsw y) < R1:(-C) is false
9561 CmpInst::Predicate SignedLPred = LPred.getPreferredSignedPredicate();
9562 if ((SignedLPred == ICmpInst::ICMP_SGT ||
9563 SignedLPred == ICmpInst::ICMP_SGE) &&
9564 match(R0, m_NSWSub(m_Specific(L0), m_Specific(L1)))) {
9565 if (match(R1, m_NonPositive()) &&
9566 ICmpInst::isImpliedByMatchingCmp(SignedLPred, RPred) == false)
9567 return false;
9568 }
9569
9570 // Take SLT as an example: L0:x < L1:y and C <= 0
9571 // ==> R0:(x -nsw y) < R1:(-C) is true
9572 if ((SignedLPred == ICmpInst::ICMP_SLT ||
9573 SignedLPred == ICmpInst::ICMP_SLE) &&
9574 match(R0, m_NSWSub(m_Specific(L0), m_Specific(L1)))) {
9575 if (match(R1, m_NonNegative()) &&
9576 ICmpInst::isImpliedByMatchingCmp(SignedLPred, RPred) == true)
9577 return true;
9578 }
9579
9580 // a - b == NonZero -> a != b
9581 // ptrtoint(a) - ptrtoint(b) == NonZero -> a != b
9582 const APInt *L1C;
9583 Value *A, *B;
9584 if (LPred == ICmpInst::ICMP_EQ && ICmpInst::isEquality(RPred) &&
9585 match(L1, m_APInt(L1C)) && !L1C->isZero() &&
9586 match(L0, m_Sub(m_Value(A), m_Value(B))) &&
9587 ((A == R0 && B == R1) || (A == R1 && B == R0) ||
9588 (match(A, m_PtrToInt(m_Specific(R0))) &&
9589 match(B, m_PtrToInt(m_Specific(R1)))) ||
9590 (match(A, m_PtrToInt(m_Specific(R1))) &&
9591 match(B, m_PtrToInt(m_Specific(R0)))))) {
9592 return RPred.dropSameSign() == ICmpInst::ICMP_NE;
9593 }
9594
9595 // L0 = R0 = L1 + R1, L0 >=u L1 implies R0 >=u R1, L0 <u L1 implies R0 <u R1
9596 if (L0 == R0 &&
9597 (LPred == ICmpInst::ICMP_ULT || LPred == ICmpInst::ICMP_UGE) &&
9598 (RPred == ICmpInst::ICMP_ULT || RPred == ICmpInst::ICMP_UGE) &&
9599 match(L0, m_c_Add(m_Specific(L1), m_Specific(R1))))
9600 return CmpPredicate::getMatching(LPred, RPred).has_value();
9601
9602 if (auto P = CmpPredicate::getMatching(LPred, RPred))
9603 return isImpliedCondOperands(*P, L0, L1, R0, R1);
9604
9605 return std::nullopt;
9606}
9607
9608/// Return true if LHS implies RHS (expanded to its components as "R0 RPred R1")
9609/// is true. Return false if LHS implies RHS is false. Otherwise, return
9610/// std::nullopt if we can't infer anything.
9611static std::optional<bool>
9613 FCmpInst::Predicate RPred, const Value *R0, const Value *R1,
9614 const DataLayout &DL, bool LHSIsTrue) {
9615 // The rest of the logic assumes the LHS condition is true. If that's not the
9616 // case, invert the predicate to make it so.
9617 if (!LHSIsTrue)
9618 LPred = FCmpInst::getInversePredicate(LPred);
9619
9620 // We can have non-canonical operands, so try to normalize any common operand
9621 // to L0/R0.
9622 if (L0 == R1) {
9623 std::swap(R0, R1);
9624 RPred = FCmpInst::getSwappedPredicate(RPred);
9625 }
9626 if (R0 == L1) {
9627 std::swap(L0, L1);
9628 LPred = FCmpInst::getSwappedPredicate(LPred);
9629 }
9630 if (L1 == R1) {
9631 // If we have L0 == R0 and L1 == R1, then make L1/R1 the constants.
9632 if (L0 != R0 || match(L0, m_ImmConstant())) {
9633 std::swap(L0, L1);
9634 LPred = ICmpInst::getSwappedCmpPredicate(LPred);
9635 std::swap(R0, R1);
9636 RPred = ICmpInst::getSwappedCmpPredicate(RPred);
9637 }
9638 }
9639
9640 // Can we infer anything when the two compares have matching operands?
9641 if (L0 == R0 && L1 == R1) {
9642 if ((LPred & RPred) == LPred)
9643 return true;
9644 if ((LPred & ~RPred) == LPred)
9645 return false;
9646 }
9647
9648 // See if we can infer anything if operand-0 matches and we have at least one
9649 // constant.
9650 const APFloat *L1C, *R1C;
9651 if (L0 == R0 && match(L1, m_APFloat(L1C)) && match(R1, m_APFloat(R1C))) {
9652 if (std::optional<ConstantFPRange> DomCR =
9654 if (std::optional<ConstantFPRange> ImpliedCR =
9656 if (ImpliedCR->contains(*DomCR))
9657 return true;
9658 }
9659 if (std::optional<ConstantFPRange> ImpliedCR =
9661 FCmpInst::getInversePredicate(RPred), *R1C)) {
9662 if (ImpliedCR->contains(*DomCR))
9663 return false;
9664 }
9665 }
9666 }
9667
9668 return std::nullopt;
9669}
9670
9671/// Return true if LHS implies RHS is true. Return false if LHS implies RHS is
9672/// false. Otherwise, return std::nullopt if we can't infer anything. We
9673/// expect the RHS to be an icmp and the LHS to be an 'and', 'or', or a 'select'
9674/// instruction.
9675static std::optional<bool>
9677 const Value *RHSOp0, const Value *RHSOp1,
9678 const DataLayout &DL, bool LHSIsTrue, unsigned Depth) {
9679 // The LHS must be an 'or', 'and', or a 'select' instruction.
9680 assert((LHS->getOpcode() == Instruction::And ||
9681 LHS->getOpcode() == Instruction::Or ||
9682 LHS->getOpcode() == Instruction::Select) &&
9683 "Expected LHS to be 'and', 'or', or 'select'.");
9684
9685 assert(Depth <= MaxAnalysisRecursionDepth && "Hit recursion limit");
9686
9687 // If the result of an 'or' is false, then we know both legs of the 'or' are
9688 // false. Similarly, if the result of an 'and' is true, then we know both
9689 // legs of the 'and' are true.
9690 const Value *ALHS, *ARHS;
9691 if ((!LHSIsTrue && match(LHS, m_LogicalOr(m_Value(ALHS), m_Value(ARHS)))) ||
9692 (LHSIsTrue && match(LHS, m_LogicalAnd(m_Value(ALHS), m_Value(ARHS))))) {
9693 // FIXME: Make this non-recursion.
9694 if (std::optional<bool> Implication = isImpliedCondition(
9695 ALHS, RHSPred, RHSOp0, RHSOp1, DL, LHSIsTrue, Depth + 1))
9696 return Implication;
9697 if (std::optional<bool> Implication = isImpliedCondition(
9698 ARHS, RHSPred, RHSOp0, RHSOp1, DL, LHSIsTrue, Depth + 1))
9699 return Implication;
9700 return std::nullopt;
9701 }
9702 return std::nullopt;
9703}
9704
9705std::optional<bool>
9707 const Value *RHSOp0, const Value *RHSOp1,
9708 const DataLayout &DL, bool LHSIsTrue, unsigned Depth) {
9709 // Bail out when we hit the limit.
9711 return std::nullopt;
9712
9713 // A mismatch occurs when we compare a scalar cmp to a vector cmp, for
9714 // example.
9715 if (RHSOp0->getType()->isVectorTy() != LHS->getType()->isVectorTy())
9716 return std::nullopt;
9717
9718 assert(LHS->getType()->isIntOrIntVectorTy(1) &&
9719 "Expected integer type only!");
9720
9721 // Match not
9722 if (match(LHS, m_Not(m_Value(LHS))))
9723 LHSIsTrue = !LHSIsTrue;
9724
9725 // Both LHS and RHS are icmps.
9726 if (RHSOp0->getType()->getScalarType()->isIntOrPtrTy()) {
9727 if (const auto *LHSCmp = dyn_cast<ICmpInst>(LHS))
9728 return isImpliedCondICmps(LHSCmp->getCmpPredicate(),
9729 LHSCmp->getOperand(0), LHSCmp->getOperand(1),
9730 RHSPred, RHSOp0, RHSOp1, DL, LHSIsTrue);
9731 const Value *V;
9732 if (match(LHS, m_NUWTrunc(m_Value(V))))
9734 ConstantInt::get(V->getType(), 0), RHSPred,
9735 RHSOp0, RHSOp1, DL, LHSIsTrue);
9736 } else {
9737 assert(RHSOp0->getType()->isFPOrFPVectorTy() &&
9738 "Expected floating point type only!");
9739 if (const auto *LHSCmp = dyn_cast<FCmpInst>(LHS))
9740 return isImpliedCondFCmps(LHSCmp->getPredicate(), LHSCmp->getOperand(0),
9741 LHSCmp->getOperand(1), RHSPred, RHSOp0, RHSOp1,
9742 DL, LHSIsTrue);
9743 }
9744
9745 /// The LHS should be an 'or', 'and', or a 'select' instruction. We expect
9746 /// the RHS to be an icmp.
9747 /// FIXME: Add support for and/or/select on the RHS.
9748 if (const Instruction *LHSI = dyn_cast<Instruction>(LHS)) {
9749 if ((LHSI->getOpcode() == Instruction::And ||
9750 LHSI->getOpcode() == Instruction::Or ||
9751 LHSI->getOpcode() == Instruction::Select))
9752 return isImpliedCondAndOr(LHSI, RHSPred, RHSOp0, RHSOp1, DL, LHSIsTrue,
9753 Depth);
9754 }
9755 return std::nullopt;
9756}
9757
9758std::optional<bool> llvm::isImpliedCondition(const Value *LHS, const Value *RHS,
9759 const DataLayout &DL,
9760 bool LHSIsTrue, unsigned Depth) {
9761 // LHS ==> RHS by definition
9762 if (LHS == RHS)
9763 return LHSIsTrue;
9764
9765 // Match not
9766 bool InvertRHS = false;
9767 if (match(RHS, m_Not(m_Value(RHS)))) {
9768 if (LHS == RHS)
9769 return !LHSIsTrue;
9770 InvertRHS = true;
9771 }
9772
9773 if (const ICmpInst *RHSCmp = dyn_cast<ICmpInst>(RHS)) {
9774 if (auto Implied = isImpliedCondition(
9775 LHS, RHSCmp->getCmpPredicate(), RHSCmp->getOperand(0),
9776 RHSCmp->getOperand(1), DL, LHSIsTrue, Depth))
9777 return InvertRHS ? !*Implied : *Implied;
9778 return std::nullopt;
9779 }
9780 if (const FCmpInst *RHSCmp = dyn_cast<FCmpInst>(RHS)) {
9781 if (auto Implied = isImpliedCondition(
9782 LHS, RHSCmp->getPredicate(), RHSCmp->getOperand(0),
9783 RHSCmp->getOperand(1), DL, LHSIsTrue, Depth))
9784 return InvertRHS ? !*Implied : *Implied;
9785 return std::nullopt;
9786 }
9787
9788 const Value *V;
9789 if (match(RHS, m_NUWTrunc(m_Value(V)))) {
9790 if (auto Implied = isImpliedCondition(LHS, CmpInst::ICMP_NE, V,
9791 ConstantInt::get(V->getType(), 0), DL,
9792 LHSIsTrue, Depth))
9793 return InvertRHS ? !*Implied : *Implied;
9794 return std::nullopt;
9795 }
9796
9798 return std::nullopt;
9799
9800 // LHS ==> (RHS1 || RHS2) if LHS ==> RHS1 or LHS ==> RHS2
9801 // LHS ==> !(RHS1 && RHS2) if LHS ==> !RHS1 or LHS ==> !RHS2
9802 const Value *RHS1, *RHS2;
9803 if (match(RHS, m_LogicalOr(m_Value(RHS1), m_Value(RHS2)))) {
9804 if (std::optional<bool> Imp =
9805 isImpliedCondition(LHS, RHS1, DL, LHSIsTrue, Depth + 1))
9806 if (*Imp == true)
9807 return !InvertRHS;
9808 if (std::optional<bool> Imp =
9809 isImpliedCondition(LHS, RHS2, DL, LHSIsTrue, Depth + 1))
9810 if (*Imp == true)
9811 return !InvertRHS;
9812 }
9813 if (match(RHS, m_LogicalAnd(m_Value(RHS1), m_Value(RHS2)))) {
9814 if (std::optional<bool> Imp =
9815 isImpliedCondition(LHS, RHS1, DL, LHSIsTrue, Depth + 1))
9816 if (*Imp == false)
9817 return InvertRHS;
9818 if (std::optional<bool> Imp =
9819 isImpliedCondition(LHS, RHS2, DL, LHSIsTrue, Depth + 1))
9820 if (*Imp == false)
9821 return InvertRHS;
9822 }
9823
9824 return std::nullopt;
9825}
9826
9827// Returns a pair (Condition, ConditionIsTrue), where Condition is a branch
9828// condition dominating ContextI or nullptr, if no condition is found.
9829static std::pair<Value *, bool>
9831 if (!ContextI || !ContextI->getParent())
9832 return {nullptr, false};
9833
9834 // TODO: This is a poor/cheap way to determine dominance. Should we use a
9835 // dominator tree (eg, from a SimplifyQuery) instead?
9836 const BasicBlock *ContextBB = ContextI->getParent();
9837 const BasicBlock *PredBB = ContextBB->getSinglePredecessor();
9838 if (!PredBB)
9839 return {nullptr, false};
9840
9841 // We need a conditional branch in the predecessor.
9842 Value *PredCond;
9843 BasicBlock *TrueBB, *FalseBB;
9844 if (!match(PredBB->getTerminator(), m_Br(m_Value(PredCond), TrueBB, FalseBB)))
9845 return {nullptr, false};
9846
9847 // The branch should get simplified. Don't bother simplifying this condition.
9848 if (TrueBB == FalseBB)
9849 return {nullptr, false};
9850
9851 assert((TrueBB == ContextBB || FalseBB == ContextBB) &&
9852 "Predecessor block does not point to successor?");
9853
9854 // Is this condition implied by the predecessor condition?
9855 return {PredCond, TrueBB == ContextBB};
9856}
9857
9858std::optional<bool> llvm::isImpliedByDomCondition(const Value *Cond,
9859 const Instruction *ContextI,
9860 const DataLayout &DL) {
9861 assert(Cond->getType()->isIntOrIntVectorTy(1) && "Condition must be bool");
9862 auto PredCond = getDomPredecessorCondition(ContextI);
9863 if (PredCond.first)
9864 return isImpliedCondition(PredCond.first, Cond, DL, PredCond.second);
9865 return std::nullopt;
9866}
9867
9869 const Value *LHS,
9870 const Value *RHS,
9871 const Instruction *ContextI,
9872 const DataLayout &DL) {
9873 auto PredCond = getDomPredecessorCondition(ContextI);
9874 if (PredCond.first)
9875 return isImpliedCondition(PredCond.first, Pred, LHS, RHS, DL,
9876 PredCond.second);
9877 return std::nullopt;
9878}
9879
9881 APInt &Upper, const InstrInfoQuery &IIQ,
9882 bool PreferSignedRange) {
9883 unsigned Width = Lower.getBitWidth();
9884 const APInt *C;
9885 switch (BO.getOpcode()) {
9886 case Instruction::Sub:
9887 if (match(BO.getOperand(0), m_APInt(C))) {
9888 bool HasNSW = IIQ.hasNoSignedWrap(&BO);
9889 bool HasNUW = IIQ.hasNoUnsignedWrap(&BO);
9890
9891 // If the caller expects a signed compare, then try to use a signed range.
9892 // Otherwise if both no-wraps are set, use the unsigned range because it
9893 // is never larger than the signed range. Example:
9894 // "sub nuw nsw i8 -2, x" is unsigned [0, 254] vs. signed [-128, 126].
9895 // "sub nuw nsw i8 2, x" is unsigned [0, 2] vs. signed [-125, 127].
9896 if (PreferSignedRange && HasNSW && HasNUW)
9897 HasNUW = false;
9898
9899 if (HasNUW) {
9900 // 'sub nuw c, x' produces [0, C].
9901 Upper = *C + 1;
9902 } else if (HasNSW) {
9903 if (C->isNegative()) {
9904 // 'sub nsw -C, x' produces [SINT_MIN, -C - SINT_MIN].
9906 Upper = *C - APInt::getSignedMaxValue(Width);
9907 } else {
9908 // Note that sub 0, INT_MIN is not NSW. It techically is a signed wrap
9909 // 'sub nsw C, x' produces [C - SINT_MAX, SINT_MAX].
9910 Lower = *C - APInt::getSignedMaxValue(Width);
9912 }
9913 }
9914 }
9915 break;
9916 case Instruction::Add:
9917 if (match(BO.getOperand(1), m_APInt(C)) && !C->isZero()) {
9918 bool HasNSW = IIQ.hasNoSignedWrap(&BO);
9919 bool HasNUW = IIQ.hasNoUnsignedWrap(&BO);
9920
9921 // If the caller expects a signed compare, then try to use a signed
9922 // range. Otherwise if both no-wraps are set, use the unsigned range
9923 // because it is never larger than the signed range. Example: "add nuw
9924 // nsw i8 X, -2" is unsigned [254,255] vs. signed [-128, 125].
9925 if (PreferSignedRange && HasNSW && HasNUW)
9926 HasNUW = false;
9927
9928 if (HasNUW) {
9929 // 'add nuw x, C' produces [C, UINT_MAX].
9930 Lower = *C;
9931 } else if (HasNSW) {
9932 if (C->isNegative()) {
9933 // 'add nsw x, -C' produces [SINT_MIN, SINT_MAX - C].
9935 Upper = APInt::getSignedMaxValue(Width) + *C + 1;
9936 } else {
9937 // 'add nsw x, +C' produces [SINT_MIN + C, SINT_MAX].
9938 Lower = APInt::getSignedMinValue(Width) + *C;
9939 Upper = APInt::getSignedMaxValue(Width) + 1;
9940 }
9941 }
9942 }
9943 break;
9944
9945 case Instruction::And:
9946 if (match(BO.getOperand(1), m_APInt(C)))
9947 // 'and x, C' produces [0, C].
9948 Upper = *C + 1;
9949 // X & -X is a power of two or zero. So we can cap the value at max power of
9950 // two.
9951 if (match(BO.getOperand(0), m_Neg(m_Specific(BO.getOperand(1)))) ||
9952 match(BO.getOperand(1), m_Neg(m_Specific(BO.getOperand(0)))))
9953 Upper = APInt::getSignedMinValue(Width) + 1;
9954 break;
9955
9956 case Instruction::Or:
9957 if (match(BO.getOperand(1), m_APInt(C)))
9958 // 'or x, C' produces [C, UINT_MAX].
9959 Lower = *C;
9960 break;
9961
9962 case Instruction::AShr:
9963 if (match(BO.getOperand(1), m_APInt(C)) && C->ult(Width)) {
9964 // 'ashr x, C' produces [INT_MIN >> C, INT_MAX >> C].
9966 Upper = APInt::getSignedMaxValue(Width).ashr(*C) + 1;
9967 } else if (match(BO.getOperand(0), m_APInt(C))) {
9968 unsigned ShiftAmount = Width - 1;
9969 if (!C->isZero() && IIQ.isExact(&BO))
9970 ShiftAmount = C->countr_zero();
9971 if (C->isNegative()) {
9972 // 'ashr C, x' produces [C, C >> (Width-1)]
9973 Lower = *C;
9974 Upper = C->ashr(ShiftAmount) + 1;
9975 } else {
9976 // 'ashr C, x' produces [C >> (Width-1), C]
9977 Lower = C->ashr(ShiftAmount);
9978 Upper = *C + 1;
9979 }
9980 }
9981 break;
9982
9983 case Instruction::LShr:
9984 if (match(BO.getOperand(1), m_APInt(C)) && C->ult(Width)) {
9985 // 'lshr x, C' produces [0, UINT_MAX >> C].
9986 Upper = APInt::getAllOnes(Width).lshr(*C) + 1;
9987 } else if (match(BO.getOperand(0), m_APInt(C))) {
9988 // 'lshr C, x' produces [C >> (Width-1), C].
9989 unsigned ShiftAmount = Width - 1;
9990 if (!C->isZero() && IIQ.isExact(&BO))
9991 ShiftAmount = C->countr_zero();
9992 Lower = C->lshr(ShiftAmount);
9993 Upper = *C + 1;
9994 }
9995 break;
9996
9997 case Instruction::Shl:
9998 if (match(BO.getOperand(0), m_APInt(C))) {
9999 if (IIQ.hasNoUnsignedWrap(&BO)) {
10000 // 'shl nuw C, x' produces [C, C << CLZ(C)]
10001 Lower = *C;
10002 Upper = Lower.shl(Lower.countl_zero()) + 1;
10003 } else if (BO.hasNoSignedWrap()) { // TODO: What if both nuw+nsw?
10004 if (C->isNegative()) {
10005 // 'shl nsw C, x' produces [C << CLO(C)-1, C]
10006 unsigned ShiftAmount = C->countl_one() - 1;
10007 Lower = C->shl(ShiftAmount);
10008 Upper = *C + 1;
10009 } else {
10010 // 'shl nsw C, x' produces [C, C << CLZ(C)-1]
10011 unsigned ShiftAmount = C->countl_zero() - 1;
10012 Lower = *C;
10013 Upper = C->shl(ShiftAmount) + 1;
10014 }
10015 } else {
10016 // If lowbit is set, value can never be zero.
10017 if ((*C)[0])
10018 Lower = APInt::getOneBitSet(Width, 0);
10019 // If we are shifting a constant the largest it can be is if the longest
10020 // sequence of consecutive ones is shifted to the highbits (breaking
10021 // ties for which sequence is higher). At the moment we take a liberal
10022 // upper bound on this by just popcounting the constant.
10023 // TODO: There may be a bitwise trick for it longest/highest
10024 // consecutative sequence of ones (naive method is O(Width) loop).
10025 Upper = APInt::getHighBitsSet(Width, C->popcount()) + 1;
10026 }
10027 } else if (match(BO.getOperand(1), m_APInt(C)) && C->ult(Width)) {
10028 Upper = APInt::getBitsSetFrom(Width, C->getZExtValue()) + 1;
10029 }
10030 break;
10031
10032 case Instruction::SDiv:
10033 if (match(BO.getOperand(1), m_APInt(C))) {
10034 APInt IntMin = APInt::getSignedMinValue(Width);
10035 APInt IntMax = APInt::getSignedMaxValue(Width);
10036 if (C->isAllOnes()) {
10037 // 'sdiv x, -1' produces [INT_MIN + 1, INT_MAX]
10038 // where C != -1 and C != 0 and C != 1
10039 Lower = IntMin + 1;
10040 Upper = IntMax + 1;
10041 } else if (C->countl_zero() < Width - 1) {
10042 // 'sdiv x, C' produces [INT_MIN / C, INT_MAX / C]
10043 // where C != -1 and C != 0 and C != 1
10044 Lower = IntMin.sdiv(*C);
10045 Upper = IntMax.sdiv(*C);
10046 if (Lower.sgt(Upper))
10048 Upper = Upper + 1;
10049 assert(Upper != Lower && "Upper part of range has wrapped!");
10050 }
10051 } else if (match(BO.getOperand(0), m_APInt(C))) {
10052 if (C->isMinSignedValue()) {
10053 // 'sdiv INT_MIN, x' produces [INT_MIN, INT_MIN / -2].
10054 Lower = *C;
10055 Upper = Lower.lshr(1) + 1;
10056 } else {
10057 // 'sdiv C, x' produces [-|C|, |C|].
10058 Upper = C->abs() + 1;
10059 Lower = (-Upper) + 1;
10060 }
10061 }
10062 break;
10063
10064 case Instruction::UDiv:
10065 if (match(BO.getOperand(1), m_APInt(C)) && !C->isZero()) {
10066 // 'udiv x, C' produces [0, UINT_MAX / C].
10067 Upper = APInt::getMaxValue(Width).udiv(*C) + 1;
10068 } else if (match(BO.getOperand(0), m_APInt(C))) {
10069 // 'udiv C, x' produces [0, C].
10070 Upper = *C + 1;
10071 }
10072 break;
10073
10074 case Instruction::SRem:
10075 if (match(BO.getOperand(1), m_APInt(C))) {
10076 // 'srem x, C' produces (-|C|, |C|).
10077 Upper = C->abs();
10078 Lower = (-Upper) + 1;
10079 } else if (match(BO.getOperand(0), m_APInt(C))) {
10080 if (C->isNegative()) {
10081 // 'srem -|C|, x' produces [-|C|, 0].
10082 Upper = 1;
10083 Lower = *C;
10084 } else {
10085 // 'srem |C|, x' produces [0, |C|].
10086 Upper = *C + 1;
10087 }
10088 }
10089 break;
10090
10091 case Instruction::URem:
10092 if (match(BO.getOperand(1), m_APInt(C)))
10093 // 'urem x, C' produces [0, C).
10094 Upper = *C;
10095 else if (match(BO.getOperand(0), m_APInt(C)))
10096 // 'urem C, x' produces [0, C].
10097 Upper = *C + 1;
10098 break;
10099
10100 default:
10101 break;
10102 }
10103}
10104
10106 bool UseInstrInfo) {
10107 unsigned Width = II.getType()->getScalarSizeInBits();
10108 const APInt *C;
10109 switch (II.getIntrinsicID()) {
10110 case Intrinsic::ctlz:
10111 case Intrinsic::cttz: {
10112 APInt Upper(Width, Width);
10113 if (!UseInstrInfo || !match(II.getArgOperand(1), m_One()))
10114 Upper += 1;
10115 // Maximum of set/clear bits is the bit width.
10117 }
10118 case Intrinsic::ctpop:
10119 // Maximum of set/clear bits is the bit width.
10121 APInt(Width, Width) + 1);
10122 case Intrinsic::uadd_sat:
10123 // uadd.sat(x, C) produces [C, UINT_MAX].
10124 if (match(II.getOperand(0), m_APInt(C)) ||
10125 match(II.getOperand(1), m_APInt(C)))
10127 break;
10128 case Intrinsic::sadd_sat:
10129 if (match(II.getOperand(0), m_APInt(C)) ||
10130 match(II.getOperand(1), m_APInt(C))) {
10131 if (C->isNegative())
10132 // sadd.sat(x, -C) produces [SINT_MIN, SINT_MAX + (-C)].
10134 APInt::getSignedMaxValue(Width) + *C +
10135 1);
10136
10137 // sadd.sat(x, +C) produces [SINT_MIN + C, SINT_MAX].
10139 APInt::getSignedMaxValue(Width) + 1);
10140 }
10141 break;
10142 case Intrinsic::usub_sat:
10143 // usub.sat(C, x) produces [0, C].
10144 if (match(II.getOperand(0), m_APInt(C)))
10145 return ConstantRange::getNonEmpty(APInt::getZero(Width), *C + 1);
10146
10147 // usub.sat(x, C) produces [0, UINT_MAX - C].
10148 if (match(II.getOperand(1), m_APInt(C)))
10150 APInt::getMaxValue(Width) - *C + 1);
10151 break;
10152 case Intrinsic::ssub_sat:
10153 if (match(II.getOperand(0), m_APInt(C))) {
10154 if (C->isNegative())
10155 // ssub.sat(-C, x) produces [SINT_MIN, -SINT_MIN + (-C)].
10157 *C - APInt::getSignedMinValue(Width) +
10158 1);
10159
10160 // ssub.sat(+C, x) produces [-SINT_MAX + C, SINT_MAX].
10162 APInt::getSignedMaxValue(Width) + 1);
10163 } else if (match(II.getOperand(1), m_APInt(C))) {
10164 if (C->isNegative())
10165 // ssub.sat(x, -C) produces [SINT_MIN - (-C), SINT_MAX]:
10167 APInt::getSignedMaxValue(Width) + 1);
10168
10169 // ssub.sat(x, +C) produces [SINT_MIN, SINT_MAX - C].
10171 APInt::getSignedMaxValue(Width) - *C +
10172 1);
10173 }
10174 break;
10175 case Intrinsic::umin:
10176 case Intrinsic::umax:
10177 case Intrinsic::smin:
10178 case Intrinsic::smax:
10179 if (!match(II.getOperand(0), m_APInt(C)) &&
10180 !match(II.getOperand(1), m_APInt(C)))
10181 break;
10182
10183 switch (II.getIntrinsicID()) {
10184 case Intrinsic::umin:
10185 return ConstantRange::getNonEmpty(APInt::getZero(Width), *C + 1);
10186 case Intrinsic::umax:
10188 case Intrinsic::smin:
10190 *C + 1);
10191 case Intrinsic::smax:
10193 APInt::getSignedMaxValue(Width) + 1);
10194 default:
10195 llvm_unreachable("Must be min/max intrinsic");
10196 }
10197 break;
10198 case Intrinsic::abs:
10199 // If abs of SIGNED_MIN is poison, then the result is [0..SIGNED_MAX],
10200 // otherwise it is [0..SIGNED_MIN], as -SIGNED_MIN == SIGNED_MIN.
10201 if (match(II.getOperand(1), m_One()))
10203 APInt::getSignedMaxValue(Width) + 1);
10204
10206 APInt::getSignedMinValue(Width) + 1);
10207 case Intrinsic::vscale:
10208 if (!II.getParent() || !II.getFunction())
10209 break;
10210 return getVScaleRange(II.getFunction(), Width);
10211 default:
10212 break;
10213 }
10214
10215 return ConstantRange::getFull(Width);
10216}
10217
10219 const InstrInfoQuery &IIQ) {
10220 unsigned BitWidth = SI.getType()->getScalarSizeInBits();
10221 const Value *LHS = nullptr, *RHS = nullptr;
10223 if (R.Flavor == SPF_UNKNOWN)
10224 return ConstantRange::getFull(BitWidth);
10225
10226 if (R.Flavor == SelectPatternFlavor::SPF_ABS) {
10227 // If the negation part of the abs (in RHS) has the NSW flag,
10228 // then the result of abs(X) is [0..SIGNED_MAX],
10229 // otherwise it is [0..SIGNED_MIN], as -SIGNED_MIN == SIGNED_MIN.
10230 if (match(RHS, m_Neg(m_Specific(LHS))) &&
10234
10237 }
10238
10239 if (R.Flavor == SelectPatternFlavor::SPF_NABS) {
10240 // The result of -abs(X) is <= 0.
10242 APInt(BitWidth, 1));
10243 }
10244
10245 const APInt *C;
10246 if (!match(LHS, m_APInt(C)) && !match(RHS, m_APInt(C)))
10247 return ConstantRange::getFull(BitWidth);
10248
10249 switch (R.Flavor) {
10250 case SPF_UMIN:
10252 case SPF_UMAX:
10254 case SPF_SMIN:
10256 *C + 1);
10257 case SPF_SMAX:
10260 default:
10261 return ConstantRange::getFull(BitWidth);
10262 }
10263}
10264
10266 // The maximum representable value of a half is 65504. For floats the maximum
10267 // value is 3.4e38 which requires roughly 129 bits.
10268 unsigned BitWidth = I->getType()->getScalarSizeInBits();
10269 if (!I->getOperand(0)->getType()->getScalarType()->isHalfTy())
10270 return;
10271 if (isa<FPToSIInst>(I) && BitWidth >= 17) {
10272 Lower = APInt(BitWidth, -65504, true);
10273 Upper = APInt(BitWidth, 65505);
10274 }
10275
10276 if (isa<FPToUIInst>(I) && BitWidth >= 16) {
10277 // For a fptoui the lower limit is left as 0.
10278 Upper = APInt(BitWidth, 65505);
10279 }
10280}
10281
10283 bool UseInstrInfo, AssumptionCache *AC,
10284 const Instruction *CtxI,
10285 const DominatorTree *DT,
10286 unsigned Depth) {
10287 assert(V->getType()->isIntOrIntVectorTy() && "Expected integer instruction");
10288
10290 return ConstantRange::getFull(V->getType()->getScalarSizeInBits());
10291
10292 if (auto *C = dyn_cast<Constant>(V))
10293 return C->toConstantRange();
10294
10295 unsigned BitWidth = V->getType()->getScalarSizeInBits();
10296 InstrInfoQuery IIQ(UseInstrInfo);
10297 ConstantRange CR = ConstantRange::getFull(BitWidth);
10298 if (auto *BO = dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(V)) {
10299 APInt Lower = APInt(BitWidth, 0);
10300 APInt Upper = APInt(BitWidth, 0);
10301 // TODO: Return ConstantRange.
10302 setLimitsForBinOp(*BO, Lower, Upper, IIQ, ForSigned);
10304 } else if (auto *II = dyn_cast<IntrinsicInst>(V))
10305 CR = getRangeForIntrinsic(*II, UseInstrInfo);
10306 else if (auto *SI = dyn_cast<SelectInst>(V)) {
10308 SI->getTrueValue(), ForSigned, UseInstrInfo, AC, CtxI, DT, Depth + 1);
10310 SI->getFalseValue(), ForSigned, UseInstrInfo, AC, CtxI, DT, Depth + 1);
10311 CR = CRTrue.unionWith(CRFalse);
10313 } else if (isa<FPToUIInst>(V) || isa<FPToSIInst>(V)) {
10314 APInt Lower = APInt(BitWidth, 0);
10315 APInt Upper = APInt(BitWidth, 0);
10316 // TODO: Return ConstantRange.
10319 } else if (const auto *A = dyn_cast<Argument>(V))
10320 if (std::optional<ConstantRange> Range = A->getRange())
10321 CR = *Range;
10322
10323 if (auto *I = dyn_cast<Instruction>(V)) {
10324 if (auto *Range = IIQ.getMetadata(I, LLVMContext::MD_range))
10326
10327 if (const auto *CB = dyn_cast<CallBase>(V))
10328 if (std::optional<ConstantRange> Range = CB->getRange())
10329 CR = CR.intersectWith(*Range);
10330 }
10331
10332 if (CtxI && AC) {
10333 // Try to restrict the range based on information from assumptions.
10334 for (auto &AssumeVH : AC->assumptionsFor(V)) {
10335 if (!AssumeVH)
10336 continue;
10337 CallInst *I = cast<CallInst>(AssumeVH);
10338 assert(I->getParent()->getParent() == CtxI->getParent()->getParent() &&
10339 "Got assumption for the wrong function!");
10340 assert(I->getIntrinsicID() == Intrinsic::assume &&
10341 "must be an assume intrinsic");
10342
10343 if (!isValidAssumeForContext(I, CtxI, DT))
10344 continue;
10345 Value *Arg = I->getArgOperand(0);
10346 ICmpInst *Cmp = dyn_cast<ICmpInst>(Arg);
10347 // Currently we just use information from comparisons.
10348 if (!Cmp || Cmp->getOperand(0) != V)
10349 continue;
10350 // TODO: Set "ForSigned" parameter via Cmp->isSigned()?
10351 ConstantRange RHS =
10352 computeConstantRange(Cmp->getOperand(1), /* ForSigned */ false,
10353 UseInstrInfo, AC, I, DT, Depth + 1);
10354 CR = CR.intersectWith(
10355 ConstantRange::makeAllowedICmpRegion(Cmp->getPredicate(), RHS));
10356 }
10357 }
10358
10359 return CR;
10360}
10361
10362static void
10364 function_ref<void(Value *)> InsertAffected) {
10365 assert(V != nullptr);
10366 if (isa<Argument>(V) || isa<GlobalValue>(V)) {
10367 InsertAffected(V);
10368 } else if (auto *I = dyn_cast<Instruction>(V)) {
10369 InsertAffected(V);
10370
10371 // Peek through unary operators to find the source of the condition.
10372 Value *Op;
10375 InsertAffected(Op);
10376 }
10377 }
10378}
10379
10381 Value *Cond, bool IsAssume, function_ref<void(Value *)> InsertAffected) {
10382 auto AddAffected = [&InsertAffected](Value *V) {
10383 addValueAffectedByCondition(V, InsertAffected);
10384 };
10385
10386 auto AddCmpOperands = [&AddAffected, IsAssume](Value *LHS, Value *RHS) {
10387 if (IsAssume) {
10388 AddAffected(LHS);
10389 AddAffected(RHS);
10390 } else if (match(RHS, m_Constant()))
10391 AddAffected(LHS);
10392 };
10393
10394 SmallVector<Value *, 8> Worklist;
10396 Worklist.push_back(Cond);
10397 while (!Worklist.empty()) {
10398 Value *V = Worklist.pop_back_val();
10399 if (!Visited.insert(V).second)
10400 continue;
10401
10402 CmpPredicate Pred;
10403 Value *A, *B, *X;
10404
10405 if (IsAssume) {
10406 AddAffected(V);
10407 if (match(V, m_Not(m_Value(X))))
10408 AddAffected(X);
10409 }
10410
10411 if (match(V, m_LogicalOp(m_Value(A), m_Value(B)))) {
10412 // assume(A && B) is split to -> assume(A); assume(B);
10413 // assume(!(A || B)) is split to -> assume(!A); assume(!B);
10414 // Finally, assume(A || B) / assume(!(A && B)) generally don't provide
10415 // enough information to be worth handling (intersection of information as
10416 // opposed to union).
10417 if (!IsAssume) {
10418 Worklist.push_back(A);
10419 Worklist.push_back(B);
10420 }
10421 } else if (match(V, m_ICmp(Pred, m_Value(A), m_Value(B)))) {
10422 bool HasRHSC = match(B, m_ConstantInt());
10423 if (ICmpInst::isEquality(Pred)) {
10424 AddAffected(A);
10425 if (IsAssume)
10426 AddAffected(B);
10427 if (HasRHSC) {
10428 Value *Y;
10429 // (X << C) or (X >>_s C) or (X >>_u C).
10430 if (match(A, m_Shift(m_Value(X), m_ConstantInt())))
10431 AddAffected(X);
10432 // (X & C) or (X | C).
10433 else if (match(A, m_And(m_Value(X), m_Value(Y))) ||
10434 match(A, m_Or(m_Value(X), m_Value(Y)))) {
10435 AddAffected(X);
10436 AddAffected(Y);
10437 }
10438 // X - Y
10439 else if (match(A, m_Sub(m_Value(X), m_Value(Y)))) {
10440 AddAffected(X);
10441 AddAffected(Y);
10442 }
10443 }
10444 } else {
10445 AddCmpOperands(A, B);
10446 if (HasRHSC) {
10447 // Handle (A + C1) u< C2, which is the canonical form of
10448 // A > C3 && A < C4.
10450 AddAffected(X);
10451
10452 if (ICmpInst::isUnsigned(Pred)) {
10453 Value *Y;
10454 // X & Y u> C -> X >u C && Y >u C
10455 // X | Y u< C -> X u< C && Y u< C
10456 // X nuw+ Y u< C -> X u< C && Y u< C
10457 if (match(A, m_And(m_Value(X), m_Value(Y))) ||
10458 match(A, m_Or(m_Value(X), m_Value(Y))) ||
10459 match(A, m_NUWAdd(m_Value(X), m_Value(Y)))) {
10460 AddAffected(X);
10461 AddAffected(Y);
10462 }
10463 // X nuw- Y u> C -> X u> C
10464 if (match(A, m_NUWSub(m_Value(X), m_Value())))
10465 AddAffected(X);
10466 }
10467 }
10468
10469 // Handle icmp slt/sgt (bitcast X to int), 0/-1, which is supported
10470 // by computeKnownFPClass().
10472 if (Pred == ICmpInst::ICMP_SLT && match(B, m_Zero()))
10473 InsertAffected(X);
10474 else if (Pred == ICmpInst::ICMP_SGT && match(B, m_AllOnes()))
10475 InsertAffected(X);
10476 }
10477 }
10478
10479 if (HasRHSC && match(A, m_Intrinsic<Intrinsic::ctpop>(m_Value(X))))
10480 AddAffected(X);
10481 } else if (match(V, m_FCmp(Pred, m_Value(A), m_Value(B)))) {
10482 AddCmpOperands(A, B);
10483
10484 // fcmp fneg(x), y
10485 // fcmp fabs(x), y
10486 // fcmp fneg(fabs(x)), y
10487 if (match(A, m_FNeg(m_Value(A))))
10488 AddAffected(A);
10489 if (match(A, m_FAbs(m_Value(A))))
10490 AddAffected(A);
10491
10493 m_Value()))) {
10494 // Handle patterns that computeKnownFPClass() support.
10495 AddAffected(A);
10496 } else if (!IsAssume && match(V, m_Trunc(m_Value(X)))) {
10497 // Assume is checked here as X is already added above for assumes in
10498 // addValueAffectedByCondition
10499 AddAffected(X);
10500 } else if (!IsAssume && match(V, m_Not(m_Value(X)))) {
10501 // Assume is checked here to avoid issues with ephemeral values
10502 Worklist.push_back(X);
10503 }
10504 }
10505}
10506
10508 // (X >> C) or/add (X & mask(C) != 0)
10509 if (const auto *BO = dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(V)) {
10510 if (BO->getOpcode() == Instruction::Add ||
10511 BO->getOpcode() == Instruction::Or) {
10512 const Value *X;
10513 const APInt *C1, *C2;
10514 if (match(BO, m_c_BinOp(m_LShr(m_Value(X), m_APInt(C1)),
10518 m_Zero())))) &&
10519 C2->popcount() == C1->getZExtValue())
10520 return X;
10521 }
10522 }
10523 return nullptr;
10524}
10525
10527 return const_cast<Value *>(stripNullTest(const_cast<const Value *>(V)));
10528}
10529
10532 unsigned MaxCount, bool AllowUndefOrPoison) {
10535 auto Push = [&](const Value *V) -> bool {
10536 Constant *C;
10537 if (match(const_cast<Value *>(V), m_ImmConstant(C))) {
10538 if (!AllowUndefOrPoison && !isGuaranteedNotToBeUndefOrPoison(C))
10539 return false;
10540 // Check existence first to avoid unnecessary allocations.
10541 if (Constants.contains(C))
10542 return true;
10543 if (Constants.size() == MaxCount)
10544 return false;
10545 Constants.insert(C);
10546 return true;
10547 }
10548
10549 if (auto *Inst = dyn_cast<Instruction>(V)) {
10550 if (Visited.insert(Inst).second)
10551 Worklist.push_back(Inst);
10552 return true;
10553 }
10554 return false;
10555 };
10556 if (!Push(V))
10557 return false;
10558 while (!Worklist.empty()) {
10559 const Instruction *CurInst = Worklist.pop_back_val();
10560 switch (CurInst->getOpcode()) {
10561 case Instruction::Select:
10562 if (!Push(CurInst->getOperand(1)))
10563 return false;
10564 if (!Push(CurInst->getOperand(2)))
10565 return false;
10566 break;
10567 case Instruction::PHI:
10568 for (Value *IncomingValue : cast<PHINode>(CurInst)->incoming_values()) {
10569 // Fast path for recurrence PHI.
10570 if (IncomingValue == CurInst)
10571 continue;
10572 if (!Push(IncomingValue))
10573 return false;
10574 }
10575 break;
10576 default:
10577 return false;
10578 }
10579 }
10580 return true;
10581}
assert(UImm &&(UImm !=~static_cast< T >(0)) &&"Invalid immediate!")
AMDGPU Register Bank Select
Rewrite undef for PHI
This file declares a class to represent arbitrary precision floating point values and provide a varie...
This file implements a class to represent arbitrary precision integral constant values and operations...
MachineBasicBlock MachineBasicBlock::iterator DebugLoc DL
Function Alias Analysis Results
This file contains the simple types necessary to represent the attributes associated with functions a...
static GCRegistry::Add< ErlangGC > A("erlang", "erlang-compatible garbage collector")
static GCRegistry::Add< StatepointGC > D("statepoint-example", "an example strategy for statepoint")
static GCRegistry::Add< CoreCLRGC > E("coreclr", "CoreCLR-compatible GC")
static GCRegistry::Add< OcamlGC > B("ocaml", "ocaml 3.10-compatible GC")
This file contains the declarations for the subclasses of Constant, which represent the different fla...
Utilities for dealing with flags related to floating point properties and mode controls.
static Value * getCondition(Instruction *I)
Hexagon Common GEP
Module.h This file contains the declarations for the Module class.
static bool hasNoUnsignedWrap(BinaryOperator &I)
#define F(x, y, z)
Definition MD5.cpp:54
#define I(x, y, z)
Definition MD5.cpp:57
This file contains the declarations for metadata subclasses.
ConstantRange Range(APInt(BitWidth, Low), APInt(BitWidth, High))
uint64_t IntrinsicInst * II
#define P(N)
PowerPC Reduce CR logical Operation
R600 Clause Merge
const SmallVectorImpl< MachineOperand > & Cond
static cl::opt< RegAllocEvictionAdvisorAnalysisLegacy::AdvisorMode > Mode("regalloc-enable-advisor", cl::Hidden, cl::init(RegAllocEvictionAdvisorAnalysisLegacy::AdvisorMode::Default), cl::desc("Enable regalloc advisor mode"), cl::values(clEnumValN(RegAllocEvictionAdvisorAnalysisLegacy::AdvisorMode::Default, "default", "Default"), clEnumValN(RegAllocEvictionAdvisorAnalysisLegacy::AdvisorMode::Release, "release", "precompiled"), clEnumValN(RegAllocEvictionAdvisorAnalysisLegacy::AdvisorMode::Development, "development", "for training")))
std::pair< BasicBlock *, BasicBlock * > Edge
This file contains some templates that are useful if you are working with the STL at all.
This file defines the make_scope_exit function, which executes user-defined cleanup logic at scope ex...
This file defines the SmallPtrSet class.
This file defines the SmallVector class.
static TableGen::Emitter::Opt Y("gen-skeleton-entry", EmitSkeleton, "Generate example skeleton entry")
static TableGen::Emitter::OptClass< SkeletonEmitter > X("gen-skeleton-class", "Generate example skeleton class")
static std::optional< unsigned > getOpcode(ArrayRef< VPValue * > Values)
Returns the opcode of Values or ~0 if they do not all agree.
Definition VPlanSLP.cpp:247
static SmallVector< VPValue *, 4 > getOperands(ArrayRef< VPValue * > Values, unsigned OperandIndex)
Definition VPlanSLP.cpp:210
static void computeKnownFPClassFromCond(const Value *V, Value *Cond, bool CondIsTrue, const Instruction *CxtI, KnownFPClass &KnownFromContext, unsigned Depth=0)
static bool isPowerOfTwoRecurrence(const PHINode *PN, bool OrZero, SimplifyQuery &Q, unsigned Depth)
Try to detect a recurrence that the value of the induction variable is always a power of two (or zero...
static cl::opt< unsigned > DomConditionsMaxUses("dom-conditions-max-uses", cl::Hidden, cl::init(20))
static unsigned computeNumSignBitsVectorConstant(const Value *V, const APInt &DemandedElts, unsigned TyBits)
For vector constants, loop over the elements and find the constant with the minimum number of sign bi...
static bool isTruePredicate(CmpInst::Predicate Pred, const Value *LHS, const Value *RHS)
Return true if "icmp Pred LHS RHS" is always true.
static bool isModifyingBinopOfNonZero(const Value *V1, const Value *V2, const APInt &DemandedElts, const SimplifyQuery &Q, unsigned Depth)
Return true if V1 == (binop V2, X), where X is known non-zero.
static bool isGEPKnownNonNull(const GEPOperator *GEP, const SimplifyQuery &Q, unsigned Depth)
Test whether a GEP's result is known to be non-null.
static bool isNonEqualShl(const Value *V1, const Value *V2, const APInt &DemandedElts, const SimplifyQuery &Q, unsigned Depth)
Return true if V2 == V1 << C, where V1 is known non-zero, C is not 0 and the shift is nuw or nsw.
static bool isKnownNonNullFromDominatingCondition(const Value *V, const Instruction *CtxI, const DominatorTree *DT)
static const Value * getUnderlyingObjectFromInt(const Value *V)
This is the function that does the work of looking through basic ptrtoint+arithmetic+inttoptr sequenc...
static bool isNonZeroMul(const APInt &DemandedElts, const SimplifyQuery &Q, unsigned BitWidth, Value *X, Value *Y, bool NSW, bool NUW, unsigned Depth)
static bool rangeMetadataExcludesValue(const MDNode *Ranges, const APInt &Value)
Does the 'Range' metadata (which must be a valid MD_range operand list) ensure that the value it's at...
static bool outputDenormalIsIEEEOrPosZero(const Function &F, const Type *Ty)
static KnownBits getKnownBitsFromAndXorOr(const Operator *I, const APInt &DemandedElts, const KnownBits &KnownLHS, const KnownBits &KnownRHS, const SimplifyQuery &Q, unsigned Depth)
static void breakSelfRecursivePHI(const Use *U, const PHINode *PHI, Value *&ValOut, Instruction *&CtxIOut, const PHINode **PhiOut=nullptr)
static bool isNonZeroSub(const APInt &DemandedElts, const SimplifyQuery &Q, unsigned BitWidth, Value *X, Value *Y, unsigned Depth)
static OverflowResult mapOverflowResult(ConstantRange::OverflowResult OR)
Convert ConstantRange OverflowResult into ValueTracking OverflowResult.
static void addValueAffectedByCondition(Value *V, function_ref< void(Value *)> InsertAffected)
static unsigned getBitWidth(Type *Ty, const DataLayout &DL)
Returns the bitwidth of the given scalar or pointer type.
static bool haveNoCommonBitsSetSpecialCases(const Value *LHS, const Value *RHS, const SimplifyQuery &SQ)
static void setLimitsForBinOp(const BinaryOperator &BO, APInt &Lower, APInt &Upper, const InstrInfoQuery &IIQ, bool PreferSignedRange)
static Value * lookThroughCast(CmpInst *CmpI, Value *V1, Value *V2, Instruction::CastOps *CastOp)
Helps to match a select pattern in case of a type mismatch.
static std::pair< Value *, bool > getDomPredecessorCondition(const Instruction *ContextI)
static constexpr unsigned MaxInstrsToCheckForFree
Maximum number of instructions to check between assume and context instruction.
static bool isNonZeroShift(const Operator *I, const APInt &DemandedElts, const SimplifyQuery &Q, const KnownBits &KnownVal, unsigned Depth)
static std::optional< bool > isImpliedCondFCmps(FCmpInst::Predicate LPred, const Value *L0, const Value *L1, FCmpInst::Predicate RPred, const Value *R0, const Value *R1, const DataLayout &DL, bool LHSIsTrue)
Return true if LHS implies RHS (expanded to its components as "R0 RPred R1") is true.
UndefPoisonKind
static bool isKnownNonEqualFromContext(const Value *V1, const Value *V2, const SimplifyQuery &Q, unsigned Depth)
static bool includesPoison(UndefPoisonKind Kind)
static SelectPatternResult matchFastFloatClamp(CmpInst::Predicate Pred, Value *CmpLHS, Value *CmpRHS, Value *TrueVal, Value *FalseVal, Value *&LHS, Value *&RHS)
Match clamp pattern for float types without care about NaNs or signed zeros.
static std::optional< bool > isImpliedCondICmps(CmpPredicate LPred, const Value *L0, const Value *L1, CmpPredicate RPred, const Value *R0, const Value *R1, const DataLayout &DL, bool LHSIsTrue)
Return true if LHS implies RHS (expanded to its components as "R0 RPred R1") is true.
static bool includesUndef(UndefPoisonKind Kind)
static std::optional< bool > isImpliedCondCommonOperandWithCR(CmpPredicate LPred, const ConstantRange &LCR, CmpPredicate RPred, const ConstantRange &RCR)
Return true if "icmp LPred X, LCR" implies "icmp RPred X, RCR" is true.
static ConstantRange getRangeForSelectPattern(const SelectInst &SI, const InstrInfoQuery &IIQ)
static void computeKnownBitsFromOperator(const Operator *I, const APInt &DemandedElts, KnownBits &Known, const SimplifyQuery &Q, unsigned Depth)
static uint64_t GetStringLengthH(const Value *V, SmallPtrSetImpl< const PHINode * > &PHIs, unsigned CharSize)
If we can compute the length of the string pointed to by the specified pointer, return 'len+1'.
static void computeKnownBitsFromShiftOperator(const Operator *I, const APInt &DemandedElts, KnownBits &Known, KnownBits &Known2, const SimplifyQuery &Q, unsigned Depth, function_ref< KnownBits(const KnownBits &, const KnownBits &, bool)> KF)
Compute known bits from a shift operator, including those with a non-constant shift amount.
static bool onlyUsedByLifetimeMarkersOrDroppableInstsHelper(const Value *V, bool AllowLifetime, bool AllowDroppable)
static std::optional< bool > isImpliedCondAndOr(const Instruction *LHS, CmpPredicate RHSPred, const Value *RHSOp0, const Value *RHSOp1, const DataLayout &DL, bool LHSIsTrue, unsigned Depth)
Return true if LHS implies RHS is true.
static bool isSignedMinMaxClamp(const Value *Select, const Value *&In, const APInt *&CLow, const APInt *&CHigh)
static bool isNonZeroAdd(const APInt &DemandedElts, const SimplifyQuery &Q, unsigned BitWidth, Value *X, Value *Y, bool NSW, bool NUW, unsigned Depth)
static bool directlyImpliesPoison(const Value *ValAssumedPoison, const Value *V, unsigned Depth)
static bool isNonEqualSelect(const Value *V1, const Value *V2, const APInt &DemandedElts, const SimplifyQuery &Q, unsigned Depth)
static bool matchTwoInputRecurrence(const PHINode *PN, InstTy *&Inst, Value *&Init, Value *&OtherOp)
static bool isNonEqualPHIs(const PHINode *PN1, const PHINode *PN2, const APInt &DemandedElts, const SimplifyQuery &Q, unsigned Depth)
static void computeKnownBitsFromCmp(const Value *V, CmpInst::Predicate Pred, Value *LHS, Value *RHS, KnownBits &Known, const SimplifyQuery &Q)
static SelectPatternResult matchMinMaxOfMinMax(CmpInst::Predicate Pred, Value *CmpLHS, Value *CmpRHS, Value *TVal, Value *FVal, unsigned Depth)
Recognize variations of: a < c ?
static void unionWithMinMaxIntrinsicClamp(const IntrinsicInst *II, KnownBits &Known)
static void setLimitForFPToI(const Instruction *I, APInt &Lower, APInt &Upper)
static bool isSameUnderlyingObjectInLoop(const PHINode *PN, const LoopInfo *LI)
PN defines a loop-variant pointer to an object.
static bool isNonEqualPointersWithRecursiveGEP(const Value *A, const Value *B, const SimplifyQuery &Q)
static bool isSignedMinMaxIntrinsicClamp(const IntrinsicInst *II, const APInt *&CLow, const APInt *&CHigh)
static Value * lookThroughCastConst(CmpInst *CmpI, Type *SrcTy, Constant *C, Instruction::CastOps *CastOp)
static bool handleGuaranteedWellDefinedOps(const Instruction *I, const CallableT &Handle)
Enumerates all operands of I that are guaranteed to not be undef or poison.
static void computeKnownBitsFromLerpPattern(const Value *Op0, const Value *Op1, const APInt &DemandedElts, KnownBits &KnownOut, const SimplifyQuery &Q, unsigned Depth)
Try to detect the lerp pattern: a * (b - c) + c * d where a >= 0, b >= 0, c >= 0, d >= 0,...
static KnownFPClass computeKnownFPClassFromContext(const Value *V, const SimplifyQuery &Q)
static void computeKnownBitsAddSub(bool Add, const Value *Op0, const Value *Op1, bool NSW, bool NUW, const APInt &DemandedElts, KnownBits &KnownOut, KnownBits &Known2, const SimplifyQuery &Q, unsigned Depth)
static Value * getNotValue(Value *V)
If the input value is the result of a 'not' op, constant integer, or vector splat of a constant integ...
static unsigned ComputeNumSignBitsImpl(const Value *V, const APInt &DemandedElts, const SimplifyQuery &Q, unsigned Depth)
Return the number of times the sign bit of the register is replicated into the other bits.
static void computeKnownBitsFromICmpCond(const Value *V, ICmpInst *Cmp, KnownBits &Known, const SimplifyQuery &SQ, bool Invert)
static bool isKnownNonZeroFromOperator(const Operator *I, const APInt &DemandedElts, const SimplifyQuery &Q, unsigned Depth)
static bool matchOpWithOpEqZero(Value *Op0, Value *Op1)
static bool isNonZeroRecurrence(const PHINode *PN)
Try to detect a recurrence that monotonically increases/decreases from a non-zero starting value.
static SelectPatternResult matchClamp(CmpInst::Predicate Pred, Value *CmpLHS, Value *CmpRHS, Value *TrueVal, Value *FalseVal)
Recognize variations of: CLAMP(v,l,h) ==> ((v) < (l) ?
static bool shiftAmountKnownInRange(const Value *ShiftAmount)
Shifts return poison if shiftwidth is larger than the bitwidth.
static bool isEphemeralValueOf(const Instruction *I, const Value *E)
static SelectPatternResult matchMinMax(CmpInst::Predicate Pred, Value *CmpLHS, Value *CmpRHS, Value *TrueVal, Value *FalseVal, Value *&LHS, Value *&RHS, unsigned Depth)
Match non-obvious integer minimum and maximum sequences.
static KnownBits computeKnownBitsForHorizontalOperation(const Operator *I, const APInt &DemandedElts, const SimplifyQuery &Q, unsigned Depth, const function_ref< KnownBits(const KnownBits &, const KnownBits &)> KnownBitsFunc)
static bool handleGuaranteedNonPoisonOps(const Instruction *I, const CallableT &Handle)
Enumerates all operands of I that are guaranteed to not be poison.
static std::optional< std::pair< Value *, Value * > > getInvertibleOperands(const Operator *Op1, const Operator *Op2)
If the pair of operators are the same invertible function, return the the operands of the function co...
static bool cmpExcludesZero(CmpInst::Predicate Pred, const Value *RHS)
static void computeKnownBitsFromCond(const Value *V, Value *Cond, KnownBits &Known, const SimplifyQuery &SQ, bool Invert, unsigned Depth)
static bool isKnownNonZeroFromAssume(const Value *V, const SimplifyQuery &Q)
static std::optional< bool > isImpliedCondOperands(CmpInst::Predicate Pred, const Value *ALHS, const Value *ARHS, const Value *BLHS, const Value *BRHS)
Return true if "icmp Pred BLHS BRHS" is true whenever "icmp PredALHS ARHS" is true.
static const Instruction * safeCxtI(const Value *V, const Instruction *CxtI)
static bool isNonEqualMul(const Value *V1, const Value *V2, const APInt &DemandedElts, const SimplifyQuery &Q, unsigned Depth)
Return true if V2 == V1 * C, where V1 is known non-zero, C is not 0/1 and the multiplication is nuw o...
static bool isImpliedToBeAPowerOfTwoFromCond(const Value *V, bool OrZero, const Value *Cond, bool CondIsTrue)
Return true if we can infer that V is known to be a power of 2 from dominating condition Cond (e....
static void computeKnownBitsMul(const Value *Op0, const Value *Op1, bool NSW, bool NUW, const APInt &DemandedElts, KnownBits &Known, KnownBits &Known2, const SimplifyQuery &Q, unsigned Depth)
static bool isKnownNonNaN(const Value *V, FastMathFlags FMF)
static ConstantRange getRangeForIntrinsic(const IntrinsicInst &II, bool UseInstrInfo)
static void computeKnownFPClassForFPTrunc(const Operator *Op, const APInt &DemandedElts, FPClassTest InterestedClasses, KnownFPClass &Known, const SimplifyQuery &Q, unsigned Depth)
static Value * BuildSubAggregate(Value *From, Value *To, Type *IndexedType, SmallVectorImpl< unsigned > &Idxs, unsigned IdxSkip, BasicBlock::iterator InsertBefore)
Value * RHS
Value * LHS
static LLVM_ABI unsigned int semanticsPrecision(const fltSemantics &)
Definition APFloat.cpp:290
static LLVM_ABI bool isRepresentableAsNormalIn(const fltSemantics &Src, const fltSemantics &Dst)
Definition APFloat.cpp:340
bool isFinite() const
Definition APFloat.h:1436
bool isNaN() const
Definition APFloat.h:1429
static APFloat getLargest(const fltSemantics &Sem, bool Negative=false)
Returns the largest finite number in the given semantics.
Definition APFloat.h:1120
static APFloat getInf(const fltSemantics &Sem, bool Negative=false)
Factory for Positive and Negative Infinity.
Definition APFloat.h:1080
static APFloat getZero(const fltSemantics &Sem, bool Negative=false)
Factory for Positive and Negative Zero.
Definition APFloat.h:1061
Class for arbitrary precision integers.
Definition APInt.h:78
LLVM_ABI APInt umul_ov(const APInt &RHS, bool &Overflow) const
Definition APInt.cpp:1971
LLVM_ABI APInt udiv(const APInt &RHS) const
Unsigned division operation.
Definition APInt.cpp:1573
static APInt getAllOnes(unsigned numBits)
Return an APInt of a specified width with all bits set.
Definition APInt.h:235
void clearBit(unsigned BitPosition)
Set a given bit to 0.
Definition APInt.h:1407
bool isMinSignedValue() const
Determine if this is the smallest signed value.
Definition APInt.h:424
uint64_t getZExtValue() const
Get zero extended value.
Definition APInt.h:1541
void setHighBits(unsigned hiBits)
Set the top hiBits bits.
Definition APInt.h:1392
unsigned popcount() const
Count the number of bits set.
Definition APInt.h:1671
void setBitsFrom(unsigned loBit)
Set the top bits starting from loBit.
Definition APInt.h:1386
static APInt getMaxValue(unsigned numBits)
Gets maximum unsigned value of APInt for specific bit width.
Definition APInt.h:207
void setBit(unsigned BitPosition)
Set the given bit to 1 whose position is given as "bitPosition".
Definition APInt.h:1331
unsigned ceilLogBase2() const
Definition APInt.h:1765
bool sgt(const APInt &RHS) const
Signed greater than comparison.
Definition APInt.h:1202
bool isAllOnes() const
Determine if all bits are set. This is true for zero-width values.
Definition APInt.h:372
bool ugt(const APInt &RHS) const
Unsigned greater than comparison.
Definition APInt.h:1183
bool isZero() const
Determine if this value is zero, i.e. all bits are clear.
Definition APInt.h:381
LLVM_ABI APInt urem(const APInt &RHS) const
Unsigned remainder operation.
Definition APInt.cpp:1666
unsigned getBitWidth() const
Return the number of bits in the APInt.
Definition APInt.h:1489
bool ult(const APInt &RHS) const
Unsigned less than comparison.
Definition APInt.h:1112
static APInt getSignedMaxValue(unsigned numBits)
Gets maximum signed value of APInt for a specific bit width.
Definition APInt.h:210
static APInt getMinValue(unsigned numBits)
Gets minimum unsigned value of APInt for a specific bit width.
Definition APInt.h:217
bool isNegative() const
Determine sign of this APInt.
Definition APInt.h:330
bool intersects(const APInt &RHS) const
This operation tests if there are any pairs of corresponding bits between this APInt and RHS that are...
Definition APInt.h:1250
LLVM_ABI APInt sdiv(const APInt &RHS) const
Signed division function for APInt.
Definition APInt.cpp:1644
void clearAllBits()
Set every bit to 0.
Definition APInt.h:1397
LLVM_ABI APInt reverseBits() const
Definition APInt.cpp:768
bool sle(const APInt &RHS) const
Signed less or equal comparison.
Definition APInt.h:1167
unsigned getNumSignBits() const
Computes the number of leading bits of this APInt that are equal to its sign bit.
Definition APInt.h:1629
unsigned countl_zero() const
The APInt version of std::countl_zero.
Definition APInt.h:1599
static APInt getSignedMinValue(unsigned numBits)
Gets minimum signed value of APInt for a specific bit width.
Definition APInt.h:220
LLVM_ABI APInt sextOrTrunc(unsigned width) const
Sign extend or truncate to width.
Definition APInt.cpp:1041
bool isStrictlyPositive() const
Determine if this APInt Value is positive.
Definition APInt.h:357
unsigned logBase2() const
Definition APInt.h:1762
APInt ashr(unsigned ShiftAmt) const
Arithmetic right-shift function.
Definition APInt.h:828
bool getBoolValue() const
Convert APInt to a boolean value.
Definition APInt.h:472
bool isMaxSignedValue() const
Determine if this is the largest signed value.
Definition APInt.h:406
bool isNonNegative() const
Determine if this APInt Value is non-negative (>= 0)
Definition APInt.h:335
bool ule(const APInt &RHS) const
Unsigned less or equal comparison.
Definition APInt.h:1151
APInt shl(unsigned shiftAmt) const
Left-shift function.
Definition APInt.h:874
bool isSubsetOf(const APInt &RHS) const
This operation checks that all bits set in this APInt are also set in RHS.
Definition APInt.h:1258
bool slt(const APInt &RHS) const
Signed less than comparison.
Definition APInt.h:1131
static APInt getHighBitsSet(unsigned numBits, unsigned hiBitsSet)
Constructs an APInt value that has the top hiBitsSet bits set.
Definition APInt.h:297
static APInt getZero(unsigned numBits)
Get the '0' value for the specified bit-width.
Definition APInt.h:201
void setLowBits(unsigned loBits)
Set the bottom loBits bits.
Definition APInt.h:1389
bool sge(const APInt &RHS) const
Signed greater or equal comparison.
Definition APInt.h:1238
static APInt getBitsSetFrom(unsigned numBits, unsigned loBit)
Constructs an APInt value that has a contiguous range of bits set.
Definition APInt.h:287
static APInt getOneBitSet(unsigned numBits, unsigned BitNo)
Return an APInt with exactly one bit set in the result.
Definition APInt.h:240
APInt lshr(unsigned shiftAmt) const
Logical right-shift function.
Definition APInt.h:852
bool uge(const APInt &RHS) const
Unsigned greater or equal comparison.
Definition APInt.h:1222
void clearSignBit()
Set the sign bit to 0.
Definition APInt.h:1450
an instruction to allocate memory on the stack
This class represents an incoming formal argument to a Function.
Definition Argument.h:32
ArrayRef - Represent a constant reference to an array (0 or more elements consecutively in memory),...
Definition ArrayRef.h:40
iterator end() const
Definition ArrayRef.h:131
size_t size() const
size - Get the array size.
Definition ArrayRef.h:142
iterator begin() const
Definition ArrayRef.h:130
bool empty() const
empty - Check if the array is empty.
Definition ArrayRef.h:137
ArrayRef< T > slice(size_t N, size_t M) const
slice(n, m) - Chop off the first N elements of the array, and keep M elements in the array.
Definition ArrayRef.h:186
Class to represent array types.
This represents the llvm.assume intrinsic.
A cache of @llvm.assume calls within a function.
MutableArrayRef< ResultElem > assumptionsFor(const Value *V)
Access the list of assumptions which affect this value.
Functions, function parameters, and return types can have attributes to indicate how they should be t...
Definition Attributes.h:69
LLVM_ABI std::optional< unsigned > getVScaleRangeMax() const
Returns the maximum value for the vscale_range attribute or std::nullopt when unknown.
LLVM_ABI unsigned getVScaleRangeMin() const
Returns the minimum value for the vscale_range attribute.
bool isValid() const
Return true if the attribute is any kind of attribute.
Definition Attributes.h:223
LLVM_ABI bool isSingleEdge() const
Check if this is the only edge between Start and End.
LLVM Basic Block Representation.
Definition BasicBlock.h:62
iterator end()
Definition BasicBlock.h:472
iterator begin()
Instruction iterator methods.
Definition BasicBlock.h:459
const Function * getParent() const
Return the enclosing method, or null if none.
Definition BasicBlock.h:213
LLVM_ABI InstListType::const_iterator getFirstNonPHIIt() const
Returns an iterator to the first instruction in this block that is not a PHINode instruction.
InstListType::const_iterator const_iterator
Definition BasicBlock.h:171
LLVM_ABI const BasicBlock * getSinglePredecessor() const
Return the predecessor of this block if it has a single predecessor block.
LLVM_ABI const BasicBlock * getSingleSuccessor() const
Return the successor of this block if it has a single successor.
InstListType::iterator iterator
Instruction iterators...
Definition BasicBlock.h:170
const Instruction * getTerminator() const LLVM_READONLY
Returns the terminator instruction if the block is well formed or null if the block is not well forme...
Definition BasicBlock.h:233
LLVM_ABI Instruction::BinaryOps getBinaryOp() const
Returns the binary operation underlying the intrinsic.
BinaryOps getOpcode() const
Definition InstrTypes.h:374
Conditional or Unconditional Branch instruction.
Base class for all callable instructions (InvokeInst and CallInst) Holds everything related to callin...
Function * getCalledFunction() const
Returns the function called, or null if this is an indirect function invocation or the function signa...
LLVM_ABI bool paramHasAttr(unsigned ArgNo, Attribute::AttrKind Kind) const
Determine whether the argument or parameter has the given attribute.
LLVM_ABI bool isIndirectCall() const
Return true if the callsite is an indirect call.
bool onlyReadsMemory(unsigned OpNo) const
Value * getCalledOperand() const
Value * getArgOperand(unsigned i) const
unsigned arg_size() const
This class represents a function call, abstracting a target machine's calling convention.
This is the base class for all instructions that perform data casts.
Definition InstrTypes.h:448
This class is the base class for the comparison instructions.
Definition InstrTypes.h:664
Predicate
This enumeration lists the possible predicates for CmpInst subclasses.
Definition InstrTypes.h:676
@ ICMP_SLT
signed less than
Definition InstrTypes.h:705
@ ICMP_SLE
signed less or equal
Definition InstrTypes.h:706
@ FCMP_OLT
0 1 0 0 True if ordered and less than
Definition InstrTypes.h:682
@ FCMP_ULE
1 1 0 1 True if unordered, less than, or equal
Definition InstrTypes.h:691
@ FCMP_OGT
0 0 1 0 True if ordered and greater than
Definition InstrTypes.h:680
@ FCMP_OGE
0 0 1 1 True if ordered and greater than or equal
Definition InstrTypes.h:681
@ ICMP_UGE
unsigned greater or equal
Definition InstrTypes.h:700
@ ICMP_UGT
unsigned greater than
Definition InstrTypes.h:699
@ ICMP_SGT
signed greater than
Definition InstrTypes.h:703
@ FCMP_ULT
1 1 0 0 True if unordered or less than
Definition InstrTypes.h:690
@ ICMP_ULT
unsigned less than
Definition InstrTypes.h:701
@ FCMP_UGT
1 0 1 0 True if unordered or greater than
Definition InstrTypes.h:688
@ FCMP_OLE
0 1 0 1 True if ordered and less than or equal
Definition InstrTypes.h:683
@ ICMP_NE
not equal
Definition InstrTypes.h:698
@ ICMP_SGE
signed greater or equal
Definition InstrTypes.h:704
@ ICMP_ULE
unsigned less or equal
Definition InstrTypes.h:702
@ FCMP_UGE
1 0 1 1 True if unordered, greater than, or equal
Definition InstrTypes.h:689
bool isSigned() const
Definition InstrTypes.h:930
static LLVM_ABI bool isEquality(Predicate pred)
Determine if this is an equals/not equals predicate.
Predicate getSwappedPredicate() const
For example, EQ->EQ, SLE->SGE, ULT->UGT, OEQ->OEQ, ULE->UGE, OLT->OGT, etc.
Definition InstrTypes.h:827
bool isTrueWhenEqual() const
This is just a convenience.
Definition InstrTypes.h:942
static bool isFPPredicate(Predicate P)
Definition InstrTypes.h:770
Predicate getInversePredicate() const
For example, EQ -> NE, UGT -> ULE, SLT -> SGE, OEQ -> UNE, UGT -> OLE, OLT -> UGE,...
Definition InstrTypes.h:789
Predicate getPredicate() const
Return the predicate for this instruction.
Definition InstrTypes.h:765
Predicate getFlippedStrictnessPredicate() const
For predicate of kind "is X or equal to 0" returns the predicate "is X".
Definition InstrTypes.h:893
static bool isIntPredicate(Predicate P)
Definition InstrTypes.h:776
static LLVM_ABI bool isOrdered(Predicate predicate)
Determine if the predicate is an ordered operation.
bool isUnsigned() const
Definition InstrTypes.h:936
An abstraction over a floating-point predicate, and a pack of an integer predicate with samesign info...
static LLVM_ABI std::optional< CmpPredicate > getMatching(CmpPredicate A, CmpPredicate B)
Compares two CmpPredicates taking samesign into account and returns the canonicalized CmpPredicate if...
LLVM_ABI CmpInst::Predicate getPreferredSignedPredicate() const
Attempts to return a signed CmpInst::Predicate from the CmpPredicate.
CmpInst::Predicate dropSameSign() const
Drops samesign information.
bool hasSameSign() const
Query samesign information, for optimizations.
An array constant whose element type is a simple 1/2/4/8-byte integer or float/double,...
Definition Constants.h:707
ConstantDataSequential - A vector or array constant whose element type is a simple 1/2/4/8-byte integ...
Definition Constants.h:598
StringRef getAsString() const
If this array is isString(), then this method returns the array as a StringRef.
Definition Constants.h:673
A vector constant whose element type is a simple 1/2/4/8-byte integer or float/double,...
Definition Constants.h:781
static LLVM_ABI Constant * getAdd(Constant *C1, Constant *C2, bool HasNUW=false, bool HasNSW=false)
static LLVM_ABI Constant * getBitCast(Constant *C, Type *Ty, bool OnlyIfReduced=false)
static LLVM_ABI Constant * getTrunc(Constant *C, Type *Ty, bool OnlyIfReduced=false)
static LLVM_ABI std::optional< ConstantFPRange > makeExactFCmpRegion(FCmpInst::Predicate Pred, const APFloat &Other)
Produce the exact range such that all values in the returned range satisfy the given predicate with a...
ConstantFP - Floating Point Values [float, double].
Definition Constants.h:282
This is the shared class of boolean and integer constants.
Definition Constants.h:87
static LLVM_ABI ConstantInt * getTrue(LLVMContext &Context)
uint64_t getZExtValue() const
Return the constant as a 64-bit unsigned integer value after it has been zero extended as appropriate...
Definition Constants.h:168
This class represents a range of values.
PreferredRangeType
If represented precisely, the result of some range operations may consist of multiple disjoint ranges...
const APInt * getSingleElement() const
If this set contains a single element, return it, otherwise return null.
static LLVM_ABI ConstantRange fromKnownBits(const KnownBits &Known, bool IsSigned)
Initialize a range based on a known bits constraint.
LLVM_ABI OverflowResult unsignedSubMayOverflow(const ConstantRange &Other) const
Return whether unsigned sub of the two ranges always/never overflows.
LLVM_ABI bool isAllNegative() const
Return true if all values in this range are negative.
LLVM_ABI OverflowResult unsignedAddMayOverflow(const ConstantRange &Other) const
Return whether unsigned add of the two ranges always/never overflows.
LLVM_ABI KnownBits toKnownBits() const
Return known bits for values in this range.
LLVM_ABI bool icmp(CmpInst::Predicate Pred, const ConstantRange &Other) const
Does the predicate Pred hold between ranges this and Other?
LLVM_ABI APInt getSignedMin() const
Return the smallest signed value contained in the ConstantRange.
LLVM_ABI OverflowResult unsignedMulMayOverflow(const ConstantRange &Other) const
Return whether unsigned mul of the two ranges always/never overflows.
LLVM_ABI bool isAllNonNegative() const
Return true if all values in this range are non-negative.
static LLVM_ABI ConstantRange makeAllowedICmpRegion(CmpInst::Predicate Pred, const ConstantRange &Other)
Produce the smallest range such that all values that may satisfy the given predicate with any value c...
LLVM_ABI ConstantRange unionWith(const ConstantRange &CR, PreferredRangeType Type=Smallest) const
Return the range that results from the union of this range with another range.
static LLVM_ABI ConstantRange makeExactICmpRegion(CmpInst::Predicate Pred, const APInt &Other)
Produce the exact range such that all values in the returned range satisfy the given predicate with a...
LLVM_ABI bool contains(const APInt &Val) const
Return true if the specified value is in the set.
LLVM_ABI OverflowResult signedAddMayOverflow(const ConstantRange &Other) const
Return whether signed add of the two ranges always/never overflows.
LLVM_ABI ConstantRange intersectWith(const ConstantRange &CR, PreferredRangeType Type=Smallest) const
Return the range that results from the intersection of this range with another range.
OverflowResult
Represents whether an operation on the given constant range is known to always or never overflow.
@ AlwaysOverflowsHigh
Always overflows in the direction of signed/unsigned max value.
@ AlwaysOverflowsLow
Always overflows in the direction of signed/unsigned min value.
@ MayOverflow
May or may not overflow.
static ConstantRange getNonEmpty(APInt Lower, APInt Upper)
Create non-empty constant range with the given bounds.
uint32_t getBitWidth() const
Get the bit width of this ConstantRange.
LLVM_ABI OverflowResult signedSubMayOverflow(const ConstantRange &Other) const
Return whether signed sub of the two ranges always/never overflows.
LLVM_ABI ConstantRange sub(const ConstantRange &Other) const
Return a new range representing the possible values resulting from a subtraction of a value in this r...
This is an important base class in LLVM.
Definition Constant.h:43
static LLVM_ABI Constant * replaceUndefsWith(Constant *C, Constant *Replacement)
Try to replace undefined constant C or undefined elements in C with Replacement.
LLVM_ABI Constant * getSplatValue(bool AllowPoison=false) const
If all elements of the vector constant have the same value, return that value.
static LLVM_ABI Constant * getNullValue(Type *Ty)
Constructor to create a '0' constant of arbitrary type.
LLVM_ABI Constant * getAggregateElement(unsigned Elt) const
For aggregates (struct/array/vector) return the constant that corresponds to the specified element if...
LLVM_ABI bool isZeroValue() const
Return true if the value is negative zero or null value.
Definition Constants.cpp:76
LLVM_ABI bool isNullValue() const
Return true if this is the value that would be returned by getNullValue.
Definition Constants.cpp:90
A parsed version of the target data layout string in and methods for querying it.
Definition DataLayout.h:64
bool isLittleEndian() const
Layout endianness...
Definition DataLayout.h:214
LLVM_ABI const StructLayout * getStructLayout(StructType *Ty) const
Returns a StructLayout object, indicating the alignment of the struct, its size, and the offsets of i...
LLVM_ABI unsigned getIndexTypeSizeInBits(Type *Ty) const
The size in bits of the index used in GEP calculation for this type.
LLVM_ABI unsigned getPointerTypeSizeInBits(Type *) const
The pointer representation size in bits for this type.
TypeSize getTypeSizeInBits(Type *Ty) const
Size examples:
Definition DataLayout.h:771
ArrayRef< BranchInst * > conditionsFor(const Value *V) const
Access the list of branches which affect this value.
DomTreeNodeBase * getIDom() const
DomTreeNodeBase< NodeT > * getNode(const NodeT *BB) const
getNode - return the (Post)DominatorTree node for the specified basic block.
Concrete subclass of DominatorTreeBase that is used to compute a normal dominator tree.
Definition Dominators.h:164
LLVM_ABI bool dominates(const BasicBlock *BB, const Use &U) const
Return true if the (end of the) basic block BB dominates the use U.
This instruction extracts a struct member or array element value from an aggregate value.
ArrayRef< unsigned > getIndices() const
unsigned getNumIndices() const
static LLVM_ABI Type * getIndexedType(Type *Agg, ArrayRef< unsigned > Idxs)
Returns the type of the element that would be extracted with an extractvalue instruction with the spe...
This instruction compares its operands according to the predicate given to the constructor.
Utility class for floating point operations which can have information about relaxed accuracy require...
Definition Operator.h:200
Convenience struct for specifying and reasoning about fast-math flags.
Definition FMF.h:22
bool noSignedZeros() const
Definition FMF.h:67
bool noInfs() const
Definition FMF.h:66
void setNoSignedZeros(bool B=true)
Definition FMF.h:84
void setNoNaNs(bool B=true)
Definition FMF.h:78
bool noNaNs() const
Definition FMF.h:65
const BasicBlock & getEntryBlock() const
Definition Function.h:807
bool hasNoSync() const
Determine if the call can synchroize with other threads.
Definition Function.h:637
DenormalMode getDenormalMode(const fltSemantics &FPType) const
Returns the denormal handling type for the default rounding mode of the function.
Definition Function.cpp:806
an instruction for type-safe pointer arithmetic to access elements of arrays and structs
PointerType * getType() const
Global values are always pointers.
LLVM_ABI const DataLayout & getDataLayout() const
Get the data layout of the module this global belongs to.
Definition Globals.cpp:132
Type * getValueType() const
const Constant * getInitializer() const
getInitializer - Return the initializer for this global variable.
bool isConstant() const
If the value is a global constant, its value is immutable throughout the runtime execution of the pro...
bool hasDefinitiveInitializer() const
hasDefinitiveInitializer - Whether the global variable has an initializer, and any other instances of...
This instruction compares its operands according to the predicate given to the constructor.
CmpPredicate getSwappedCmpPredicate() const
CmpPredicate getInverseCmpPredicate() const
Predicate getFlippedSignednessPredicate() const
For example, SLT->ULT, ULT->SLT, SLE->ULE, ULE->SLE, EQ->EQ.
static bool isEquality(Predicate P)
Return true if this predicate is either EQ or NE.
static LLVM_ABI std::optional< bool > isImpliedByMatchingCmp(CmpPredicate Pred1, CmpPredicate Pred2)
Determine if Pred1 implies Pred2 is true, false, or if nothing can be inferred about the implication,...
bool isRelational() const
Return true if the predicate is relational (not EQ or NE).
Predicate getUnsignedPredicate() const
For example, EQ->EQ, SLE->ULE, UGT->UGT, etc.
This instruction inserts a struct field of array element value into an aggregate value.
static InsertValueInst * Create(Value *Agg, Value *Val, ArrayRef< unsigned > Idxs, const Twine &NameStr="", InsertPosition InsertBefore=nullptr)
LLVM_ABI bool hasNoNaNs() const LLVM_READONLY
Determine whether the no-NaNs flag is set.
LLVM_ABI bool hasNoUnsignedWrap() const LLVM_READONLY
Determine whether the no unsigned wrap flag is set.
LLVM_ABI bool hasNoSignedWrap() const LLVM_READONLY
Determine whether the no signed wrap flag is set.
bool isBinaryOp() const
LLVM_ABI InstListType::iterator eraseFromParent()
This method unlinks 'this' from the containing basic block and deletes it.
LLVM_ABI bool isExact() const LLVM_READONLY
Determine whether the exact flag is set.
LLVM_ABI const Function * getFunction() const
Return the function this instruction belongs to.
LLVM_ABI bool comesBefore(const Instruction *Other) const
Given an instruction Other in the same basic block as this instruction, return true if this instructi...
unsigned getOpcode() const
Returns a member of one of the enums like Instruction::Add.
bool isUnaryOp() const
LLVM_ABI const DataLayout & getDataLayout() const
Get the data layout of the module this instruction belongs to.
A wrapper class for inspecting calls to intrinsic functions.
This is an important class for using LLVM in a threaded context.
Definition LLVMContext.h:68
An instruction for reading from memory.
Value * getPointerOperand()
Align getAlign() const
Return the alignment of the access that is being performed.
bool isLoopHeader(const BlockT *BB) const
LoopT * getLoopFor(const BlockT *BB) const
Return the inner most loop that BB lives in.
Represents a single loop in the control flow graph.
Definition LoopInfo.h:40
Metadata node.
Definition Metadata.h:1078
This is a utility class that provides an abstraction for the common functionality between Instruction...
Definition Operator.h:33
unsigned getOpcode() const
Return the opcode for this Instruction or ConstantExpr.
Definition Operator.h:43
Utility class for integer operators which may exhibit overflow - Add, Sub, Mul, and Shl.
Definition Operator.h:78
iterator_range< const_block_iterator > blocks() const
Value * getIncomingValueForBlock(const BasicBlock *BB) const
BasicBlock * getIncomingBlock(unsigned i) const
Return incoming basic block number i.
Value * getIncomingValue(unsigned i) const
Return incoming value number x.
unsigned getNumIncomingValues() const
Return the number of incoming edges.
static LLVM_ABI PoisonValue * get(Type *T)
Static factory methods - Return an 'poison' object of the specified type.
A udiv, sdiv, lshr, or ashr instruction, which can be marked as "exact", indicating that no bits are ...
Definition Operator.h:154
bool isExact() const
Test whether this division is known to be exact, with zero remainder.
Definition Operator.h:173
This class represents the LLVM 'select' instruction.
const Value * getFalseValue() const
const Value * getCondition() const
const Value * getTrueValue() const
This instruction constructs a fixed permutation of two input vectors.
VectorType * getType() const
Overload to return most specific vector type.
static LLVM_ABI void getShuffleMask(const Constant *Mask, SmallVectorImpl< int > &Result)
Convert the input shuffle mask operand to a vector of integers.
size_type size() const
Definition SmallPtrSet.h:99
A templated base class for SmallPtrSet which provides the typesafe interface that is common across al...
size_type count(ConstPtrType Ptr) const
count - Return 1 if the specified pointer is in the set, 0 otherwise.
std::pair< iterator, bool > insert(PtrType Ptr)
Inserts Ptr if and only if there is no element in the container equal to Ptr.
bool contains(ConstPtrType Ptr) const
SmallPtrSet - This class implements a set which is optimized for holding SmallSize or less elements.
This class consists of common code factored out of the SmallVector class to reduce code duplication b...
void reserve(size_type N)
void append(ItTy in_start, ItTy in_end)
Add the specified range to the end of the SmallVector.
void push_back(const T &Elt)
This is a 'vector' (really, a variable-sized array), optimized for the case when the array is small.
StringRef - Represent a constant reference to a string, i.e.
Definition StringRef.h:55
constexpr StringRef substr(size_t Start, size_t N=npos) const
Return a reference to the substring from [Start, Start + N).
Definition StringRef.h:573
Used to lazily calculate structure layout information for a target machine, based on the DataLayout s...
Definition DataLayout.h:723
TypeSize getElementOffset(unsigned Idx) const
Definition DataLayout.h:754
Class to represent struct types.
unsigned getNumElements() const
Random access to the elements.
Type * getElementType(unsigned N) const
Provides information about what library functions are available for the current target.
bool getLibFunc(StringRef funcName, LibFunc &F) const
Searches for a particular function name.
The instances of the Type class are immutable: once they are created, they are never changed.
Definition Type.h:45
static LLVM_ABI IntegerType * getInt64Ty(LLVMContext &C)
Definition Type.cpp:297
LLVM_ABI unsigned getIntegerBitWidth() const
bool isVectorTy() const
True if this is an instance of VectorType.
Definition Type.h:273
static LLVM_ABI IntegerType * getInt32Ty(LLVMContext &C)
Definition Type.cpp:296
bool isIntOrIntVectorTy() const
Return true if this is an integer type or a vector of integer types.
Definition Type.h:246
bool isPointerTy() const
True if this is an instance of PointerType.
Definition Type.h:267
LLVM_ABI unsigned getPointerAddressSpace() const
Get the address space of this pointer or pointer vector type.
LLVM_ABI uint64_t getArrayNumElements() const
static LLVM_ABI IntegerType * getInt8Ty(LLVMContext &C)
Definition Type.cpp:294
Type * getScalarType() const
If this is a vector type, return the element type, otherwise return 'this'.
Definition Type.h:352
static LLVM_ABI IntegerType * getInt16Ty(LLVMContext &C)
Definition Type.cpp:295
bool isSized(SmallPtrSetImpl< Type * > *Visited=nullptr) const
Return true if it makes sense to take the size of this type.
Definition Type.h:311
LLVM_ABI unsigned getScalarSizeInBits() const LLVM_READONLY
If this is a vector type, return the getPrimitiveSizeInBits value for the element type.
Definition Type.cpp:230
bool isPtrOrPtrVectorTy() const
Return true if this is a pointer type or a vector of pointer types.
Definition Type.h:270
bool isIntOrPtrTy() const
Return true if this is an integer type or a pointer type.
Definition Type.h:255
bool isIntegerTy() const
True if this is an instance of IntegerType.
Definition Type.h:240
static LLVM_ABI IntegerType * getIntNTy(LLVMContext &C, unsigned N)
Definition Type.cpp:300
bool isFPOrFPVectorTy() const
Return true if this is a FP type or a vector of FP.
Definition Type.h:225
LLVM_ABI const fltSemantics & getFltSemantics() const
Definition Type.cpp:106
static LLVM_ABI UndefValue * get(Type *T)
Static factory methods - Return an 'undef' object of the specified type.
A Use represents the edge between a Value definition and its users.
Definition Use.h:35
LLVM_ABI unsigned getOperandNo() const
Return the operand # of this use in its User.
Definition Use.cpp:35
User * getUser() const
Returns the User that contains this Use.
Definition Use.h:61
op_range operands()
Definition User.h:292
Value * getOperand(unsigned i) const
Definition User.h:232
unsigned getNumOperands() const
Definition User.h:254
LLVM Value Representation.
Definition Value.h:75
Type * getType() const
All values are typed, get the type of this value.
Definition Value.h:256
const Value * stripAndAccumulateInBoundsConstantOffsets(const DataLayout &DL, APInt &Offset) const
This is a wrapper around stripAndAccumulateConstantOffsets with the in-bounds requirement set to fals...
Definition Value.h:759
iterator_range< user_iterator > users()
Definition Value.h:426
LLVM_ABI const Value * stripAndAccumulateConstantOffsets(const DataLayout &DL, APInt &Offset, bool AllowNonInbounds, bool AllowInvariantGroup=false, function_ref< bool(Value &Value, APInt &Offset)> ExternalAnalysis=nullptr, bool LookThroughIntToPtr=false) const
Accumulate the constant offset this value has compared to a base pointer.
const KnownBits & getKnownBits(const SimplifyQuery &Q) const
Definition WithCache.h:59
PointerType getValue() const
Definition WithCache.h:57
Represents an op.with.overflow intrinsic.
constexpr ScalarTy getFixedValue() const
Definition TypeSize.h:200
constexpr bool isScalable() const
Returns whether the quantity is scaled by a runtime quantity (vscale).
Definition TypeSize.h:168
constexpr ScalarTy getKnownMinValue() const
Returns the minimum value this quantity can represent.
Definition TypeSize.h:165
An efficient, type-erasing, non-owning reference to a callable.
TypeSize getSequentialElementStride(const DataLayout &DL) const
const ParentTy * getParent() const
Definition ilist_node.h:34
self_iterator getIterator()
Definition ilist_node.h:123
A range adaptor for a pair of iterators.
CallInst * Call
This provides a very simple, boring adaptor for a begin and end iterator into a range type.
#define UINT64_MAX
Definition DataTypes.h:77
#define llvm_unreachable(msg)
Marks that the current location is not supposed to be reachable.
LLVM_ABI APInt ScaleBitMask(const APInt &A, unsigned NewBitWidth, bool MatchAllBits=false)
Splat/Merge neighboring bits to widen/narrow the bitmask represented by.
Definition APInt.cpp:3009
const APInt & umax(const APInt &A, const APInt &B)
Determine the larger of two APInts considered to be unsigned.
Definition APInt.h:2264
@ C
The default llvm calling convention, compatible with C.
Definition CallingConv.h:34
SpecificConstantMatch m_ZeroInt()
Convenience matchers for specific integer values.
BinaryOp_match< SpecificConstantMatch, SrcTy, TargetOpcode::G_SUB > m_Neg(const SrcTy &&Src)
Matches a register negated by a G_SUB.
BinaryOp_match< SrcTy, SpecificConstantMatch, TargetOpcode::G_XOR, true > m_Not(const SrcTy &&Src)
Matches a register not-ed by a G_XOR.
OneUse_match< SubPat > m_OneUse(const SubPat &SP)
cst_pred_ty< is_all_ones > m_AllOnes()
Match an integer or vector with all bits set.
cst_pred_ty< is_lowbit_mask > m_LowBitMask()
Match an integer or vector with only the low bit(s) set.
BinaryOp_match< LHS, RHS, Instruction::And > m_And(const LHS &L, const RHS &R)
PtrToIntSameSize_match< OpTy > m_PtrToIntSameSize(const DataLayout &DL, const OpTy &Op)
BinaryOp_match< LHS, RHS, Instruction::Add > m_Add(const LHS &L, const RHS &R)
CmpClass_match< LHS, RHS, FCmpInst > m_FCmp(CmpPredicate &Pred, const LHS &L, const RHS &R)
cst_pred_ty< is_sign_mask > m_SignMask()
Match an integer or vector with only the sign bit(s) set.
OverflowingBinaryOp_match< LHS, RHS, Instruction::Add, OverflowingBinaryOperator::NoUnsignedWrap > m_NUWAdd(const LHS &L, const RHS &R)
cst_pred_ty< is_power2 > m_Power2()
Match an integer or vector power-of-2.
BinaryOp_match< LHS, RHS, Instruction::URem > m_URem(const LHS &L, const RHS &R)
auto m_LogicalOp()
Matches either L && R or L || R where L and R are arbitrary values.
class_match< Constant > m_Constant()
Match an arbitrary Constant and ignore it.
ap_match< APInt > m_APInt(const APInt *&Res)
Match a ConstantInt or splatted ConstantVector, binding the specified pointer to the contained APInt.
BinaryOp_match< LHS, RHS, Instruction::And, true > m_c_And(const LHS &L, const RHS &R)
Matches an And with LHS and RHS in either order.
cst_pred_ty< is_power2_or_zero > m_Power2OrZero()
Match an integer or vector of 0 or power-of-2 values.
CastInst_match< OpTy, TruncInst > m_Trunc(const OpTy &Op)
Matches Trunc.
BinaryOp_match< LHS, RHS, Instruction::Xor > m_Xor(const LHS &L, const RHS &R)
OverflowingBinaryOp_match< LHS, RHS, Instruction::Sub, OverflowingBinaryOperator::NoSignedWrap > m_NSWSub(const LHS &L, const RHS &R)
bool match(Val *V, const Pattern &P)
BinOpPred_match< LHS, RHS, is_idiv_op > m_IDiv(const LHS &L, const RHS &R)
Matches integer division operations.
bind_ty< Instruction > m_Instruction(Instruction *&I)
Match an instruction, capturing it if we match.
cstfp_pred_ty< is_any_zero_fp > m_AnyZeroFP()
Match a floating-point negative zero or positive zero.
specificval_ty m_Specific(const Value *V)
Match if we have a specific specified value.
BinOpPred_match< LHS, RHS, is_right_shift_op > m_Shr(const LHS &L, const RHS &R)
Matches logical shift operations.
ap_match< APFloat > m_APFloat(const APFloat *&Res)
Match a ConstantFP or splatted ConstantVector, binding the specified pointer to the contained APFloat...
CmpClass_match< LHS, RHS, ICmpInst, true > m_c_ICmp(CmpPredicate &Pred, const LHS &L, const RHS &R)
Matches an ICmp with a predicate over LHS and RHS in either order.
OverflowingBinaryOp_match< LHS, RHS, Instruction::Add, OverflowingBinaryOperator::NoUnsignedWrap, true > m_c_NUWAdd(const LHS &L, const RHS &R)
cst_pred_ty< is_nonnegative > m_NonNegative()
Match an integer or vector of non-negative values.
class_match< ConstantInt > m_ConstantInt()
Match an arbitrary ConstantInt and ignore it.
cst_pred_ty< is_one > m_One()
Match an integer 1 or a vector with all elements equal to 1.
IntrinsicID_match m_Intrinsic()
Match intrinsic calls like this: m_Intrinsic<Intrinsic::fabs>(m_Value(X))
ThreeOps_match< Cond, LHS, RHS, Instruction::Select > m_Select(const Cond &C, const LHS &L, const RHS &R)
Matches SelectInst.
IntrinsicID_match m_VScale()
Matches a call to llvm.vscale().
match_combine_or< MaxMin_match< FCmpInst, LHS, RHS, ofmin_pred_ty >, MaxMin_match< FCmpInst, LHS, RHS, ufmin_pred_ty > > m_OrdOrUnordFMin(const LHS &L, const RHS &R)
Match an 'ordered' or 'unordered' floating point minimum function.
ExtractValue_match< Ind, Val_t > m_ExtractValue(const Val_t &V)
Match a single index ExtractValue instruction.
MaxMin_match< ICmpInst, LHS, RHS, smin_pred_ty > m_SMin(const LHS &L, const RHS &R)
bind_ty< WithOverflowInst > m_WithOverflowInst(WithOverflowInst *&I)
Match a with overflow intrinsic, capturing it if we match.
BinaryOp_match< LHS, RHS, Instruction::Xor, true > m_c_Xor(const LHS &L, const RHS &R)
Matches an Xor with LHS and RHS in either order.
BinaryOp_match< LHS, RHS, Instruction::Mul > m_Mul(const LHS &L, const RHS &R)
deferredval_ty< Value > m_Deferred(Value *const &V)
Like m_Specific(), but works if the specific value to match is determined as part of the same match()...
MaxMin_match< ICmpInst, LHS, RHS, smin_pred_ty, true > m_c_SMin(const LHS &L, const RHS &R)
Matches an SMin with LHS and RHS in either order.
auto m_LogicalOr()
Matches L || R where L and R are arbitrary values.
MaxMin_match< ICmpInst, LHS, RHS, umax_pred_ty, true > m_c_UMax(const LHS &L, const RHS &R)
Matches a UMax with LHS and RHS in either order.
SpecificCmpClass_match< LHS, RHS, ICmpInst > m_SpecificICmp(CmpPredicate MatchPred, const LHS &L, const RHS &R)
CastInst_match< OpTy, ZExtInst > m_ZExt(const OpTy &Op)
Matches ZExt.
BinaryOp_match< LHS, RHS, Instruction::UDiv > m_UDiv(const LHS &L, const RHS &R)
MaxMin_match< ICmpInst, LHS, RHS, umax_pred_ty > m_UMax(const LHS &L, const RHS &R)
brc_match< Cond_t, bind_ty< BasicBlock >, bind_ty< BasicBlock > > m_Br(const Cond_t &C, BasicBlock *&T, BasicBlock *&F)
match_immconstant_ty m_ImmConstant()
Match an arbitrary immediate Constant and ignore it.
NoWrapTrunc_match< OpTy, TruncInst::NoUnsignedWrap > m_NUWTrunc(const OpTy &Op)
Matches trunc nuw.
MaxMin_match< ICmpInst, LHS, RHS, umin_pred_ty, true > m_c_UMin(const LHS &L, const RHS &R)
Matches a UMin with LHS and RHS in either order.
BinaryOp_match< LHS, RHS, Instruction::Add, true > m_c_Add(const LHS &L, const RHS &R)
Matches a Add with LHS and RHS in either order.
match_combine_or< BinaryOp_match< LHS, RHS, Instruction::Add >, DisjointOr_match< LHS, RHS > > m_AddLike(const LHS &L, const RHS &R)
Match either "add" or "or disjoint".
match_combine_or< MaxMin_match< FCmpInst, LHS, RHS, ofmax_pred_ty >, MaxMin_match< FCmpInst, LHS, RHS, ufmax_pred_ty > > m_OrdOrUnordFMax(const LHS &L, const RHS &R)
Match an 'ordered' or 'unordered' floating point maximum function.
MaxMin_match< ICmpInst, LHS, RHS, smax_pred_ty, true > m_c_SMax(const LHS &L, const RHS &R)
Matches an SMax with LHS and RHS in either order.
OverflowingBinaryOp_match< LHS, RHS, Instruction::Sub, OverflowingBinaryOperator::NoUnsignedWrap > m_NUWSub(const LHS &L, const RHS &R)
MaxMin_match< ICmpInst, LHS, RHS, smax_pred_ty > m_SMax(const LHS &L, const RHS &R)
match_combine_or< OverflowingBinaryOp_match< LHS, RHS, Instruction::Add, OverflowingBinaryOperator::NoSignedWrap >, DisjointOr_match< LHS, RHS > > m_NSWAddLike(const LHS &L, const RHS &R)
Match either "add nsw" or "or disjoint".
class_match< Value > m_Value()
Match an arbitrary value and ignore it.
AnyBinaryOp_match< LHS, RHS, true > m_c_BinOp(const LHS &L, const RHS &R)
Matches a BinaryOperator with LHS and RHS in either order.
OverflowingBinaryOp_match< LHS, RHS, Instruction::Add, OverflowingBinaryOperator::NoSignedWrap > m_NSWAdd(const LHS &L, const RHS &R)
BinaryOp_match< LHS, RHS, Instruction::LShr > m_LShr(const LHS &L, const RHS &R)
CmpClass_match< LHS, RHS, ICmpInst > m_ICmp(CmpPredicate &Pred, const LHS &L, const RHS &R)
match_combine_or< CastInst_match< OpTy, ZExtInst >, CastInst_match< OpTy, SExtInst > > m_ZExtOrSExt(const OpTy &Op)
FNeg_match< OpTy > m_FNeg(const OpTy &X)
Match 'fneg X' as 'fsub -0.0, X'.
BinOpPred_match< LHS, RHS, is_shift_op > m_Shift(const LHS &L, const RHS &R)
Matches shift operations.
BinaryOp_match< LHS, RHS, Instruction::Shl > m_Shl(const LHS &L, const RHS &R)
BinOpPred_match< LHS, RHS, is_irem_op > m_IRem(const LHS &L, const RHS &R)
Matches integer remainder operations.
auto m_LogicalAnd()
Matches L && R where L and R are arbitrary values.
class_match< BasicBlock > m_BasicBlock()
Match an arbitrary basic block value and ignore it.
BinaryOp_match< LHS, RHS, Instruction::SRem > m_SRem(const LHS &L, const RHS &R)
cst_pred_ty< is_nonpositive > m_NonPositive()
Match an integer or vector of non-positive values.
BinaryOp_match< LHS, RHS, Instruction::Or > m_Or(const LHS &L, const RHS &R)
CastInst_match< OpTy, SExtInst > m_SExt(const OpTy &Op)
Matches SExt.
is_zero m_Zero()
Match any null constant or a vector with all elements equal to 0.
BinaryOp_match< LHS, RHS, Instruction::Or, true > m_c_Or(const LHS &L, const RHS &R)
Matches an Or with LHS and RHS in either order.
match_combine_or< OverflowingBinaryOp_match< LHS, RHS, Instruction::Add, OverflowingBinaryOperator::NoUnsignedWrap >, DisjointOr_match< LHS, RHS > > m_NUWAddLike(const LHS &L, const RHS &R)
Match either "add nuw" or "or disjoint".
ElementWiseBitCast_match< OpTy > m_ElementWiseBitCast(const OpTy &Op)
m_Intrinsic_Ty< Opnd0 >::Ty m_FAbs(const Opnd0 &Op0)
BinaryOp_match< LHS, RHS, Instruction::Mul, true > m_c_Mul(const LHS &L, const RHS &R)
Matches a Mul with LHS and RHS in either order.
CastOperator_match< OpTy, Instruction::PtrToInt > m_PtrToInt(const OpTy &Op)
Matches PtrToInt.
MatchFunctor< Val, Pattern > match_fn(const Pattern &P)
A match functor that can be used as a UnaryPredicate in functional algorithms like all_of.
BinaryOp_match< LHS, RHS, Instruction::Sub > m_Sub(const LHS &L, const RHS &R)
MaxMin_match< ICmpInst, LHS, RHS, umin_pred_ty > m_UMin(const LHS &L, const RHS &R)
match_combine_or< LTy, RTy > m_CombineOr(const LTy &L, const RTy &R)
Combine two pattern matchers matching L || R.
static unsigned decodeVSEW(unsigned VSEW)
LLVM_ABI unsigned getSEWLMULRatio(unsigned SEW, VLMUL VLMul)
static constexpr unsigned RVVBitsPerBlock
initializer< Ty > init(const Ty &Val)
std::enable_if_t< detail::IsValidPointer< X, Y >::value, X * > extract(Y &&MD)
Extract a Value from Metadata.
Definition Metadata.h:667
This is an optimization pass for GlobalISel generic memory operations.
LLVM_ABI bool haveNoCommonBitsSet(const WithCache< const Value * > &LHSCache, const WithCache< const Value * > &RHSCache, const SimplifyQuery &SQ)
Return true if LHS and RHS have no common bits set.
LLVM_ABI bool mustExecuteUBIfPoisonOnPathTo(Instruction *Root, Instruction *OnPathTo, DominatorTree *DT)
Return true if undefined behavior would provable be executed on the path to OnPathTo if Root produced...
LLVM_ABI Intrinsic::ID getInverseMinMaxIntrinsic(Intrinsic::ID MinMaxID)
LLVM_ABI bool willNotFreeBetween(const Instruction *Assume, const Instruction *CtxI)
Returns true, if no instruction between Assume and CtxI may free memory and the function is marked as...
@ Offset
Definition DWP.cpp:532
@ Length
Definition DWP.cpp:532
@ NeverOverflows
Never overflows.
@ AlwaysOverflowsHigh
Always overflows in the direction of signed/unsigned max value.
@ AlwaysOverflowsLow
Always overflows in the direction of signed/unsigned min value.
@ MayOverflow
May or may not overflow.
LLVM_ABI KnownFPClass computeKnownFPClass(const Value *V, const APInt &DemandedElts, FPClassTest InterestedClasses, const SimplifyQuery &SQ, unsigned Depth=0)
Determine which floating-point classes are valid for V, and return them in KnownFPClass bit sets.
bool all_of(R &&range, UnaryPredicate P)
Provide wrappers to std::all_of which take ranges instead of having to pass begin/end explicitly.
Definition STLExtras.h:1737
MaybeAlign getAlign(const CallInst &I, unsigned Index)
LLVM_ABI bool isValidAssumeForContext(const Instruction *I, const Instruction *CxtI, const DominatorTree *DT=nullptr, bool AllowEphemerals=false)
Return true if it is valid to use the assumptions provided by an assume intrinsic,...
auto size(R &&Range, std::enable_if_t< std::is_base_of< std::random_access_iterator_tag, typename std::iterator_traits< decltype(Range.begin())>::iterator_category >::value, void > *=nullptr)
Get the size of a range.
Definition STLExtras.h:1667
LLVM_ABI bool canCreatePoison(const Operator *Op, bool ConsiderFlagsAndMetadata=true)
LLVM_ABI bool mustTriggerUB(const Instruction *I, const SmallPtrSetImpl< const Value * > &KnownPoison)
Return true if the given instruction must trigger undefined behavior when I is executed with any oper...
LLVM_ABI bool isKnownNeverInfinity(const Value *V, const SimplifyQuery &SQ, unsigned Depth=0)
Return true if the floating-point scalar value is not an infinity or if the floating-point vector val...
LLVM_ABI void computeKnownBitsFromContext(const Value *V, KnownBits &Known, const SimplifyQuery &Q, unsigned Depth=0)
Merge bits known from context-dependent facts into Known.
detail::scope_exit< std::decay_t< Callable > > make_scope_exit(Callable &&F)
Definition ScopeExit.h:59
LLVM_ABI bool isOnlyUsedInZeroEqualityComparison(const Instruction *CxtI)
LLVM_ABI bool isSignBitCheck(ICmpInst::Predicate Pred, const APInt &RHS, bool &TrueIfSigned)
Given an exploded icmp instruction, return true if the comparison only checks the sign bit.
LLVM_ABI const Value * getArgumentAliasingToReturnedPointer(const CallBase *Call, bool MustPreserveNullness)
This function returns call pointer argument that is considered the same by aliasing rules.
LLVM_ABI bool isAssumeLikeIntrinsic(const Instruction *I)
Return true if it is an intrinsic that cannot be speculated but also cannot trap.
auto enumerate(FirstRange &&First, RestRanges &&...Rest)
Given two or more input ranges, returns a new range whose values are tuples (A, B,...
Definition STLExtras.h:2484
LLVM_ABI AllocaInst * findAllocaForValue(Value *V, bool OffsetZero=false)
Returns unique alloca where the value comes from, or nullptr.
LLVM_ABI APInt getMinMaxLimit(SelectPatternFlavor SPF, unsigned BitWidth)
Return the minimum or maximum constant value for the specified integer min/max flavor and type.
decltype(auto) dyn_cast(const From &Val)
dyn_cast<X> - Return the argument parameter cast to the specified type.
Definition Casting.h:643
LLVM_ABI bool isOnlyUsedInZeroComparison(const Instruction *CxtI)
const Value * getLoadStorePointerOperand(const Value *V)
A helper function that returns the pointer operand of a load or store instruction.
LLVM_ABI bool getConstantStringInfo(const Value *V, StringRef &Str, bool TrimAtNul=true)
This function computes the length of a null-terminated C string pointed to by V.
LLVM_ABI bool isDereferenceableAndAlignedPointer(const Value *V, Type *Ty, Align Alignment, const DataLayout &DL, const Instruction *CtxI=nullptr, AssumptionCache *AC=nullptr, const DominatorTree *DT=nullptr, const TargetLibraryInfo *TLI=nullptr)
Returns true if V is always a dereferenceable pointer with alignment greater or equal than requested.
Definition Loads.cpp:229
LLVM_ABI bool onlyUsedByLifetimeMarkersOrDroppableInsts(const Value *V)
Return true if the only users of this pointer are lifetime markers or droppable instructions.
LLVM_ABI Constant * ReadByteArrayFromGlobal(const GlobalVariable *GV, uint64_t Offset)
LLVM_ABI Value * stripNullTest(Value *V)
Returns the inner value X if the expression has the form f(X) where f(X) == 0 if and only if X == 0,...
LLVM_ABI bool getUnderlyingObjectsForCodeGen(const Value *V, SmallVectorImpl< Value * > &Objects)
This is a wrapper around getUnderlyingObjects and adds support for basic ptrtoint+arithmetic+inttoptr...
LLVM_ABI std::pair< Intrinsic::ID, bool > canConvertToMinOrMaxIntrinsic(ArrayRef< Value * > VL)
Check if the values in VL are select instructions that can be converted to a min or max (vector) intr...
iterator_range< T > make_range(T x, T y)
Convenience function for iterating over sub-ranges.
LLVM_ABI bool getConstantDataArrayInfo(const Value *V, ConstantDataArraySlice &Slice, unsigned ElementSize, uint64_t Offset=0)
Returns true if the value V is a pointer into a ConstantDataArray.
int bit_width(T Value)
Returns the number of bits needed to represent Value if Value is nonzero.
Definition bit.h:303
LLVM_ABI bool isGuaranteedToExecuteForEveryIteration(const Instruction *I, const Loop *L)
Return true if this function can prove that the instruction I is executed for every iteration of the ...
void append_range(Container &C, Range &&R)
Wrapper function to append range R to container C.
Definition STLExtras.h:2148
LLVM_ABI bool mustSuppressSpeculation(const LoadInst &LI)
Return true if speculation of the given load must be suppressed to avoid ordering or interfering with...
Definition Loads.cpp:420
constexpr bool isPowerOf2_64(uint64_t Value)
Return true if the argument is a power of two > 0 (64 bit edition.)
Definition MathExtras.h:284
gep_type_iterator gep_type_end(const User *GEP)
int ilogb(const APFloat &Arg)
Returns the exponent of the internal representation of the APFloat.
Definition APFloat.h:1516
LLVM_ABI bool isSafeToSpeculativelyExecute(const Instruction *I, const Instruction *CtxI=nullptr, AssumptionCache *AC=nullptr, const DominatorTree *DT=nullptr, const TargetLibraryInfo *TLI=nullptr, bool UseVariableInfo=true, bool IgnoreUBImplyingAttrs=true)
Return true if the instruction does not have any effects besides calculating the result and does not ...
LLVM_ABI Value * getSplatValue(const Value *V)
Get splat value if the input is a splat vector or return nullptr.
LLVM_ABI CmpInst::Predicate getMinMaxPred(SelectPatternFlavor SPF, bool Ordered=false)
Return the canonical comparison predicate for the specified minimum/maximum flavor.
bool isa_and_nonnull(const Y &Val)
Definition Casting.h:676
unsigned Log2_64(uint64_t Value)
Return the floor log base 2 of the specified value, -1 if the value is zero.
Definition MathExtras.h:337
LLVM_ABI bool canIgnoreSignBitOfZero(const Use &U)
Return true if the sign bit of the FP value can be ignored by the user when the value is zero.
LLVM_ABI bool isGuaranteedNotToBeUndef(const Value *V, AssumptionCache *AC=nullptr, const Instruction *CtxI=nullptr, const DominatorTree *DT=nullptr, unsigned Depth=0)
Returns true if V cannot be undef, but may be poison.
LLVM_ABI ConstantRange getConstantRangeFromMetadata(const MDNode &RangeMD)
Parse out a conservative ConstantRange from !range metadata.
std::tuple< Value *, FPClassTest, FPClassTest > fcmpImpliesClass(CmpInst::Predicate Pred, const Function &F, Value *LHS, FPClassTest RHSClass, bool LookThroughSrc=true)
LLVM_ABI ConstantRange computeConstantRange(const Value *V, bool ForSigned, bool UseInstrInfo=true, AssumptionCache *AC=nullptr, const Instruction *CtxI=nullptr, const DominatorTree *DT=nullptr, unsigned Depth=0)
Determine the possible constant range of an integer or vector of integer value.
const Value * getPointerOperand(const Value *V)
A helper function that returns the pointer operand of a load, store or GEP instruction.
LLVM_ABI bool MaskedValueIsZero(const Value *V, const APInt &Mask, const SimplifyQuery &SQ, unsigned Depth=0)
Return true if 'V & Mask' is known to be zero.
int countr_zero(T Val)
Count number of 0's from the least significant bit to the most stopping at the first 1.
Definition bit.h:202
LLVM_ABI bool isOverflowIntrinsicNoWrap(const WithOverflowInst *WO, const DominatorTree &DT)
Returns true if the arithmetic part of the WO 's result is used only along the paths control dependen...
LLVM_ABI RetainedKnowledge getKnowledgeFromBundle(AssumeInst &Assume, const CallBase::BundleOpInfo &BOI)
This extracts the Knowledge from an element of an operand bundle.
LLVM_ABI bool matchSimpleRecurrence(const PHINode *P, BinaryOperator *&BO, Value *&Start, Value *&Step)
Attempt to match a simple first order recurrence cycle of the form: iv = phi Ty [Start,...
auto dyn_cast_or_null(const Y &Val)
Definition Casting.h:753
bool any_of(R &&range, UnaryPredicate P)
Provide wrappers to std::any_of which take ranges instead of having to pass begin/end explicitly.
Definition STLExtras.h:1744
LLVM_ABI OverflowResult computeOverflowForUnsignedMul(const Value *LHS, const Value *RHS, const SimplifyQuery &SQ, bool IsNSW=false)
LLVM_ABI bool getShuffleDemandedElts(int SrcWidth, ArrayRef< int > Mask, const APInt &DemandedElts, APInt &DemandedLHS, APInt &DemandedRHS, bool AllowUndefElts=false)
Transform a shuffle mask's output demanded element mask into demanded element masks for the 2 operand...
unsigned Log2_32(uint32_t Value)
Return the floor log base 2 of the specified value, -1 if the value is zero.
Definition MathExtras.h:331
bool isGuard(const User *U)
Returns true iff U has semantics of a guard expressed in a form of call of llvm.experimental....
LLVM_ABI SelectPatternFlavor getInverseMinMaxFlavor(SelectPatternFlavor SPF)
Return the inverse minimum/maximum flavor of the specified flavor.
constexpr unsigned MaxAnalysisRecursionDepth
LLVM_ABI void adjustKnownBitsForSelectArm(KnownBits &Known, Value *Cond, Value *Arm, bool Invert, const SimplifyQuery &Q, unsigned Depth=0)
Adjust Known for the given select Arm to include information from the select Cond.
LLVM_ABI bool isKnownNegative(const Value *V, const SimplifyQuery &SQ, unsigned Depth=0)
Returns true if the given value is known be negative (i.e.
LLVM_ABI OverflowResult computeOverflowForSignedSub(const Value *LHS, const Value *RHS, const SimplifyQuery &SQ)
SelectPatternFlavor
Specific patterns of select instructions we can match.
@ SPF_ABS
Floating point maxnum.
@ SPF_NABS
Absolute value.
@ SPF_FMAXNUM
Floating point minnum.
@ SPF_UMIN
Signed minimum.
@ SPF_UMAX
Signed maximum.
@ SPF_SMAX
Unsigned minimum.
@ SPF_UNKNOWN
@ SPF_FMINNUM
Unsigned maximum.
LLVM_ABI bool isIntrinsicReturningPointerAliasingArgumentWithoutCapturing(const CallBase *Call, bool MustPreserveNullness)
{launder,strip}.invariant.group returns pointer that aliases its argument, and it only captures point...
LLVM_ABI bool impliesPoison(const Value *ValAssumedPoison, const Value *V)
Return true if V is poison given that ValAssumedPoison is already poison.
LLVM_ABI void getHorizDemandedEltsForFirstOperand(unsigned VectorBitWidth, const APInt &DemandedElts, APInt &DemandedLHS, APInt &DemandedRHS)
Compute the demanded elements mask of horizontal binary operations.
LLVM_ABI SelectPatternResult getSelectPattern(CmpInst::Predicate Pred, SelectPatternNaNBehavior NaNBehavior=SPNB_NA, bool Ordered=false)
Determine the pattern for predicate X Pred Y ? X : Y.
FPClassTest
Floating-point class tests, supported by 'is_fpclass' intrinsic.
LLVM_ABI void computeKnownBits(const Value *V, KnownBits &Known, const DataLayout &DL, AssumptionCache *AC=nullptr, const Instruction *CxtI=nullptr, const DominatorTree *DT=nullptr, bool UseInstrInfo=true, unsigned Depth=0)
Determine which bits of V are known to be either zero or one and return them in the KnownZero/KnownOn...
LLVM_ABI bool programUndefinedIfPoison(const Instruction *Inst)
LLVM_ABI SelectPatternResult matchSelectPattern(Value *V, Value *&LHS, Value *&RHS, Instruction::CastOps *CastOp=nullptr, unsigned Depth=0)
Pattern match integer [SU]MIN, [SU]MAX and ABS idioms, returning the kind and providing the out param...
LLVM_ABI bool matchSimpleBinaryIntrinsicRecurrence(const IntrinsicInst *I, PHINode *&P, Value *&Init, Value *&OtherOp)
Attempt to match a simple value-accumulating recurrence of the form: llvm.intrinsic....
LLVM_ABI bool NullPointerIsDefined(const Function *F, unsigned AS=0)
Check whether null pointer dereferencing is considered undefined behavior for a given function or an ...
LLVM_ABI bool cannotBeNegativeZero(const Value *V, const SimplifyQuery &SQ, unsigned Depth=0)
Return true if we can prove that the specified FP value is never equal to -0.0.
LLVM_ABI bool programUndefinedIfUndefOrPoison(const Instruction *Inst)
Return true if this function can prove that if Inst is executed and yields a poison value or undef bi...
generic_gep_type_iterator<> gep_type_iterator
LLVM_ABI bool collectPossibleValues(const Value *V, SmallPtrSetImpl< const Constant * > &Constants, unsigned MaxCount, bool AllowUndefOrPoison=true)
Enumerates all possible immediate values of V and inserts them into the set Constants.
FunctionAddr VTableAddr Count
Definition InstrProf.h:139
LLVM_ABI uint64_t GetStringLength(const Value *V, unsigned CharSize=8)
If we can compute the length of the string pointed to by the specified pointer, return 'len+1'.
LLVM_ABI OverflowResult computeOverflowForSignedMul(const Value *LHS, const Value *RHS, const SimplifyQuery &SQ)
LLVM_ABI ConstantRange getVScaleRange(const Function *F, unsigned BitWidth)
Determine the possible constant range of vscale with the given bit width, based on the vscale_range f...
LLVM_ABI Constant * ConstantFoldCastOperand(unsigned Opcode, Constant *C, Type *DestTy, const DataLayout &DL)
Attempt to constant fold a cast with the specified operand.
LLVM_ABI bool canCreateUndefOrPoison(const Operator *Op, bool ConsiderFlagsAndMetadata=true)
canCreateUndefOrPoison returns true if Op can create undef or poison from non-undef & non-poison oper...
LLVM_ABI EHPersonality classifyEHPersonality(const Value *Pers)
See if the given exception handling personality function is one that we understand.
LLVM_ABI bool isKnownInversion(const Value *X, const Value *Y)
Return true iff:
bool isa(const From &Val)
isa<X> - Return true if the parameter to the template is an instance of one of the template type argu...
Definition Casting.h:547
LLVM_ABI bool intrinsicPropagatesPoison(Intrinsic::ID IID)
Return whether this intrinsic propagates poison for all operands.
LLVM_ABI bool isNotCrossLaneOperation(const Instruction *I)
Return true if the instruction doesn't potentially cross vector lanes.
LLVM_ABI bool isKnownNonZero(const Value *V, const SimplifyQuery &Q, unsigned Depth=0)
Return true if the given value is known to be non-zero when defined.
constexpr int PoisonMaskElem
LLVM_ABI RetainedKnowledge getKnowledgeValidInContext(const Value *V, ArrayRef< Attribute::AttrKind > AttrKinds, AssumptionCache &AC, const Instruction *CtxI, const DominatorTree *DT=nullptr)
Return a valid Knowledge associated to the Value V if its Attribute kind is in AttrKinds and the know...
LLVM_ABI bool isSafeToSpeculativelyExecuteWithOpcode(unsigned Opcode, const Instruction *Inst, const Instruction *CtxI=nullptr, AssumptionCache *AC=nullptr, const DominatorTree *DT=nullptr, const TargetLibraryInfo *TLI=nullptr, bool UseVariableInfo=true, bool IgnoreUBImplyingAttrs=true)
This returns the same result as isSafeToSpeculativelyExecute if Opcode is the actual opcode of Inst.
LLVM_ABI bool onlyUsedByLifetimeMarkers(const Value *V)
Return true if the only users of this pointer are lifetime markers.
LLVM_ABI Intrinsic::ID getIntrinsicForCallSite(const CallBase &CB, const TargetLibraryInfo *TLI)
Map a call instruction to an intrinsic ID.
@ Other
Any other memory.
Definition ModRef.h:68
@ First
Helpers to iterate all locations in the MemoryEffectsBase class.
Definition ModRef.h:74
LLVM_ABI const Value * getUnderlyingObjectAggressive(const Value *V)
Like getUnderlyingObject(), but will try harder to find a single underlying object.
LLVM_ABI Intrinsic::ID getMinMaxIntrinsic(SelectPatternFlavor SPF)
Convert given SPF to equivalent min/max intrinsic.
LLVM_ABI SelectPatternResult matchDecomposedSelectPattern(CmpInst *CmpI, Value *TrueVal, Value *FalseVal, Value *&LHS, Value *&RHS, FastMathFlags FMF=FastMathFlags(), Instruction::CastOps *CastOp=nullptr, unsigned Depth=0)
Determine the pattern that a select with the given compare as its predicate and given values as its t...
LLVM_ABI OverflowResult computeOverflowForSignedAdd(const WithCache< const Value * > &LHS, const WithCache< const Value * > &RHS, const SimplifyQuery &SQ)
LLVM_ABI bool propagatesPoison(const Use &PoisonOp)
Return true if PoisonOp's user yields poison or raises UB if its operand PoisonOp is poison.
@ Add
Sum of integers.
LLVM_ABI ConstantRange computeConstantRangeIncludingKnownBits(const WithCache< const Value * > &V, bool ForSigned, const SimplifyQuery &SQ)
Combine constant ranges from computeConstantRange() and computeKnownBits().
SelectPatternNaNBehavior
Behavior when a floating point min/max is given one NaN and one non-NaN as input.
@ SPNB_RETURNS_NAN
NaN behavior not applicable.
@ SPNB_RETURNS_OTHER
Given one NaN input, returns the NaN.
@ SPNB_RETURNS_ANY
Given one NaN input, returns the non-NaN.
LLVM_ABI bool isKnownNonEqual(const Value *V1, const Value *V2, const SimplifyQuery &SQ, unsigned Depth=0)
Return true if the given values are known to be non-equal when defined.
DWARFExpression::Operation Op
LLVM_ABI bool isGuaranteedNotToBeUndefOrPoison(const Value *V, AssumptionCache *AC=nullptr, const Instruction *CtxI=nullptr, const DominatorTree *DT=nullptr, unsigned Depth=0)
Return true if this function can prove that V does not have undef bits and is never poison.
ArrayRef(const T &OneElt) -> ArrayRef< T >
LLVM_ABI unsigned ComputeNumSignBits(const Value *Op, const DataLayout &DL, AssumptionCache *AC=nullptr, const Instruction *CxtI=nullptr, const DominatorTree *DT=nullptr, bool UseInstrInfo=true, unsigned Depth=0)
Return the number of times the sign bit of the register is replicated into the other bits.
constexpr unsigned BitWidth
LLVM_ABI KnownBits analyzeKnownBitsFromAndXorOr(const Operator *I, const KnownBits &KnownLHS, const KnownBits &KnownRHS, const SimplifyQuery &SQ, unsigned Depth=0)
Using KnownBits LHS/RHS produce the known bits for logic op (and/xor/or).
LLVM_ABI OverflowResult computeOverflowForUnsignedSub(const Value *LHS, const Value *RHS, const SimplifyQuery &SQ)
LLVM_ABI bool isGuaranteedToTransferExecutionToSuccessor(const Instruction *I)
Return true if this function can prove that the instruction I will always transfer execution to one o...
LLVM_ABI bool isKnownNeverInfOrNaN(const Value *V, const SimplifyQuery &SQ, unsigned Depth=0)
Return true if the floating-point value can never contain a NaN or infinity.
decltype(auto) cast(const From &Val)
cast<X> - Return the argument parameter cast to the specified type.
Definition Casting.h:559
LLVM_ABI bool isKnownNeverNaN(const Value *V, const SimplifyQuery &SQ, unsigned Depth=0)
Return true if the floating-point scalar value is not a NaN or if the floating-point vector value has...
gep_type_iterator gep_type_begin(const User *GEP)
LLVM_ABI Value * isBytewiseValue(Value *V, const DataLayout &DL)
If the specified value can be set by repeating the same byte in memory, return the i8 value that it i...
LLVM_ABI std::optional< std::pair< CmpPredicate, Constant * > > getFlippedStrictnessPredicateAndConstant(CmpPredicate Pred, Constant *C)
Convert an integer comparison with a constant RHS into an equivalent form with the strictness flipped...
LLVM_ABI unsigned ComputeMaxSignificantBits(const Value *Op, const DataLayout &DL, AssumptionCache *AC=nullptr, const Instruction *CxtI=nullptr, const DominatorTree *DT=nullptr, unsigned Depth=0)
Get the upper bound on bit size for this Value Op as a signed integer.
bool is_contained(R &&Range, const E &Element)
Returns true if Element is found in Range.
Definition STLExtras.h:1909
LLVM_ABI OverflowResult computeOverflowForUnsignedAdd(const WithCache< const Value * > &LHS, const WithCache< const Value * > &RHS, const SimplifyQuery &SQ)
unsigned Log2(Align A)
Returns the log2 of the alignment.
Definition Alignment.h:197
LLVM_ABI bool isKnownToBeAPowerOfTwo(const Value *V, const DataLayout &DL, bool OrZero=false, AssumptionCache *AC=nullptr, const Instruction *CxtI=nullptr, const DominatorTree *DT=nullptr, bool UseInstrInfo=true, unsigned Depth=0)
Return true if the given value is known to have exactly one bit set when defined.
LLVM_ABI std::optional< bool > isImpliedByDomCondition(const Value *Cond, const Instruction *ContextI, const DataLayout &DL)
Return the boolean condition value in the context of the given instruction if it is known based on do...
LLVM_ABI bool isGuaranteedNotToBePoison(const Value *V, AssumptionCache *AC=nullptr, const Instruction *CtxI=nullptr, const DominatorTree *DT=nullptr, unsigned Depth=0)
Returns true if V cannot be poison, but may be undef.
LLVM_ABI void computeKnownBitsFromRangeMetadata(const MDNode &Ranges, KnownBits &Known)
Compute known bits from the range metadata.
LLVM_ABI Value * FindInsertedValue(Value *V, ArrayRef< unsigned > idx_range, std::optional< BasicBlock::iterator > InsertBefore=std::nullopt)
Given an aggregate and an sequence of indices, see if the scalar value indexed is already around as a...
LLVM_ABI bool isKnownNegation(const Value *X, const Value *Y, bool NeedNSW=false, bool AllowPoison=true)
Return true if the two given values are negation.
LLVM_ABI const Value * getUnderlyingObject(const Value *V, unsigned MaxLookup=MaxLookupSearchDepth)
This method strips off any GEP address adjustments, pointer casts or llvm.threadlocal....
LLVM_ABI bool isKnownPositive(const Value *V, const SimplifyQuery &SQ, unsigned Depth=0)
Returns true if the given value is known be positive (i.e.
LLVM_ABI Constant * ConstantFoldIntegerCast(Constant *C, Type *DestTy, bool IsSigned, const DataLayout &DL)
Constant fold a zext, sext or trunc, depending on IsSigned and whether the DestTy is wider or narrowe...
LLVM_ABI bool isKnownNonNegative(const Value *V, const SimplifyQuery &SQ, unsigned Depth=0)
Returns true if the give value is known to be non-negative.
LLVM_ABI bool cannotBeOrderedLessThanZero(const Value *V, const SimplifyQuery &SQ, unsigned Depth=0)
Return true if we can prove that the specified FP value is either NaN or never less than -0....
LLVM_ABI void getUnderlyingObjects(const Value *V, SmallVectorImpl< const Value * > &Objects, const LoopInfo *LI=nullptr, unsigned MaxLookup=MaxLookupSearchDepth)
This method is similar to getUnderlyingObject except that it can look through phi and select instruct...
LLVM_ABI bool mayHaveNonDefUseDependency(const Instruction &I)
Returns true if the result or effects of the given instructions I depend values not reachable through...
LLVM_ABI bool isTriviallyVectorizable(Intrinsic::ID ID)
Identify if the intrinsic is trivially vectorizable.
LLVM_ABI bool isIdentifiedObject(const Value *V)
Return true if this pointer refers to a distinct and identifiable object.
LLVM_ABI std::optional< bool > isImpliedCondition(const Value *LHS, const Value *RHS, const DataLayout &DL, bool LHSIsTrue=true, unsigned Depth=0)
Return true if RHS is known to be implied true by LHS.
LLVM_ABI std::optional< bool > computeKnownFPSignBit(const Value *V, const SimplifyQuery &SQ, unsigned Depth=0)
Return false if we can prove that the specified FP value's sign bit is 0.
LLVM_ABI bool canIgnoreSignBitOfNaN(const Use &U)
Return true if the sign bit of the FP value can be ignored by the user when the value is NaN.
LLVM_ABI void findValuesAffectedByCondition(Value *Cond, bool IsAssume, function_ref< void(Value *)> InsertAffected)
Call InsertAffected on all Values whose known bits / value may be affected by the condition Cond.
void swap(llvm::BitVector &LHS, llvm::BitVector &RHS)
Implement std::swap in terms of BitVector swap.
Definition BitVector.h:872
This struct is a compact representation of a valid (non-zero power of two) alignment.
Definition Alignment.h:39
SmallPtrSet< Value *, 4 > AffectedValues
Represents offset+length into a ConstantDataArray.
const ConstantDataArray * Array
ConstantDataArray pointer.
Represent subnormal handling kind for floating point instruction inputs and outputs.
DenormalModeKind Input
Denormal treatment kind for floating point instruction inputs in the default floating-point environme...
constexpr bool outputsAreZero() const
Return true if output denormals should be flushed to 0.
@ PositiveZero
Denormals are flushed to positive zero.
@ IEEE
IEEE-754 denormal numbers preserved.
constexpr bool inputsAreZero() const
Return true if input denormals must be implicitly treated as 0.
DenormalModeKind Output
Denormal flushing mode for floating point instruction results in the default floating point environme...
static constexpr DenormalMode getIEEE()
InstrInfoQuery provides an interface to query additional information for instructions like metadata o...
bool isExact(const BinaryOperator *Op) const
MDNode * getMetadata(const Instruction *I, unsigned KindID) const
bool hasNoSignedZeros(const InstT *Op) const
bool hasNoSignedWrap(const InstT *Op) const
bool hasNoUnsignedWrap(const InstT *Op) const
static KnownBits makeConstant(const APInt &C)
Create known bits from a known constant.
Definition KnownBits.h:301
static LLVM_ABI KnownBits sadd_sat(const KnownBits &LHS, const KnownBits &RHS)
Compute knownbits resulting from llvm.sadd.sat(LHS, RHS)
static LLVM_ABI std::optional< bool > eq(const KnownBits &LHS, const KnownBits &RHS)
Determine if these known bits always give the same ICMP_EQ result.
KnownBits anyextOrTrunc(unsigned BitWidth) const
Return known bits for an "any" extension or truncation of the value we're tracking.
Definition KnownBits.h:186
static LLVM_ABI KnownBits mulhu(const KnownBits &LHS, const KnownBits &RHS)
Compute known bits from zero-extended multiply-hi.
unsigned countMinSignBits() const
Returns the number of times the sign bit is replicated into the other bits.
Definition KnownBits.h:255
static LLVM_ABI KnownBits smax(const KnownBits &LHS, const KnownBits &RHS)
Compute known bits for smax(LHS, RHS).
bool isNonNegative() const
Returns true if this value is known to be non-negative.
Definition KnownBits.h:108
LLVM_ABI KnownBits blsi() const
Compute known bits for X & -X, which has only the lowest bit set of X set.
void makeNonNegative()
Make this value non-negative.
Definition KnownBits.h:124
static LLVM_ABI KnownBits usub_sat(const KnownBits &LHS, const KnownBits &RHS)
Compute knownbits resulting from llvm.usub.sat(LHS, RHS)
unsigned countMinLeadingOnes() const
Returns the minimum number of leading one bits.
Definition KnownBits.h:251
unsigned countMinTrailingZeros() const
Returns the minimum number of trailing zero bits.
Definition KnownBits.h:242
static LLVM_ABI KnownBits ashr(const KnownBits &LHS, const KnownBits &RHS, bool ShAmtNonZero=false, bool Exact=false)
Compute known bits for ashr(LHS, RHS).
static LLVM_ABI KnownBits ssub_sat(const KnownBits &LHS, const KnownBits &RHS)
Compute knownbits resulting from llvm.ssub.sat(LHS, RHS)
static LLVM_ABI KnownBits urem(const KnownBits &LHS, const KnownBits &RHS)
Compute known bits for urem(LHS, RHS).
bool isUnknown() const
Returns true if we don't know any bits.
Definition KnownBits.h:66
unsigned countMaxTrailingZeros() const
Returns the maximum number of trailing zero bits possible.
Definition KnownBits.h:274
LLVM_ABI KnownBits blsmsk() const
Compute known bits for X ^ (X - 1), which has all bits up to and including the lowest set bit of X se...
void makeNegative()
Make this value negative.
Definition KnownBits.h:119
void setAllConflict()
Make all bits known to be both zero and one.
Definition KnownBits.h:99
KnownBits trunc(unsigned BitWidth) const
Return known bits for a truncation of the value we're tracking.
Definition KnownBits.h:161
KnownBits byteSwap() const
Definition KnownBits.h:514
bool hasConflict() const
Returns true if there is conflicting information.
Definition KnownBits.h:51
unsigned countMaxPopulation() const
Returns the maximum number of bits that could be one.
Definition KnownBits.h:289
void setAllZero()
Make all bits known to be zero and discard any previous information.
Definition KnownBits.h:86
KnownBits reverseBits() const
Definition KnownBits.h:518
unsigned getBitWidth() const
Get the bit width of this value.
Definition KnownBits.h:44
static LLVM_ABI KnownBits umax(const KnownBits &LHS, const KnownBits &RHS)
Compute known bits for umax(LHS, RHS).
KnownBits zext(unsigned BitWidth) const
Return known bits for a zero extension of the value we're tracking.
Definition KnownBits.h:172
bool isConstant() const
Returns true if we know the value of all bits.
Definition KnownBits.h:54
void resetAll()
Resets the known state of all bits.
Definition KnownBits.h:74
KnownBits unionWith(const KnownBits &RHS) const
Returns KnownBits information that is known to be true for either this or RHS or both.
Definition KnownBits.h:321
static LLVM_ABI KnownBits lshr(const KnownBits &LHS, const KnownBits &RHS, bool ShAmtNonZero=false, bool Exact=false)
Compute known bits for lshr(LHS, RHS).
bool isNonZero() const
Returns true if this value is known to be non-zero.
Definition KnownBits.h:111
KnownBits extractBits(unsigned NumBits, unsigned BitPosition) const
Return a subset of the known bits from [bitPosition,bitPosition+numBits).
Definition KnownBits.h:225
KnownBits intersectWith(const KnownBits &RHS) const
Returns KnownBits information that is known to be true for both this and RHS.
Definition KnownBits.h:311
KnownBits sext(unsigned BitWidth) const
Return known bits for a sign extension of the value we're tracking.
Definition KnownBits.h:180
unsigned countMinTrailingOnes() const
Returns the minimum number of trailing one bits.
Definition KnownBits.h:245
static KnownBits add(const KnownBits &LHS, const KnownBits &RHS, bool NSW=false, bool NUW=false)
Compute knownbits resulting from addition of LHS and RHS.
Definition KnownBits.h:347
KnownBits zextOrTrunc(unsigned BitWidth) const
Return known bits for a zero extension or truncation of the value we're tracking.
Definition KnownBits.h:196
unsigned countMinLeadingZeros() const
Returns the minimum number of leading zero bits.
Definition KnownBits.h:248
APInt getMaxValue() const
Return the maximal unsigned value possible given these KnownBits.
Definition KnownBits.h:145
static LLVM_ABI KnownBits smin(const KnownBits &LHS, const KnownBits &RHS)
Compute known bits for smin(LHS, RHS).
static LLVM_ABI KnownBits mulhs(const KnownBits &LHS, const KnownBits &RHS)
Compute known bits from sign-extended multiply-hi.
static LLVM_ABI KnownBits srem(const KnownBits &LHS, const KnownBits &RHS)
Compute known bits for srem(LHS, RHS).
static LLVM_ABI KnownBits udiv(const KnownBits &LHS, const KnownBits &RHS, bool Exact=false)
Compute known bits for udiv(LHS, RHS).
APInt getMinValue() const
Return the minimal unsigned value possible given these KnownBits.
Definition KnownBits.h:129
static LLVM_ABI KnownBits computeForAddSub(bool Add, bool NSW, bool NUW, const KnownBits &LHS, const KnownBits &RHS)
Compute known bits resulting from adding LHS and RHS.
Definition KnownBits.cpp:60
static LLVM_ABI KnownBits sdiv(const KnownBits &LHS, const KnownBits &RHS, bool Exact=false)
Compute known bits for sdiv(LHS, RHS).
static bool haveNoCommonBitsSet(const KnownBits &LHS, const KnownBits &RHS)
Return true if LHS and RHS have no common bits set.
Definition KnownBits.h:326
bool isNegative() const
Returns true if this value is known to be negative.
Definition KnownBits.h:105
static KnownBits sub(const KnownBits &LHS, const KnownBits &RHS, bool NSW=false, bool NUW=false)
Compute knownbits resulting from subtraction of LHS and RHS.
Definition KnownBits.h:353
unsigned countMaxLeadingZeros() const
Returns the maximum number of leading zero bits possible.
Definition KnownBits.h:280
void setAllOnes()
Make all bits known to be one and discard any previous information.
Definition KnownBits.h:92
void insertBits(const KnownBits &SubBits, unsigned BitPosition)
Insert the bits from a smaller known bits starting at bitPosition.
Definition KnownBits.h:219
static LLVM_ABI KnownBits uadd_sat(const KnownBits &LHS, const KnownBits &RHS)
Compute knownbits resulting from llvm.uadd.sat(LHS, RHS)
static LLVM_ABI KnownBits mul(const KnownBits &LHS, const KnownBits &RHS, bool NoUndefSelfMultiply=false)
Compute known bits resulting from multiplying LHS and RHS.
KnownBits anyext(unsigned BitWidth) const
Return known bits for an "any" extension of the value we're tracking, where we don't know anything ab...
Definition KnownBits.h:167
LLVM_ABI KnownBits abs(bool IntMinIsPoison=false) const
Compute known bits for the absolute value.
static LLVM_ABI std::optional< bool > sgt(const KnownBits &LHS, const KnownBits &RHS)
Determine if these known bits always give the same ICMP_SGT result.
static LLVM_ABI std::optional< bool > uge(const KnownBits &LHS, const KnownBits &RHS)
Determine if these known bits always give the same ICMP_UGE result.
static LLVM_ABI KnownBits shl(const KnownBits &LHS, const KnownBits &RHS, bool NUW=false, bool NSW=false, bool ShAmtNonZero=false)
Compute known bits for shl(LHS, RHS).
static LLVM_ABI KnownBits umin(const KnownBits &LHS, const KnownBits &RHS)
Compute known bits for umin(LHS, RHS).
KnownBits sextOrTrunc(unsigned BitWidth) const
Return known bits for a sign extension or truncation of the value we're tracking.
Definition KnownBits.h:206
FPClassTest KnownFPClasses
Floating-point classes the value could be one of.
bool isKnownNeverInfinity() const
Return true if it's known this can never be an infinity.
bool cannotBeOrderedGreaterThanZero() const
Return true if we can prove that the analyzed floating-point value is either NaN or never greater tha...
static constexpr FPClassTest OrderedGreaterThanZeroMask
static constexpr FPClassTest OrderedLessThanZeroMask
void knownNot(FPClassTest RuleOut)
void copysign(const KnownFPClass &Sign)
bool isKnownNeverSubnormal() const
Return true if it's known this can never be a subnormal.
LLVM_ABI bool isKnownNeverLogicalZero(DenormalMode Mode) const
Return true if it's know this can never be interpreted as a zero.
bool isUnknown() const
bool isKnownNeverNegInfinity() const
Return true if it's known this can never be -infinity.
bool isKnownNeverNegSubnormal() const
Return true if it's known this can never be a negative subnormal.
bool isKnownNeverPosZero() const
Return true if it's known this can never be a literal positive zero.
std::optional< bool > SignBit
std::nullopt if the sign bit is unknown, true if the sign bit is definitely set or false if the sign ...
bool isKnownNeverNaN() const
Return true if it's known this can never be a nan.
bool isKnownNever(FPClassTest Mask) const
Return true if it's known this can never be one of the mask entries.
bool isKnownNeverNegZero() const
Return true if it's known this can never be a negative zero.
void propagateNaN(const KnownFPClass &Src, bool PreserveSign=false)
bool cannotBeOrderedLessThanZero() const
Return true if we can prove that the analyzed floating-point value is either NaN or never less than -...
void signBitMustBeOne()
Assume the sign bit is one.
LLVM_ABI void propagateCanonicalizingSrc(const KnownFPClass &Src, DenormalMode Mode)
Report known classes if Src is evaluated through a potentially canonicalizing operation.
void signBitMustBeZero()
Assume the sign bit is zero.
LLVM_ABI bool isKnownNeverLogicalPosZero(DenormalMode Mode) const
Return true if it's know this can never be interpreted as a positive zero.
bool isKnownNeverPosInfinity() const
Return true if it's known this can never be +infinity.
LLVM_ABI bool isKnownNeverLogicalNegZero(DenormalMode Mode) const
Return true if it's know this can never be interpreted as a negative zero.
bool isKnownNeverPosSubnormal() const
Return true if it's known this can never be a positive subnormal.
Represent one information held inside an operand bundle of an llvm.assume.
SelectPatternFlavor Flavor
static bool isMinOrMax(SelectPatternFlavor SPF)
When implementing this min/max pattern as fcmp; select, does the fcmp have to be ordered?
const DataLayout & DL
SimplifyQuery getWithoutCondContext() const
const Instruction * CxtI
const DominatorTree * DT
SimplifyQuery getWithInstruction(const Instruction *I) const
AssumptionCache * AC
const DomConditionCache * DC
const InstrInfoQuery IIQ
const CondContext * CC